IE1-0063 rev 1.0 INS..
Galaxy Dimension
Installer Manual
Honeywell Security
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Table of Contents
Contents
INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................... 1-1
Variants ................................................................................................................ 1-1
SECTION 1: QUICK SETUP .................................................................... 1-3
SECTION 2: SYSTEM ARCHTECTURE .................................................. 2-1
PCB Layout .......................................................................................................... 2-2
RS485 Expansion Module (GD-520 only) ......................................................... 2-3
System Installation and Wiring ......................................................................... 2-4
Connecting the Galaxy Dimension to the PSTN.............................................. 2-5
Connecting Additional Telecom Apparatus .......................................................................... 2-6
Line Monitoring .................................................................................................................... 2-6
Stand-by Battery ................................................................................................. 2-7
Battery Start-up ..................................................................................................................... 2-7
On-Board Power Supply Unit............................................................................. 2-7
Memory ................................................................................................................ 2-8
RS485 Data Communication Bus (AB Lines) ................................................... 2-8
RS485 Wiring Configurations ............................................................................ 2-8
RS485 Wiring Recommendations ..................................................................... 2-9
Zones ................................................................................................................. 2-11
Zone Addresses ................................................................................................................ 2-11
Wiring Zones ..................................................................................................................... 2-13
Wiring Multiple Detectors ................................................................................ 2-15
Wiring Keyswitches ............................................................................................................ 2-15
Wiring Terminator Buttons .................................................................................................. 2-16
Outputs .............................................................................................................. 2-16
Output Applications ......................................................................................... 2-17
Trigger Header .................................................................................................. 2-18
Trig 1-6 ............................................................................................................................... 2-18
Supply ................................................................................................................................ 2-18
SPI Header ......................................................................................................... 2-19
SECTION 3: PERIPHERALS ................................................................... 3-1
General................................................................................................................. 3-1
Wiring ................................................................................................................... 3-1
i
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Table of Contents
Configuring ......................................................................................................... 3-1
Addressing........................................................................................................................... 3-1
Connecting the RIO .............................................................................................................. 3-2
Configuring the RIO .............................................................................................................. 3-2
RIO Outputs .......................................................................................................................... 3-3
RF RIO .................................................................................................................. 3-4
Connecting the RF RIO ........................................................................................................ 3-4
Addressing the RF RIO ........................................................................................................ 3-5
RF RIO Programming .......................................................................................................... 3-6
Configuring the RF RIO ........................................................................................................ 3-6
Power Supply Unit .............................................................................................. 3-7
Configuration ........................................................................................................................ 3-7
Installation Instructions ......................................................................................................... 3-8
Battery .................................................................................................................................. 3-9
Battery Test ........................................................................................................................... 3-9
Specifications ....................................................................................................................... 3-9
EN50131 Compliance ......................................................................................................... 3-9
Printer Interface Module .................................................................................. 3-10
ISDN Module ...................................................................................................... 3-11
Programming the ISDN Module ......................................................................................... 3-11
Ethernet Module ............................................................................................... 3-12
Configuring the Ethernet Module ....................................................................................... 3-12
Ethernet Communication ................................................................................................... 3-12
Galaxy Dimension and 2-Way Audio .............................................................. 3-13
Introduction......................................................................................................................... 3-13
Audio Interface Module ...................................................................................................... 3-13
MUX Module ...................................................................................................................... 3-15
Remote Servicing Suite.................................................................................... 3-17
User Management Suite ................................................................................... 3-17
SECTION 4: KEYPADS ........................................................................... 4-1
The Galaxy Mk7 Keypad/KeyProx..................................................................... 4-1
General ................................................................................................................................ 4-1
Power Consumption ............................................................................................................ 4-1
Wiring the Keypad/KeyProx ................................................................................................. 4-2
Keypad/KeyProx Installation Procedure............................................................................... 4-2
Self Diagnostics.................................................................................................................... 4-5
Keypad/KeyProx Operation ................................................................................................. 4-5
The Galaxy KeyProx ........................................................................................... 4-8
General ................................................................................................................................ 4-8
Addressing........................................................................................................................... 4-8
ii
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Table of Contents
Operation ............................................................................................................................. 4-8
Card Types........................................................................................................................... 4-8
The Galaxy Dimension TouchCenter................................................................ 4-9
General ................................................................................................................................ 4-9
TouchCenter Installation Procedure ..................................................................................... 4-9
Configuring a TouchCenter ................................................................................................ 4-10
Set-up Menu ...................................................................................................................... 4-10
TouchCenter - Operation ................................................................................................... 4-11
Specifications ..................................................................................................................... 4-11
SECTION 5: ACCESS CONTROL ........................................................... 5-1
Group Based Access Control ............................................................................ 5-1
User and Access Templates .............................................................................. 5-1
Time Schedules .................................................................................................. 5-1
Door Control Module .......................................................................................... 5-2
MAX3 .................................................................................................................... 5-7
SECTION 6: SYSTEM OPERATION ........................................................ 6-1
Menu Options ...................................................................................................... 6-1
General ................................................................................................................................ 6-1
The Full Menu ...................................................................................................................... 6-1
The Quick Menu .................................................................................................................. 6-1
Menu Access ....................................................................................................................... 6-1
Engineer Mode .................................................................................................................... 6-2
Setting Options ................................................................................................... 6-5
Setting the System Using a PIN ............................................................................................ 6-5
Cancelling the Setting .......................................................................................................... 6-5
Unsetting the System Using a PIN ........................................................................................ 6-6
Engineer Unsetting .............................................................................................................. 6-6
Keyswitch Setting Options .................................................................................................... 6-6
Setting the System with Cards/Tags/Fobs ............................................................................ 6-6
Cancelling and Resetting Alarms and Alerts ........................................................................ 6-7
Recording of Events ............................................................................................................. 6-7
Overriding of Faults and Tampers ........................................................................................ 6-8
Setting Features ................................................................................................................... 6-8
Menu Options 11-19 ......................................................................................... 6-11
Option 11 – Omit Zones (Quick Menu Option 0) .............................................................. 6-11
Option 12 – Timed Set ....................................................................................................... 6-13
Option 13 – Part Set ........................................................................................................... 6-13
Option 14 – Forced Set (Quick Menu Option 1) ................................................................ 6-13
Option 15 – Chime (Quick Menu Option 2) ....................................................................... 6-13
iii
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Table of Contents
Option 16 – Instant Set ....................................................................................................... 6-13
Option 17 – Silent Part ....................................................................................................... 6-14
Option 18 – Home Set ....................................................................................................... 6-14
Option 19 – All Set .............................................................................................................. 6-14
Display Options ................................................................................................ 6-15
Option 21 – Display Zones (Quick Menu Option 3) ........................................................... 6-15
Option 22 – Display Log (Quick Menu Option 4) ............................................................... 6-16
Option 23 – System ............................................................................................................ 6-17
Option 24 – Print (Quick Menu Option 5) ........................................................................... 6-18
Option 25 – Access Doors ................................................................................................. 6-19
Test Options ...................................................................................................... 6-23
Option 31 – Walk Test (Quick Menu Option 6) ................................................................... 6-23
Option 32 – Outputs ........................................................................................................... 6-25
Modify Options ................................................................................................. 6-26
Option 41 – Time/Date (Quick Menu Option 7) ................................................................. 6-26
Option 42 – Codes (Quick Menu Option 8) ....................................................................... 6-27
Option 43 – Summer (Quick Menu Option 9) .................................................................... 6-38
Option 44 – Trace .............................................................................................................. 6-38
Option 45 – Timer Control .................................................................................................. 6-39
Option 46 – Group Omit ..................................................................................................... 6-43
Option 47 – Remote Access .............................................................................................. 6-44
Option 48 – Engineer access ............................................................................................ 6-50
Engineer 1 ......................................................................................................... 6-51
Option 51 – Parameters ..................................................................................................... 6-51
Option 52 – Program Zones .............................................................................................. 6-71
Option 53 – Program Outputs ............................................................................................ 6-87
Option 54 – Links .............................................................................................................6-104
Option 55 – Soak .............................................................................................................6-107
Option 56 – Communications .......................................................................................... 6-108
Option 57 – System Print ..................................................................................................6-151
Option 58 – Keypad ......................................................................................................... 6-152
Option 59 – Quick Menu ..................................................................................................6-155
Engineer 2 ....................................................................................................... 6-156
Option 61 – Diagnostics ................................................................................................... 6-156
Option 62 – Full Test ........................................................................................................6-159
Option 63 – Options .........................................................................................................6-160
Option 64 – Assemble Zone ............................................................................................6-164
Option 65 – Timers ..........................................................................................................6-168
Option 66 – Pre-checks ................................................................................................... 6-175
Option 67 – Remote Reset .............................................................................................. 6-176
Option 68 – Menu Access ...............................................................................................6-177
Option 69 – Integrated Access Control ............................................................................ 6-178
iv
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Table of Contents
Engineer 3 ....................................................................................................... 6-192
Option 71 – SPI Key .........................................................................................................6-192
Appendix A: Library .............................................................................. A-1
Appendix B: SIA and Contact ID Event Codes .................................... B-1
Appendix C: SIA Event Structure ........................................................ C-1
Appendix D: Event Log Messages ....................................................... D-1
Appendix E: Site Data Storage ..............................................................E-1
Preparing for Storage Mode ..............................................................................E-1
Enabling Storage Mode .....................................................................................E-1
Using Storage Mode ...........................................................................................E-2
Leaving Storage Mode .......................................................................................E-2
Appendix F: Specifications ................................................................... F-1
Panel Specifications...........................................................................................F-1
Appendix G: Declaration of Conformity .............................................. G-1
Compliance and Approvals .............................................................................. G-1
EN50131 Compliance......................................................................................... G-2
PD6662 Compliance........................................................................................... G-2
Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) approval .................................. G-2
Appendix H: Parts List Index................................................................ H-1
Index ..................................................................................................Index-1
v
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Table of Contents
vi
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Introduction
INTRODUCTION
This manual gives full instructions required to install and program a Galaxy Dimension control panel and
associated peripherals.
Variants
The Galaxy Dimension is available in four variants: GD- 48, GD-96, GD-264 and GD-520. The differences
between each variant are shown in the following table:
Features
GD-48
GD-96
GD-264
GD-520
Zones
16-48
16-96
16-264
16-520
Outputs (400mA)
8-24
8-48
8-132
8-260
6
6
6
6
2.5A
2.5A
2.5A
2.5A
RS485 Databuses
1
2
2
4
Telecom onboard
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
RS232 Interface for online PC
RS232
RS232
RS232
RS232
Printer Interface
RS232
RS232
RS232
RS232
Ethernet option
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
3rd Party
3rd Party
3rd Party
3rd Party
Groups
8
16
32
32
Keypads
8
16
16
32
Keyprox
3
7
7
24
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
DCM's with 2 x wiegand
interfaces
4
16
16
32
DCM Controlled doors
8
32
32
64
Bus mounted prox readers
(MAX)
4
16
16
32
Access control groups (user
templates)
50
50
100
100
Weekly Timer Schedules
19
35
67
67
Annual Holiday Schedules
16
32
32
32
Users
100
250
999
999
Links
64
128
256
256
Remote software update
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Upload/Download
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Remote service
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Network downloader
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Alarm monitoring
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Graphics mimic
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
1
2
2
4
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Trigger Outputs on Flying Lead
(100mA)
PSU
GPRS option
Multi-user
TouchCenter
Mimic panel
Wireless
Ademco 5800 Ademco 5800
Audio Verification Channels
SMS
Ademco 5800 Ademco 5800
8
16
32
32
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Table 1-1. Galaxy Dimension General Specification
1-1
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
1-2
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Quick Setup
SECTION 1: QUICK SETUP
To quickly set up a Galaxy Dimension control panel for programming follow these simple steps:
1. Connect a 1k Ω (1%) resistor across each of the zones on the panel and any RIO’s (if connected).
2. Ensure that the tamper return loop — the terminals marked as AUX TAMP/GND on the PCB — is a
complete loop.
3. Connect a keypad to the AB LINE terminals on the control panel.
Control Panel
(Line 1)
Keypad
B1
B
A1
A
-
-
+12V
+
Table 1-2. Terminal Connections
4. Connect a 680 Ω End Of Line (EOL) resistor across the A and B terminals of the keypad.
5. Ensure that the keypad is fitted to the wall (see Keypad Installation Procedure, Section 4).
6. Connect the battery before replacing the control panel lid.
7. Connect the mains wiring to the control panel. Do not switch the mains ON.
8. Replace the control panel lid and secure the fastening screws.
9. Switch on the mains voltage (230 Va.c. / 50 Hz).
10. The following sequence of events occur:
• the keypad buzzer and control panel horn (if fitted) activate for 10 - 20 seconds,
• flashing
is displayed on the keypad,
• the sounders stop and the keypad displays become blank,
• the green power LED lights and the following displays on the keypad
Configuring
Please Wait
•
the default banner is then displayed on the keypad.
GALAXY <XXX> <VY.YY>
01:01
SUN 01 JAN
where:
XXX is the panel type
Y.YY is the panel software revision
11. The system is now ready to be programmed. Refer to Section 6 System Operation for programming details.
12. Default User code is 12345
Default Engineer code is 112233
1-3
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
1-4
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Configuration
SECTION 2: SYSTEM ARCHTECTURE
16 zones on board
PSTN (comm 1)
on board
telecom
Trigger
area
Header
Galaxy
Line
1
Audio Interface
Module (1)
Line
2
Line
3
8 outputs
on board
plus 6 outputs
on trigger header
Line
4
RS232
Serial Port
(comm 6)
Lines 2, 3 and 4 have
the same configuration
RS485 line
Cable run 1 km (max)
* NOTE:
*Keypads
Valid addresses for the
keyprox are:
Line 1 (0, 1 & 2).
Line 2 (0, 1, 2, & 3 ).
This sets the address for both
the keypad and card reader
parts of the keyprox.
CP027/
Keyprox
CP028
Touch
Center
CP040
*Keypads
CP027/
Keyprox
CP028
* Certain keypad and
max addresses can
be replaced by a
combined keyprox unit.
4 outputs
RIO
C072
NOTE:
RIOs, RF RIO's and
PSU's can be mixed on
the lines.
Touch
Center
CP040
8 zones
OR
4 outputs
*Max
MX03
Smart PSU
P015
*Max
OR
MX03
8 zones
OR
4 outputs
Power Unit P025
or
Power RIO P026
OR
DCM
C080/81
DCM
C080/81
8 zones
OR
RF RIO Module
C076
4 outputs
RIO
C072
8 zones
NOTE:
The Telecom, Printer Interface,
RS232, Ethernet and ISDN
modules can only be
connected to line 1.
If a Telecom module is attached,
keypad address E cannot be
connected to line 1(address E is
shown as 18 on the system).
If an RS232 module is attached,
keypad address D cannot be
connected to line 1 (address D is
shown as 17 on the system).
If an Ethernet module is attached,
keypad address B cannot be
connected to line 1 (address B is
shown as 15 on the system).
If an ISDN module is attached,
keypad address C cannot be
connected to line 1 (address C is
shown as 16 on the system).
OR
Telecom Module
E062 (comm 5)
4 outputs
Smart PSU
P015
8 zones
RS232 Module
E054 (comm 2)
OR
4 outputs
Power Unit P025
or
Power RIO P026
ISDN Module
E077 (comm 3)
8 zones
OR
Twisted Pair
Screened Cable
RF RIO Module
C076
Ethernet Module
E080 (comm 4)
Printer Interface
A134/A161
GD-48
GD-96
GD-264
GD-520
Lines
1
2
2
4
Keypads
8
8 per line
8 per line
8 per line
Keyproxes
3
3 (line 1)
4 (line 2)
3 (line 1)
4 (line 2)
3 (line 1)
7 (lines 2, 3, 4)
Touch Center
1
1 per line
1 per line
1 per line
MAX's
4
8 per line
8 per line
8 per line
DCM's
4
8 per line
8 per line
8 per line
RIO's/PSU's
4
4 (line 1)
6 (line 2)
15 (line 1)
15 (line 1)
16 (line 2) 16 (lines 2, 3, 4)
Figure 2-1. Galaxy Dimension System Configuration
2-1
RS232 Port
RS485 line 2
RS485 line 1
+12V
GND
2-2
Figure 2-2. PCB Layout
NOTE:
RTS
CTS
RX
TX
+12V
GND
0V
2
3
0V
F4
4
+12V
6
5
0V
RIO 0
RS232 Port socket
AUX1
Fuse AUX3 controls an independent
12V output which can be used for a
communicator or screw.
Fuse AUX2 controls
RS485 line 2, RIO 1 (zones 1-8)
7
8
1
0V
2
AUX2
3
Trigger
Header
0V
+12V
RIO 1
FLASH
RAM1
5
0V
6
7
0V
8
+12V
MICRO
PROCESSOR
Expansion card
interface
Zones 1-8 (RIO 1 line 1 (switch SW3-8 OFF))
OR
Zones 1-8 (RIO 1 line 0 (switch SW3-8 ON))
Zones 1-8 (RIO 0 line 1)
4
F3
Memory
backup
battery
16 on-board zones
+12V
NOTE:
0V
Engineer socket
(RS485 Line 2)
LED2 (for RS232)
LED1(for Telecoms)
LK5 RS485 line 1, 680 9 termination
Engineer socket
(RS485 Line1)
Fuse AUX1 controls
RS485 line 1, RIO 0 (zones 1-8)
1
Debug
Header
LK3 RS485 line 2, 680 9 termination
SKT2
Telecom
Socket
1
ON
1
4
5
6 7
8
RIO 0
Relay
Output
2
N/O C N/C
2 3
Pull-up switches
3
4
RIO
SWITCH
AUX3
LK4
2 3
RIO 1
F2
4
LK2
AUX G
N
TAMP D
F1
External
loudspeaker
Horn output
volume control
AUX3
1
OFF WALL
TAMPER
BATTERY
START UP
BATT
Telecom
Connect
B2 A2
SW3
B1 A1
AC
14.5
+BAT
-BAT
LID
TAMP
LINE PHONE
B A B A
+12V
SPI
Program
Header
Battery
terminals
Leads for
lid tamper
microswitch
Jumper Lead
for off-wall
tamper switch
PCB Layout
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
PCB Layout
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
RS485 Expansion Module
The 7 transistorised outputs on the Galaxy Dimension can be configured to open collectors by setting the dip
switch SW3 to the OFF position.
NOTE: Output 2 on RIO 0 (relay output) is not affected.This is a form C relay that can switch up to 1 amp
at 24 volts DC.
The following table shows which outputs are controlled by which switches.
(SW3)
RIO
Output
1
0
1
2
0
3
3
0
4
4
1
1
5
1
2
6
1
3
7
1
4
Table 2-1. SW3 Transistorised Outputs Control
RS485 Expansion Module (GD-520 only)
The RS485 Expansion Module is attached to the GD-520 to give 2 extra RS485 (AB) lines.
This module can also be added to a GD-264 to convert it into a GD-520. Jumpers LK1 and LK2 can be
removed to disable the on-board end-of-line resistors.
SKT2
LINE PHONE
B A B A
B1 A1
RS485
EXPANSION
MODULE
GND
+12V
B2 A2
Jumpers
AC
GND
ON
TX
LK1
CTS
RTS
1
0V
2
3
0V
4
+12V
6
5
0V
RIO 0
7
0V
8
+12V
1
0V
2
1
2 3
4
5
6 7
8
-BAT
Twin
RS485
lines
+BAT
14.5
A3 B3 A4 B4
3
0V
4
+12V
RIO 1
5
0V
6
N/O C N/C
7
0V
8
+12V
1
3
2
RIO 0
Figure 2-3. RS485 Expansion Module
2-3
4
+12V
RX
LK2
LID
TAMP
F1
+12V
1
2 3
RIO 1
4
AUX G
N
TAMP D
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Installation Recommendations
System Installation and Wiring
The installation and wiring must be performed by a competent engineer. For permanently connected equipment, a readily accessible disconnect device must be incorporated in the fixed wiring. The Galaxy Dimension
control panel must be connected to the a.c. mains supply (230/240 Va.c. 50 Hz) via a fused connection outlet
in accordance with EN60950-1: 2001
The fuse in the mains outlet must not exceed 3A.
WARNING:
A means of isolation from the mains supply must be provided within 2 metres of
the control panel. Where live and neutral supplies can be identified, a fused spur
with a 3 amp fuse, must be fitted on the live circuit. Where live and neutral circuits
cannot be reliably identified, 3 amp fuses must be fitted to both circuits.
Route the mains cable through the hole on the right hand side of the enclosure base. Securely anchor the
cable to the box using the tie-wrap as shown in the following Figure:
AC connect
Keyhole
slot (top)
Mains
transformer
PCB
Earth wire
Terminal
block
Enclosure
base
Mains cable
Tie wrap
Attaching hole
Attaching hole
Figure 2-4. Securing the Mains Cable to the Enclosure Base
Secure the panel base to the wall using three 1.5" No. 8 round head steel screws through the holes provided.
The mains cable used must be a three core type (with green/yellow earth insulation) of adequate current
carrying capacity.
Connect the mains cable to the mains terminal block as follows:
•
blue wire to the terminal marked N (Neutral)
•
green/yellow wire to the terminal marked (Earth)
•
brown wire to the terminal marked L (Live)
NOTE: No other connections to the mains connector are permitted.
All wiring must be in accordance with local regulations and the installation must conform to EN60950.
2-4
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
System Wiring
Connecting the Galaxy Dimension to the PSTN
The Telecommunications Network Voltage (TNV) port (terminals A and B on PCB) must be permanently
connected (hard-wired) to the PSTN via a master socket, refer to Figure 2-5.
Telecom
Socket
RJ11
Plug
LINE PHONE
Master socket
Incoming
PSTN Line
B A B A
Secondary socket
line 2
line 1
line 1
line 2
Figure 2-5. Connecting the Galaxy Dimension to the PSTN
NOTES:
1.
Terminals 1 and 2 on the Master Socket must be hard-wired to LINE A and B
terminals on the Galaxy Dimension PCB. The connection is polarity independent.
2.
It is strongly recommended that the Galaxy Dimension panel is the only device on the line.
3.
If another device is to be connected to the line, connect the PHONE terminals on the PCB
to terminals 1 and 2 on a Secondary socket.
There are two methods of connecting the on-board Telecom Module to the PSTN:
Method 1
Using cable suitable for connection to 2.8 mm diameter screw terminals, strip back approximately 20 mm of
the outer sheath and then remove approximately 4 mm of the insulation from the wires to be connected to the
Galaxy Dimension PCB.
Connect terminals 1 and 2 on the Master socket across the LINE A and B terminals on the Galaxy Dimension
PCB, see Figure 2-5.
Method 2
Use a standard cable with RJ11 plug on one end and plug into the telecom socket on the Galaxy Dimension
PCB. Connect the other end of the cable to the Master socket as described in Method 1.
NOTE: Digital Subscriber Line (DSL) should not be used. If it is used, connect a suitable filter to the phone
line.
2-5
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
System Wiring (cont’d)
Connecting Additional Telecom Apparatus
A secondary socket, allows additional telecom apparatus to be connected in series with the on-board telecom
module. Connect the PHONE terminals A and B on the PCB to the terminals on the secondary socket. See
Figure 2-5.
Line Monitoring
Under normal idle state conditions, the on-board Telecom Module monitors the PSTN line. The communication status is indicated by the state of the red LED (LED1) as shown in the following table:
LED STATE
INDICATION
LED OFF
No d.c. supply
ON - 01s, OFF - 0.9s
Normal Communication
Single pulse at end of call
Normal Communication
Flashing at end of alarm call
Failed Communication
On during alarm monitoring,
Remote Servicing and SMS
Flickering during alarm monitoring,
Remote servicing and SMS
Normal Communication
Poor Communication
Flashes in time with ringing signal
Line Ringing
Pulses as each digit is dialled
Normal indication when
making call
Table 2-2. Comms Status
2-6
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Stand-by Battery
Stand-by Battery
The Galaxy Dimension control panels can accommodate up to 2 x 17 Ah batteries. Ensure that the battery
connector leads on the control panel Powers Supply Unit (PSU) are connected to the correct terminals on the
battery.
CAUTION:
There is a risk of explosion if the battery is replaced by an incorrect type.
Dispose of used batteries according to the instructions.
Control Panel
Battery
-BAT
-ve terminal
+BAT
+ve terminal
Table 2-3. Battery/Control Panel connections
Battery Start-up
The system can be powered up via the Battery Start-up jumper if there is no AC power. To do this, short
out the Battery Start-up jumper for the duration of the configuration process only. Never leave the Battery
Start-up connected or else deep discharge of the Stand-by Battery will occur.
On-Board Power Supply Unit
The on-board Power Supply Unit (PSU) supplies and monitors power to the system and peripherals. The
following table shows the fuse name and value in amps.
The Galaxy Dimension control panel contains four fuses. Details are given in the following table.
FUSE NAME
VALUE (AMPS)
PROTECTS
TYPE
AUX1
1.0
RS485 Line 1, RIO 0, Zones 1-8: +12V,
on-board comms
20 mm, anti-surge
AUX2
1.0
RS485 Line 2, RIO 1, zones 1-8 +12V
20 mm, anti-surge
AUX3
1.0
+12V AUX3 terminal
20 mm, anti-surge
BATT
1.6
Battery
20 mm, anti-surge
Table 2-4. On-board PSU Fuses
Power Monitoring Characteristics:
Low battery level: 11.2V
Deep discharge protection: 10.5V
Overvoltage protection: 14.7V
The PSU total capacity is 2.5A. Internally the PSU is split in two in order to ensure sufficient current is always
available for stand-by battery recharge. The PSU capacity is broken down as follows:
•
•
•
Battery:
Control PCB:
AUX +12V:
1.25A
0.25A
1.00A
The PSU is available for zones/outputs and peripherals.
2-7
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Memory
Memory
The Galaxy Dimension control panel is fitted with a memory chip with its own battery backup on the main
PCB. This allows the panel to retain the system configuration, programming details and the event log for up to
a year when both the mains power and standby battery have been disconnected. The memory backup battery
must be kept in place to retain the memory during a mains failure. Re-apply power, this is known as a warm
start.
To completely erase the system memory and return to the default settings, place a piece of thin card between
the retaining clip and the memory backup battery then remove all power to the PCB for one minute. Re-apply
power and remove the card. This is known as a cold start.
The memory backup battery shoud be replaced every 5 years.
CAUTION:
There is a risk of explosion if the battery is replaced by an incorrect type.
Dispose of used batteries according to the instructions.
CAUTION:
Do not overstress the retaining clip when removing and installing the backup
battery. The clip must maintain a firm pressure on the backup battery at all times.
RS485 Data Communication Bus (AB Lines)
Communication between the Galaxy control panels and the modules attached to the system takes place on the
AB lines. The communication protocol is RS 485 format. The control panel constantly monitors the modules
attached to it. A break in the communication from any of the modules generates a module tamper alarm
RS485 Wiring Configurations
The system must be wired in a daisy-chain configuration. That is the A line from the previous module is
connected to the A terminal of the current module and then on to the A line of the next module.
The RS485 (AB) line must have a 680 Ω resistor fitted across the A and B terminals of the last module on the
line. If two lines are connected, both ends must be terminated with 680 Ω resistors and the appropriate link
(LK3 or LK5) removed.
Galaxy
Control
Panel
680 Ω
Keypad/Keyprox
OR
Module
A
B
A
B
A
B
680 Ω EOL
Fit LK3/LK5 on PCB
Figure 2-6. Daisy Chain Configuration
Each AB line can run in two directions from the control panel.
•
Remove link LK3 (RS485 line1) or link LK5 (RS485 line2).
•
Run two lines from the A and B terminals of the line.
•
Terminate both Ends of Line (EOL) with a 680 ohm resistor.
NOTE: It is permissable to have different configurations on each line. For example, line 1 - Daisy chain;
line 2 - twin AB daisy chain.
2-8
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
RS485 Recommendations
Keypad/Keyprox
OR
Module
Galaxy
Control
Panel
B
A
Keypad/Keyprox
OR
Module
B
A
A
B
680 Ω EOL
680 Ω EOL
Remove
LK3/LK5
Figure 2-7. Twin AB Line Daisy-Chain configuration
RS485 Wiring Recommendations
To ensure that the system communicates at the maximum level of efficiency, the following recommendations
must be adhered to:
1.
The maximum number of devices on each line are:
GD-48
(Line 1 only)
GD-96
(Lines 1-2)
GD-264
(Lines 1-2)
GD-520
(Lines 1-4)
Keypads
8
8 per line
8 per line
8 per line
Keyprox
3
3 (line 1)
4 (line 2)
3 (line 1)
4 (line 2)
3 (line 1)
7(lines 2, 3, 4)
Touch Center
1
1 per line
1 per line
1 per line
RIO's/SPSU's
4
4 (line 1)
6 (line 2)
15 (line 1)
16 (line 2)
15 (line1)
16 (lines 2, 3, 4)
RF RIO
4
4 (line 1)
6 (line 2)
15 (line 1)
16 (line 2)
15 (line 1)
16 (lines 2, 3, 4)
MAX/DCM
4
8 per line
8 per line
8 per line
RS232
1
1 (line 1 only)
1 (line 1 only)
1 (line 1 only)
Telecoms
1
1 (line 1 only)
1 (line 1 only)
1 (line 1 only)
Printer
1
1 (line 1 only)
1 (line 1 only)
1 (line 1 only)
ISDN
1
1 (line 1 only)
1 (line 1 only)
1 (line 1 only)
Ethernet
1
1 (line 1 only)
1 (line 1 only)
1 (line 1 only)
Audio Interface
1
1 (line 1 only)
1 (line 1 only)
1 (line 1 only)
Table 2-5. Communication Devices
2.
The system must be wired in a daisy-chain configuration. Spur and star configurations must not
be used as they reduce the immunity to electrical interference.
3.
The cable used must screened twisted pair (Part No W002) to connect the RS485 (AB) line. This
would be CAT5 or Belden 8723 equivalent.
2-9
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
RS485 Recommendations
4.
Shielded twisted pair cable, where used, is connected to the earthing pillar on the Galaxy control
panel using the P-clip and nut supplied (refer to Figure 2-8).
5.
The RS485 (AB) line must have a 680 Ω resistor fitted across the A and B terminals of the last
module on the line. If twin lines are connected, both ends must be terminated with 680 Ω resistors and
the appropriate link on the control panel PCB must be removed (refer to figure 2-7).
6.
There must only be a single AB pair of wires in each of the cables.
7.
The minimum supply voltage level is 10.5 Vd.c. with 12.5 Vd.c. being the recommended working
minimum.
8.
The power supply in the Galaxy control panel and remote power supplies must not be connected
in parallel.
9.
The 0 V of all remote power supplies should be connected in common to the 0 V of the Galaxy
control panel.
10.
Ensure that any extension loudspeakers are not wired in the same cable as an AB pair of wires.
11.
Where possible, ensure that the AB cable is at least 30 centimetres away from any other cables.
12.
Where possible, ensure that the AB cable does not run parallel to other cables for extended
distances (maximum 5 metres).
AB connectors
B
A
data line
data line
RS 485 cable
Cable screen
P-clip
Nut
P-clip
Earthing pillar
(threaded)
Figure 2-8. Connection of cable screen using P-Clip
2-10
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Zone Addresses
Zones
The default setting for the zones on the Galaxy Dimension are as follows:
Zone 1001 = Final
Zone 1002 = Exit
All remaining zones = Intruder
Zone Addresses
Each zone has a four digit address; 1004, 4136. The address is made up of three reference numbers as shown
in the following figure:
Example: 3057
3 05
Represents Panel
Line No.
7
Represents
RIO Address
Represents
Zone No. 1-8 on
RIO
GALAXY
PANEL
1234
RIO
ADDRESS 05
Figure 2-9. Zone Addresses
For example, zone 3057 is the detector connected to line 3, RIO 05, zone 7.
2-11
ZONE 7
RIO Switch
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Zone Addressing with Onboard RIO Switch (Line 0 Switch)
The RIO switch (SW3, dipswitch 8) controls the ordering of the on-board RIO’s. This dipswitch must be set
before powering up the panel. Setting the switch to ON sets the on-board RIO1 to operate on line 0 and
allows a RIO addressed as 1 to be connected to line 1, giving a total of 15 RIO’s on a GD-264 and
GD-520. The RIO switch only needs to be activated when the full compliment of RIO’s is required, or when
replacing a Galaxy 512 panel with a power supply/RIO already using address 1.
NOTE: The RIO switch is not functional on other variants. It defaults to the Switch off configuration.
Switch off (default)
When the switch is set to this mode, the onboard RIO’s configure to the following addresses:
Onboard RIO0
Zone address range:
1001-1008
Outputs:
1001-1004
Onboard RIO1
Zone address range:
1011-1018
Outputs:
1011-1014
Switch on
When the switch is set to this mode, the onboard RIO’s configure to the following addresses:
Onboard RIO0
Zone address range:
1001-1008
Outputs:
1011-1014
Onboard RIO1
Zone address range:
0011-0018
Outputs:
0011-0014
Panel
GD-48
GD-96
GD-264
GD-520
On-Board RIO Address Range
Total
on-board
Zones
Max No of
External RIO's
(Line 1)
Valid External
RIO Addresses
(Line 1)
Total Zone
Addresses
(Switch ON)
1001 - 1008, 1011 - 1018
16
4
2-5
48
1001 - 1008, 1011 - 1018 (switch off)
16
4
2-5
1001 - 1008, 0011 - 0018 (switch on)
16
5
1-5
1001 - 1008, 1011 - 1018 (switch off)
16
14
2 - 9, A - F
1001 - 1008, 0011 - 0018 (switch on)
16
15
1 - 9, A - F
1001 - 1008, 1011 - 1018 (switch off)
16
14
2 - 9, A - F
1001 - 1008, 0011 - 0018 (switch on)
16
15
1 - 9, A - F
Table 2-6. Zone Address Ranges
2-12
96
264
520
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Wiring Zones
Wiring Zones
The zones on Galaxy Dimension panels can be Double Balanced (default) or End of Line. Zones can be
programmed with different resistance ranges for zone status activation (see Parameter 51.46 =
Parameters.Zone Resistance). Refer to Table 2-7 (Double Balanced) or Table 2-8 (End of Line) for
details of the zone resistance and resulting conditions.The system default is Option 9, giving fault monitoring on
1k double balanced wiring.
NOTE: The circuit debounce time (the period the zone must remain in a state to register a change in condition) is 300 milliseconds by default.
Option 01 - 1k
Option 03 - 2k2
Option 05 - 4k7
Option 07 - 5K6
Option 09 - 1k Fault
0 - 800
0 - 1800
0 - 3700
0 -1400
0 - 800
Low Res
800 - 900
1800 - 2000
3700 - 4200
1400 - 2800
800 - 900
Normal
900 - 1200
2000 - 2500
4200 - 5500
2800 - 8400
900 -1200
High Res
1200 - 1300
2500 - 2700
5500 - 6500
8400 - 9800
1200 - 1300
Open
1300 - 12000
2700 - 12000
6500 - 19000
9800 - 12600
1300 - 3500
Fault
-
-
-
-
3500 - 4500
Masked
12000 - 19000
12000 - 15000
19000 - 22000
12600 - 22000
4500 - 19000
Tamper O/C
19000 - infinity
15000 - infinity
22000 - infinity
22000 - infinity
19000 - infinity
Tamper S/C
Table 2-7. Double Balanced Zone Resistance and Conditions
Option 09 - 1k Fault Double-balanced (default)
The wiring in Figure 2-10 should be used if the detector uses combined fault and mask signalling. A mask
condition is generated if an alarm and fault are signalled at the same time. Alternatively, if the detector has
seperate fault and mask indications then the wiring in Figure 2-11 should be used.
3k
1k
Zone
Alarm N/C
Tamper N/C
Fault N/C
1k
100 m
Figure 2-10. Option 09 - Double balanced 1k Fault Monitoring Wiring
1k
Zone
Alarm N/C
3k
Tamper N/C
Fault N/C
12k
Anti-Mask N/C
1k
100 m
Figure 2-11. Option 09 - Double balanced 1k Fault/Mask Monitoring Wiring
NOTE: N/C = Normally Closed.
2-13
Wiring Zones (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
When this wiring mode is employed, only one detector which can report fault conditions should be connected
to the zone. A maximum of two detectors or contacts of any type should be connected to a zone when this
mode is selected. It is recommended that zone cable lengths are kept below 100m in this configuration.
NOTE: The recommended maximum cable run from a zone to a detector is 500 metres in all other configurations.
Option 02 - 1k
Option 04 - 2k2
Option 06 - 4k7
Option 08 - 5k6
Option 10 -1k Fault
0 - 800
0 - 1800
0 - 3700
0 - 1400
0 - 800
Low Res
800 - 900
1800 - 2000
3700 - 4200
1400 - 2800
800 - 900
Normal
900 - 1200
2000 - 2500
4200 - 5500
2800 - 8400
900 - 1200
High Res
1200 - 1300
2500 - 2700
5500 - 6500
8400 - 9800
1200 - 1300
-
-
-
-
1300 - 4500
Masked
1300 - 12000
2700 - 12000
6500 - 19000
9800 - 19000
4500 - 19000
Open
12000 - infinity
12000 - infinity
19000 - infinity
19000 - infinity
19000 - infinity
Tamper S/C
Fault
Table 2-8. End of Line Zone Resistance and Conditions
Option 10 - 1k Fault End-Of-Line
The wiring in Figure 2-12 should be used if the mode is end-of-line. Fault and mask indications can only be
signalled if the detector has seperate fault and mask indications.
3k
Zone
Alarm N/C
Tamper N/C
Fault N/C
12k
Anti-Mask N/C
1k
100 m
Figure 2-12. Option 10 - End of Line Zone/Detector wiring
When this wiring mode is employed, only one detector which can report fault conditions should be connected
to the zone. A maximum of two detectors or contacts of any type should be connected to a zone when this
mode is selected. It is recommended that zone cable lengths are kept below 100m in this configuration.
NOTE: The recommended maximum cable run from a zone to a detector is 500 metres in all other configurations.
2-14
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Wiring Zones (cont’d)
Wiring Multiple Detectors
Multiple detectors can be wired into a single zone when using preset 1 as shown in the following Figure. The
maximum number of detectors that can be connected to a single zone is ten.
Alarm
N/C
Zone
Alarm
N/C
Alarm
N/C
Alarm
N/C
(10 max)
N/C
1k
1k
1k
1k
1%
1%
1%
1%
N/C TAMP
1% 1k
500 m
Figure 2-13. Zone to Multiple Detector Wiring
Wiring Keyswitches
Latching or spring loaded keyswitches can be used to set and unset the Galaxy Dimension panels; option
52 = PROGRAM ZONES has provision to accommodate both types of transition.
If the keyswitch latches, the transition from 1 kΩ to 2 kΩ initiates the setting procedure of an unset system,
the transition from 2 kΩ to 1 kΩ instantly unsets a set system. If the system is already set, then the transition
from 1 kΩ to 2 kΩ has no effect. If the system is unset, the transition from 2 kΩ to 1 kΩ has no effect. This
is programmed as a Keyswitch in the PROGRAM ZONES option.
If the keyswitch is spring-loaded (returns to its normal position), the transition from 1 kΩ to 2 kΩ initiates the
setting procedure of an unset system and instantly unsets a set system, the transition from 2 kΩ to 1 kΩ - the
return to the normal position - has no effect. This is programmed as a Keyswitch in the PROGRAM
ZONES option.
2-15
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Terminator Zone Wiring
Wiring Terminator Buttons
Zones programmed as Push-Set (terminator) buttons can be open going closed (2 kΩ to 1 kΩ) or closed
going open (1 kΩ to 2 kΩ). The first activation of the terminator button initialises its status to the system.
NOTE: The first activation of a terminator may not set the system as this can be the initialisation routine. If
the system continues setting, push the button again. The system will set on the second push. This
initialisation only occurs on the first setting. All subsequent setting routines set on the first push of the
terminator.
1k to unset, 2k to set
1k
Open - Closed
Push-set
zone
1k
Keyswitch
zone
1%
1k
The wiring of the terminator and keyswitch zone type is shown in the following figure:
1%
1%
OR
Closed - Open
1k
1%
1%
1k
500m
Figure 2-14. Terminator and Keyswitch Zone Wiring
Outputs
The Galaxy Dimension control panel on-board outputs are detailed in the following table:
Output Address
Default
Default
Function
Line 0 Enable
Type
Rating
Normal State
(w ith 3k3 pull-up)
1001
1001
Bells
Transistorised
12V, 400mA
Positive
1002
1002
Strobe
Single Pole
Change Over
Relay (SPCO)
30V, 1A
De-energised
1003
1003
PA
Transistorised
12V, 400mA
Positive
1004
1004
Reset
Transistorised
12V, 400mA
Positive
1011
0011
S et
Transistorised
12V, 400mA
Positive
1012
0012
Intruder
Transistorised
12V, 400mA
Positive
1013
0013
Confirm
Transistorised
12V, 400mA
Positive
1014
0014
Reset
Transistorised
12V, 400mA
Positive
Table 2-9. Outputs
2-16
Output Applications
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Output Applications
The outputs on the Galaxy panels, with the exception of the SPCO relay output, are transistorised outputs;
negative applied (positive removed) by default. These supply up to 400 mA and can be used to drive the
necessary output devices.
NOTE:
The polarity of each output can be changed using option 53 = PROGRAM OUTPUTS
Transistorised Output
Typical Applications
A) LED
Output
LED
+12 V
+12 V
1kΩ (typical)
3k3Ω
B) Bell
Output
Bell
+ 12 V
Output
C) Output used to trigger zone
Output
0V
*
Switch out 3k3Ω
to give open collector
1kΩ
1%
zone
Output must be
open collector
1kΩ
1%
If the output used is one of the panel's
* NOTE:
on-board outputs, then substitute this resistor
with a 680 Ω resistor.
Figure 2-15. Output Configuration and Typical Applications
Note: For the appropriate 3k3Ω pull-up resistor refer to DIP switch SW3 (Table 2-1).
The relay output is a single pole change over; this can be used to drive output devices that require a clean set
of contacts, isolated from the output voltage.
Horn
Single Pole
Change - 0ver
relay contacts
Normally
closed
+12 V
0V
Normally open
Figure 2-16. Single Pole Change–Over Relay Output Configuration and Typical application
2-17
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Trigger Header
Trigger Header
The Trigger Header on the Galaxy Dimension is a set of pins that consist of programmable outputs for an
external communication module. The connection is via an optional ribbon cable.
Trig 1-6
There are six trigger outputs, that can be used as communication triggers, but can also be used for any other
purpose. By default these outputs are programmed as positive. They are designed to sink current (to 0V) not
source current (from 12V). The function of these outputs are as follows:
Output
Address
Default
function
Current (mA)
0001
Fire
100
0002
Panic
100
0003
Intruder
100
0004
Set
100
0005
Omit
100
0006
Confirm
100
Table 2-10. Trigger Output functions
The function of the trigger outputs can be programmed in menu option 53 = Program Outputs.
Supply
A 100 mA, 12V output is also provided. This output is fused by the on-board AUX3 FUSE (F2).
+12V
Not Used
Not Used
Trig 6
Trig 5
Trig 4
Trig 3
Trig 2
Trig 1
Not Used
Not Used
GND
Figure 2-17. Trigger Header
2-18
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
SPI Key
SPI Header
The SPI (Serial Peripheral Interface) key is an engineering peripheral used for copy/overwriting programming
data and carrying out software upgrades.
Fitting the SPI Key
The SPI key is fitted directly on to the Galaxy Dimension control panel.
CAUTION:
Always power down the panel BEFORE removing or connecting the SPI key.
Failure to do so may result in damage to the SPI key. Never “hot-plug” the SPI
key.
The SPI Key has a 10-way connector. These locate on to the 10 pins of the SPI Program Header
(see Figures below).
NOTE: The SPI Key should only be fitted in the direction shown in Figure 2-19.
SPI Key
Control
Panel
(part view)
10-way
connector
Fitted
here
SPI
Program
Header
Hinged
cap
Figure 2-18. SPI Key
Figure 2-19. Location of SPI Key on Program Header
1. Release the hinged cap to expose the 10-way connector.
2. Plug the SPI Key on to the Program Header on the Galaxy Dimension control panel.
Removing the SPI Key
CAUTION:
Always power down the panel BEFORE removing or connecting the SPI key.
Failure to do so may result in damage to the SPI key. Never “hot-plug” the SPI
key.
1. Remove the SPI Key from the Program Header on the Galaxy Dimension control panel.
2. Secure the hinged cap to protect the 10-way connector.
2-19
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
2-20
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
RIOs
SECTION 3: PERIPHERALS
General
The following peripherals can be connected to the Galaxy Dimension panel:
All bus lines: Mk7 Keypad/Keyprox; TouchCenter; MAX3; Door Control Module (DCM); Remote Input
Output module (RIO); Power Supply Unit (PSU).
Bus line 1 only: Telecom; RS232; ISDN; Ethernet.
Wiring
Th following table shows the wiring between the Galaxy panel and the different peripherals.
Panel
Keypad/Keyprox
Touch
Center
RIO/DCM
PSU
Telecom
RS232
ISDN
Ethernet
+12V
+
+
+
X*
+12V
+12V
+12V
+
GND
-
-
-
0V
-
-
GND
-
A
A
G
A
A
A
A
A
A
B
B
Y
B
B
B
B
B
B
Table 3-1. Peripheral Wiring to Galaxy Panel
* Do not connect +12V terminals between panels and remote power supplies.
Configuring
New peripherals will be configured onto the system at system power up or on leaving programming mode.
Changes to peripheral addresses will only take effect when the peripheral is re-powered.
Addressing
The addresses on most peripherals is
set by either jumpers or a rotary
switch. These must be set before the
system is powered up. The table
opposite shows the available peripheral
addresses.
NOTES:
1
2
A single TouchCenter can be
fitted to each bus line.
If RIO 2 on-board is set to line 0
(dip switch 8), then the first
external RIO can use address 1
to give 8 extra zones where
needed.
Valid Addresses
Peripheral
Line
GD-48
GD-96
GD-264
GD-520
Mk7 Keypad
1
2
3-4
0-2, B-F
-
0-2, B-F
0-2, B-F
-
0-2, B-F
0-6, F
-
0-2, B-F
0-6, F
0-6, F
Mk7 Keyprox
1
2
3-4
0-2
-
0-2
0-3
-
0-2
0-3
-
0-2
0-6
0-6
TouchCenter1
1
2
3-4
0-2
-
0-2
0-3
-
0-2
0-3
-
02
0-6
0-6
RIO/PSU
1
2
3-4
2-5
-
22-5
0-5
-
22-9, A-F 22-9, A-F
0-9, A-F 0-9, A-F
0-9, A-F
MAX/DCM Reader
1
2
3-4
0-3
-
0-3
0-3
-
0-3
0-3
-
0-7
0-7
0-7
Telecom
1
(E)
(E)
(E)
(E)
RS232
1
(D)
(D)
(D)
(D)
ISDN
1
(C)
(C)
(C)
(C)
Ethernet
1
(B)
(B)
(B)
(B)
Table 3-2. Galaxy Dimension Peripheral Addresses
3-1
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
RIO
Connecting the RIO
The RIO can only be connected to the system while engineer mode is accessed. The RS485 (AB) line of the
Galaxy RIO must be wired in parallel (daisy-chain configuration) with the RS485 (AB) line of any keypads
connected to the system. The RIO requires 12 Vd.c. (range 10.5 to 16.0 V) and 40 mA. This can be supplied from the control panel power supply or from a remote power supply if the distance causes a large
voltage drop on the cable.
NOTE: A Power RIO can be fitted in place of a RIO.
Connect the RIO terminals as follows:
+12 V (either control panel, keypad or remote power supply);
–0 V or ground (either control panel, keypad or remote power supply);
A to the A terminal of the previous module (or control panel if RIO is the first on the line);
B to the B terminal of the previous module (or control panel if RIO is the first on the line).
NOTE: If the RIO is the last module on the line, connect a 680 Ω EOL resistor across the A and B terminals.
Configuring the RIO
The added RIO is configured into the system on exiting from engineer mode. If the message XX Mod Added
[<],[>] To View is displayed, the system has recognised that a new module is present. Press the A or B keys
to confirm that the RIO has been added. If this message is not displayed or the RIO is not on the list of added
modules, then the RIO is not communicating with the control panel or has been set to the same address as the
RIO already connected to the system.
The flash rate of the red LED (LED1) on the RIO indicates the status of the communication with the control
panel - refer to the following Table:
Flash Rate
Meaning
0.1 ON / 0.9 OFF
Normal communications
OFF
No d.c. supply
1.5 ON / 1.5 OFF
RIO has not been configured into system
0.2 ON / 0.2 OFF
RIO has lost communication with system
0.9 ON / 0.1 OFF
Very poor communications
Table 3-3. RIO LED Flash Rates
Zones
The Galaxy RIO has eight programmable zones. These default to INTRUDER. Each zone is Double
Balance monitored with a 1 kΩ resistor in series with the zone detector and a 1 kΩ (1%) resistor in parallel
across the detector switch. The change to 2 kΩ (1%) resistance registers the zone as open/alarm.
3-2
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
RIO Outputs
RIO Outputs
The RIO has four transistorised outputs. Each output is connected to +12 V via a 3k3Ω pull-up resistor
(refer to Table 3-4). When an output is activated, the load is switched to the negative supply voltage (ground
or 0 V) of the RIO. The current available from each output is 400 mA.
The default functions and pull-up resistors of each RIO output, when connected to a Galaxy are shown in the
following Table:
Output No.
Function
Pull-up Resistor
1
Bells
R1
2
Strobe
R3
3
PA
R5
4
Reset
R7
Table 3-4. RIO Output Default Functions
3-3
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
RF RIO
RF RIO
The Galaxy Radio Frequency (RF) RIO module is an optional add-on to the existing Galaxy product range.
The module acts as an RF receiver for the Ademco 868MHz transmitter range.
Features
The RF RIO contains the following features:
•
Support for up to 32 RF zones (dependent upon panel type)
•
Support for up to 30 RF keyfobs
•
4 transistorised outputs
Pull-up
Resistors
Outputs
Panel
1 2 3 4
B A - +
R7 R5
LED1
R3
Keypad
B A -
+
Programming
Keypad
Socket
R1
SW6 SW2
LK1
Tamper
link
Tamper
Switch
SW1
SW3
Processor
Programming
Switch
Retaining Slot
Rotary
Address
Switch
Rev 1.0
Figure 3-1. RF RIO PCB Layout
Connecting the RF RIO
The RS 485 (AB) line of the RF RIO must be wired in parallel (daisy chain configuration) with the RS 485
(AB) line of the keypad connected to it. The RF RIO requires 12 V d.c. (range 10.5 to 16.0 V) and 55 mA.
This can be supplied from the control panel power supply or from a remote power supply if the distance
causes a large voltage drop on the cable.
3-4
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
RF RIO (cont’d)
Connect the RF RIO terminals in accordance with the following Table:
RF RIO Terminal
Note:
Connected to...
+
+12 V (at control panel, keypad or remote power supply)
-
0V or ground (at control panel, keypad or remote power supply)
A
To the A terminal of the previous module on the line (or the control
panel if the RF RIO is the first module on the line)
B
To the B terminal of the previous module on the line (or the control
panel if the RF RIO is the first module on the line)
Table 3-5. RF RIO Connections
If the RF RIO is the last Module on the line, connect a 680 Ω resistor across the A and B terminals.
Outputs
The RF RIO has four transistorised outputs. Each output is connected to +12 V via a 3k3Ω pull-up resistor
(refer to Table 3-6 RF RIO Connections). When an output is activated, the load is switched to the negative
supply voltage (ground or 0 V) of the RF RIO. Each output is capable of supplying 400 mA.
The default functions and pull-up resistors of each RF RIO output, when connected to a Galaxy are shown in
the following Table:
Output No.
Default
Function
Pull-up Resistor
1
Bells
R43
2
Strobe
R37
3
PA
R33
4
Reset
R23
Table 3-6. Output Functions
NOTE: The number of pull-up resistors may vary with different hardware revisions.
RF RIO Tamper
Switch SW2 on the RF RIO acts as a tamper if the Tamper Link (LK1) is missing. Removing the lid from the
RF RIO enclosure activates the RF RIO tamper alarm if the system is not in Engineer Mode. The tamper
switch can be bypassed by fitting a 0 Ω link to LK1.
Addressing the RF RIO
The Galaxy RF RIO must be given unique addresses before it is connected to a power supply. This unique
address is selected using the 16-way Rotary Address Switch (SW1). The address selected will act as the
base address for the RF RIO. Subsequent addresses will be
base address + 1, base address + 2, base address + 3. For example:
Base address = 2 followed by 3, 4 and 5.
3-5
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
RF RIO (cont’d)
Address Ranges
This option allows the programming of the RIO addresses, which are to be simulated by the RF RIO.
For example, if the RF RIO being programmed supports 32 zones (4 RIO addresses), and the base address,
programmed at the hexi-decimal rotary switch is 02, the available addresses would be 02, 03, 04, 05. However, you may want to only respond as RIO addresses 02, 04. The remaining addresses should be disabled
and will not respond to commands from the control panel. The base address is enabled by default. All other
addresses are disabled by default.
Module status on the RF RIO such as lid tamper,will be reported to the panel using the address set on the
rotary switch.
RF RIO Programming
Programming of the RF RIO is achieved by connecting a Galaxy Mk7 keypad directly to the RF RIO at the
Programming Keypad Socket or the Keypad Connector Block. The Keypad is not part of the Galaxy network and must be addressed as 0.
Note:
To program RF devices, please refer to RF RIO Module, Installation and Programming
Instructions, (II1-0076) supplied with the RF RIO.
Configuring the RF RIO
The RF RIO is configured into the system in the same way as a standard RIO. Refer to standard RIO instructions for further details.
3-6
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Power Supply Unit
Power Supply Unit
The Galaxy Dimension Power Supply Unit is available in 2 variants.
The Galaxy Power RIO consists of a Power Block and a Control Unit that includes an on-board RIO.
The Galaxy Power Unit consists of a Power Block and a Control Unit without the on-board RIO.
WARNING:
There are lethal voltages present in the Power Block. Remove mains power from
the Power Block before handling it.
Each variant can be integrated with all Galaxy Dimension control panels. The number of Power Units or
Power RIO’s that can be used on a system is limited by the number of RIO’s that can be added to each panel.
Off-wall
Tamper
OW
LID
TAMP TAMP
HEATSINK
Bell-Box
connection
LK5
+14.5
0V
0V
+12V2
LK10
F1
LED2
(AC)
F4
Power Block
+BAT
-BAT
F2
0V
Outputs
From
Power
Block
F3
+12V1
Comms
Line
13.8
0V
14.5
0V
BT
AC/F
Rotary
Address
Switch
LED1
(comms)
A(DO)
B(DI)
OP4
LK4
OP3
LK3
OP2
LK2
Control Unit
SLAVE
E/E
13.8V
0V
14.5V
0V
BT
AC/F
NEUTRAL
Power
Header
OP1
LK1
1 1/2 2
To Control
Unit
3 3/4
4
5 5/6
6
7 7/8 8
LIVE
Mains
Terminal
Block
WARNING: The Power Block PCB
is connected to mains voltage. Always
disconnect mains supply for at least
1 minute before removing the box lid.
AC BATPWR 0V
FAULT OP
Zones 1-8
Figure 3-2. Power Supply Unit
Configuration
The Galaxy Power Supply Unit (PSU) consists of 2 modules, the Power Block and the Control Unit. The
PSU can be connected to the Galaxy Dimension control panel via the RS485 (AB) line. The PSU can be used
in place of a standard RIO to overcome power problems that arise when the additional RIO is fitted distant to
the control panel.
A 6-way jumper lead connects the Power Block to the Control Unit.
The PSU has 8 zones and 4 outputs. Each PSU takes one of the 4 RIO address (2 - 5). Addressing is identical to that described for RIO Modules.
The 4 outputs are switched 0V (0V active). Without the jumper links (LK1-4) fitted, the outputs will float in
the OFF state. They can apply a +12V signal, if required, by fitting the appropriate pull-up jumper supplied.
LK5 will short out the off-wall tamper if it is not used.
The SLAVE and E/E links must be in place for normal operation.
FAULT OP AC: This is an open collector transistor which is normally off. The output is activated by an AC
failure.
FAULT OP BAT:This is an open collector transistor which is normally off. The output is activated by a
Battery Low or Battery Fail condition.
FAULT OP POWER: This is an open collector transistor which is normally off. The output is activated by
low voltage present in +12V1, +12V2 or +14.5V.
3-7
Power Supply Unit (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Installation Instructions
The installation and wiring must be performed by a competent engineer. The Galaxy Dimension Power Supply
Unit must be connected to the a.c. mains supply (230/240 Va.c. 50Hz) via a fused connection outlet. The fuse
in the mains outlet must not exceed 3A.
The Galaxy Dimension Power Supply Unit comes installed in the metal enclosure base. The installation procedure of the panel base is as follows:
1.
Route the mains cable through the hole on the right hand side of the enclosure base. Securely anchor
the cable to the box using the tie-wrap as shown in the following Figure:
Lid Tamper
Microswitch
Keyhole
slot (top)
6fro way
to m p jum
co ow pe
ntr e
r
ol r bl lea
un oc d
k
it
Control
Unit
Power
Block
Terminal
block
Enclosure
base
Mains cable
Tie wrap
Attaching hole
Off-Wall
Tamper
Micro-switch
Attaching hole
Figure 3-3. Enclosure Base
2.
Secure the panel base to the wall using three 1.5" No. 8 round head steel screws through the holes
provided.
The mains cable used must be a three core type (with green/yellow earth insulation) of adequate current
carrying capacity.
3.
Connect the mains cable to the mains terminal block as follows:
•
blue wire to the terminal marked N (Neutral)
•
green/yellow wire to the terminal marked (Earth)
•
brown wire to the terminal marked L (Live)
NOTE: No other connections to the mains connector are permitted.
All wiring must be in accordance with local regulations and the installation must conform to EN60950.
4.
Power up by applying mains first. This unit can be powered up from the battery by momentarily shorting
LK10. Never leave LK10 connected, as deep discharge of the battery will occur. LK10 is for start-up
only.
3-8
Power Supply Unit (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Battery
The minimum capacity battery to supply the PSU is 1x 7Ah. The maximum capacity battery to supply the
PSU is 2 x 17Ah.
Battery Test
A battery test on full load is automatically performed once an hour and during the Engineer Mode exiting
procedure. If the battery voltage falls to 10 V while the Power Supply Unit is running on the battery, then it is
automatically disconnected to prevent deep discharge of the battery.
Specifications
Electrical (based on 34 Ah battery and UK grade 3 compliance)
Input voltage:
230V a.c. (+10%/-15%) @50Hz
Output voltage (nominal):
13.8V & 14.5V
Output current (max):
3.0A
Operating temperature:
-10 deg C to +40 deg C
Aux1 & Aux2
Output voltage (nominal):
Output current (max):
13.8V
0.75A each
14.5V Output (French variant only)
Output voltage (nominal):
14.5V
Output current (max):
0.15A (when using this current, the AUX1 & AUX2 currents will
be reduced by an equivalent amount).
Battery charge current (max):
Maximum ripple voltage:
1.4A
less than 100mV
Fuses
F1 (14.5V)
F2 (Battery)
F3 ( 12V Aux1)
F4 (12V Aux2)
500mA - 20mm anti-surge
1.6A - 20mm anti-surge
1.0A - 20mm anti-surge
1.0A - 20mm anti-surge
EN50131 Compliance
This product is suitable for use in systems designed to comply with EN50131-6 and PD6662:2004.
Security Grade - 3
Environmental Class - II
Power Supply Type - A
3-9
Printer Interface
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Printer Interface Module
The Printer Interface module allows the Galaxy to be connected to a serial printer and the contents of the
event log and the programming details of the system to be printed out. The module is available with either a:
•
25 way sub D type RS232 serial connector (part number A161)
OR
•
6 pin DIN plug (part number A134)
The printer must have a serial interface port. The printer protocol must be set to:
Protocol
Setting
Start Bit
ON
Stop Bit
ON
Word Length
8 Data Bits
Parity
None
Baud Rate
1200
Table 3-7. Printer Protocol Settings
3-10
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
ISDN Module
ISDN Module
The ISDN Module is an optional add-on to the existing Galaxy product range. It connects directly to the
Galaxy RS485 communication bus, allowing signalling and remote servicing over an ISDN network. The
ISDN Module is housed inside the Galaxy enclosure in the same way as the existing Telecom Module.
The ISDN Module supports the following features:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Full existing Galaxy Telecom Module functionality
Analogue/digital/X.25 communication
Support for existing DTMF, SIA, Contact ID and Microtech signalling formats in addition to two
receiver specific X.25 protocols
Hardware and software line snatch
Comprehensive line fail detection and reporting
Two-way communication using B-Channel and D-Channel.
The ISDN Module is allocated keypad address C on line 1 of the panel, and reports itself as Comm Mod 3.
As a result of the addition of the ISDN Module, keypad address C is not available on line 1. If this keypad is
required, the ISDN Module should be removed.
Jumper
Links
ISDN OUT
JP2 JP1
D22
JP3
D23
12V GND RS485
ISDN IN
LED's
PROCESSOR
PROM
IMOD 1 Rev 4
Figure 3-4. ISDN PCB Layout
The position of components on the ISDN PCB may vary with different hardware revisions.
Programming the ISDN Module
The ISDN module is programmed from the Galaxy Dimension control panel using menu option
56 - Communications. The menu is allocated as option 3 after the Int. Telecom and Ext. RS232 Modules.
3-11
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Ethernet Module
Ethernet Module
LED3
The Ethernet Module is an optional add-on to the Galaxy control panel. It is a highly intelligent and compact
module, combining alarm signalling, remote servicing and integrated facilities over Ethernet LAN and/or WAN.
The Ethernet Module connects to 10 Base T Ethernet networks both supporting UDP/IP and TCP/IP
protocols.
The Ethernet module supports the following features:
•
Full alarm signalling on SIA
•
Microtech protocol signalling with Event Monitoring Software
•
Remote servicing via remote servicing software
Programming
Header
Processor
Processor
LED1
Engineer
Socket
S
+
-
A B
Line
SKT1
LED2
SKT2
Rev. 1.0
Figure 3-5. Ethernet PCB Layout
NOTE: The position of components on the Ethernet PCB may vary with different hardware revisions
Configuring the Ethernet Module
The added Ethernet Module is configured into the system on exiting from engineer mode and is allocated
keypad address 15 (B). If the message XX Mod Added [<],[>] To View is displayed, the system has
recognised that a new module is present. Press the A or B keys to confirm that com 4 has been added. If
this message is not displayed or the Ethernet Module is not on the list of added modules, then the Ethernet
Module is not communicating with the control panel.
The flash rate of the red LED (LED3) on the Ethernet Module indicates the status of the communication with
the control.
Ethernet Communication
The green LED (LED1) is illuminated when the Ethernet Module is connected to Ethernet.
The amber LED (LED2) flashes when the Ethernet Module is sending or receiving data.
For further information regarding the Ethernet Module, refer to Ethernet Module, Installation Instructions
(II1-0080).
3-12
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Audio Control
Galaxy Dimension and 2-Way Audio
Introduction
The Galaxy Dimension allows multiple audio channels to be linked to the intruder system in order to provide
audio verification following an alarm activation. This will allow sound from the area of the alarm activation to
be transmitted to the Alarm Receiving Centre with the alarm signal. This can be recorded audio captured at
the time of the activation as well as live audio. Depending on the set-up, it may be possible for the operator at
the receiving centre to talk back to the site. An Audio Interface Module is required to enable audio on the
Galaxy. This allows up to two audio channels to be connected. If further channels are required, the audio
system can be expanded using the MUX modules. Each alarm group on the Galaxy can have one audio
channel assigned to it.
Audio Interface Module
The Audio Interface Module is connected to the Galaxy RS485 line to allow the panel to control the audio
function and connected to the PSTN line to allow it to transmit the audio signals to the Alarm Receiving Centre.
For expansion using MUX modules, the Audio Interface Module has connections for a high speed digital
audio bus in order to connect the MUX modules. Up to three speaker-mic devices, such as the TP800, can
be connected to each audio channel.
The Audio Interface Module acts as the master to a dedicated Audio RS485 line on to which 8 off-board
Mux Modules can be connected.
Telecom
Socket
Off-wall Tamper
microswitch
Audio Expansion
Header
Fuse for
+4.5V
LK3
NOTE: Audio Expansion
Header is not currently
used - it is for future
product development.
PL2
PL6
Engineer Header
Audio Bus
CMD 2
SPARE
TMP 2
GND
SPK 2
A
MIC 3
GND
PL3
Debug Header
B
AUDIO
Engineer Header
RS485 line
+12V
GND
GALAXY
A B
Galaxy
RS485 line
F1
LK4
Jumper lead
RS485
termination
RS485
Audio
Bus
SW3
SKT1
LINE PHONE
B A B A
Telecom
Connect
+4.5V
CMD 1
TMP 1
SPK 1
MIC 1
LK2
Diagnostic
LED's
Figure 3-6. Interface PCB
3-13
Audio Channel
Terminals (2)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Audio Control (cont’d)
Addressing
The AudioInterface has a fixed module address.
Mounting
the Audio Interface Module can be mounted in two ways:
•
above the control panel PCB using a specially designed mounting plate.
•
inside a standard RIO box separate from the control panel.
Connecting the Audio Interface Module to the PSTN
The Audio Interface Module must be connected to the Galaxy panel PCB as in the following diagram.
Audio Interface PCB
30 metres maximum from
panel to Audio Interface
LINE PHONE
B A B A
Galaxy Panel PCB
LINE PHONE
B A B A
Extension Phone
Incoming
PSTN Line
Figure 3-7. Audio Interface connected to PSTN
Connecting Microphones and Speakers
The Audio channels can work with most line-level audio equipment. Microphones must have a pre-amplifier
that delivers audio or can deliver audio at line level (3V peak to peak). The audio card can transmit audio to
speakers with their own amplifier which accepts line level signals. Please see any instructions with the Microphone device regarding the adjustment of sensitivity. The Galaxy Audio system can be used with the following
Honeywell audio devices:
TP800/TP2-800GY:
Speaker and Microphone unit
IS215TCE-MIC:
DT7450-MIC:
PIR detector with built-in microphone
Dual Tech detector with built-in microphone
IS215TCE-MIC/DT7450-MIC
Connection
TP800/TP2-800GY Connection
The following table details the terminal connections
of the TP800 speaker unit to the Audio Interface:
Audio Interface
IS215TCE-MIC/DT7450MIC
-
Audio Interface
TP800/TP2-800GY
GND
GND
VS-
12V
+
+4.5V
VS+
CMD
CMD
MIC
M
SPK
RML
GRD
G
MIC
ECOUT
TMP
AP
Link AP to VSto complete
tamper circuit
AP
Table 3-8. TP800/TP2-800GY
Connections to Audio Interface
3-14
Table 3-9. Detector Connections to
Audio Interface
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Audio Control (cont’d)
MUX Module
The MUX Module allows four additional audio channels to be connected. It is connected to the RS485
Audio Bus and acts as a slave module to the Audio Interface.
Each audio channel can have three standard speaker-mic devices such as the TP800 connected.
Off-wall Tamper
microswitch
Audio Expansion
Header (for future
product development)
Fuse for
+4.5V
LK3
CMD 4
F1
SW3
TMP 4
SPK 4
MIC 4
GND
PL2
LK4
Jumper lead
RS485
termination
Rotary
Address
Switch SW1
+4.5V
CMD 3
TMP 3
SPK 3
MIC 3
TMP 2
GND
SPK 2
A
+12V
GND
MIC 3
GND
Debug Header
B
DC Supply
from Master
or from
local PSU
Audi Channel
Terminals (4)
CMD 2
SPARE
AUDIO
RS485
Audio
PL6
Engineer Header
Audio Bus
+4.5V
CMD 1
TMP 1
SPK 1
MIC 1
Diagnostic
LED's
Figure 3-8. Mux Module PCB
Addressing
The Mux Module must be given a unique address before it is connected to a power supply. This address is
selected using the 16-way Rotary address Switch (SW1). Valid addresses are 0 - 7.
Connecting the MUX Module to the Audio Interface
The MUX Module is connected to the Audio Interface via the RS485 Audio Bus. The following table shows
the connections.
Audio Interface
RS485 Bus
MUX RS485
Audio Bus
GND
GND
Audio A
Audio A
Audio B
Audio B
Table 3-10. Mux Connections
NOTE: The MUX module can either be supplied with DC power from the Audio Interface or from a local
Power Supply Unit (eg Smart). See Figure 3-8.
Connecting Microphones and Speakers
The MUX module is connected to microphones and speakers as per the Audio Interface. See table 3-8.
3-15
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Audio Control (cont’d)
Using the Audio
Programming Set up
The Audio channels must be mapped to alarm groups using menu 56.7. This allows the Galaxy panel to know
which audio channel to send to the alarm receiving centre following an alarm activation. In this menu, its also
possible to specify which type of alarm events will result in listen-in operation.
In Use
The audio system continuously records the audio from all channels in a 10 second loop. When an alarm
activation occurs, the audio form the specified channel stops recording and the audio from the time of the
alarm is saved, including a few seconds from before the activation of the detector. The panel will dial the
Alarm Receiving Centre normally and transmit the alarm message and then stay on the line to allow the operator to listen to the audio. The Galaxy system will automatically select the specific channel to be transmitted and
play the live audio initially. The operator has three control options using a DTMF telephone keypad;
1:
2:
3:
99:
Talk to site
Listen to recorded audio from the activated channel
Listen to live audio from the activated channel
End call
3-16
Optional Software Packages
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Remote Servicing Suite
Remote Servicing Suite (RSS) is an advanced PC based application that allows full remote servicing of Galaxy
systems. Functions include configuration and programming, control and diagnostic servicing. RSS also includes
an Event Monitoring application.
Event Monitoring is an advanced, high performance software program that allows a PC to receive and store
detailed event and alarm information from Galaxy control panels.
User Management Suite
User Management Suite is a software program designed specifically for in-house security managers, and
allows access to key features of the Remote Servicing program in order to facilitate:
•
Event log copying
•
Holiday period changes
•
Summer time date change
•
User code amendment
SYSTEM
ORDER CODE
Remote Servicing Suite Standalone non-dongled
R050
Remote Servicing Suite Standalone/Network-dongled
R051
User Management Suite Standalone/Network-dongled
R053
Table 3-11. Galaxy PC Products and Order Codes
3-17
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
3-18
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Mk7 Keypad/KeyProx
SECTION 4: KEYPADS
Two types of keypad can be fitted to the Galaxy Dimension: The Mk7 Keypad and the Touch Center keypad.
Both types of keypad are described in this section.
The Galaxy Mk7 Keypad/KeyProx
NOTE: References in the text to the Mk7 keypad also includes the KeyProx in this section.
General
The Galaxy Mk7 keypad/keyProx has the following features:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
a 2 x 16 alphanumeric character backlit display
16 backlit push buttons as shown in figure 4-1
internal horn
power indicator LED
Lid tamper
Off-wall tamper
GALAXY 264 V6.00
08:58 TUE 22 NOV
Address switch
RS485 serial connector
1
2
3
A
4
5
6
B
7
8
9
ent
*
0
#
esc
Figure 4-1. Galaxy Mk7 Keypad/KeyProx
Power Consumption
The Galaxy Mk 7 keypad/keyProx requires a 12 Vd.c. supply – from the control panel or a remote power
supply. The current consumption of the keypad/keyProx is:
Current Draw
Mode
Mk7 Keypad
Mk7 Keyprox
Nominal (backlight OFF)
35 mA
75 mA
Backlight ON
70 mA
90 mA
Maximum Alarm Current
90 mA
130 mA
Table 4-1. Keypad/KeyProx Current draw
4-1
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Keypad Installation
Wiring the Keypad/KeyProx
A 16-way rotary address switch is used to address Galaxy LCD keypads. The address switch assigns a
hexadecimal address value to the keypad.
NOTE:
Any change to the keypad address must be made when the power is disconnected from the
keypad.
Addressing
Addresses are set by means of a rotary switch on the PCB. Each keypad must be assigned a unique address
for its line.
It is possible to add additional keypads at any unused comms module addresses (B, C, D and E) as detailed
in the following NOTE. These must be standard keypads. An engineer keypad can also be used at address F.
NOTE: On Line 1, keypad addresses B, C, D and E are not available if the Ethernet,
ISDN, RS232 or Telecom modules respectively are fitted.
Keypad/KeyProx Installation Procedure
1.
To attach the keypad to the wall, the back plate must first be removed from the front plate. To do this,
insert a suitable tool into both openings at the bottom of the keypad and turn the tool gently.
CAUTION: When the keypad is separated make sure that the anti-static precautions are taken
with the keypad pcb to avoid damage from esd (electro static discharge).
Connections to the terminals are:
Connector
Terminals
Galaxy Keypads
A
A line to panel
B
B line to panel
+
12 Vd.c. input
–
0V
Table 4-2. Keypad/keyProx Terminal Connections
2.
Use the backplate as a template, then mark the locations for the three attachment screws in the
required position.
3.
If it is a new installation, use the keyhole slot at the top of the backplate and the two elongated
holes at the bottom. If replacing an existing Mk3 keypad with a Mk7 keypad, use the keyhole
slot at the top of the backplate and the two knockout holes at the bottom. This means that you
can use the existing holes in the wall, whist keeping the backplate in the same position.
4.
If you are using a wall-run cable for the keypad (A, B, +12V, 0V) position the cable behind the
back plate in the cable channels provided. The cable can be run in from either the top or the
bottom of the back plate. Use a sharp tool to remove the plastic from the top or the bottom of the
cable guides on the back plate skirting.
CAUTION:
5.
Use of any screws other than No. 6 Pan-head can damage the keypad
mouldings.
Make sure that the keypad wiring is fed through the large opening on the keypad backplate, then
position the keypad base on the wall and attach it securely with the three No. 6 Pan-head screws.
4-2
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Keypad Installation (cont’d)
6.
If an off the wall tamper is required, using a No. 6 Pan-head screw, secure the sacrificial wall
tamper, indicated in Figure 4-2, to the wall. Make sure that the tamper knockout is still
connected to the backplate moulding.
7.
Connect the A, B and power wires to the correct terminals of the removable, four-way connector
block.
keyhole slot
aperture
aperture
cable
channel
cable
stowage
area
sacrificial
wall
tamper
elongated
hole
B
A
+
-
knockout
hole
4-way
connector
8.
9.
Figure 4-2. Galaxy Mk7 Keypad/KeyProx Backplate Installation
Make sure that the power is disconnected then set the keypad to the required address using the 16
way rotary switch on the PCB.
To re-assemble the keypad, connect the four-way connector block onto the pins on the keypad
PCB. Attach the keypad front plate to the back plate by inserting the two clips on the top of the
keypad front plate into the two apertures at the top of the keypad back plate, then gently push the
bottom of the keypad front plate into the back plate until it snaps securely into place. Ensure the front
and back sections of the keypad are securely fixed at all points of the keypad perimeter.
Note:
The keypad door can be re-orientated to allow opening from either the left or right-hand
sides. However, fitting or removal of the door must only be done when the front plate is
detached from the back plate. Attempting to remove or install the door, when the keypad is
assembled, may cause damage to the keypad mouldings.
4-3
Adding/Removing Keypads
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Volume Control
Where fitted, the Mk7 keypad/keyprox has a volume control switch marked VOL at the bottom right-hand
corner of the pcb. Make sure the keypad/keyprox is powered up and adjust to the desired volume (+ or -)
for buzzer functions. Refer to Appendix F for keypad/keyprox part numbers with volume control function.
Adding a Keypad/KeyProx to the System
When adding a keypad to an existing system, the following points must be considered:
1.
Ensure that the keypad to be added has a unique address from the other keypads on the system.
2.
Ensure that the keypad has a valid address.
3.
Connect the keypad to the system - refer to the Keypad Installation Procedure.
Note:
A new keypad can only be configured into an existing Galaxy system from engineer mode.
4.
Access engineer mode.
5.
Connect the RS485 (AB) line of the keypad in parallel with the RS485 (AB) line of the
existing keypads.
6.
Connect + and – terminals of the keypad to a power supply.
7.
Exit engineer mode - engineer code + esc:
8.
The Mk7 keypad displays the message 1 MOD. ADDED — esc=CONTINUE. Press the esc
key; the keypad returns to the unset banner.
NOTE: If this message is not displayed, the keypad is not communicating with the control panel and has not
been configured into the system. In this case all connections and addresses should be rechecked.
NOTE: If adding a keyProx to the system, the message 2 MOD ADDED will be displayed to indicate that
both a keypad and MAX have been added to the system.
9.
The keypad is now configured into the system.
Removing a Keypad/KeyProx from the System
A keypad can only be removed from an existing Galaxy system from engineer mode
1.
Access engineer mode.
2.
Disconnect the keypad.
3.
Exit engineer mode. The message 1 MOD. MISSING — [<],[>] to View is displayed
4.
Press the A or B key. The message KEYPAD XX —
5.
Press the key to acknowledge and accept that the keypad has been removed. The keypad
returns to the unset banner.
=REMOVE MODULE is displayed.
NOTE: If removing a keyProx from the system the message 2 MOD MISSING is displayed to indicate
both a keypad and MAX have been removed from the system. Each should be removed separately
by pressing the * key twice.
4-4
Keypad Operation
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Self Diagnostics
The keypad has a self diagnostic feature that is used to test the operational status of the inputs and outputs of
the keypad.
The test is started by disconnecting the power from the keypad, then reapplying the power while pressing the
ent key. The test routine commences immediately. Each test last approximately four seconds. The test is
terminated by removing the power.
• Keypad address is displayed
• Keypad buzzer is activated and a bell symbol is displayed.
• Power LED is illuminated and an a.c. ( ) and LED ( ) symbol is displayed.
• Keypad keys are displayed. Each key press is confirmed by the buzzer sounding and the key display
being highlighted.
• To return keypad to operational mode remove and reapply power.
Keypad/KeyProx Operation
Number Keys
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
0
9
The number keys are used to enter the Personal Identification Number
(PIN) which identifies users to the Galaxy and permits access to the system
options. The PIN Code is a 5 or 6 digit number.
Default Code
Engineer
112233
Remote User
543210
Master Manager
12345
Authorisation
54321
Table 4-3. Default Codes
The number keys are also used, once access to the system has been gained, to select and modify options.
View Keys
A
B
These keys are used to initiate the setting of the Galaxy
Pressing the A or B key immediately after a valid PIN has been entered starts
one of the routines for setting the system. The A key initiates the full setting of
the Galaxy. The B key starts the part setting routine.
Once the system has been successfully accessed the A key can be used to
step forward through the Galaxy menu options and the B key to step backwards.
The A and B keys can also be re-programmed for different functions.
Enter Key
ent
The ent key is used to:
•
Access the menu options
•
Confirm the programming selections
4-5
Keypad Operation (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Escape Key
esc
The esc key cancels any modification made to the current option and returns
to the previous option level. Successive pressing of this key returns the user
to the banner display.
The esc key also aborts the setting routine if pressed during the exit time.
Hash Key
The # key is used :
#
•
as a toggle key, which enables or disables the programming features of
the Galaxy options, for example, enabling the OMIT attribute of a zone,
•
to give additional information on the programming options, for example
pressing the # key while in option 22=DISPLAY LOG shows details of the
user number, descriptor and keypad used to cancel alarms or unset the
system.
•
to activate the Duress and PA outputs; enter a valid user code followed by two
presses of the # key, then the ent key to activate the duress alarm.
Star Key
*
The º key is used:
•
to correct or erase PINs in the CODES option and alpha-numeric
descriptors in the TEXT option,
•
to start printing from the current event when viewing option
22=DISPLAY LOG.
•
to display the set status of the groups. When Show Status (refer to option
58.6=KEYPADS.Show Status) is enabled, pressing the º and # keys simultaneously
when the normal banner is displayed indicates the group set status.
R
= Ready to Set (all active zones in group closed)
F
= Faulted (at least one of the active zones in the group is open)
S
= Set
P
= Part Set
L
= Locked Out
= Group not assigned to keypad
Note: The Show Status indicates the set conditions of groups when the system is set
(keypad blank) or unset (normal banner). Show Status does not operate while
engineer mode is accessed.
Pressing the º and # keys again toggles the display to show the status of the groups
individually. To move between each groups, press the º and A or the º and B keys
simultaneously.
Pressing the º and # again returns the keypad to the banner display.
4-6
Keypad Operation (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Multiple Group Systems
The larger Galaxy systems have more than eight groups; these are displayed on the keypad in blocks of eight
groups. Press the A or B key to display each of the group blocks.
Power LED
The green power LED indicates the status of the a.c. power supply and the stand-by battery.
P o w er L E D
a.c. Status Battery Status
Fuse Status
ON
a.c. OK
Battery OK
Fuses OK
Slow flash
a.c. Fail
Battery OK
Fuses OK
Quick Flash
a.c. Fail/OK Battery Low
Fuse blown
Table 4-4. a.c./Battery Status Indicator
NOTE: It is advised that a suitably rated stand-by battery is fitted to the system in order to provide continued protection in the event of a mains failure. The battery is not included.
Display
The Galaxy Keypad/KeyProx have a 2 x 16 character backlit display used to display programming information and system status.
GALAXY 264 V6.00
08:58 TUE 22 NOV
4-7
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Keyprox
The Galaxy KeyProx
General
The KeyProx is a standard Mk7 keypad with a proximity card reader built in to the lower right corner. This
allows users to set and unset the system, using proximity cards, rather than a pin.
NOTE: The keyProx is not intended for use as a door control unit. Installation and wiring of the KeyProx is
identical to the Mk7 keypad.
Addressing
Both the KeyProx and reader share a common address, set by the rotary address switch.
An address must be chosen which will be valid for both the keypad and MAX.
Please note that in order for the reader to operate, MAX mode must be enabled in the panel programming,
(option 63.2.1 = Options.MAX.MAX Mode). The MAX addressing function in option 63.2.2 = MAX
Address, is not required for keyprox units.
Operation
The operation of the KeyProx is identical to the Mk7 keypad. The proximity reader is seen by the panel as an
on-line MAX reader. It is programmed in exactly the same way with the exception that it does not require to
be addressed (this being set already by the rotary switch).
Card Types
The KeyProx can read standard ASK (Amplitude Shift Keying) type cards up to 34 bit. A self learn feature is
incorporared into the KeyProx to aid in card programming.
For further details on how to set up user cards, to set and unset the system, refer to Option 42 - Codes.
4-8
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
TouchCenter
The Galaxy Dimension TouchCenter
General
The Galaxy Dimension TouchCenter connects to the RS485 data bus of the Galaxy Dimension panels. The
TouchCenter combines a clear graphical display with simple touch-screen control, providing an easy user
interface.
EMERGENCY
button
Mk7 Keypad
Interface button
Figure 4.3 Homepage Screen
TouchCenter Installation Procedure
1
Remove the mounting plate from the TouchCenter by pushing it towards the bottom of the keypad.
2
Locate the mounting plate over the mounting surface such that the opening of the mounting plate is
aligned with the cable.
3
Pass the cable through the opening of the mounting plate.
4
Secure the mounting plate to the mounting surface using the four screws supplied.
5
Connect the wires to the TouchCenter terminals as per the following table:
Galaxy Terminals
TouchCenter Terminals
A
G
B
Y
GND
-
+12V
+
Table 4-5. TouchCenter Terminal Connections
6.
Mount the TouchCenter to the mounting plate by locating the four elongated holes over the locations on
the mounting plate and pushing down until it snaps into position.
4-9
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
TouchCenter (cont’d)
Configuring a TouchCenter
To configure a new TouchCenter do the following:
1 - Set an Address
On first power up, the TouchCenter will immediately prompt for a bus address. This should be any valid
address that is not shared with any other keypad on the same RS485 (AB) Line. The default address is
usually acceptable.
Or
If the address has previously been set and the address prompt does not appear, re-power the keypad and
within five seconds of power up, press the Console mode button
then press the ent button to change the
address.
2 - Register with the Control Panel
Once the address has been selected, the control panel must be repowered or, if another keypad is already
configured, exit from Engineer mode and the new TouchCenter will be registered.
The Home Page will be displayed and the keypad is ready to use.
NOTE: Refer to the control panel literature for valid addresses. One TouchCenter can be fitted to each
Galaxy RS485 line.
Set-up Menu
The TouchCenter has a number of configuration settings which are set up directly within the keypad. To
access these settings, the TouchCenter must be in communication with the Galaxy Panel. The panel must be in
Engineer’s mode. Proceed as follows:
1.
From the home screen press the SECURITY button and then enter the Authorisation code. This is the
Engineer PIN of the control panel. The Security screen is displayed.
2.
Press the MORE CHOICES button to enter the More Choices screen.
3.
Press the KEYPAD SETUP button to enter the Setup screen.
4.
Press the KEYPAD TEST button.
From this screen, the following options are available;
Self Diagnostics
A series of diagnostic tests are provided that allows verification of correct operation of the TouchCenter and
its connection to the Galaxy system. There are three diagnostic tests:
•
LCD Display Test
•
Audio Test
•
LED Test
Address
This allows the RS485 address to be changed. A change to this will require reconfiguration of the
TouchCenter with the control panel.
4-10
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
TouchCenter (cont’d)
TouchCenter - Operation
For general operation refer to the on-screen information and to the separate user’s guide.
For programming of the control panel, all options can be accessed via the virtual terminal mode, that emulates
a standard installer keypad. To access the terminal mode, press the terminal keypad icon in the lower left
corner of the Home Page.
Specifications
Mechanical
Dimensions:
Width:
182 mm
Height:
128 mm
Depth:
34 mm
Weight:
500g (approx)
Electrical
Operating Voltage:10.5 to 14V DC
Current Drain:
Backlight OFF, Sound ON:
Backlight ON, Sound OFF
Backlight ON, Sound ON:
Standby:
120mA
150mA
170mA
105mA
4-11
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
4-12
Access Control
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
SECTION 5: ACCESS CONTROL
Door Control Modules (DCMs) can be added onto the Galaxy bus lines to add fully integrated access control. Each DCM allows two Wiegand readers to be connected to control two separate doors; each door with
an exit button or one door with an entry and exit reader..
Group Based Access Control
Access control works best when Group Mode is enabled. Each access reader can then be programmed to
control access to a particular group (or area/subsystem) within the building. Only users who have access
privileges to that group will be granted access via that reader.
User and Access Templates
Every user on the system must be allocated an access template. An access template is a list of groups and
time schedules that will dictate which groups a user is able to gain access to and also the times that the user
can gain access. This method means that if there are multiple doors leading into one group or area, then a user
will be given access to all those doors in one move. This reduces programming time and complexity.
The Access Template to be used for each user is chosen within each user’s options in menu
42.1.11.= Template. There are multiple access templates available (dependant on panel variant) and each
one is fully customisable.
Access Templates are programmed in menu 45.7 = Access Templates. In each Access Template each
group on the system must be allocated a time schedule as required. If no schedule is allocated to a particular
group (default) in the list then users will have full access through any doors leading to that group. When a
schedule is allocated, access will be granted during the OFF periods of the schedule and denied during the
ON periods. Time schedules are programmed in menu 65 = Timers .
Time Schedules
A Time schedule is a weekly list of on and off times and can be used to control the security of any object that
it is assigned to. When a timer is ON it forces a secure state (system set, access denied etc). When a timer is
in the OFF state, it causes an un-secure state (system unset or access allowed etc). Up to 28 on or off times
can be programmed into each weekly schedule. Up to 67 schedules are available dependant on panel variant.
For each time schedule, it is possible to allocate one of 32 Holiday Calendars. A Holiday Calendar is a list of
20 holiday periods, each with a start and end date, which suspend normal timer operation. During a holiday
period, one of two things can happen.
1.
The timer is frozen in its current state (on or off) and will resume operation from the next event when the
holiday period finishes.
2.
An alternate time schedule can be appointed to be used for the duration of the holiday period.
5-1
Access Control (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Door Control Module
Door Control Modules (DCMs) can be added onto the Galaxy bus lines to add fully integrated access control. Each DCM allows up to two Wiegand readers to be connected to control two separate doors; each door
with an exit button or one door with an entry and exit reader.
BUS1/2
U in
0V
Data
0V
0V
A
B
Shield
RS485
* 2
! "
Shield
Shield
U EXT
U EXT
0V
# D0/
CLK
$% &$ %'
0V
D0/
CLK
D1/
DATA
D1/
DATA
$( &$ ('
LED
Red
LED
Red
)*$
LED
Yel
LED
Yel
)*$ LED
Grn
LED
Grn
)*$ +
BUZ
LED 2
(power)
LED 1
(comms)
BUZ
,, BC
BC
- .
0V
0V
# EC
EC
/* DC
$ 0V
# FC
0 & '
NC
- DC
$
$ 1
ON
0V
2 3
4
FC
5
NC
6 7
C
8
NO
C
NO
TC
/
Wiegand
Reader
Inputs
- 0V
) "!
3 "!
$(1 "!
Figure 5-1. Door Control Module PCB
NOTES:
1.
2.
If only one door is being connected, then always use the connections for Door 1 (Left Side) and
terminate the inputs with a 1K resistor.
When door readers are being connected for entry and exit to the same door, then connect the entry
reader to Door 1 and connect the exit reader to Door 2.
5-2
Access Control (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Inputs
0V
DC
The DCM includes the following sensing inputs:
1k
Door Contact (DC)
This input is a normal alarm zone input that has the same functionality as a
normal security zone type. It uses normal 1k/2k double balanced zone
wiring.
Normally
Closed
1k
Door Contact Wiring
Request To Exit Contact (EC)
0V
EC
This input is a normally open contact. When activated it will allow
the door to unlock for the programmed duration. Additionally, the
door can be held unlocked indefinitely by holding the EC closed. In
this case, the relay activates only for the programmed duration but
the door propped alarm is held off. This can be achieved, for
example, by using a keyswitch wired in parallel with the normal EC
button.
Function Contact
Normally
Open
Request to Exit
Contact Wiring
0V
FC
This uses normal 1 k/2 k double balanced zone wiring. It
has the function of initiating a pre-programmed menu option
following a valid card. The normal use is to activate the
setting procedure via the reader but any menu option can
be programmed.
1k
Normally
Closed
1k
Function Contact Wiring
Tamper Inputs
The tamper circuits for both readers should be wired to the same tamper
terminals on the DCM. The two circuits are wired in parallel, each with its
own series resistor as follows:
0V
TC
5k6
The reader tamper is double-balanced.
•
Reader 1 - 5.6kΩ
•
Reader 2 - 12kΩ
Normally
Closed
12k
Tamper Contact Wiring
Connecting a Wiegand Device
A standard Wiegand card reader or keypad can be connected to the DCM.
The keypad can operate in 4-bit and 8-bit burst mode.
Wiegand Reader Inputs
The wires from the Reader are connected to the Wiegand Reader Inputs (see
Figure 5-1). Refer to separate Reader instructions for method of wiring the
Reader to the DCM.
5-3
Access Control (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Buzzer Output
This activates the buzzer on the reader to indicate card read, access granted and card rejected. The output is
open collector and can switch up to 100 mA.
LED Output
LED output 3 is used to drive a reader LED. It is open collector and can switch up to 100 mA. LED outputs
1 and 2 are not used. The LED gives a visible indication on the reader of card read and access granted.
Relay Output
This is a relay output which is activated upon any valid card read or RTE button operation in order to temporarily unlock the door. The relay can switch up to 1A @ 30V AC.
Installation and Mounting
The DCM can be supplied installed in a standard plastic RIO box or within a Power RIO box.
Mounting the RIO Box
1.
2.
3.
4.
If necessary, remove the DCM PCB from the box to allow access to the screw holes.
Fix the base to the mounting surface, using the screw holes provided.
All cables must be brought into the enclosure base via the cable entry points. There are six cable entry
holes for the entry of alarm cables.
Attach the RIO box lid with the four thread forming screws provided.
Mounting the Power RIO Box
The DCM is mounted above the control PCB on a mounting plate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Remove the screws securing the left hand control PCB to the box.
Fit the four mounting pillars supplied with the kit in place of the PCB screws.
Fit the mounting plate to the pillars and secure using the screws removed from the PCB.
Attach the DCM to the mounting plate using the plastic clips supplied.
Wiring the Reader to the DCM
The wires from the Reader are connected to the Weigand Reader Inputs (see Figure 5-3). Refer to separate
Reader instructions for method of wiring the Reader to the DCM.
Addressing with DIP Switches
The DCM must be given a unique address before it is connected to a power supply. The DCM can be addressed with the DIP switches. The addressing works in a binary mode. The following table shows each DIP
switch with related address number. Switches 4 to 8 must be left in the off position.
5-4
Access Control (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Switch
Address
1
2
3
4-8
0
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
1
ON
OFF
OFF
OFF
2
OFF
ON
OFF
OFF
3
ON
ON
OFF
OFF
4
OFF
OFF
ON
OFF
5
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
6
OFF
ON
ON
OFF
7
ON
ON
ON
OFF
Table 5-1. DIP Switch Addressing
Connecting the DCM to Galaxy System
The DCM must be wired to the Galaxy RS485 (AB) line in parallel (daisy-chain configuration). The DCM
requires 12V d.c. This can be supplied from the control panel power supply or from the Power RIO when
mounted inside the Power RIO box.
See Figure 5-1 for a diagram of the connections.
NOTE: If the DCM is the last module on the line, connect a 680 Ω EOL resistor across the A and B
terminals.
Configuring the DCM
The added DCM is configured into the system on power up of the control panel or when exiting from engineer
mode. The flash rate of the green comms LED (LED1) on the DCM indicates the status of the communication
with the control panel. A short flash once per second indicates good communications.
LED 2 when lit indicates that there is power to the DCM.
5-5
Access Control (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Specifications
Physical
Weight (RIO):
270g approx.
Dimensions (RIO Box mm): 150 wide x 162 high x 39 deep
For additional weight and Dimension when housed within a Power RIO enclosure, please see the Power RIO
documentation.
Electrical
Operating voltage range:
Current draw, Typical:
Current draw, Maximum
(2 readers):
10.5V to 15V
40mA Typical
130 mA
Compliance
This product is suitable for use in systems compliant to EN50131-1: 2006, EN50133-1 and PD6662.
This product has been tested for compliance to EN50131-3 and EN50133-3 by CNPP.
Security Grade:
3
Environmental class: II
5-6
Access Control (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
MAX3
The MAX3 is a proximity reader access control device for a single door, which can also be used for setting
and unsetting of your alarm control panel. The MAX3 can be configured in one of two ways:
Standalone
In this configuration the MAX3 can be used for either door control or alarm system set/unset control, by either
connecting the internal relay output to a door lock or external relay. When in standalone mode the MAX3 is
programmed and operated using the MAX3 proximity cards or tags.The proximity cards and tags each have
unique ID numbers and must be identified to the MAX3 before being used to operate the system. The MAX3
memory can store up to 999 ID numbers, including at least three reserved for Masters. Once programmed,
the ID number of the tags and cards are stored indefinitely in the MAX3 memory until voided (removed) or
erased. Removing power from the MAX3 does not erase the programming memory.
Note : The MAX3 defaults to standalone mode. It can be configured to on-line mode directly from the
Galaxy Dimension control panels.
On-line
The MAX3 can operate in on-line mode, with the Galaxy Dimension control panel range, as a completely
integrated module on the system. In this configuration the MAX3 can be used for both door control and alarm
system set/unset control with complete user traceability stored within the Galaxy control panel.
For detailed instructions on how to programme the MAX3 onto the system in on-line mode refer to Option
69.2=MAX.
Installing the MAX3
MAX3 Pack
Your Max3 pack contains the following:
• Max3 proximity reader *
• Max3 drilling template
• Max3 installation instructions
• Surge suppressor
* The MAX3 is supplied with 3 metres of 12 wire E111235 AWG cable which is fixed and sealed through a
keyhole opening on the rear surface of the MAX3 .
Mounting the MAX3
To mount the MAX3 use the step by step diagrams provided with the drilling template.
The drilling template should be used as an aid to locate the holes required to secure the MAX3 and insert the
connection cable.
The MAX3 comes with an infra red lid tamper. The tamper is activated when the lid is removed from the
MAX3 unit.
5-7
Access Control (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Wiring the MAX3
The MAX3 unit can be connected to the control panel in
one of two ways depending upon whether it is being
used in an on-line or standalone configuration. The
diagram opposite provides details for both configurations. The MAX3 relay is configured in either the NC or
NO configuration depending upon the variant purchased
(MX03 - Normally Closed, MX03-NO - Normally
Open).
NOTE: Fitting of an external relay may be required
when using AC powered locks.
Supply Volts
12V dc
Quiescent Current
35 mA
)
!"#
Maximum Current
50 mA
)
'/ !"#
Maximum Switching Current
1A @ 30V dc max.
-*
'( ) Security Grade
3
) Environmental class
IV
-
Weight (boxed)
267 gm
Dimensions (box)
185x120x48 mm (LxBxH)
Galaxy Panel
Compatibility
Galaxy Dimension
Series
All
Galaxy 2 Series
V1.4 or later
Galaxy 8-512 Series
V2 or later
)"# +,
Table 5-2. MAX3 Specifications
.*
# -
"-
'/
"#
#* ! $%& !
$%&- !
)( $%&
- 0/
$%& $%&- Figure 5-2. Connection diagram
Table 5-3. Panel compatibility
1 = Read (Amber)
2 = Open (Green)
x
3 = Closed (Red)
4 = Nightlock (Red)
5 = Add (Red)
6 = Void (Red)
P
7 = Program (Red)
MAX3
Figure 5-3. MAX3 LED’s
5-8
Access Control (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Configuring a MAX3 Reader into the System
NOTE: MAX3 readers can only be configured into the Galaxy system from engineer mode.
1.
Connect the MAX3 to the Galaxy control panel as per the instructions given in Figure 5-1.
2.
Access engineer mode.
3.
Ensure that the Mode is enabled (option 69.1.1 = Access Control.Mode.Enabled).
4.
Assign the MAX3 reader as either On-Line or Stand-Alone using option 69.2.1 = Access
Control.MAX.MAX Address:
0 = On-Line: The MAX3 is fully integrated with the Galaxy system and communicates via the AB line,
sharing system resources and facilities.
1 = Standalone (default): The MAX3 operates as an entirely independent unit. The Galaxy does not
monitor the MAX3 for alarms, tampers or power failure.
5.
Press the ent key; the Galaxy panel may prompt (depending on model) for the AB line (1 – 4)) that is
to be searched; select the line and press the ent key. The Galaxy searches for the MAX3 with the
highest address. New MAX3 readers are addressed as 8 (standalone) by default.
6.
Only if adding a new MAX3 reader: On locating the MAX3 address, the keypad prompts for the
OPERATING MODE of MAX3 to be assigned: select 0 = On-Line or 1 = Standalone as required
and press the ent key.
When 0 = On-Line mode is selected, the keypad displays the current address of the MAX3 and the
range of valid addresses. Enter the new MAX3 address and press the ent key; the Galaxy then repro
grams the address of the MAX3. The keypad indicates the old and new MAX3 addresses and the
status of the reprogramming.
NOTE: It is recommended that when adding a reader, it is addressed as the lowest available number on the
line.
7.
When the reprogramming is complete the MAX3 bleeps, the LED’s on the MAX3 switch off and the
keypad display returns to 1 = MAX Address.
8.
Exit engineer mode - engineer code + esc: the keypad displays the message 1 MOD. ADDED esc=CONTINUE. LED 2 on the MAX3 reader switches on. Press the esc key; the keypad
returns to the unset banner.
If this message is not displayed, the MAX3 reader is not communicating with the control panel
and has not been configured into the system (LED 2 does not switch on).
NOTES:
1. The MAX3 reader will not operate until engineer mode is exited and the reader is configured into the
system.
2. All MAX3 doors must be closed, otherwise engineer mode cannot be exited.
9.
The on-line MAX3 reader is now configured into the system.
5-9
Access Control (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Removing a MAX3 Reader from the System
On-Line Mode
1.
Access engineer mode.
2.
Disconnect the MAX3 reader (AB line and power).
3.
Exit engineer mode.
4.
The message 1 MOD. MISSING — [<],[>] to View is displayed.
5.
Press the A or B key.
6.
The message MAX XX —º =REMOVE MODULE is displayed.
7.
Press the º key to acknowledge and accept that the MAX3 reader has been removed. The keypad
returns to the unset banner.
Operating Instructions
The MAX3 must be presented with a valid user card to allow access. Opening the door without presenting a
valid card activates a door forced alarm at the panel; the buzzer sounds and LED 2 flashes until the door is
closed.
Activating the egress switch allows the door to be opened without activating an alarm when no card has been
presented to the MAX3.
1. Ensure that LED 3 is on and all other LEDs are off.
2. Swipe the MAX with a standard user or nightlock access user card. LED 3 switches off and LED 2
switches on for the programmed Open Timeout.
3. Open the door while the LED 2 is on and access the area.
4. Close the door; LED 2 switches off and LED 3 switches on. The door must be closed within the programmed Close Timeout; if the door remains open longer than this, an alarm is activated.
Card-Held Function
The MAX3 or DCM card can be assigned a single menu option (refer to option 42.1.8 = CODES.User
Codes.MAX Function). To activate the function assigned to the MAX3 or DCM card, hold the card in front
of the reader for three seconds; all of the LEDs switch on. If a keypad has been assigned to the MAX function then it displays the details of this option. If no keypad is assigned, pressing a key on any of the keypads
assigned to a common group to the user displays the card-held function.
Card-Held System Setting
If the MAX3 or DCM card is assigned one of the setting options (option 12, 13, 14 & 16 – 19), the card-held
functions starts the setting procedure for the groups assigned to the card.
NOTE: If Group Restriction is assigned, then only the groups that are common to both the MAX3 reader
and the MAX3 user are set/unset
To unset the system using the MAX3 or DCM card, swipe the reader with a valid card. The reader beeps. All
of the groups assigned to the card are instantly unset.
5-10
Access Control (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
MAX3 Log
The Galaxy system has a panel dependent event log for recording the MAX3 activations. This log is shared by
all readers on the system and operates on a first-in-first-out basis for overwriting events when the log is filled.
To display the events in the MAX3 log select option 25 = ACCESS DOORS; use the A or B keys to select
the required MAX3 address then press the ent key. The first event that occurred on the selected MAX3 is
displayed along with details of the time, date and MAX3 number.
To view the log press the A key to move forward in time through the events or the B key to move backwards.
Press the esc key to return to the MicroMAX address display. To view the log of another MAX3, use the A
or B key to select the required address. To escape from the Access Doors option press the esc key.
Time and date
of event
02:25 SUN 22 OCT
USR032 Valid
MAX3 user number
Event type
MAX3 Events Print-Out
The MAX3 events can be printed out as they occur to an on-line printer. To print the MAX3 events ensure
that option 51.27 = PARAMETERS.On-Line Print is enabled. Select option 51.28 =
PARAMETERS.On-Line Level and enter 2 to print out all system events including the MAX3 events or 3
to print out only the MAX3 events.
NOTE: A serial printer must be connected to line one of the Galaxy panel and the printer must remain on-line
(ready to print) at all times.
Downloading the MAX3/ DCM Log
The MAX3/DCM event log can be downloaded to Remote Servicing by using the MAX/DCM Log copy
option in Remote Servicing.
5-11
Access Control (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Dual Access Cards
If a user’s card number is assigned a *, then the card becomes Dual access. This means that it will not open
the door on its own; it needs another PIN or card as well. (see option 42 = Codes for programming).
Dual Focus (Card Held)
If a card has a # assigned to the number, then any card-held function will only work in conjunction with the
PIN from the same user, provided that the PIN has a # assigned also. The Dual Focus function will work in
either order, but if the card is presented first, it will simply enable the PIN to gain access to the normal menu
(see option 42 = Codes for programming).
Timed Anti-Passback
When the Timed Anti-Passback feature is enabled, it will prevent more than one use of any particular card at a
particular reader within a given time period. See option
69.2.2.6 = Access Control.MAX.Max Parameters.Anti-Passback for programming details.
A forgiveness function is available to clear all or particular antipassback restrictions in force. There are set
Anti-Passback users as defined in the following Table. If a card belonging to one of these users is swiped at a
reader, all anti-passback restriction at that reader are cleared. A manager code can authorise a forgive function
on a particular user in option 42.1 = Codes.User Codes. An engineer code can authorise a forgive function
on a particular reader in option 69.2.2.6.3 = Access Control.MAX.Max Parameters.AntiPassback.Forgive.
5-12
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Menu options
SECTION 6: SYSTEM OPERATION
Menu Options
General
The Galaxy Dimension provides various menu options for modifying the functional performance of the system.
There are two menu structures:
1.
Full Menu — only accessed by authorized users including the master manager code and by the
engineer.
2.
Quick Menu — a selection of options from the full menu. The quick menu is the default menu
access for all user codes (type 2.3 and above), except master manager and engineer.
The Full Menu
The full menu has a hierarchy of 5 structures contained within it. Each structure is accessible by an increased
type of user code.
The Quick Menu
The quick menu offers type 2.3 and above users a selection of up to 10 options, numbered 0 – 9. The options
available from the quick menu can be modified to the user’s requirement via option 59 = QUICK MENU.
Quick Menu
Full Menu
User (Type 2.3)
User (Type 2.4)
User (Type 2.5)
Manager (Type 3.6)
Engineer (Type 3.7)
Engineer (Type 3.7)
Engineer (Type 3.7)
0 = Omit Zones
10 = Setting
20 = Display
30 = Test
40 = Modify
50 = Engineer 1
60 = Engineer 2
70 = Engineer 3
1 = Forced Set
11 = Omit Zones
21 = Display Zones
31 = Walk Test
41 = Time/Date
51 = Parameters
61 = Diagnostics
71 = Program Key
2 = Chime
12 = Timed Set
22 = Display Log
32 = Outputs
42 = Codes
52 = Program Zones
62 = Full Test
3 = Display Zones
13 = Part Set
23 = System
43 = Summer
53 = Program Outputs
63 = Options
4 = Display Log
14 = Forced Set
24 = Print
44 = Trace
54 = Links
64 = Assemble Zone
5 = Print
15 = Chime
25 = Access Doors
45 = Timer Control
55 = Soak
65 = Timers
66 = Pre-Check
6 = Walk Test
16 = Instant Set
46 = Group Omit
56 = Communication
7 = Time/Date
17 = Silent Part
47 = Remote Access
57 = System Print
67 = Remote Reset
8 = Codes
18 = Home Set
48 = Eng Access
58 = Keypad
68 = Menu Access
9 = Summer
19 = All Set
59 = Quick Menu
69 = Access Control
Table 6-1. Quick and Full Menu Options Reference
Menu Access
Only valid codes (type 2.3 and above) can access the menu options. Access to the user options is assigned
by the engineer (refer to options 42 = CODES and 68 = MENU ACCESS). Users cannot view or access
options for which they are not authorized; this includes options in the Quick Menu.
NOTE: Menu options 51 – 67 (ENGINEER 1 and ENGINEER 2) can be assigned additional access to
user type 2.3 - 3.6, by the engineer.
6-1
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Menu Access
There are two methods of selecting menu options:
1.
Direct Access:
Code + ent + option number + ent.
2.
Menu Driven Access:
Code + ent + A (to select menu level) + ent;
A key (to select menu option) + ent.
Direct Access
Entering a valid menu option number while in the menu immediately moves to that option. For example, pressing 52 (type 3.7 only) when the keypad is displaying 22 = DISPLAY LOG moves directly to option
52 = PROGRAM ZONES; Pressing 10 while accessing the PROGRAM ZONES option moves directly
to 10 = Group (group mode must be first enabled in option 63.1). The option number entered must be valid
for the type of the menu structure that is currently being accessed.
Menu Driven Access
Menu driven access allows the engineer (and users) to enter the menu and, by using the A and B keys, navigate through the available options. The options are accessed by pressing the ent key. If you press and hold
the A key it will scroll forward through the options and if you press and hold the B key it will scroll backwards
through the options.
Keypad Menu Timeout
Once the user menu has been accessed (irrespective of user type), if there are no keypresses for two minutes,
then the keypad timeout occurs; the system returns to the banner text.
NOTE: This feature does not apply when the system is in the Walk Test option. If no zones are tested or no
keypresses occur for 20 minutes when Walk Test is selected, then the keypad timeout occurs. In
Menu Option 66 (Pre-check) there is also a 20 minute timeout after the last zone has been activated.
Engineer Mode
To program the Galaxy Dimension control panel, the system must be in engineering mode. This allows access
to the engineer menu options 50 = ENGINEER 1, 60 = ENGINEER 2 and 70 = ENGINEER 3.
6-2
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Engineer Menu
Accessing Engineer Mode
User Authorized Access
Entry to the engineer mode is authorized by a user with access to menu option 48.1.1 =Eng Access.System
Access.Engineer. The user selects this option and presses key 1 to enable engineer access. The engineer
code must then be entered within five minutes of the option being enabled. A single entry of the engineer code
directly accesses the mode. If the code is not entered within the five minute period, the engineer code is invalid
and has no effect. Once the engineer mode has been accessed, there is no time limit on the period that the
engineer can remain in the mode.
On accessing engineering mode, any group that is set becomes inaccessible to the engineer. The set groups
cannot be assigned to zones, outputs and any other functions permitting group allocation. When the engineer
code is entered three things happen:
•
•
•
All system tampers become isolated.
The engineer is given access to the full menu.
The banner message is changed to indicate engineer mode.
Exiting from Engineer Mode
To exit from engineer mode and return to the normal banner enter, carry out the following operation:
1.
Return to the engineer banner
2.
Enter the engineer code
3.
Press the esc key
The Galaxy carries out the following checks:
1.
That there are no module or zone tampers. If there are any module or zone tampers the escape
procedure is aborted.
2.
That it is communicating with all of the attached modules.
If any modules are reported as missing from the system, the Galaxy prompts the engineer to
remove each of the missing modules by pressing the key. If the engineer does not remove the
missing modules, the escape procedure is aborted.
3.
That all of the access doors (controlled by the on-line MAX) are closed. If any of the access doors
are open, then the exit procedure is halted until all of the doors are closed.
4.
That there are no power failures on the galaxy system, such as AC fail, fuse fail or battery fail.
6-3
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
User Access
Aborting the Exit Engineer Mode Procedure
If the esc key is pressed at any point while engineer mode is being exited, before the normal banner is displayed, the exit procedure is aborted and the system remains in engineering mode.
Multi User Access
The Galaxy allows multi-user access. A maximum of 4 users (GD-48), 8 users (GD-96) and 16 users
(GD-264/520) can simultaneously carry out tasks on the system.
6-4
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Setting the System
Setting Options
Setting the System Using a PIN
Full Setting
Enter: USER CODE + A
If groups are enabled and the user code has been assigned group choice then the keypad displays the set
status of the available groups:
R = Ready
F = Fault (group is unset and at least 1
SET
A12345678
zone is open)
Groups RRSRSSSS
P = Part Set
S (flashing) = selected for setting
S (steady) = already set
L = Group is locked out and cannot be unset.
- = Group is not available to the user
Pressing the keys for the groups toggles the R (Ready) to an S (set flashing).
SET
A12345678
Groups SSSRR--NOTE: On systems with more than eight groups, the groups are displayed in blocks of eight. Each block can
be viewed by pressing the A or B keys.
Once the required groups have been selected press the ent key to begin the setting procedure.
If groups are not enabled or the user does not have group choice, entering the user code followed by the A
key immediately starts the setting procedure.
TIMED
060
The keypad displays the exit time countdown. At the end of the exit time, or when the setting procedure is
terminated by a FINAL or PUSH-SET zone closing, the ENTRY/EXIT HORN outputs and keypad buzzers become silent for four seconds, then emit two long tones to confirm that the system is set. The message
SYSTEM IS SET appears briefly before the keypad display changes back to the normal day banner.
Part Setting
Enter:
PART SET
060
CODE + B
This is identical to the Full Setting procedure, except the keypad display indicates that the system is being
Part Set. Only the zones which have the Part attribute enabled (refer to option 52.5 = PROGRAM
ZONE.Part), are included.
Cancelling the Setting
The full and part setting routines can be aborted by pressing the esc key (on the keypad used to begin setting)
before the system sets.
6-5
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Unsetting the System
Unsetting the System Using a PIN
During the unsetting procedure, initiated by the opening of FINAL or ENTRY zone on a set group, the
system is unset by entering the user code followed by the A key.
•
If the user does not have group choice, all of the groups assigned to the code are instantly unset.
•
If the user has group choice only the group that the FINAL or ENTRY zone is assigned to is
unset; all of the other groups remain set. The system displays the set status of the remaining
groups and prompts for the required groups to be unset. To unset the required groups press the
relevant number keys — the S or P (Set or Part Set) changes to flashing U — and then press the
ent key.
•
When the system/group is unset three short beeps are emitted to advise the user that the system/group is
unset
Engineer Unsetting
The engineer can only unset a system that was set using the engineer code. The engineer code cannot be used
to unset a system that was set by a user code.
Keyswitch Setting Options
Zones programmed as KEYSWITCH can be used to full set, part set and unset the system. Refer to option
52 = PROGRAM ZONE.
Setting the System with a Keyswitch
The KEYSWITCH starts the setting procedure of each of the groups assigned to the keyswitch zone. At the
end of the exit time, or when the setting procedure is terminated by a FINAL or PUSH-SET zone closing, the
ENTRY/EXIT HORN outputs and keypad buzzers become silent for four seconds, then emit two long tones
to confirm that the system is set.
NOTE: If the KEYSWITCH has its Part attribute enabled (refer to option 52 = PROGRAM ZONE) then
the KEYSWITCH part sets the system.
Unsetting the System with a Keyswitch
Activating the KEYSWITCH when the group that it is assigned to is set instantly unsets the group. All other
groups which have been “starred” to the KEYSWITCH are not affected and remain set.
Setting the System with Cards/Tags/Fobs
The Proximity user cards can be used to set and unset the system. This is done by assigning a user with one
of the setting options (refer to option 42.1.8 = CODES.User Codes.MAX Function). When the card is
held against a MAX module or keyprox for five seconds, the card held function programmed to the card user
is activated. For access control readers, a function button or triple swipe will be required to activate the card
function.
If the card user has a keypad assigned, the function will be shown as the assigned keypad. If the card user has
no keypad assigned then all keypads in the group assigned to the card user will show “Press any Key”. If a
6-6
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Card Setting
key is pressed the keypad containing the key to be pressed will show the card held function. If no keys are
pressed all keypads in the group(s) allocated to the card will show card the held menu function.
If the card user has group choice all groups available to the user will be displayed on the keypad. The user
must select the groups to be set/unset/part set using the appropriate number keys, as per normal PIN users.
If the card user has no group choice then the card held setting function will commence automatically.
Unsetting the System with Proximity Cards
The system or groups can be unset using proximity cards with the MAX, KeyProx modules and access
control readers.
If the unsetting procedure has been started by activating a Final or Entry zone then, swiping the card will unset
the system. If the card user has group choice then, only the group assigned to the Final or Entry zone will be
unset. All other groups available to the user will be displayed on the programmed/selected keypad or keyprox.
NOTE: The reader module must have common groups to the proximity card user to allow the card held
function to be activated.
Cancelling and Resetting Alarms and Alerts
Following an alarm, sounders and strobes are activated. When a fault condition occurs in the unset state, an
alert condition is activated. This consists of an intermittent beep at the keypad and/or a visual alert on the
keypad. Following each alarm activation, the alarm must be cancelled and the Galaxy reset. The activation is
cancelled by entry of any valid user code (type 2.2 and above) assigned to the group that has alarmed or by
presentation of a valid proximity card to a reader. The alarm sounders, Bell and Strobe outputs are silenced
and the keypad displays information on the zones or faults that have been activated. Use the A> and <B keys
to scroll through multiple activations.
If the user code entered is not of a sufficient level to reset the Galaxy, the keypad displays the message CALL
MANAGER RESET REQUIRED or CALL ENGINEER RESET REQUIRED (parameter 51.63 =
Banner Alerts must be enabled), depending on the type of alarm and level of reset required.
The Galaxy is reset by entering a valid user code assigned to the group that has alarmed, with the appropriate
reset level for the type of alarm that has activated — System, Tamper or PA (refer to option 51.6 =
PARAMETERS.System Reset, 51.7 = PARAMETERS.Tamper Reset and 51.22 =
PARAMETERS.PA Reset or 51.65 = PARAMETERS.Reset Levels). The keypad displays information on the zones that have been activated during the alarm.
NOTE: If a tamper alarm has activated (zone or module) then the system cannot be reset until the tamper
condition is restored.
On the next setting of the Galaxy, if any of the zones that were opened during the previous alarm have not
closed since the alarm activation, then the system is prevented from setting. The addresses of the open zones
are displayed on the keypad; there is no sounder activation. Closing the zones permits the setting procedure to
start.
NOTE: This is not the same as open zones being indicated on the keypad; these are accompanied by rapid
tones on the Entry/Exit Horn.
Recording of Events
During any given set period, there is no limit to the number of signals sent from individual activations. However, no more than three events from any single source will be recorded in the event log.
6-7
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Setting Features
Resetting Using Alarm Cause Code
If enabled in menu option 51.72, when a reset is required, an alarm cause code must be entered to reset the
system.
If there are multiple alarm causes and/or multiple groups require to be reset, then the alarm cause code only
has to be entered once. The user enters the most appropriate code as determined on site. The cause code
values should be determined in conjunction with the Alarm Receiving Centre (ARC).
Overriding of Faults and Tampers
Whenever a user logs in, the display shows any unrestored faults and tampers. If the condition cannot be
cleared and restored, then to enable the system to be set, a facility to override the condition is included.
When a user tries to set the system, the system displays any conditions and allow the user to scroll through
multiple conditions. If the user has the authority to override the condition, the following display accompanies
the condition;
ENT to Continue
0001 +CU-BATT
If the user cannot override the condition, the ENT to Continue will not be displayed.
The user can override each authorized condition, by pressing the ent key while the condition is displayed on
the keypad. Each and every condition is individually displayed and overridden.
Pressing enter omits the condition for one set period only. Pressing escape returns to the previous banner.
When setting the system with an overridden fault or tamper condition, the display indicates the overridden
function in place of the set mode by showing the omit message as detailed in the omit menu function. The
Override condition is logged, and will last for one set period only. When all the groups that are affected by the
override condition become unset, the override status is cleared. An override restore is logged at unset.
If, during a setting attempt, there are conditions that haven’t restored and cannot be overridden, then the
system will not set. The display shows the CALL MANAGER RESET REQUIRED banner with a short
beep every 30 seconds .
Setting Features
The Galaxy control panels provide a range of features to assist the user in the setting and unsetting of the
system, minimising the possibility of error when carrying out these procedures.
Show Set Status
When Show Status is enabled (refer to option 58.6 = KEYPAD.Show Status), pressing the
simultaneously when the normal banner is displayed indicates the group set status.
and # keys
F = Fault
R = Ready
S = Set
P = Part Set
STATUS
Groups
12345678
RRSRLPFP
Group Block
L = Locked Out
– = Group not assigned to keypad
NOTE: The Show Status indicates the set conditions of groups when the system is set (keypad blank) or
unset (normal banner). Show Status does not operate while engineer mode is accessed.
6-8
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Setting Features (cont’d)
Pressing the and # keys again toggles the display to show the status of the groups individually. To move
between each groups, press the and A or the and B keys simultaneously.
08:58 TUE 22 NOV
A1U Group A1
Group A1 is unset
Pressing the
and # keys again returns the keypad to the banner display.
Multi-group Systems
The larger Galaxy panels have 32 groups; these are displayed on the keypad in blocks of eight groups, subdivided into A, B, C and D:
Exit Time
Once the setting routine starts, outputs programmed as Entry/Exit Horn emit a continuous tone. The keypad
used to set the system indicates the time, in seconds, remaining before the system sets.
Exit Time Reset
If any zones are open when setting starts or are opened during the setting routine, the sounder begins to pulse
rapidly; zones types other than Final, Exit, Entry or Push-Set (and Secure Final or Part Final when acting
as a Final), indicate on the setting keypad the number of zones open. The A or B keys can be used to view
the open zone types and addresses. Closing the zones resets and restarts the exit time.
Omitted Zones
If zones are omitted when the system starts setting, this is indicated on the keypad. The keypad indicates how
many zones are omitted.
Expiry Warning
During the last 25% of the programmed exit time outputs programmed as Entry/Exit Horn begin to pulse
rapidly, indicating that time is running short.
System Set Indication
At the end of the exit time the Entry/Exit Horns become silent for four seconds. This allows the door to be
locked and secured and gives the detectors time to settle before the system finally sets. Two long tones are
emitted to confirm that the system has set. If all groups are set the keypad briefly displays the message SYSTEM IS SET before returning to the normal banner.
Group Logic Setting Restriction
If Setting Logic has been assigned to a group (refer to 63.1.2 = OPTIONS.Groups.Setting Logic), the set
status of the groups must satisfy the conditions defined in the option to permit the group to set. If the Setting
Logic conditions are not satisfied, then the group cannot set. If multiple groups are being set simultaneously,
but one group is restricted due to the programmed Setting Logic, the remainder of the groups set. The
restricted group does not set; there is no warning or indication given.
6-9
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Setting Features (cont’d)
If the programmed Setting Logic results in none of the selected groups being allowed to set, a warning
message is displayed on the keypad. This message does not appear if at least one group sets.
2 Groups not set
[<],[>]
to view
Entry Time
The system begins the unsetting routine whenever a Final or Entry zone activates. The Entry/Exit Horns
pulse slowly indicating that the entry time countdown has started. The user must go directly to the keypad,
using the agreed entry route, and unset the system before the entry time expires. When 75% of the entry time
has elapsed the Entry/Exit horns pulse rapidly, indicating that time is running short.
Timeout (Slow Entry)
If the entry time expires before a valid code is entered to unset the group, a full alarm occurs. This is recorded
in the event log as a Timeout against the group which was in the process of being unset.
Straying from the Entry Route
If, during the entry routine, the user strays from the agreed entry route and activates a zone in a protected
area, a full alarm occurs.
Abort Time
Should the user exceed the entry time or stray from the entry route a full alarm occurs. However the activation
of the intruder output can be delayed to allow time for the user to abort the remote signalling.
The Abort Time parameter can also be programmed so that an Intruder alarm is activated immediately the
entry time expires or a zone is activated, but entry of any valid code cancels the alarm and deactivates the
Intruder outputs without the need for a system reset.
Abort Setting Message
Zones that are open or opened during the exit period are indicated to the user by a rapid audible tone from the
entry/exit horns. The keypad displays the open zones and then prompts the user to abort the setting by pressing the ESC key. This message is designed to prevent users from re-entering the building, closing the open
zones, allowing the system to set and trapping the user in the building.
Fail to Set
An output type (Option 53-Program output 40, Fail Set) is available that activates if a full set has not
occurred after a programmed period of time (determined by Option 51-Parameter 35, Fail to Set) from the
start of the setting procedure.
Power Failure While System is Set
When power is restored to the system, following a complete mains (a.c.) and standby battery (d.c.) power
failure, the system attempts to return to the set status — full or part — prior to the power failure. The system
begins the setting procedure. If there are no zones open that prevent the system from setting, at the end of the
programmed exit time, the appropriate groups and parts are set.
6-10
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
11 - Omit Zones
Menu Options 11-19
Option 11 – Omit Zones (Quick Menu Option 0)
Code + ent + 11 + ent + A or B to select zone + # +
A or B to select zone + # + ..........
ent (to set) or esc (to select another option)
This option allows zones to be temporarily removed (omitted) from the system. Once a zone has been omitted
it does not generate an alarm condition (including tamper). The omitted zones are reinstated automatically
when the system is unset or manually when the zone omit option is disabled.
On selecting the Omit Zones option, the first zone that has the omit attribute enabled is displayed (refer to
option 52 = PROGRAM ZONE). If there are no omittable zones, then the message NO ENTRIES is
displayed.
Press the A or B keys to view other omittable zones. Press the # key to toggle the omit status of the required
zone. The display indicates the new omit status.
NOTE: A zone is omitted from the system as soon as it is selected.
This process is continued until all the required zones have been omitted:
•
pressing the ent key starts the timed setting routine. The number of zones omitted from the system are
displayed during the exit time countdown;
• pressing the esc key returns to the 11 = OMIT ZONES without starting the setting routine.
On returning to the banner (normal or engineer) the keypad displays the message ZONES OMITTED.
Omitted zones remain omitted for one set period only or until they are manually reinstated to the system.
Outputs programmed as Zone Omit (mode programmed as reflex) are activated as soon as the zone is
omitted and remains active until the zone is reinstated.
6-11
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
11 - Omit Zones (cont’d)
There are five zone types which vary from the standard Omit Zones operation:
•
Vibration Zones — if the omitted zone is a Vibration zone, then all zones (in all groups) programmed as
this type are block omitted. The Vibration zones remain omitted until they are manually reinstated.
Unsetting the system does not reinstate Vibration zones.
•
ATM1/2/3/4 Zones — a single ATM zone type can be omitted for the duration of the period entered in
the ATM Timeout parameter (option 51.39). The ATM Delay parameter (option 51.38) determines
the delay before ATM zones are omitted following the entry of one of the ten ATM Codes.
Entry of a code allows the user to omit one of the ATM zone types. Once omitted, the initiating keypad
indicates the number of minutes remaining until the selected ATM zones are reintroduced to the system. A
warning is given ten and five minutes before the zones are reinstated. The omit time may be extended indefinitely by re-entering an ATM Code. Outputs programmed as ATM1/2/3/4 are active when the respective
ATM zone type is omitted, and remain active until the zone type is reinstated.
Refer to option 52 = PROGRAM ZONES for details on the operation of Vibration and ATM zone types.
Manually Reintroducing Omitted Zones to the System
Selecting the OMIT ZONES option; using the A or B keys, select the omitted zone to be reinstated. Press
the # key toggle the omit status of the required zone. The display indicates the new omit status.
Normal Setting with Omitted Zones
Initiate the full or part setting routine. The system starts to set; the display indicates that zones have been
omitted. The zone remains omitted until the system is unset (with the exception of Vibration and ATM zones).
6-12
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Options 12 - 16
Option 12 – Timed Set
This option, when entered, starts the setting routine. The Entry/Exit Horns emit the expiry warning using the
programmed exit time (0-300 seconds). The system sets at the end of the exit time or earlier if a Final Zone is
opened and closed, key 0 is pressed — if programmed as an exit terminator — or if a push-set terminator is
operated. The option displays the time remaining until the system sets or the number of open zones preventing
the system from setting. Opening a zone during the exit routine resets the exit timer. Pressing the esc key prior
to the system setting aborts the setting routine.
NOTE: The factory default setting allows the timed setting routine to be initiated by entering a valid type2.3
(or above) user code and pressing the A key. By default the A key is assigned the function Timed
Set. The A key can be reprogrammed by the engineer to perform another function, or to start the
setting routine without a code being entered.
Option 13 – Part Set
This option operates exactly as the Timed Set option with the exception that only those zones that have the
part attribute enabled (refer to option 52 = PROGRAM ZONES) are set. All zones have the part attribute
enabled by default. Therefore selecting PART SET from the factory will set all zones. The part attribute of
the zones must be disabled if they are not to be included in the part set.
NOTE: The factory default setting allows the part setting routine to be initiated by entering a valid type 2.3
(or above) user code and pressing the B key. By default the B key is assigned the function Part Set.
The B key can be reprogrammed by the engineer to perform another function, or to start the part
setting routine without a code being entered.
Option 14 – Forced Set (Quick Menu Option 1)
Forced Set allows a timed set of the system when there are zones that are open at the point of selecting the option. The open zones must have the omit attribute enabled (refer to option 52 = PROGRAM
ZONES). This option is only available if the Forced parameter (option 51.26) is enabled; otherwise, the
selection is invalid and the keypad displays the message Option not available.
When the Forced Set option is entered, the keypad displays the number of zones that have been omitted
(manually by option 11 = OMIT ZONES and automatically by the Forced Set) and the setting routine
begins. If there are any open zones that do not have the omit attribute enabled, the keypad displays the
number of open zones that are not omittable and prompts the user to view them. The non-omittable zones
must be closed before the setting routine can continue.
Option 15 – Chime (Quick Menu Option 2)
The Chime option allows the user to switch the chime facility on and off. Any zones that have the chime attribute enabled (refer to option 52 = PROGRAM ZONES) momentarily operate Entry/Exit Horns when
opened; 2 long tones are emitted.
Option 16 – Instant Set
Selecting this option immediately sets all zones. No sounder or exit time is involved.
NOTE: The zones must be closed to allow the system to set. If any zones are open, then the exit time reset
feature (detailed previously) is activated.
6-13
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Options 17 - 19
Option 17 – Silent Part
Selecting this option sets all zones that have the part attribute enabled. It starts a normal timed exit procedure
but exit sounders are not activated. In the event of an alarm occuring during a Silent Part set (e.g. fire alarm),
normal operation will be re-instated.
When group mode is enabled (Menu option 63.1), setting of a group using Silent Part set will not affect the
operation of any of the other group setting options.
NOTE:
The zones must be closed to allow the system to silent set. If any zones are open, then the Exit
Time Reset feature (detailed previously) is activated.
Unsetting from Menu option 17 will still give a double beep.
Option 18 – Home Set
The Home Set option either fully sets or part sets the system. The system is:
•
fully set if the exit time is manually terminated via a Final or Push-Set zone operation;
•
part set if the exit time is allowed to expire.
Option 19 – All Set
All Set allows a timed set of groups assigned to the user code without offering the choice of which groups are
to be set. No group choice is offered. The groups that are set when this option is selected is determined by the
keypad group restriction (refer to option 58.7 = KEYPADS.Groups):
•
If there is no keypad group restriction then all of the groups assigned to the user are set — as long as
there is at least one common group assigned to the keypad.
•
If there is a group restriction on the setting keypad, then only the groups that are common to both the user
and the keypad on which the menu option is selected are set. For example, a user assigned groups 1, 2, 3,
and 4 selecting the All Set option on a keypad assigned groups 2 and 3 will only set groups 2 and 3.
6-14
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
21 - Display Zones
Display Options
Option 21 – Display Zones (Quick Menu Option 3)
Selecting and entering the Display Zones option shows the first zone on the system. Other zones may be
viewed by pressing the A and B keys or by entering the zone number directly.
The top line displays:
•
the address;
•
the group assigned — if the group mode is enabled. Only the zones assigned to the user’s group are
displayed.
•
the zone function alternating with the status — open, closed, high resistance, low resistance, tamper short
or tamper open circuit or masked.
The bottom line shows:
•
the zone descriptor (if used);
•
by pressing the # key the bottom line changes to show the circuit resistance in Ohms, if using a hardwired
RIO and the RIO (not zone) voltage, pressing the # key returns the bottom line to the zone descriptor.
Pressing the # key twice gives the maximum (+) and minimum (-) zone resistance for a particular day. The
scroll keys (A & B) scrolls between the stored values for the past 14 days.
A printout of all the zones is available from this option by pressing the key; pressing the esc key aborts the
printout.
NOTE: A serial printer must be connected to the Galaxy panel via a printer interface module, an RS232
interface module, or the on-board RS232 serial port.
6-15
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
22 - Display Log
Option 22 – Display Log (Quick Menu Option 4)
The Galaxy event log is viewed using this menu option. The number of events that each of the Galaxy panels
can store are as follows:
•
GD-48
- 1000 events
• GD-96/264/520 - 1500 events
The alarm log uses a FIFO (First In, First Out) method to log and store alarms. The control panel differentiates between mandatory and non-mandatory events. All events are logged, however when the log becomes
full, non-mandatory events are dropped first. The log will always contain at least 500 mandatory events
(assuming 500 or more mandatory events have been generated). A full list of EN50131-1 mandatory events
and non-mandatory events logged by the Galaxy panel is given in Appendix D of this manual.
NOTE: The number of events logged from any one source during any set/unset period is controlled by
parameter 51.48 (Alarm Limits).
If group mode is enabled (refer to option 63 = OPTIONS) and the user code has group choice (refer to
option 42 = CODES), then the available groups are displayed for selection. Press the number of the groups
to be displayed, the N below the selected group changes to a flashing Y. When all the required groups are
selected press the ent key to access the log; only the events in the selected groups are displayed.
Once the event log is accessed, the most recent event is displayed. The B key steps backwards in time
through the log, while the A key moves forward in time. Holding down either key quickly steps through the
dates until the required date is found. When a selected date is on display the events of that day and previous
days can be viewed by repeatedly pressing the B key; events on subsequent days are viewed by repeatedly
pressing the A key.
The event log is wrapped round from beginning to end. The message START or END (depending on
whether the A key or the B key is being pressed) is briefly displayed when the wraparound is passed through.
The following information is detailed in the event log:
•
time - time that event occurred;
•
date - day and date that event occurred;
•
event - information about the type of event that occurred. Certain events are displayed with a +
(positive — indicating that the event started or was activated) or – (negative — indicating that the event
ended or was terminated) symbol;
•
user - alternates between the name and number of the user who initiated the event. If the event is
one that is not associated with a user code, for example, an alarm activation or a Final zone
closing, then no user information is displayed.
Pressing the # key while viewing the log can reveal additional information about certain event types:
•
User events reveal the keypad, user type and user group involved in the event;
•
Alarm events reveal the zone descriptor, if programmed.
•
Walk tested RF zones reveal the measured signal strength of each RF device.
•
REM CALL event displays the Remote Station ID for the Remote Servicing Software which has made
the connection with the panel.
6-16
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
23 - System
10:24 SUN 01 JAN
K10
L7
Level of User Code
Keypad Address
K = Keypad
AB Line
NOTES:
1.
Where two identical events occur within 1 second, only one is logged.
2.
Only the first occurrences of high resistance and low resistance events on each day are logged.
Subsequent activations are ignored until midnight of the same day. This is to prevent the log
from being filled with high and low resistance activations from a faulty zone.
The event log can be printed while accessing the Display Log option. Pressing the key while displaying an
event starts the printout from the displayed event and prints forward to the most recent event. The esc key
aborts the print out.
NOTE: A serial printer must be connected to the Galaxy panel via a printer interface module, the RS232
interface module, or the RS232 serial port.
Option 23 – System
This option provides a quick overview of the system configuration; two lines of information are displayed at a
time - the A and B keys are used to scroll through the entire list:
•
•
Groups
Group status
use the A and B keys to scroll through groups A1–8, B1–8, C1–8 and D1–8
U = Unset, S = Set, P = Part set and L = Locked-out for each of the groups
displayed;
NOTE: Enabling the Show Status option (refer to option 58 = KEYPADS) allows the group set status to
be displayed from the normal banner (when the system is set or unset) by pressing the and # keys
simultaneously.
•
Type
Galaxy 48, 96, 264 or 520;
•
Version
version of software in Galaxy panel;
•
RIOs fitted
includes the on-board RIOs;
•
Codes used
includes the manager, engineer and remote codes;
•
Keypads fitted
1–8 (Galaxy 48), 1–16 (Galaxy 96/264), 1–32 (Galaxy 520);
•
Comms modules 1-7 (Telecom, RS232, ISDN, Ethernet, Int Telecom, Int RS232, Audio Module);
•
Printer
0–1 (Printer Interface Module);
•
MAX Modules
gives the number of MAX modules on the system;
•
DCM Modules
gives the number of Door Control Modules on the system;
•
MUX Modules
gives the number of MUX Modules on the system
•
Panel location
up to 16 characters of text entered in System Text parameter (option 51.15.2).
•
Default Set
gives the default settings set up in menu 51.17.
6-17
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
24 - Print
Option 24 – Print (Quick Menu Option 5)
NOTE: A serial printer must be connected to the Galaxy panel via a printer interface module, an RS232
interface module, or an on-board RS232 serial port.
This option has two sub-menus:
1 = Printer Module
2 = INT RS232 1
Each of these two sub-menus allows one of the four listed options below to be printed. Only information
corresponding to the groups assigned to the user is printed.
1 = Codes
Prints user number and name, type and groups assigned;
NOTE: Only the manager can print out the user PINS; the Print Codes parameter (option 51.23) must be
enabled (default is disabled).
2 = Zones
Prints address, function, group (if group mode is enabled), status, descriptor (if assigned),
status of the chime, omit and part attributes, the RIO voltage and the zone resistance in Ohms;
3 = Log
Prints all events in the log, starting with the most recent and working backwards;
4 = All
Prints codes, zones and log details respectively.
The required option is selected by pressing the appropriate key 1-4. The printing begins immediately and can
be aborted by pressing esc.
6-18
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
25 - Access Doors
Option 25 – Access Doors
This option dispays information about the DCM and MAX readers together with users connected to the
system. There are 4 options:
1 = View All
This option displays the access log but with no filter. All events are displayed.
NOTE: If the Access mode has not been enabled (refer to option 69.1 = Mode) the message No Entries is
displayed on entering this option.
2 = User
This option shows all events for the selected user. Managers can see all the users. Induvidual users can only
see their own events.
3 = Reader
Accessing this option when the access mode is enabled (option 69.1) and there are MAX/DCM modules
connected to the system displays the address and descriptor details of the first MAX/DCM module on the
system. Press the A and B keys to view details of the other MAX/DCM modules on the system.
If there are no MAX/DCM modules attached to the system the message None Detected is displayed.
4 = Date
This option allows a specific date to be entered in the format DD/MM/YY. This forces the display to go to a
specific date.
Access Log
Access events are transmitted using Contact ID, SIA and Alarm Monitoring formats. Access events transmitted are listed in the table that follows:
E ven t
Description
SIA Code
CID
C ode
Trigger
Mod No User ID
A cce ss
Granted
Valid card presented and
validated
DG
421
MAX TAGS
Yes
Yes
Invalid Card
Card presented has not
been programmed onto
system
DD
422
MAX TAGS
Yes
No
Card
Rejected
Valid card presented, but
rejected for some reason
DK
422
MAX TAGS
Yes
Yes
Table 6-2. Access Log Events
Galaxy Variant
Access Log
Event Size
GD-48
500
GD-96
1000
GD-264
1000
GD-520
1000
Table 6-3. Access Log Event Size
6-19
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
25 - Access Doors (cont’d)
Access Log Information
The access log contains a reason why the door will not operate. These can be:
•
Not Grp Match
•
Reject Grp Set
•
Illegal Time
The keypad display in the access log also shows user information:
01:00 THU 26 APR
USER
001 Rejct
DCM Address
Reader number
Line number
Press the # key to view the reason for rejection:
1021
Grp A1
Reject Grp Set
The line number for MAX or prox readers is in the format, for example 0013:
00 = not required
1 = line number 1
3 = Address number 3.
Access Log Print and Store Option
The Access Doors (MAX Log) is printed on-line and stored in the event memory.
The Access Door Log print displays in the format of the Event Log and allows information to be accessed.
The format is as follows:
HH:MM_XXXXXXXXXX_USR_NNN_UUUUUU_MYY_—_ (39 character display)
HH:MM = time in hour:minutes (5 characters). The date will be printed only at the beginning of every day,
that is midnight.
XXXXXXXXXX = access message (10 character) Valid, Invalid Card, Reject Card
USR = User (3 characters)
NNN = User number to which MAX card is assigned (3 characters)
UUUUUU = User descriptor (6 characters)
M = MAX reader address (1 character)
YY = MAX physical address-M10, M24 etc (3 characters)
- (dash) = unused character slot
__ (underscore) = this represents a space and is not printed or displayed in the access log.
For example: A valid card read at MAX3 30 from the card held by user 020, name Albert, at 13:48 would
be:13:48 Valid USR 020 Albert M30 –
6-20
25 - Access Doors (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Access Door MAX LED Status
When the access doors option is entered in engineering mode the MAX address can be displayed by pressing
the # key. This is shown in the following Figure graphically for a MAX address as 26.
MicroMAX/MAX3 LEDs Displayed
MAX
MAX
26
Top (unused)
MAX LEDs Displayed
26
Bottom
Figure 6-1. LED Status
The line numbers are represented by the top row in MAX and blocks 2nd and 3rd from the top in the
MicroMAX/MAX3 and the address numbers are represented by the bottom row of blocks in the MAX and
the four bottom blocks in the MicroMAX/MAX3. The top LED on the MicroMAX or MAX3 is always off in
this mode.
The combinations are shown in the following Figure:Line No.
1
2
3
4
Module Address
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Figure 6-2. Line Number/Module Address
Address
The first digit of the two digit number refers to the line that the module is connected to ( Line 1 on the Galaxy
GD-48; lines 1-2 on Galaxy GD-96/264; and lines 1–4 on the Galaxy GD-520); the second digit is the
physical address number of the MAX module. For example, a MAX module displaying as 25 indicates that
the module is on line 2 and is addressed as 5.
Pressing the # key gives a graphic representation of the MAX address in a binary format. The top two boxes
on the top row indicate the line address; the bottom four boxes indicate the physical address.
Descriptor
The descriptor is a maximum of 16 characters entered in the MAX Parameters option (69.2.2) or DCM
Parameters (69.3.1).
Engineer Mode
On accessing the Access Doors option in engineering mode, each on-line MAX/DCM module displays its
address by lighting the appropriate LEDs. To help the engineer identify each of the MAX/DCM modules, the
keypad displays a graphic representation of the MAX/DCM module address. By matching the … (LED off)
and „ (LED on) image to the LEDs on the MAX/DCM, the engineer can identify each MAX/DCM module
on the system.
6-21
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
25 - Access Doors (cont’d)
MAX Log
The Galaxy system has a 1000 event log (GD-96, GD-264, GD-520) or 500 event log (GD-48) for the
recording the MAX activations. This log is shared by all readers on the system and operates on a first-in-firstout basis for overwriting events when the log is filled.
To display the events in the MAX log select option 25 = ACCESS DOORS; use the A or B keys to select
the required MAX address then press the ent key. The first event that occurred on the selected MAX is
displayed along with details of the time, date and MAX number.
To view the log press the A key to move forward in time through the events or the B key to move backwards.
Press the esc key to return to the MAX address display. To view the log of another MAX, use the A or B
key to select the required address. To escape from the Access Doors option press the esc key.
Time and date
of event
02:25 SUN OCT
USR032 Valid
MAX user number
Event type
Press the # key for typical additional information:
READER01 GrpA1
Reject Grp Set
NOTE: See Appendix D for MAX Event Log Messages.
Max Events Print-Out
The MAX events can be printed out as they occur to an on-line printer. To print the MAX events ensure that
option 51.28 = PARAMETERS.On-Line Print is enabled. Select option 51.29= PARAMETERS.OnLine Level and enter 2 to print out all system events including the MAX events or 3 to print out only the
MAX events.
NOTE: A serial printer must be connected to line one of the Galaxy panel and the printer must remain on-line
(ready to print) at all times.
6-22
31 - Walk Test
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Test Options
Option 31 – Walk Test (Quick Menu Option 6)
31 = Walk Test
1 = View
1 = Zones Untested
2 = Zones Tested
2 = Activate
1 = Silent
1 = Test all Zones
2 = Selected Zones
2 = Audible
1 = Test All Zones
2 = Selected Zones
Figure 6-3. Walk Test Menu
31.1 = View
This option allows the user to log on to any keypad to view which zones have been tested and which zones
have still to be tested.
1 = Zones Untested
If this option is selected then the first zone that has not been tested will be displayed. Pressing the A or B keys
scrolls through all the untested zones.
2 = Zones Tested
If this option is selected then the user can view those zones already tested.
31.2 = Activate
This option allows a Walk Test to be carried out silently or audibly.
1 = Silent
This option allows the user to do a Walk Test that does not produce any audible sound. It will be completely
silent. The walk Test offers two methods of testing zones:
1 = Test all Zones
This option initiates a walk test that includes all zones that have the omit attribute enabled (refer to option 52 =
PROGRAM ZONES). When selected, the walk test starts immediately. The message NO ENTRIES is
displayed if all zones are non-omittable when selecting All Zones. Non-omittable zones are not included in this
test and remain active throughout the test.
2 = Selected Zones
This option allows the user to select any zones, irrespective of function type, for walk testing. As many zones
as necessary may be added to the list before starting the test. On entering this option the details of the first
zone are displayed. Each zone required for test can be selected using the A or B keys or by entering the zone
6-23
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
31 - Walk Test (cont’d)
number. Press the # key to toggle the test status of each zone in the Walk Test: the test status of the zone
changes to TEST if it is included in the test and # = TEST if it is not. When all the required zones have been
selected, press the ent key to start the walk test.
Press the key to include all zones in the Selected Zones walk test, without having to individually select the
zones. Once all zones are selected, the # key can be used to remove selected zones from the test.
NOTE: PA, PA Silent, PA Delay, PA Silent Delay and Fire are not included in the test when the key is
used to include all zones.
The response times of the zone circuits are reduced to 20 msecs (40 msecs for RF RIO’s) for the duration of
the walk test to facilitate the detection of loose connections or damaged wiring.
Once the walk test has started, opening a zone (or a zone that is open at the start of the test) activates outputs
programmed as Entry/Exit Horn. If a single zone is open, the keypad displays the address and function of
the zone. If multiple zones are open, then the keypad indicates how many zones are open; the open zones can
be viewed by pressing the A or B keys.
NOTE: The Walk Test option does not display the status of the zones. If an open zone is included in the
walk test, the Entry/Exit Horn will activate as soon as the test is started and remains active until the
zone is closed.
While the walk test is active the message WALK TEST ACTIVE / ESC to abort is displayed; press the #
key to view all zones that have been walk tested so far. To return to the walk test press the # key again.
NOTE: RF zones will also record the signal strength in reduced gain mode.
2 = Audible
This option allows the user to do a Walk Test that does produce an audible sound. The Walk Test works in
the same way as the Silent Walk Test.
Ending the Walk Test
To terminate the walk test, press the esc key. The test will terminate automatically if no zones are activated for
20 minutes.
The results of the test can be viewed by accessing the event log (refer to option 22 = DISPLAY LOG). The
start of the walk test is indicated by the display WALK TEST +; each zone that was tested is recorded (the
activation of each zone is recorded only once during the test — even if it was opened several times); the end
of the test is indicated by WALK TEST –.
6-24
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
32 - Outputs
Option 32 – Outputs
Outputs are tested by function: for example, when 01 = BELLS is selected, then all outputs programmed as
Bells are activated. Refer to option 53 = PROGRAM OUTPUT for a full description of each output function.
On selecting the Outputs option, output function type 01 = BELLS is offered for selection. Press the A or B
keys to move to the required output function type. Alternatively, the function type number can be entered
directly, for example entering 13 selects SECURITY. To test the selected output function press the ent key.
The ent key can be used to toggle the function ON and OFF as required. To escape from the Outputs
option, press the esc key.
Users
User types 2.5 & 3.6 only have access to 01 = BELLS and 02 = STROBE of the Output option. Only the
engineer has access to all the output types.
6-25
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
41 - Time/Date
Modify Options
Option 41 – Time/Date (Quick Menu Option 7)
The Time/Date option can be accessed and modified by type 3.6 codes, the engineer and the remote code.
If any groups are locked, then the time and date cannot be modified.
Modifying the Time and Date
The Time/Date option allows the system time and date to be modified. On entering this option the display
prompts for selection A = TIME B = DATE. Press the A key to select the time option; this allows a new
time to be entered. The time must be a valid four digit number — in the 24 hour format (hh:mm). The entry, if
valid, will be accepted immediately and the display is returned to the selection screen. Press the B key to
select the date option; this allows a new date to be entered. The date must be a valid 6 digit number - in the
day, month and year format (dd/mm/yy). The date entry, if valid, will be accepted immediately and the display
is returned to the selection screen.
NOTE: The time and date can be modified when groups are set.
Adjusting the Clock Speed
Variations in the accuracy of the clock speed can be compensated by pressing the # key while the A = TIME
B = DATE selection screen in the Time/Date menu is displayed. The keypads prompts for the Adjustment/
Week, in seconds, to be entered; the range is 0 – 120 seconds. If the clock requires to gain time, enter the
required number of seconds. If the clock requires to lose time, enter the required number of seconds and
press the key; the retards the clock speed.
6-26
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
42 - Codes
Option 42 – Codes (Quick Menu Option 8)
The Codes option is used to assign, modify and delete the codes that allow users to operate and access the
system. The Codes option is divided into two sub-menus:
1.
User Codes - sub-divided into up to 11 menus (depending on panel used and whether the group and
MAX mode options are enabled in Menu 63) that determine all of the access information for users who are
requiring PINs. This option also assigns MAX details to user numbers;
2.
PIN Warning - determines the warning period given to users prior to the programmed PIN Change
date (refer to option 51.42 = PARAMETER.PIN Change);
3.
Card Users - determines the tags/cards on the system for various users.
Programming Codes
1 = User Codes
1 = Modify Pin
2 = Modify Level
3 = Modify Name
4 = Schedule
4, 5 or 6 digit pin
1.0 to 3.6
6 alpha-numeric characters
(00=None)
5 = Temp Code
6 = Modify Groups
00-99 days
7 = Card Number
8 = MAX Function
9 = MAX Keypad
10 = APB Forgive
11 = Template
2 = PIN Warning
3 = Card Users
GD-48: 1-4
GD-96: 1-16
GD-264: 1-32
GD-520: 1-32
10 digit number on access control card or fob
number of required menu option
address of keypad that MAX function displays on
This function clears passback restrictions
1 - 28 days
1 = Add Batch
2 = Test Batch
3 = Delete Batch
4 = Batch Start
5 = Batch End
6 = Batch DCM Rdr
7 = Template User
Figure 6-4. Programming Codes
6-27
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
42 - Codes (cont’d)
Default Codes
The Galaxy system provides four default codes: Manager, Engineer, Remote and Authorization User. Refer to
the following table:
Manager
Galaxy
Engineer
Remote
Authorization*
No. of Codes
Default PIN
User No.
Default PIN
User No.
Default PIN
User No.
Default PIN
User No.
GD-48
100
12345
98
112233
99
543210
100
-
97
GD-96
250
12345
248
112233
249
543210
250
-
247
GD-264
1000
12345
998
112233
999
54321
1000
GD-520
1000
12345
998
112233
999
543210
1000
997
-
997
Table 6-4. Default Codes
* The authorization code is a secondary system manager code but is not programmed by default.
Engineer Code
•
Engineer access is enabled via menu 48.1. This menu is only available to type 3.6 users.
•
The engineer code can only modify the engineer PIN.
•
The engineer code cannot assign, modify or delete the manager or user codes;
•
On accessing engineering mode, any group that is set becomes inaccessible to the engineer. The
set groups cannot be assigned to zones, outputs and any other functions permitting group
allocation;
•
While engineer mode is accessed, all tampers are disabled, however, all constantly alert zone
types — PA zone types, 24 Hour, Security, Fire — remain active.
•
The engineer banner is shown on all keypads while engineer mode is being accessed; the
message ENGINEER MODE is displayed;
Entry to the engineer mode must be authorized by a valid type 3.6 user (refer to option 48 = ACCESS
AUTHORIZATION). The engineer code must then be entered within five minutes of the option being enabled. A single entry of the engineer code directly accesses engineer mode, without activating an engineer
tamper alarm; ENGINEER MODE is displayed on the keypad. If the engineer code is not entered within
the five minute period, the code is invalid and an Insufficient Access Rights message is displayed on the
keypad. Once the engineer mode has been accessed, there is no time limit on the period that the engineer can
remain in the mode.
NOTE: Dual entry of the engineer code in a system requiring user authorization does not give access to
engineer mode.
6-28
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
42 - Codes (cont’d)
ATM User Codes
ATM ( Automatic Teller Machine) user codes work in conjunction with ATM zone types (refer to Menu
Option 52.48-51=Program Zones ATM1-4). ATM user codes cannot be used as normal user codes for
setting/unsetting etc. The following table shows the users for each Galaxy variant that are dedicated as ATM
users::
Galaxy Variant
User codes
GD-48
94 to 96
GD-96
242 to 246
GD-264
986 to 995
GD-520
986 to 995
Table 6-5. ATM User codes
Escaping from Engineer Mode
1.
Return to the engineer banner.
2.
Enter the engineer code.
3.
Press the esc key.
The Galaxy begins the exit engineer mode procedure by checking the integrity and security of the system:
•
CHECKING FOR TAMPERS — the panel calculates that the standby battery connected to it is capable of
operating the system for the required period (as entered in the Standby Battery parameter — refer to
option 51.37). The system then verifies that there are no tamper conditions present on the panel, the
modules or the zones.
•
SYSTEM MODULES — if there are no tamper conditions the Galaxy checks the number of modules con-
nected to the system:
•
If no modules have been added or removed, “ NO MODULES ADDED, ESC TO CONTINUE” is
displayed. Pressing esc returns the system to the normal banner.
• If modules have been removed they are reported as missing; the engineer is prompted to view the missing
modules and to remove them from the system by pressing the ; a warning is given before the module is
removed. Press the ent key to confirm the removal of the module. Once all missing modules are removed,
the Galaxy reports the previous and current number of modules connected to the system, before returning
to the normal banner.
• If modules have been added, the Galaxy reports the previous and current number of modules connected
to the system, before returning to the normal banner.
If the esc key is pressed at any time during the exit engineer mode procedure, the procedure is aborted and
the Galaxy returns to the engineer mode. This return may take several seconds to complete.
6-29
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
42 - Codes (cont’d)
Manager Code
The manager is authorized to:
•
modify the manager PIN — the manager PIN cannot be deleted — and assign the MAX features
to the code.
If authorized via menu option 48.2 the manager is also authorized to:
•
program the User Code options of each of the user codes;
•
allocate other codes to the manager type (3.6);
NOTE: The manager PIN can be reset to the default code (12345) by the engineer and remote code using
the Reset Mgr (Manager) parameter (refer to option 51.21).
The manager code defaults to group choice when groups are enabled. The manager is able to toggle
the group choice option on and off (using the key) as required.
The manager code defaults to accessing the full menu (options 11 – 48). To access the quick menu (options 0
– 9), remove the assigned to the manager in the Modify Level option.
Programming Codes
Each PIN user has access to modify their own PIN. Users do not have access to user codes other than their
own. The only exception to this is the manager code.
42.1 = User Codes
Enter option 42=Codes and select option 1=User Codes. Press the ent key; details of the first user (User
001) are displayed. The following typical information is displayed on the keypad.
= no pin assigned
User No
= pin assigned
User Name
m
0 0 1 User
L2.3
A 1234
max card/tag/fob assigned
Group mode
User Type
Each of the users can be displayed using the A and B keys, or a specific user can be selected by entering the
required user number, for example 023, 069. When the required code is displayed, press the ent key to select
the user codes modification options; 1=Modify PIN is displayed. The available modification options can be
viewed by pressing the A or B keys; press the ent key to select the required option. The options are detailed
in the following paragraphs:
6-30
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
42 - Codes (cont’d)
STANDARD USER ACCESS
1 = Modify PIN
The PIN identifies each user to the Galaxy panel and permits the user to operate the system. The Modify
PIN option allows a PIN to be assigned to the user or an existing PIN to be modified. The PIN must be a
four, five or six digit number that is unique to the system.
NOTE: PIN size is dependent upon programming of parameter 51.66=Min Pin Size.
If a duplicate PIN is assigned, the message DUPLICATE ENTRY is displayed; the PIN is not assigned to
the user. As each digits is entered it appears on the lower line of the display. Pressing the key erases the last
digit displayed; continued pressing of the key will erase all of the digits. When the correct PIN has been
assigned press the ent key to accept the programming. If a MAX No. has been previously assigned the
display will prompt: delete max no. A = YES, B = NO and return to the previous menu level. When a PIN
has been assigned to a user number, a solid box ( ) is displayed on the top line of the user number details
screen.
AUTHORIZED MANAGER ACCESS
Deleting a PIN
Existing PIN entries can be completely erased by using the key instead of a digit entry. When there is no
PIN assigned to a user number a hollow square (…) is displayed on the top line of the user number details
screen.
Assigning Dual Codes
To program a user code as a Dual Code press the # key while the Modify PIN option is selected. The #
displays at the start of the assigned user PIN (#1314). When a PIN has been assigned as a dual code two
solid boxes (
) are displayed on the top line of the user number details screen.
NOTE: The Master manager code can not be assigned as dual.
Dual Codes Operation
Entry of a single dual code can not gain access to the menu, set or unset the system. The message NO ACCESS – ADDITIONAL CODE is displayed. A second dual code must be entered within 60 seconds of the
first dual code to access the menu, set or unset the system. Dual codes can be different types, the highest type
entered is granted access to the system — whether it is entered first or second.
A single entry of a dual code - without a second dual code entry within 60 seconds - is recorded in the event
log as an Illegal Code; all outputs programmed as Illegal Code are activated.
Dual Focus
If a MAX number for the same user has a # assigned the dual function only works between the PIN and the
MAX card of the same user.
6-31
42 - Codes (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
2=Modify Level
Each user is assigned an access level which determines the menu options available to the user. The programmable level are from 1.0 - 2.5.
3.6 is assigned to the manager.
3.7 is assigned to the engineer — this is fixed and cannot be assigned to user codes.
3.8 is assigned to the remote code. This is fixed and cannot be assigned to the engineer or user codes. The
remote code can only be used via keypads addressed as E.
On selecting this option, enter the level to be assigned to the user and press the ent key to accept the programming and return to the previous menu level.
EN50131-1
Level
Level
Access Availability
1
1.0†
Guard
Entered into event memory – no other option
2
2.1†
Cleaner
Can only set the system and change own PIN
2
2.2†
Caretaker
Can only set and unset the system and change own PIN
2
2.3
Users
Menu options 11 - 19
2
2.4
Users
Menu options 11 - 25
2
2.5
Users
Menu options 11 - 32
2
3.6‡
Manager
Menu options 11 - 48
3
3.7‡
Engineer
Menu options 11 - 71
3
3.8‡
Remote
Menu options 11 - 71
†
‡
No access to menu functions
The manager, engineer and remote codes (the last three codes on
the system) have fixed types which cannot be reprogrammed.
NOTE: All levels except guard can change their own PIN.
Table 6-6. User Access Levels
Duress Code
If the # key is pressed while the Modify Level option is accessed, then the current user code is assigned as a
Duress Code. Entry of a Duress Code at any time activates any output programmed as Duress (refer to
option 53 = OUTPUTS). There is no limit to the number of codes that can be assigned as Duress Codes.
Entry of any valid user code followed by ## is also a duress code (disabled in the UK to comply with
regulations).
Quick Menu
All of the user codes default to the quick menu. This menu is made up of a selection of ten options
(0 – 9) from the full menu options 11 – 68. Access to the quick menu is controlled by the user type. Any user
can be upgraded from the quick menu to the full menu by assigning a to the user while the Modify Type
option is accessed. Therefore a user with type 2.5 would have access to the full menu from options 11 – 42.
No code can access both menus.
The engineer can reprogram the options contained in the quick menu (refer to option 59 = QUICK MENU).
NOTE: The master manager code defaults to the full menu.
The engineer can determine the menu option access type (refer to option 68 = MENU ACCESS); this allows
users to access menu options that their code types are not, by default, authorized to access.
6-32
42 - Codes (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
3 = Modify Name
This option allows a name to be assigned to the user (maximum 6 characters). Each of the user codes default
to the name USER. The engineer (ENG) and manager (MGR) are fixed and cannot be reprogrammed. On
selecting the Modify Name option, a section of the alpha-numeric characters that can be assigned to the user
name is displayed on the bottom line of the keypad; the cursor flashes on the letter L. Press the key to
erase the characters of the default or previous name. When the previous name has been erased, use the A or
B keys to move the cursor to the first character of the name and press the ent key; the selected character
appears on the top line. Continue this process until the name is completed.
The # key moves between upper and lower case characters and the system library. The alpha-numeric characters and library words can be selected by entering the character or word reference number (refer to Appendix A — Library) or by pressing the A or B keys.
When the user name is completed, press the esc key to accept the programming and return to the previous
menu level.
4 = Schedule
This option allows the user’s pin code access to the panel menu options for setting and unsetting. The pin code
only operates during the OFF period of an assigned weekly schedule which is created in option 65.1.
If a user attempts to use his pin code during the ON periods of his assigned schedule, then an illegal code
event is logged and any outputs programmed as illegal code are activated.
Setting this option to 00=None means that pin codes are always operational.
NOTE: This option does not control card access through doors at all. This is now controlled by templates
and is allocated to a user in option 42.11=Template.
6-33
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
42 - Codes (cont’d)
5 = Temporary Codes
Temporary Codes allows a PIN to be temporarily allocated to a user. On selecting this option, enter the
number of days (0 – 99) that the code is to remain active. The default setting of 0 indicates that the code is
permanent. A temporary code expires and is removed from the codes list at midnight after the assigned
number of days. A code that has been assigned as a Temporary Code is indicated on the user code display
by a ^ between the user number and the user name, for example 001^USER.
NOTE: The manager, engineer, or remote codes cannot be assigned as Temporary Codes.
PIN Change
If a user is assigned the PIN Change feature in the Temporary Code option, the user must assign a new PIN
after a predetermined period — refer to option 51.42 = PARAMETERS.PIN Change — otherwise the
user PIN expires and is no longer operational.
To program a user code to prompt for a PIN change select the Temporary Code and press the key
instead of entering a number of days for a temporary code; press the ent key to accept the programming and
return to the previous menu level. A code that has been assigned as a PIN Change code is indicated on the
used code display with a between the user number and the user name, for example 001 USER. The
Manager, Engineer, or Remote codes cannot be assigned as PIN Change Codes.
If the value entered in the PIN Change parameter is 0 then the code is assigned as a permanent PIN — a
warning message is briefly displayed to indicate that a Pin Change will not be requested. However, if PIN
Change is within the range 1 – 12, then the number entered is number of months after which the code must be
changed, otherwise it expires.
NOTE: The PIN expires on the first day of the following month.
A notification (1 – 28 days) that the PIN requires to be changed can be assigned using the PIN Warning
option (refer to option 42.2); this prompts the user to assign a new code whenever the expiring code is entered - except when the system is unsetting - for the number of days in the PIN Warning before the day the
PIN expires. The new PIN must be six digits and must be different from any current PIN including the user’s
existing one. The new PIN must be re-entered and, if confirmed, the user is returned to the banner. If the esc
key is pressed or the new PIN entered is invalid, the user may continue to use the panel as normal; the next
entry of the PIN will prompt for the PIN change.
NOTE: If the user has not assigned a new PIN by the end of the PIN Warning period, then the code is
erased on the next unsetting of the system.
6 = Modify Group
This option determines the system groups that the user has access to and operational control over. The
Modify Groups option is only available when the group mode is enabled.
Multi-group Systems
The larger Galaxy panels have 32 groups; these are displayed on the keypad in blocks of eight groups, subdivided into A, B, C and D:
Press keys 1 – 8 to assign the relevant groups in each block to the user.
Code has been enabled (refer to option 63.1 = OPTIONS.Groups); the system defaults to groups disabled.
6-34
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
42 - Codes (cont’d)
On selecting the Modify Groups option, the groups currently allocated to the user are displayed. All user
default to group 1. Pressing the group number toggles the group assigned to the user; pressing 2 and 3 assign
groups 2 and 3 to the user; pressing 1 (when group 1 is already assigned) removes group 1 from the user
code. To assign group choice to the user, press the key. When the required groups have been assigned to
the user, press the ent key to accept the programming and return to the previous menu level.
Multi-Group Systems
The larger Galaxy panels have 32 groups; these are displayed on the keypad in blocks of eight groups, subdivided into A, B, C and D:
Press keys 1 – 8 to assign the relevant groups in each block to the user.
Group Block
Physical Groups
A1-8
1-8
B1-8
9-16
C1-8
17-24
D1-8
25-32
Table 6-7. Groups
Group Options
Single Group
A user can be assigned to any single group. In this case the type 2.2 and above user can
only access, set and unset the single group.
Multiple Groups Users can be allocated to more than one group in which case access and operation is
collective; the user cannot choose to operate on a single or combination of the assigned
groups.
Group Choice
Users can be allocated more than one group but also have the choice of which of the
allocated groups to view , set or unset. Pressing the key while assigning groups to the
user assigns the group choice feature.
NOTES:
1.
The manager, engineer and remote codes have fixed access to all system groups; this cannot be
reprogrammed.
2.
The manager, engineer and remote codes are assigned group choice by default. The manager can
have the group choice feature removed; the engineer and remote codes have fixed group choice.
3.
Users authorized to access Option 42 = CODES, can only assign the groups that have been
assigned to their user code; A user who does not have access to group 4, cannot assign group 4 to
another user code.
7 = Card Number
The Card Number contains one of the following:
•
the serial number from an access control card
•
the 10 digit number etched onto the card/fob/tag
•
a number generated by the RF RIO identifying an RF Keyfob button
• the decrypted code of cards/tags self learned into the system for use with the keyprox.
These numbers identify the card/tag/fob to the system and references it to the user it has been assigned to.
6-35
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
42 - Codes (cont’d)
By default card number is empty.
To enter the required number:
1.
Enter the unique 10 digit number laser etched onto the card/fob/ tag or
enter the unique RF keyfob button identifier generated by the RF RIO (refer to RF RIO programming
instructions II1-0076 for details) or
press the A and 1 keys simultaneously of the KeyProx and present the card/fob to the KeyProx reader
within five seconds. The decrypted number in the card will be self learned onto the Galaxy panel and
displayed on the KeyProx.
2.
Press the ent key to save the programming and return to the previous menu level.
NOTE: A card number can be assigned to a user code that does not have a PIN allocated to it. All other
options assigned to this user are valid for the card/fob/tag button programmed.
NOTE: For access control cards, when the serial number is not printed on the card, the card number can be
learned using the add batch menu (42.3.1).
8 = MAX Function
The card/fob/tag/button can be assigned a single menu option. The user must be authorized to access the
menu option assigned to the MAX - either by the user level assigned or menu option 68 = Menu Access.
The default option is Not Used. A new option is assigned by pressing the A or B key until the required option
is displayed or by entering the option number directly and then pressing the ent to accept the selection.
9 = MAX Keypad
The menu option assigned to the MAX card can be limited to operate on a single keypad. On selecting this
option the display shows
, indicating that a keypad has not been specified. To specify a keypad, press the
# key. The address of the first keypad on the system is displayed. Use the A or B key to select the required
keypad and press the ent key to accept the selection.
NOTE: The address of the keypad that is currently being used is indicated by a black square flashing over
the first digit of the keypad address.
“Card-Held” Operation
The programmed MAX function is activated when either,
•
the card/fob /tag is held continuously in front of the MAX/MicroMAX/KeyProx reader for 3 seconds
or
•
the programmed RF keyfob button is pressed. It should be noted that if button 1 of the RF keyfob is
programmed as a setting function, button 2 will automatically become the unset action, as long as
button 2 has been programmed for MAX operation on the RF RIO.
If using a MAX/MicroMAX or KeyProx the reader or KeyProx must be assigned a common group to the
user. The keypad specified in option 9 = MAX Keypad displays the assigned MAX function.
Assigning Dual Functions to MAX Numbers
If a card has a # assigned to the number, then any card-held function will only work in conjunction with the
PIN from the same user, provided that the PIN has a # assigned also. The Dual Focus function will work in
either order, but if the card is presented first, it will simply enable the PIN to gain access to the normal menu
(see option 42 = Codes for programming).
If a user’s card number is assigned a *, then the card becomes Dual access. This means that it will not open
6-36
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
42 - Codes (cont’d)
the door on its own; it needs another PIN or card as well (see option 42 = Codes for programming).
10 = APB Forgive
This function, if selected, clears all antipassback restrictions for the selected user.
11 = Template
Every user on the system must be allocated an access template. Multiple users can be assigned the same
template. An access template is a list of groups and time schedules that will govern card access through
doors. This method means that if there are multiple doors leading into one group or area, then a user will be
given access to all those doors in one move. This reduces programming time and complexity. The templates
are created in option 45.7 which are in turn made up from the weekly schedules created in option 65.1.
42.2 = PIN Warning
This option determines the number of days notification before the PIN Change expiry date (refer to option
51.42 = PARAMETERS.PIN Change) that the user is prompted to assign new code on entry of the expiring PIN. The default period is 28 days, with a programmable range of 1 – 28. If the user does not assign a
new code by the end of the PIN Warning period, then the code is erased on the next unsetting of the system.
NOTE: The PIN Warning ends on the last day of the month, the PIN expires on the first day of the following month.
42.3 = Card Users
This option determines the tags/cards on the system for various users. There are seven options:
1 = Add Batch
This option starts enrolment and displays the user/tag for each presentation. When batch enrolling (auto
assigning of tags to users), the panel increments the user number, starting from Batch Start. It does this for
every new tag presented at the DCM assigned in Batch DCM.
2 = Test Batch
This option checks the tag number stored at the panel for the current tag presented at the Batch DCM. It can
also be used to go directly to the user programming details that are assigned to the presented tag.
3 = Delete Batch
This option removes card numbers from enrolment. A warning is given before deletion.
4 = Batch Start
This option determines the user number where enrolment starts.
5 = Batch End
This option determines the user number where enrolment ends.
6 = Batch DCM Rdr
This option determines the DCM reader used for enrolment. Pressing the * key returns the system to the
default of any reader.
7 = Template User
This option chooses a user to be a template whose access authority and non-unique attributes are applied to
other users on the system when using the 1 = Add Batch function.
6-37
43 - Summer/44 - Trace
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Option 43 – Summer (Quick Menu Option 9)
The Daylight Savings Time is in accordance with European standards. The Daylight Savings time is described
as follows:
On the first day of each year, the British Summer Time (BST) Start date is set to the last Sunday in March
and the End date is set to the last Sunday in October.
The operation of the Summer option is as follows: at 01:00 hours (GMT) on the Start date, the system clock
advances to 02:00 hours (DST); at 02:00 hours (DST) on the End date, the system clock goes back to 01:00
hours (GMT).
NOTE: The time always changes with reference to GMT. For example, Italy, which is +1 hour would be:
Last Sunday in March - 02.00 to 03.00
Last Sunday in October – 03.00 to 02.00
The Start and End dates can be reprogrammed by authorized user codes. Press the A key to modify the
Start date or the B key select the End date; the new date must be a valid four-digit number - in the day/
month format (dd/mm).
Option 44 – Trace
This option provides a record of the most recent alarm activation. The Trace option records the details of the
setting and unsetting of the system immediately before and after the alarm activation and the first five events
occurring during the alarm activation. This information is maintained in the trace until the next alarm activation.
On entering the option pressing the A and B keys steps through each of the seven trace entries.
Pressing the # key while viewing the Trace option displays additional information about certain events — user
events reveal the keypad, user level and current group; alarm events reveal the zone descriptor if programmed.
The currently display trace can be printed out by pressing the
out.
key; pressing the esc key aborts the print-
NOTE: A serial printer must be connected to the Galaxy panel via the on-board serial port, a printer interface module or an RS232 interface module.
Group Mode
If group mode is enabled (refer to option 63 = OPTIONS), there is a separate trace for the most recent
alarm activation in each of the groups. On selecting the Trace option, a user with group choice (refer to option
42 = CODES) can view the trace of the assigning groups; press the number of the group to be displayed —
the N below the selected group changes to a Y — and then press the ent key.
If more than one group is selected, or the user does not have group choice, then the trace for the group with
the most recent alarm activation is displayed.
6-38
45 - Timer Control
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Option 45 – Timer Control
45.1 = View
This option allows the weekly schedules programmed in option 65.1 to be viewed:
1 = Weekly Schedule
Use the A and B keys to scroll through each of the programmed schedules and on/off times.
2 = Timer Outputs
This option allows the Timer- A and Timer-B outputs with on/off times, allocated in option 65.2, to be
viewed.
3 = Autoset
Use the A and B keys to scroll through the groups to select one (optional) and also to view the time schedule
allocated per group.
4 = Lockout
Use the A and B keys to scroll through the groups to select one (optional) and also to view the time schedule
allocated per group.
NOTE: The programmed times cannot be modified using this option.
All of the programmed timers - Weekly Schedule, Timer Outputs, Autoset and Lockout - can be printed
out using option 57.11 = SYSTEM PRINT.Timers.
45.2 = Holidays
This function allows up to 32 holiday periods to be allocated. A Start and End date is entered for each holiday period using the 1=Modify Dates option, and the groups that are affected by the programmed holiday
periods are assigned using the 2 = Assign Groups function. The operation of all timers for the assigned
groups is suspended during these dates; the last operation of the Timers before the start date remains in
operation until the first operation after the end date. For example, a code which has been allocated the Timer
A period in the CODES option (42.1.4.1) will be inoperative during the programmed holiday period if the
Timer A is in the On time when the holidays starts.
1 = Modify Dates
On selecting this option, the first holiday period with 1=Name and 2=Modify Dates options are displayed.
Upon selection of 2=Modify Dates, the Start and End dates for holiday period 1 are displayed; an arrow
(>) points to the Start date. If no dates have been entered for this period, then the display shows
/
.
To program the Start date, press the ent key; the date display changes to >DD/MM<; enter a valid four
digit number and press the ent key to accept the selection; the year is not required, only the day and months
(dd/mm).
Press the # key to move to the end date and follow the procedure for programming the Start date. The #
key toggles between the Start and End dates for each holiday; the arrow (>) indicates which date is currently
selected.
To remove a programmed date, press the
key. The date display returns to
6-39
/
.
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
45 - Timer Control (cont’d)
Use the A or B key to move between the different holiday periods or enter the number of the holiday period
(1 – 10) to be programmed.
The holiday periods can only be programmed by the master manager and engineer. Users can access this
option, however, they can only view the programmed holiday dates.
2 = Assign Groups
This function determines which of the groups are affected by the programmed holiday periods.
On selecting the Assign Groups option, the groups currently assigned to the programmed holiday periods are
indicated by a Y below the group; an N is displayed below the unassigned groups. All groups default to Y.
Pressing the group number toggles the group status. When the required groups have been assigned to the
holidays, press the ent key to accept the programming and return to the previous menu level.
Multi-group Systems
The larger Galaxy panels have 32 groups; these are displayed on the keypad in blocks of eight groups, subdivided into A, B, C and D:
Press keys 1 – 8 to assign the relevant groups in each block to the user.
45.3 = Early Open
If the Early Open option (45.3.2) is enabled, the Lockout OFF time (refer to option 65 = TIMERS) for
the following day is brought forward by the number of minutes (0 – 240) programmed in parameter 44 =
Early Open. This allows the system to be manually unset earlier than normal.
1 = Early Times
If the Timer is set to off, the operation of the Timer is suspended; this option cannot be used to alter the
programmed times. The timer defaults to 0 = Off. To switch the timer on, select change the setting to 1 =On.
The Timer Status can also be altered through menu option 65.1 by the engineer only.
On selecting the option, the early opening status of the groups is displayed; early opening enabled is indicated
by a Y below the group; an N is displayed below the groups that are not programmed to open early. All
groups default to N.
NOTE: Only the engineer can enable early opening for individual groups, but global enable must be done
first.
2 = Early Open
Type 3. 6 Users and Engineer when Groups are Disabled
If groups have not been enabled on the system, the programming of the Early Open option is identical for
type 3.6 users and the engineer; the option permits early opening to be disabled or enabled:
0
=
Disabled (default) — early opening not permitted;
1
=
Enabled — early opening permitted.
Select the required status and press the ent key to accept the programming and return to the previous menu.
Engineer Mode with Groups Enabled
If groups have been enabled (option 63 = OPTIONS + early open permitted), then the groups can be
individually enabled to permit early opening.
6-40
45 - Timer Control (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
45.4 = Timers
This option allows each of the programmed weekly timer schedules to be switched on and off as required. If a
timer schedule is set to off, the operation of the timer is suspended; this option cannot be used to alter the
programmed times. All timer schedules default to 0 = Off. To switch the timer schedule on, select the required
timer and change the setting to 1 =On.
The Timer Status can also be altered through menu option 65.1 by the engineer only.
On selecting the option, the early opening status of the groups is displayed; early opening enabled is indicated
by a Y below the group; an N is displayed below the groups that are not programmed to open early. All
groups default to N.
NOTE: Only the engineer can enable early opening for individual groups, but global enable must be done
first.
45.5 = Late Work
The Late Work option — if programmed as 1 = Enabled — authorizes an Autoset Extension in advance
of the prewarning period (refer to option 65.3 = TIMERS.Autoset);
NOTE: Additional extensions can be authorized by entry of a valid code during the subsequent autoset
prewarning periods.
45.6 = Weekend Work
The Weekend Work option allows a valid user code to authorize the system to unset at the weekend. There
are two options:
1 = Program Days
This option allows the weekend day option to be selected.
1 = Weekend Day
On selecting this option the programmed Weekend Day is displayed; the default is 0 = OFF. Use the A or B
keys to select the required day or days and press the ent key to accept the programming and return to the
previous menu level:
0
=
OFF
1
=
SAT
2
=
SUN
3
=
BOTH (Saturday and Sunday)
The selected Weekend Day remains active for one occurrence only. The Weekend Day returns to the
default of OFF immediately following the assigned day. The Weekend Day must be allocated each time the
function is required.
If the Weekend Day is programmed other than 0 = OFF (default), on the next occurrence of the programmed Weekend Day, the Timers adopt the times assigned in Pattern day from option 65.1.6. For
example, this allows a Sunday to use the Autoset and Lockout Timers from Monday to Friday.
NOTE: Parameter 51.41 = Weekend Work must be enabled (default is Disabled) to allow the Weekend
Day to be selected by the user.
6-41
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
45 - Timer Control (cont’d)
2 = Pattern Day
Option not available. See Option 65.1.6
2 = Assign groups
This option assigns the groups that will be unset at the weekend.
NOTE: The larger Galaxy panels have 32 groups; these are displayed on the keypad in block of eight
groups, sub-divided into A, B, C and D. Press the A or B key to display each of the group blocks.
45.7 = Access Template
An access template defines when and where a user is allowed access. For each access template, a schedule is
given to each group (area) to define when access to each group is possible. Up to 100 templates are available
per system. There are two options for each template:
1 = Name
A name of up to 12 characters can be allocated to each template.
2 = Schedules
The schedules programmed in Menu option 65, Timers, are allocated to each group with the selected access
template under this option. Group mode has to be enabled in menu option 63.1 to allocate a weekly schedule
to a group.
6-42
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
46 - Group Omit
Option 46 – Group Omit
This option allows a 3.6 type code to block omit all the omittable zones that are open at the end of the confirm
time in a group or multiple groups. All zones in the required groups that have the omit attribute enabled (refer
to option 52.4 = PROGRAM ZONES.Omit) are omitted when this option is selected. Groups can be
omitted and reinstated without setting and unsetting the system.
On selecting the Group Omit Option the groups assigned to the user code and keypad are displayed as well
as the omit status of each group (Y below the group indicates that it is omitted, N indicates that it is not omitted). To omit a group, press the required key. The letter beneath the group number changes from N to Y. To
reinstate the group press the key to toggle from Y to N.
NOTE: The type 3.6 user must have group choice to enter Group Omit.
NOTE: The zones in the selected groups are omitted from the system as soon as the group is selected.
On returning to the banner (normal or engineer) the keypad displays the message ZONES OMITTED.
Omitted zones remain omitted for one set period only or until they are manually reinstated to the system.
Outputs programmed as Zone Omit (mode programmed as reflex) are activated as soon as the zone is
omitted and remains active until the zone is reinstated. If the output mode is programmed as latch, then the
Zone Omit outputs activate when the system is set and remain active until the system is unset — reinstating
the omitted zones.
6-43
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
47 - Remote Access
Option 47 – Remote Access
This menu option permits control of all site initiated remote connectors. The menu structure for this option is
shown below.
47 = Remote Access
1= Service
0 = Int Telecoms
0 = Direct Access
1 = Call back-1 to 5 = Call back-5
1 = ISDN
0 = Direct Access
1 = Call back-1 to 5 = Call back-5
2 = Ethernet
0 = Direct Access
1 = Call back-1 to 5 = Call back-5
3 = Ext Telecoms
0 = Direct Access
1 = Call back-1 to 5 = Call back-5
2 = Send Alarms (Option not Available)
3 = Call Galaxy (Option not Available)
4 = Auto service
1 = Mode
0 = Off
1 = Timed
2 = Instant
3 = Confirm
2 = Timers
1 = Start Time
2 = End Time
3 = Sync Schedule 000 (0-365) days
4 = Schedule Reset
3 = Terminate Idle
4 = Conn Retry
Idle Time 10 (0-60 mins)
1 = Retry Interval 30 (0-60) mins
2 = Retry Duration 06 (0-24) hours
3 = Redial Mode
5 = Control Upload
1 = Eng Prog
2 = User Prog
3 = Either
6 = Remote Maint
1 = Schedule 000 (0-365) days
2 = Advice
7 = Service Pin
8 = Send Panel ID
0 = Off
1 = Auto Reset
2 = Manual Reset
0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
9 = Delay Time 03 (3-10) secs
Figure 6-5. Remote Access Structure
6-44
0 = Off
1 = Retry
2 = Direct
1 = Code Only
0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
2 = Code + Notice
0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
3 = No Code/Notice
0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
47 - Remote Access (cont’d)
47.1 Service
This option enables type 3.6 users to control the access mode of the remote servicing package. There are
several options available for increased flexibility and security.
0 = INT Telecoms
This option selects the on-board telecoms as the communication device.
0 = Direct Access
On selecting this option, a 40 minute access period is enabled on the Galaxy panel; remote servicing software
can directly access the system during this period. Once access to the panel has been gained, it can be maintained indefinitely; there is no maximum duration. On terminating the remote servicing connection to the panel,
the access period remains valid for an additional 15 minutes.
1 – 5 = Call Back 1 – 5
A maximum of five numbers can be preprogrammed by the engineer (refer to option 56.1.12 =
COMMUNICATIONS.Telecom.Remote Access). On selecting one of the numbers (1 – 5) followed by
the ent key, the Galaxy panel dials out to the preprogrammed telephone number associated with the Call
Back number.
If the number selected does not have a preprogrammed telephone number, the system prompts for a number 1
to be entered. Enter the required telephone number and press the ent key; the panel then dials out to the
telephone number entered.
NOTE: The PC that the panel is dialling to must have remote servicing software running in the Waiting for
Call-Back mode.
1 = ISDN
0 = Direct Access
See INT Telecoms description
1 – 5 = Call Back 1 – 5
See INT Telecoms description (except menu option 56.3.09 replaces 56.1.12).
2 = Ethernet
0 = Direct Access
See INT Telecoms description
1 – 5 = Call Back 1 – 5
See INT Telecoms description (except menu option 56.4.03 replaces 56.1.12).
6-45
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
47 - Remote Access (cont’d)
3 = EXT Telecoms
0 = Direct Access
See INT Telecoms description
1 – 5 = Call Back 1 – 5 (see Telecoms description)
47.2 Send Alarms
Option not available
47.3 Call Galaxy
Option not available
47.4 Auto Service
The Galaxy Dimension panels can be programmed to automatically initiate communications to remote servicing software, under three circumstances:
•
If any site programming has changed the panel will automatically send the new programming to the
downloader.
•
On a predetermined schedule the panel can activate an automatic periodic upload.
•
On a predetermined schedule the panel can activate an automatic remote routine inspection.
NOTE: The Auto Service function works for both the Internal Telecomms and Ethernet module.
The following sub options allow the engineer to select the mode of the automatic communication in each of the
three situations. These options are not available to users.
1 = Mode
This selects the mode of the automated connection following a change to the panel programming. There are
four modes:
0 = Off
In this mode the panel will not automatically initiate a remote servicing call even if the panel programming has
changed. This is the default setting.
1 = Timed
In this mode, following modification to panel programming, a remote servicing call will be initiated automatically between a programmed start time (option 47.4.2.1) and end time (option 47.4.2.2). To avoid traffic
congestion the panel selects a random time between the start and end times to initiate the call. Once the
connection is made, the new panel programming will be uploaded to the remote servicing package.
6-46
47 - Remote Access (contd)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
2 = Instant
In this mode, following modification to panel programming, the connection to the remote servicing package is
initiated immediately, using call back number 1, on exiting engineering mode. Once the connection is made, the
new programming will be uploaded to the remote servicing package.
3 = Confirm
In this mode, when engineering mode is exited following a change to the panel programming, a message is
displayed at the keypad to asking whether a remote connection should be initiated. This must be authorized by
an appropriate user type before the call is made.
Once authorized, a two minute delay period is initiated. During this period, the engineer can initiate or cancel
the call.
If connection is initiated the panel uploads the new panel programming to the remote servicing package.
2 = Timers
This option selects the mode for automatic schedule to start a periodic upload. There are four further options:
1 = Start Time
This is the start time of the off-peak window during which the panel can initiate an automated remote servicing
call. The default is 01:00.
2 = End time
This is the end time of the off-peak window of the automated remote servicing call. The default is 06:00.
3 = Sync Schedule
If this option is programmed, after a period equal to the number of days entered (0-365), the panel will automatically carry out an automatic connection to the remote servicing application and upload the latest panel
programming during the off-peak window time programmed in menu 47.4.2.1=Start Time and
47.4.2.2=End Time. The default number of days is 0 which disables the option.
4 = Schedule Reset
The schedule reset option controls the way in which the Sync Schedule operates. There are three further
options:
0 = Off
The panel will never initiate a remote servicing connection. This is the default setting.
1 = Auto Reset
This option resets the Sync Schedule timer after an automated connection.
2 = Manual Reset
This option resets the Sync Schedule timer after a copy of site data whether done automatically or
manually..
3 = Terminate Idle
This option allows a timeout period to be programmed into the panel which terminates a remote connection
after the programmed period of activity. This is programmable within the range 0-60 minutes. After termination
6-47
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
47 - Remote Access (contd)
the panel records in the event log the message REM ABORT to indicate that the connection was unexpectedly
terminated. The default timeout period is 10 minutes.
4 = Conn. Retry
If the attempt to initiate a remote servicing call fails, the panel can be programmed to do repeat dial attempts.
There are three further options:
1 = Retry Interval
The dial attempts can be programmed to occur from 0-60 minutes. Setting the value to 0 disables the feature
The default setting is 30 minutes.
2 = Retry Duration
The length of time that the panel tries to do a remote servicing call can be programmed from 0-24 hours.
setting the value to 0 disables the feature. The default setting is 6 hours.
3 = Redial Mode
In the event of a remote servicing session terminating unexpectedly, the panel enters one of the three programmable modes that follow.
0 = Off
The panel does not try to re-establish a connection.
1 = Retry
The panel initiates a remote servicing call to re-establish a connection. The retries will be as per option
47.4.4.1 (Retry Interval) and 47.4.4.2 (Retry Duration).
2 = Direct
The panel access mode changes to allow direct access for 30 minutes. This mode operates as per
option 47.1=Service when Direct Access is selected.
5 = Control Upload
This option controls whether a connection is established when only engineer or user programming data is
uploaded. This feature has three options.
1 = Eng Prog
Only initiates a connection when engineering programming has been modified.
2 = User Prog
Only initiates a connection when user programming has been modified.
3 = Either
Initiates a connection when either engineering or user programming has been modified.
6 = Remote Maint
This option controls the mode for automatically initiating communications for remote routine inspection and
6-48
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
47 - Remote Access (contd)
maintenance. The panel uploads only the most recent information available from 61=Diagnostics. No other
panel programming is uploaded. There are two sub-options that control this:
1 = Schedule
This option controls the schedule for the initiation of communication for remote routine inspection. The schedule can be set from 0-365 days. The default is 0 days which disables the function.
2 = Advice
This option controls the method by which communication is initiated. It can be initiated automatically by the
schedule programmed above or manually by user entry of the Service PIN code, with or without a notification
message. There are three options. The default value for each is disabled.
1 = Code Only
Entry of a Service PIN code automatically initiates a remote servicing connection to call back number 1.
The Service PIN code can only be modified by remote users. When the Service PIN code is entered,
it resets any scheduled connection timers.
2 = Code + Notice
This enables the remote servicing notification timer, and display of remote servicing notification. The
remote service notification message is not displayed if the system is set. It only becomes active when the
panel is unset. The message REMOTE CALL INIT, A=SP PIN ENTER is displayed on the keypad
after entry of a valid manager type user code.
3 = No Code/Notice
This enables a remote servicing session without the need for a Service PIN code and the panel’s
remote servicing notification message. This option uses the start and end times programmed in menu
47.4.2.1 and 47.4.2.2 respectively.
7 = Service Pin
This is a 6-digit numeric Service PIN code (default 987654), which initiates an automated call to the Remote
Servicing application. The Service PIN code can only be changed from Remote Servicing and sending the
Service PIN code to the panel via the Send Remote Access Start Code. The Service PIN code cannot be
the same as any other user codes on the system. This option is only available when option 47.4.6.1 (schedule)
is greater than 0 and when option 47.4.6.2.1 (code only) are enabled.
8 = Send Panel ID
When a remote servicing connection is established, this option allows panel identification and authentication.
When enabled, the following sequence of events occur.
Once a remote servicing connection is established, whether panel or PC initiated, the panel delays for a period
as determined by Delay Time for incoming information from the remote servicing package.
If a valid control character is received by the panel within the delay period, the panel transmits an identity
string. If no character is received during the delay period the call is terminated.
9 = Delay Time
This is the time that the panel delays for incoming information from the remote servicing package. The delay
time can be set from 3-10 seconds. The default is 3 seconds
6-49
48 - Engineer Access
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Option 48 – Engineer access
This option allows access to be authorized for engineers for system programming and for managers in order to
add/delete/change all user codes.
48.1 = System Access
This option allows system programming of the Galaxy panel and is sub-divided into 1 = Engineer and
2 = Manager.
48.1.1 = Engineer
The engineer code is assigned programmed as dual by default. This prevents the engineer from accessing
engineer mode unless authorized to do so by a valid code. To gain access to the engineer menu a type 3.6
user must enter their code, and enable the Engineer Access option. This provides a five minute period during
which a single entry of the engineer code provides access to engineering mode without causing a tamper
alarm. Once the engineer mode has been accessed, there is no time limit on the access period.
If the Engineer Mode option has not been enabled, or the code is not entered within the five minute period,
then the Engineer code is invalid and has no effect.
If the PIN is programmed without the #, the Engineer Access option does not require to be enabled to allow
the engineer to gain access to engineer mode. The engineer code requires to be entered twice. The first entry
activates a tamper alarm which is cancelled by the second entry.
NOTE: Dual entry of the engineer code in a system requiring user authorization does not give access to
engineer mode.
When a manager gives authorization, from menu 48.1, for engineer access, the access is limited to one visit
only. When the engineer returns the system to user mode, the authorization is still valid for five minutes. After
this time it must be granted again by the manager.
48.1.2 = Manager
This option allows type 3.6 manager codes to be enabled for user code adding/deleting/changing. This option
can only be enabled by the authorization code. However, this option is not used by default. Manager codes
are always authorized. It can be enabled, if required, to comply with standards in certain regions. An authorization code must be assigned in Menu 42 Codes, before the function is enabled.
48.2 = SIA Access
This option allows access to the SIA alarm signalling format and has two levels of access
48.2.0 = Full Access
This option allows a SIA level 4 user to send commands to the Galaxy control panel. The user can reset the
panel after an alarm signal.
48.2.1 = Limited access
This option only allows up to SIA level 3 access but excludes resetting of the panel after an alarm signal.
6-50
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters
Engineer 1
Option 51 – Parameters
This option allows the engineer to modify the system functions. Options can be selected using the A or B keys
or by entering the two digit parameter number and pressing the ent key. The selected options can then be
programmed by using the A key to increase or the B key to decrease the values assigned to the parameter;
pressing the ent key accepts the new value and returns to the previous menu level. Any parameters that differ
from this procedure are indicated in the following paragraphs. The parameters also prompt the engineer on
which keys to press.
For example, press:
•
1 then 6
parameter 16 = Soak Time selected;
•
ent
currently soak time is displayed along with the programmable range 07 (1–14) days;
•
08
value of the required soak time, the display shows the new value 08 (1–14) days;
•
ent
accept the programming and return to 16 = Soak Time displayed.
NOTE: Default settings must be changed before programming in Menu Option 55 – Soak.
Assigning Parameters to Groups
Several of the parameters allow separate values to be assigned to the groups on the system. If groups have
been enabled, the relevant parameters prompt for a group to be selected; when selected, the value is assigned
to the group parameter using the procedure outlined in the previous example.
The parameters that permit group selection are indicated in the following paragraphs.
6-51
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
Groups
Galaxy 48/96/264/520
01 Bell Time
Parameter
9
9
02 Bell Delay
9
9
03 Abort Time
9
9
55 Confirm
04 Exit Time
9
9
05 Entry Time
9
9
06 System Reset
9
07 Tamper Reset
Groups
Galaxy 48/96/264/520
53 RF Stop Mode
not available
9
54 Keypad Access
not available
9
not available
9
56 Force Restore
not available
9
57 Bell Extend
not available
9
9
58 Power Alarm
not available
9
9
9
59 Part Tone
not available
9
08 No. Re-arms
9
9
60 RF Parameters
not available
9
09 Omit All
9
9
61 Activity Mon
not available
9
10 Key '0'
not available
9
62 Lockout
not available
9
9
9
not available
9
9
9
not available
9
15 System Text
not available
9
16 Soak Time
not available
9
17 Restart
not available
9
18 Stop Set
not available
9
9
9
11 Local Part
12 Banner
13 PA Delay
14 KEY/SW Level
19 Part Alarm
20 Power Delay
21 Reset Mgr.
22 PA reset
23 Print Codes
24 Exit Alarm
25 Global Copy
9
9
not available
9
9
9
not available
9
9
9
not available
9
26 Forced
not available
9
27 cct Debounce
not available
9
28 Online print
not available
9
29 Online level
not available
9
30 Video
9
9
31 Delay Alarm
9
9
32 Show Alarms
not available
9
33 Secure Code
not available
9
34 Comfort Time
not available
9
9
9
35 Fail To Set
Parameter
36 Battery Size
not available
9
37 Standby Time
not available
9
38 ATM Delay
not available
9
39 ATM Timeout
not available
9
40 Datelock
not available
not available
41 Weekend Work
not available
9
42 PIN Change
not available
9
43 Timer Access
not available
not available
44 Early Open
not available
9
45 High Security
not available
9
46 Res. Select
not available
9
47 Set Confirm
not available
9
48 Alarm Limits
not available
9
49 Confirm Time
not available
9
50 RF Bat Delay
not available
9
51 RF Jam Delay
not available
9
52 RF Stop Set
not available
9
63 Banner alerts
not available
9
64 Set Override
not available
9
65 Reset Levels
not available
9
66 Min Pin Size
not available
9
67 Level Format
not available
9
68 Line Fail
not available
9
69 Alert Inds
not available
9
70 SWDC Set Dly
not available
9
71 MF BL Enable
not available
9
72 Max Alm Cause
not available
9
73 Guard Unset
not available
9
74 Back-up Link
not available
9
75 Back-up Timer
not available
9
Table 6-8. System Parameters
6-52
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
01 = Bell Time
The duration of the Bells output activation is programmable within the range 0–30 minutes; the default is 15.
Assigning a value of 00 minutes sets the Bell Time to infinity.
This parameter can be assigned a different value for each group.
The Entry/Exit Horn is subject to the Bell Time parameter in both the set and unset conditions.
02 = Bell Delay
The delayed activation of the bell is programmable within the range 0–20 minutes; the default is 0. The Bell
Delay is overridden by a comms failure (either a Comms Fail on the Communication Module or by the
activation of a Line Fail zone used to monitor a digicom); an alarm condition in either of these conditions
results in instant bells activation.
This parameter can be assigned a different value for each group.
03 = Abort Time
The abort function delays the activation of a full intruder alarm condition following an entry alarm. This parameter has 2 sub-options:
1 = Abort Time
The abort time is programmable within the range 0-300 seconds and can be assigned a different value for each
group. The abort time will be initiated:
•
whenever a zone that is not on the entry route (Final, Entry and Exit zones) is activated — a
user strays from the entry route;
•
a valid code is not entered before the entry time expires.
The abort operation can be modified by adding a º or # to the programmed time. The standard abort
operation is as follows:
ƒ For entry route deviation, the signalling of an intruder alarm is delayed.
ƒ If a valid code is entered before the entry time expires:
(1) The intruder is not signalled.
(2) The system does not require a system reset.
ƒ If a valid code is not entered before the entry time expires or an entry timeout condition occurs:
(1) The intruder is signalled at the end of the entry time.
(2) The Abort timer starts on expiry of the entry time.
ƒ If a valid code is entered within the programmed abort time:
(1) If an abort output/channel is allocated to the alarmed group:
a) The Abort signal is sent.
b) The intruder condition is not restored.
c) Intruder restore is not signalled.
(2) If there is no abort output allocated to the alarmed group:
a) The intruder condition is restored.
b) Intruder restore is signalled
ƒ If the programmed abort time is allowed to expire without a valid code being entered, then the system
requires a system reset. The panel cannot be set until this occurs.
NOTE: If reduced resets (51.55.3) is enabled, the alarm will be reset by the user code, if the alarm is
unconfirmed.
6-53
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Modified Abort Operation
Hash # abort alters the standard operation so that the signalling of the intruder condition is delayed until the
end of the abort time. If the system is unset during the entry time or abort time, no alarm conditions will be
signalled.
Star º abort alters the standard operation so that if a user strays from the entry route within the entry time,
the intruder is signalled as soon as the entry deviation occurs.
NOTE 1: To comply with DD243:2002, the Standard abort operation must be used, with the abort time
set to 001 seconds.
NOTE 2: To comply with EN50131:2004 and DD243:2004, the Hash # abort operation must be used
with the Abort Time set to 30 seconds or longer.
2=Bell Delay
This option is either enabled or disabled. When enabled, it will hold off the start of any bell delay time programmed in parameter 03, until the end of the abort time programmed above.
04 = Exit Time
This parameter determines the time allowed to leave the premises via the exit route before the system sets.
The Exit Time is programmable within the range 0–300 seconds; the default is 120 seconds.
Infinite Exit Time
Assigning a value of 000 seconds sets the Exit Time to infinity; an Exit terminator activation (Final or Pushset zone) is required to complete the setting of the system. The infinite Exit Time is normally used with a
Push-set zone to terminate the setting and an Entry zone to start the unsetting procedure.
NOTE:
If the system is programmed to Autoset and the Exit Time is programmed to 000, the Exit
Time will be set to 60 seconds for the Autoset — there is no requirement for a Push-Set zone to
be activated.
Setting Multiple Groups
This parameter can be assigned a different value for each group. If more than one is group is being set, the
longest exit time is adopted for all setting groups.
6-54
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
05 = Entry Time
This parameter determines the entry time allowed to users when unsetting the system. The Entry Time is
programmable within the range 0–300 seconds; the default is 45. Assigning a value of 000 seconds sets the
Entry Time to infinity.
This parameter can be assigned a different value for each group.
NOTE: A Final zone assigned a when programming the function will double the programmed Entry
Time for the group it is allocated to.
06 = System Reset
This option allows the engineer or the remote code to determine the type that can reset the system following
an intruder alarm. The default type is 3.6 — manager; the programmable range is:
• 2.3–2.5 for the user
• 3.6 for the manager
• 3.7 for the engineer
This parameter can be assigned a different value for each group.
NOTE: This option is affected by reduced resets, menu option 51.55.3.
The panel only requests Engineer Level Reset if alarms have been signalled, via the Communication Module
and appropriate type reset is set to 3.7. If no signal is transmitted, the reset will automatically reduce to type
3.6. This feature is only active when the DTMF signalling format is selected.
NOTE: This option can also be programmed from parameter 65 = Reset Levels.
07 = Tamper Reset
This option allows the engineer or the remote code to determine the code type that can reset the system
following a tamper. The default type is 3.7 — engineer; the programmable range is:
• 2.3–2.5 for the user
• 3.6 for the manager
• 3.7 for the engineer
This parameter can be assigned a different value for each group.
NOTE: This option is affected by reduced resets, menu option (51.55.3)
The panel only requests Engineer Level Reset if alarms have been signalled, via the Communication Module
and appropriate level reset is set to 7. If no signal is transmitted, the reset will automatically reduce to type
3.7. This feature is only active when the DTMF signalling format is selected.
08 = No. Re-Arms
The Number of Re-arms parameter determines the number of times that an armed system can re-arm the
bells, following an alarm activation. The default setting is 9 (infinite) with a programmable range of 0 – 9,
where 9 is infinite re-arm. If the option is enabled, then the system re-arms at the end of the programmed
confirm time - only if all zones are closed or are open and can be omitted, or if the Omit all force is enabled.
The intruder output remains active until a system re-arm occurs.
6-55
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
Zones that are open at the end of the bell time must be omittable (Omit attribute enabled); the re-arm will omit
these zones. The complete zone circuit, including the tamper facility, is omitted. Refer to menu option 52 =
PROGRAM ZONES for details on enabling the zone omit attribute.
NOTE: If an open zone is not omittable, then the system will not re-arm, unless parameter 09 = Omit All is
set to 2.
09 = Omit All
This option determines if activated zones can be omitted at re-arm as described above.
0 = Disabled
1 = Omit All When set to 1 (enabled), omits any omittable zones that are open at re-arm. The complete zone
circuit including tamper is omitted.
2 = Force. As Omit All but omits zones whether omittable or not.
Refer to menu option 52 = PROGRAM ZONES for details on enabling the zone omit attribute.
10 = Key “0”
Key 0 on the keypad can be assigned to operate as a Push-set zone function; this will terminate the timed
setting procedure. When the option is set to 1 (enabled), pressing key 0 during the exit time completes the
setting of the system. The default is 0 (disabled).
NOTE: Key 0 must be pressed only on the keypad used to start the setting procedure.
11 = Local Part
When the Local Part parameter is set to 0 (disabled - default setting) the Intruder outputs are disabled when
the system is part set; the programmed bell delay is overridden. This is normally used to prevent the communicator from dialling the Alarm Receiving Centre.
If the Local Part parameter is set to 1 (enabled) the Intruder outputs activate if an alarm condition occurs
when the system is part set.
Option 2 (SIA part off) is identical to option 1 with the exception that when the alarm format of the telecom
module is set to SIA then the part setting and unsetting of the system is not signalled to the ARC.
This parameter can be assigned a different value for each group.
12 = Banner
This option can be used to customise both the top and bottom lines of the banner display. Press 1 to select
the TOP LINE or 2 to select the BOTTOM LINE; the display is written using the alpha-numeric assembly
method:
•
•
#
erases characters;
selects upper case, lower case or library;
•
AB
selects alphabet character/words;
•
000–500
selects alphabet character or words;
•
ent
positions selected characters/words;
• esc
accepts the programming and returns to the previous level; exits from the option.
The banner is displayed when the system is in the normal mode (set/unset).
6-56
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
13 = PA Delay
This parameter determines the delay between the activation of a PA Delay or PA Delay Silent zone and the
alarm sounding and signalling a PA via the communicator. The PA Delay is programmable within the range
1–60 seconds; the default is 60.
This parameter can be assigned a different value for each group.
14 = Key/SW Level
This parameter assigns a code type to zones programmed as Keyswitch. The Keyswitch zone can be used
to reset system, tamper and PA alarms - depending on the reset type assigned to each of these parameters.
The default type is 3.6 - manager; the programmable range is:
•
3.7 for the engineer
•
3.8 for the remote code
15 = System Text
This parameter allows two text strings to be assigned to the system: press 1 to select the System ID or 2 to
select the Panel Location.
1.
System ID — 16 character identification of system. This is used when connecting Remote Servicing
software.
2.
Panel Location — 16 character message of where control is fitted.
The text is written using the alpha-numeric assembly method:
•
•
#
erases characters;
selects upper case, lower case or library;
•
AB
selects alphabet character/words;
•
000–538
•
ent
positions selected characters/words;
•
esc
accepts the programming and returns to the previous level; exits from the option.
selects alphabet character or words;
16 = Soak Time
This parameter determines the number of days that zones can be soak tested for; the programmable range is
1 – 14 days; the default is 7.
NOTE:
Default settings must be changed before programming in Menu Option 55 – Soak.
6-57
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
17 = Restart
This parameter has three options:
1 = Restart
This option re-configures the system without the need to remove and reconnect the power. The system displays a WARNING!!! ent=RESET SYSTEM, press the ent key to reconfigure the system. The keypad
display becomes blank for a few seconds, then displays the message Configuring Please Wait. When
configuration is complete the banner returns to the normal display (day mode). The Restart option configures
any modules that have been added to the system but gives an alarm if there are any tampers open or if any
modules are reported as missing.
NOTE: This parameter exits engineer mode. It is however recommended that the exit engineer mode sequence is used when adding or removing modules from the system.
NOTE: Outputs are momentarily reset during the restart. If the system has a communications requirement,
put it on test before using the restart.
2 = Defaults
This option chooses the panel default settings for a particular country. These are: 1 = UK, 2 = Spain,
3 = Portugal, 4 = Germany, 5 = Italy.
The system displays a WARNING!!! ent=RESET SYSTEM, press the ent key to reconfigure the system.
3 = Language
This option chooses the language shown on the keypad display. These are: 1 = English, 2 = Espanol,
3 = Portugues, 4 = Deutch, 5 = Italiano. Pressing ent changes the display immediately.
18 = Stop Set
This parameter, when set to 1 (enabled), prevents the system from set override if there is a communication or
power fail condition at the time of starting the setting procedure. If the condition is the result of an open Line
Fail or AC Fail zone, then the system can not be set until the zone is closed or omitted. The Stop Set parameter is set to 0 (disabled) by default.
NOTE: Battery Low will also prevent the system from setting.
19 = Part Alarm
When the Part Alarm parameter is set to 1 (enabled — default setting) the Bells and Strobe outputs activate
if an alarm condition occurs when the system is part set.
When the Part Alarm parameter is set to 0 (disabled) the Bells and Strobe outputs are disabled when the
system is part set.
NOTE: The Horn, Entry/Exit and Intruder outputs are not affected by this parameter.
This parameter can be assigned a different value for each group.
6-58
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
20 = Power Delay
This parameter determines the delay between the activation of AC Fail outputs following a mains failure to
allow the power to return before signalling the fault. The Power Delay is programmable within the range
0–600 minutes; the default is 10.
This parameter can be assigned a different value for each group.
21 = Reset MGR
This parameter should only be used if the Master Manager code is lost or must be replaced. On selecting the
Reset MGR parameter, a warning message is displayed: WARNING!!! ENT=Code Change; press the
ent key to erase current code and reset it to the default of 12345.
22 = PA Reset
This option allows the engineer or the remote code to determine the code type that can reset the system
following a PA activation. The default type is 3.6 — manager; the programmable range is:
• 2.3 - 2.5 for the user
• 3.6 for the manager
• 3.7 for the engineer
This parameter can be assigned a different value for each group.
The panel only requests Engineer Level Reset if alarms have been signalled, via the Communication Module
and appropriate type reset is set to 3.7. If no signal is transmitted, the reset will automatically be reduced to
type 3.6. This feature is only active when the DTMF signalling format is selected.
23 = Print Codes
The Print Codes option, when set to 1 (enabled), allows the manager to print a list of the PINS for each of
the users. The option defaults to 0 (disabled).
24 = Exit Alarm
If the Exit Alarm parameter is set to 1 (enabled), any zone other than Final, Exit, Entry or Push-Set (or
Secure Final or Part Final when acting as a Final) that is opened during the exit time causes a full alarm
condition to be activated. The default is 0 (disabled).
NOTE: This option must be used only when specified.
This parameter can be assigned a different value for each group.
If the Exit Alarm parameter is enabled, any zone that is open when the Autoset begins (at the end of the prewarning period) causes an immediate full alarm condition to be activated.
If the Exit Alarm parameter is disabled, any zone open when the Autoset begins (at the end of the prewarning period) results in an “urgent” bleeping from the Entry/Exit Horns. If the open zones are not closed
by the end the time assigned in parameter 35 = Fail To Set, a full alarm is activated along with any outputs
programmed as Fail-Set.
6-59
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
25 = Global Copy
The Global Copy parameter changes all zones within the selected range to the function and parameters of the
first zone in the range. On selection of the parameter, a warning message is displayed indicating that the zone
functions will be altered — WARNING!!! ENT=ZONE CHANGES: press the ent key to continue or the
esc key to abort the programming. The address and function of the first zone on the system are displayed:
•
Copy Start: Use the A or B key to select the first zone in the range to be copied and press the ent key.
The function of this zone will be copied to all subsequent zones in the range;
•
Copy End: Use the A key to move to the last zone in the range to be copied.
•
Press the ent key to copy the zone function to the selected range.
26 = Forced
The Forced parameter enables or disables Menu option 14 = FORCED SET. If the parameter is set to 1
(enabled) the user can force the system to set, automatically omitting any omittable zones that are open at the
time of setting. If the parameter is set to 0 (disabled), option 14 = FORCED SET is not available to the user;
the message Option not available is displayed. The parameter defaults to 0 (disabled).
NOTE: It is recommended that Final, Entry and Push-Set zones have the omit attribute disabled.
27 = CCT Debounce
The cct Debounce parameter determines the response time of the zones (how long they must remain open
before registering as changing state). The cct Debounce is programmable within the range 20–1000 milliseconds (0.02–1 second); the default is 300 msecs. All entries are rounded up to the nearest 20 msecs.
NOTE: The value programmed in this option is the value allocated to the SYSTEM selection when programming zone response time in option 52.
28 = Online Print
This parameter is used to select the print mode required when connecting a serial printer to the Galaxy panel;
there are two options:
0 = disabled (default): system only prints specific details at the user’s request. The printer can be
connected and disconnected at any time as required;
1 = enabled: this option switches the printer to on-line mode and requires that a printer be
continuously connected to the system. Events are printed as and when they occur. The events printed
are controlled by parameter 29 = Online Level.
NOTE: If Online Print is enabled, the event log and other options will not be printed at the user’s request.
The parameter must be disabled to permit all other print options to operate.
6-60
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
29 = Online Level
The On-line Level parameter determines the level of events that are printed when parameter 28 = Online
Print is enabled:
0 (default) - basic print (setting, unsetting, alarms);
1
- full print excluding MAX events (setting, unsetting, alarms, modifications, technical
details)
2
- full print including MAX events (all logged events).
3
- MAX events only (only card events).
4
- Basic Print plus MAX events (option 0 + MAX events).
30 = Video
This parameter determines the number of activations that must occur on any of the zones programmed as
Video, in a single set period, before a full alarm occurs; there is no time limit on the period between
activations. The Video parameter is programmable within the range 1–9 activations; the default is 2. The video
output occurs on every activation but a full alarm does not occur until the programmed number of activations is
reached. The Video zones activation counter is reset when the system is unset.
NOTE: The activations of the Video zones are cumulative - the counter is incremented each time any Video
zone in the group is activated.
This parameter can be assigned a different value for each group.
31 = Delay Alarm
This parameter determines the delay between the activation of an Intruder Delay zone and the alarm sounding or a Log Delay zone being recorded as opening in the event log. The Delay Alarm is programmable
within the range 0–3000 seconds; the default is 60.
If a second Intruder Delay zone opens followed by the first zone closing, the Delay Alarm time continues to
count from the activation of the first zone. The Delay Alarm timer is reset only when all delay type zones
return to the closed state.
This parameter can be assigned a different value for each group.
32 = Show Alarms
If the Show Alarms parameter is enabled, the first alarm activation is immediately displayed on all the
keypads when an alarm condition occurs. Normally alarm messages are not displayed until the alarm is
cancelled by entry of a valid code. Parameter 51.63, Banner Alerts must be enabled to view alarms on the
keypad banner.
0 = disabled (default)
1 = enabled
NOTE: This parameter will only function when at least one group is unset.
6-61
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
33 = Secure Code
Once this parameter has been selected, the engineer code is randomly changed each day at 08:00 hours. The
service engineer must be informed of the “code of the day” by head office. The random code that is generated
is dependent on the local engineer code, therefore each area, company, branch or even system can have a
unique secure code.
Either the engineer or remote user code can select the Secure Code parameter. On selecting this parameter
the secure code equivalent to the current engineer code must be entered to confirm the selection. Only the
remote user code (or a cold start - erasing all programming details) can cancel it.
Select 1 to enable Secure Code, or 0 to disable the parameter; the default is 0 (disabled).
34 = Comfort Time
The Comfort Time parameter permits a period of time to be allocated when the values assigned to the entry
and abort time parameters and the number of wrong code attempts are doubled; the programmable range is
0–14 days; the default is 0. This allows new or unfamiliar users to become accustomed to the system without
causing false alarm activations. At the end of the Comfort Time the system returns all the affected parameters
to the programmed values.
35 = Fail to Set
This parameter determines the period of time that a zone must remain open, following the start of the setting
procedure, before the Fail Set outputs activate. The programmable range is 0–999 seconds; the default is
360 .
NOTE: The Fail to Set countdown time begins as soon as the setting procedure is started.
NOTE: The Fail to Set time should be at a minimum 5 seconds longer than the Exit Time (option 51.04),
to allow for the setting period to expire.
This parameter can be assigned a different value for each group.
36 = Battery Size
Enter the size of the standby battery on the control Panel PSU. The programmable range is 0–99Ah; the
default is 0.
37 = Standby Time
Enter the value (in hours) that the system is required to run on standby battery if there is a mains fail. The
programmable range is 0–99 hours; the default is 0.
The Control Panel PSU calculates the battery run time from the programmed Battery Size (parameter 36)
and the load current. If the programmed Standby Time exceeds the calculated battery run time, a
STANDBY TIME LOW message is displayed on the keypad on attempting to exit engineer mode. Exiting
engineer mode is prevented until a Standby Time that is less than the calculated battery time is entered or a
larger battery is installed in the system and the new battery size is entered in the Battery Size parameter.
To view the latest battery Standby Time refer to Option 61.1.4=Diagnostics.Latest.PSU Comms.
NOTE: The calculated battery run time has a 10% safety margin built in.
38 = ATM Delay
This parameter determines the period of time before the selected ATM zone type is omitted following the
entry of one of the ATM codes. The programmable range is 0–30 minutes; the default ATM Delay is 5.
6-62
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
39 = ATM Timeout
This parameter determines the period of time that the selected ATM zone type is omitted following the entry
of one of the ATM codes. The programmable range is 1–90 minutes; the default ATM Timeout is 30.
40 = Datelock
Option not available
41 = Weekend Work
This parameter is used to enable or disable menu option 45.6 = TIMER CONTROL.Weekend Work. If
the parameter is set to 1, the engineer can assign a Pattern Day and the user can authorize Weekend Working. If the parameter is set to 0 (disabled — default setting), the message Option not available is displayed
on selecting menu option 45.6, Weekend Work.
42 = PIN Change
This parameter defines the expiry period of user codes allocated the PIN Change attribute (refer to option 42
= CODES). The PIN Change parameter is programmable within the range 0–12 months; the default is 0.
The user PIN must be changed before the assigned PIN Change month ends. On entering the expiring user
code a warning that the code is due to expire and a prompt to assign a new code is given to the user. The
period of this warning message is determined by the PIN Warning option (refer to menu option 42.2 =
CODES. PIN Warning).
The default value is 0 - this means that although codes have been allocated the expiry attribute, they do not
expire.
43 = Timer Access
Option not available.
44 = Early Open
This parameter determines the number of minutes before the Lockout OFF time that the system can be
manually unset when the Early Open option (refer to menu option 45 = TIMERS) is switched on. The
Early Open parameter is programmable within the range 0–240 minutes; the default is 0.
45 = High Security
This option allows RIO zones to be monitored for Constant Voltage Tampers. A constant voltage tamper is
activated if a zone detector is replaced by a constant voltage source, for example, battery. This feature can
either be enabled or disabled. Only RIO zones are affected by this feature.
The High Security feature is disabled by default in the RIO, so must be turned on by the panel for this feature
to be activated. The feature can be turned on from the panel via Parameter 45 (High Security). The default
value for this parameter is disabled. If enabled, all RIOs on the system are affected.
6-63
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
46 = Resistance Select
RIOs rev 1.2 and Smart PSUs rev 0.7 and above allow the zones to be programmed, with different resistance
preset values for zone status activation. This feature allows selection of End Of Line or Double Balanced zone
resistance types. The on-board zones can also be modified using this feature.
The “EOL/Dbl. Bal.” resistance types are selectable from this option. The system default value is 1k Fault
(Double Balanced). There are 10 preset pre-programmable resistance configurations:
1 = Preset 1 (BAL); 2 = Preset 1(EOL); 3 = Preset 2 (BAL); 4 = Preset 2 (EOL); 5 = Preset 3 (BAL);
6 = Preset 3 (EOL); 7 = Preset 4 (BAL); 8 = Preset 4 (EOL); 9 = 1K Fault (BAL); 10 = 1K Fault (EOL).
The tables that follows shows the resistance windows for each type:
Option 01 - 1k
Option 03 - 2k2
Option 05 - 4k7
Option 07 - 5K6
Option 09 - 1k Fault
0 - 800
0 - 1800
0 - 3700
0 -1400
0 - 800
Low Res
800 - 900
1800 - 2000
3700 - 4200
1400 - 2800
800 - 900
Normal
900 - 1200
2000 - 2500
4200 - 5500
2800 - 8400
900 -1200
High Res
1200 - 1300
2500 - 2700
5500 - 6500
8400 - 9800
1200 - 1300
Open
1300 - 12000
2700 - 12000
6500 - 19000
9800 - 12600
1300 - 3500
Fault
-
-
-
-
3500 - 4500
Masked
12000 - 19000
12000 - 15000
19000 - 22000
12600 - 22000
4500 - 19000
Tamper O/C
19000 - infinity
15000 - infinity
22000 - infinity
22000 - infinity
19000 - infinity
Tamper S/C
Table 6-9. Preset value limits (ohms) - double balanced
Option 02 - 1k
Option 04 - 2k2
Option 06 - 4k7
Option 08 - 5k6
Option 10 -1k Fault
0 - 800
0 - 1800
0 - 3700
0 - 1400
0 - 800
Low Res
800 - 900
1800 - 2000
3700 - 4200
1400 - 2800
800 - 900
Normal
900 - 1200
2000 - 2500
4200 - 5500
2800 - 8400
900 - 1200
High Res
1200 - 1300
2500 - 2700
5500 - 6500
8400 - 9800
1200 - 1300
-
-
-
-
1300 - 4500
Masked
1300 - 12000
2700 - 12000
6500 - 19000
9800 - 19000
4500 - 19000
Open
12000 - infinity
12000 - infinity
19000 - infinity
19000 - infinity
19000 - infinity
Tamper S/C
Fault
Table 6-10. Preset value limits (ohms) - end of line
When a preset is selected, this will be the zone resistance range used by every zone on the system. Each zone
on the system can be further customised to a specific preset by using menu option 52.9, Resistance Select.
6-64
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
47 = Set Confirm
This parameter allows the system to emit a short double beep when the system/group has set. There are three
options.
0 = Off
No indication
1 = Alert on Set
A double beep when the system has set
2 = Alert on Comm
A double beep after a successful signal to the ARC that setting has occurred.
48 = Alarm Limits
This parameter allows the user to program the maximum number of alarms, per group, which may be transmitted to an Alarm Receiving Centre in any set period. There are three options:
1 = No of Alarms
This is the total number of zone activations logged in any one set period. The selectable values are 0-10
where 0 is unlimited.
2 = Unset Limit
This is the number of activations logged from any one zone in any one unset period. The selectable values are
0-7. The default is 3.
Fire alarms are not restricted by this parameter.
3 = Set Limit
This is the number of activations logged from any one zone in any one set period. The selectable values are 07. The default is 3.
Fire alarms are not restricted by this parameter.
NOTE: This feature only affects Contact ID, SIA and Microtech communication formats.
49 = Confirm Time
This option is the maximum time between two separate zones for a confirmed alarm to be generated up to a
maximum of 99 minutes, which is equivalent to the complete set period, with a default of 30 minutes.
50 = RF Bat Delay
This option allows a warning to be given at the Galaxy panel if an RF low battery is detected. An additional
option is given at the panel that allows a delay up to a maximum of 100 hours (default) before a signal of RF
BAT LOW is sent to the ARC.
6-65
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 = RF Jam Delay
This option allows the RF RIO to send an RF jam signal to the Galaxy panel if it detects interference for 30
seconds. If the interference is continuously present for five minutes (default), the signal is transmitted to central
station. The programmable range is 0 - 30 minutes.
52 = RF Stop Set
If this option is enabled, the setting is prevented if all supervised devices have not signalled to the receiver in
the stop set period prior to setting. This is selectable from 0 - 250 minutes. The default is 20 minutes.
53 = RF Stop Mode
This option controls if and how an RF fault prevents the panel from being set. There are three options:
0 = Disabled: An RF fault will not prevent setting
1 = Warning: If there is a failure the user will get a warning but can continue to set.
2 = Auto Check: If there is a failure the system cannot be set until the zone(s) have been activated.
54 = Keypad Access
This option allows the keypad to unset the system. There are two options:
1 = Always
2 = Except Entry: Except when entry time is running. This ensures that users are unsetting using a fob or
MAX tag (portable device)
55 = Confirm
This option controls how confirmed alarms are generated. It controls the operation of confirm outputs plus the
signalling of confirmed alarms. There are three options:
1 = Operation: This option controls when confirmed alarms can be triggered. An entry timeout alarm will
never contribute to a confirmed alarm. Here are three options:
1 = Before Entry. Confirmed alarms can be triggered before starting entry time only.
2 = Except entry (UK). Confirmed alarms can be triggered any time except during the entry delay
period.
3 = Always (EU). Confirmed alarms are always enabled.
2 = Entry Timeout: This option controls whether exit type zones can cause confirmed alarms, after an entry
timeout.
0 = Disable Exits. Exit type zones will only cause unconfirmed intruder alarms. They will not contribute
to the two activations required for a confirmed alarm.
1 = Enable Exits. After the expiry of the entry delay, activation of an exit type zone will be identical to an
intruder zone.
3 = Reduce Reset: This option allows user reset following an unconfirmed alarm.
0 = Off. Full system reset is required for any intruder alarm.
1 = On Unconfirmed. The system can be reset by user, if the alarm is unconfirmed. If the alarm is
classed as confirmed, a full system reset will be required.
56 = Force Restore
This option dictates when intruder restore signals are transmitted.
1 = Unset/Unconfirm: On unset or at the end of the confirmed time if the alarm is not confirmed.
2 = System Reset: Sent when the system is fully reset.
6-66
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
57 = Bell Extend
If enabled, this parameter extends the bell time if the system cannot rearm. For example , if the zone is still
open and cannot be omitted. The bell time can be extended up to 30 minutes maximum . The Default is 0, no
extension.
58 = Power Alarm
If enabled, this parameter allows the Bells, Strobe and Horn outputs to activate when there is an AC fail and
the system is set. The default is 0.
59 = Part Tone
When enabled, this parameter changes the setting tone for a part set. The new tone is on 2 secs, off 0.1 sec.
60 = RF Parameters
1 = Supervision
This parameter has two sub options:
1 = Silent Alarm. If enabled, it stops Supervision alarms from activating sounders when set.
2 = Debounce. This extends the normal 2 hour delay for supervision by a further 24 hours.
61 = Activity Mon.
This parameter allows zone activity to be checked. If zones programmed for zone activity checks are not
activated within the programmed time period and/or number of set/unset cycles a zone masked fault is indicated at the panel. Six different combinations of check criteria are available for each zone.
Each criteria type can be programmed to check the number of days, the set/unset cycles or both. Default
value is both.
1 = Mode
The mode can be set to one of three options: Max Period, Max Unsets or Either.
2 = MAX Period
The time period that zone activity is checked can be set to between 1 and 28 days. Default is 14 days.
3 = MAX Unsets
This is the number of programmable set/unset cycles that must take place before a zone masked fault is indicated at the panel. The number of set/unsets can be programmed from 1 - 10. The default is 7.
62 = Lockout
This parameter prevents code guessing on the Galaxy system.
1=Lockout
This parameter determines the number of invalid code attempts, which can be tried before keypad lockout
occurs. Keypad lockout prevents any entry via all keypads associated to the groups assigned to the keypad
where the invalid attempts were made. The lockout lasts for 90 seconds. Each subsequent invalid attempt to
cause a further 90 second lockout to occur. Entry of a valid code will reset the lockout counter. Lockout can
be programmed between 0 and 10. Default is 6. Setting to 0 disables the function.
6-67
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
2=Tamper
This parameter determines the number of invalid code attempts, which can be tried before system tamper
occurs. Lockout tamper can be programmed between 0 and 21. Default is 15. Setting to 0 disables the
function.
63 = Banner Alerts
This parameter determines whether system alerts are displayed on the Galaxy keypad banner. If enabled
system events will be indicated on the display. The default value for this parameter is disabled.
64 = Set Override
This parameter determines the type of user that can override specific fault events to set the system. The default
values are shown in the table below.
User Type
Override Level
Fault Type
System
2.1
Tamper
3.6
PA
2.1
Line Fail
3.6
General Fault
2.1
Power fail
2.1
Table 6-11. User Type Override Level
A different value can be programmed for each group.
65 = Reset levels
This parameter determines the type of user that can reset specific fault types. The default values are shown in
the table below.
User Type
Reset Level
Fault Type
System
3.6
Tamper
3.7
PA
3.6
Line Fail
3.7
General Fault
3.7
Power Fail
3.6
Table 6-12. User Type Reset Level
NOTE: This parameter affects and is affected by parameters 51.6 (System Reset), 51.7 (Tamper Reset) and
51.22 (PA Reset). If the parameter reset level is changed at 51.65 then this change is reflected at
51.6, 51.7 and 51.22.
66 = Min Pin Size
This parameter determines the minimum size of each user code. This can be set from four to six digits. The
default is five digits.
6-68
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
67 = Level Format
This parameter determines the format used for user code authorization levels.
1 = EN.Galaxy (Default)
Uses new EN Galaxy user types 1.0 to 3.8.
2 = Galaxy
Uses standard Galaxy levels 0-8.
68 = Line Fail
This parameter allows the programming of the period between the panel being alerted by a communication
module of a Line Fail condition, and the user being alerted of the alarm condition. This value can be programmed between 0 and 1800 seconds. The default is 50 seconds.
NOTE: The communication module may take up to 40 seconds to alert the panel of a Line Fail condition.
This time is in addition to the programmed time of 0-1800 seconds.
This parameter affects all communication modules on the system.
69 = Alert Inds
This parameter allows the alert audio indication to be switched off. The default is 1 = Audio only.
0 = No Indication
1 = Audio Only
2 = Visual Only (only when parameter 63 enabled)
3 = Audio/Visual (only when parameter 63 enabled)
70 = SWDC Set Dly
When enabled, this parameter delays the indication of open zones at the start of a set sequence whilst the
Switch DC output (53.08) is active; this includes keypad text and sounders.
If there are no outputs programmed as Switch DC then there will be no delay at the start of the set.
71 = MF BL Enable
When enabled, this parameter allows the panel to send a SIA event when the battery is low and there is a
mains power failure. When the event is sent, the Power Delay time set in parameter 51.20 stops immediately.
72 = Max Alm Cause
This option defines the range of valid cause codes, as agreed with the Alarm Receiving Centre. When this
function is enabled, a cause code must be entered by the user when a reset of the system is required.
This parameter can be disabled by setting the alarm cause code to 000.
73 = Guard Unset
If set to 1 = Enabled this option allows a type 2.1 user code to unset the system if an alarm has occured. The
user code becomes type 2.4 after 3 minutes of the alarm but after 60 minuts returns to type 2.1. The user
code can set the system at any time provided there are no outstanding resets required.
6-69
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
51 - Parameters (cont’d)
74 = Backup Link
If the Ethernet fails to report, this parameter, when enabled, allows the communication to revert to Telecoms.
75 = Backup Timer
This is the time that the backup link is active. The time can be set from 0-300 seconds. The default is 90
seconds.
6-70
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
52 - Program Zones
Option 52 – Program Zones
This option is used by the engineer to modify the programming of the zones on the system. The option also
allows the attributes of the zone to be changed. The programmable options are shown in the table that follows:
Attributes
Description
1
Function
assign zone type
2
Descriptor
16 character (max.) alpha-numeric description
3
Chime
enabled = momentarily chime effect if zone opened while unset
4
Omit
enabled = zone can be omitted
5
Part
enabled = zone included in part setting of system
6
Resp. Time
Modify circuit debounce time
7
Custom SIA
Select SIA event
8
Activity Mon.
Selects criteria for zone activity checking
9
Res. Select
Selects resistance range for zone
10
Group
assign zone to a single group on the system
Note:
Groups only appear if the Group option is enabled
(refer to option 63.1 = OPTIONS.Groups).
Table 6-13. Zone Attributes
Selecting Zones
On entering the option, the first zone on the system is displayed; the zone address, function and group assigned are displayed on the top line, the descriptor is displayed on the bottom line. Pressing the # key toggles
the descriptor to reveal the status of the chime, omit and part attributes. If the attribute is enabled, the initial
attribute letter is displayed, if it is disabled, a dash (–) is shown. For example, chime, part and omit enabled
display as COP, if omit is disabled the display would be C – P.
From the display of the first zone, any zone on the system can be displayed by pressing the A or B keys or by
entering the address of a specific zone.
The zone is selected for programming by pressing the ent key; the first zone programming attribute 1=Function is displayed.
Attributes
The attributes can be stepped through by pressing the A or B keys or directly selected by pressing the attribute number (1–8). Once the required attribute is on display, press the ent key to gain access for modification.
Once the attribute has been assigned press the ent key to save the programming and return to the attribute
selection level.
Pressing the esc key at any time when assigning attributes 1 and 3–10 to a zone aborts the programming and
returns to the attribute selection level. Pressing the esc key when assigning a descriptor to a zone saves the
assigned alphanumeric text and returns to the attribute selection level.
6-71
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
52 - Program Zones (cont’d)
1 = Function
Entering the Function attribute displays the address and the current function of the selected zone along with
the zone function reference number. The zone functions can be stepped through, forwards or backwards,
using the A and B keys. Alternatively a zone function can be directly selected by entering the zone function
reference number, for example, entering the 19 displays zone function 19 = FIRE.
Once the required zone function is displayed, it is assigned to the zone by pressing the ent key.
2 = Descriptor
Each zone can be assigned with an alpha-numeric descriptor of up to 16 characters. This descriptor is assembled from the character set and/or library options. On selecting the Descriptor attribute, the currently assigned descriptor (blank by default) is displayed on the top line - an underscore shows where the next character will be positioned, and a selection of the alphabet is shown on the bottom line - the cursor flashes on the
letter L.
Press the
key to erase the characters already assigned to the descriptor.
The A or B keys can be used to move the alphabet left or right until the required character is positioned
underneath the flashing cursor. When the required character is in position press the ent key to copy the character to the descriptor in the top line. Repeat this procedure to assemble the required zone descriptor.
Text Case and Library
On entering the Descriptor attribute the alpha-numeric characters are all presented in upper case. Pressing
the # key toggles the characters to lower case.
Pressing the # key when the lower case alphanumeric characters are displayed toggles to the library words.
The words can be viewed using the A or B keys or directly selected using the reference number - refer to
Appendix A - Library. When the required word is displayed, press the ent key to copy it to the descriptor.
NOTE: Library words are a maximum of 12 characters and upper case only.
3 = Chime
If the Chime attribute is set to 1 (enabled) the zone will chime momentarily whenever it is opened while the
system is unset. The Chime attribute defaults to 0 (disabled) for all zone functions.
The A or B keys can be used to toggle the status of the Chime attribute — pressing 1 or 0 will also select the
required status; press the ent key to accept the programming.
NOTE: The Chime option (full menu option 15, quick menu option 2) must be enabled if the zones are to
chime when opened.
4 = Omit
If the Omit attribute is set to 1 (enabled) the zone can be omitted from the system by using one of the omit
functions (11 = OMIT ZONES, 14 = FORCED SET, 46 = GROUP OMIT). The Omit attribute defaults
to 0 (disabled) for all zone functions.
6-72
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
52 - Program Zones (cont’d)
The A or B keys can be used to toggle the status of the Omit attribute - pressing 1 or 0 will also select the
required status; press the ent key to accept the programming.
5 = Part
If the Part attribute is set to 1 (enabled) the zone will be included in the setting procedure when one of the
part setting options is used to set the system (13 = PART SET, 17 = INSTANT PART). The Part attribute
defaults to 1 (enabled) for all zone functions except zones programmed as 09 = Keyswitch.
The A or B keys can be used to toggle the status of the Part attribute - pressing 1 or 0 will also select the
required status; press the ent key to accept the programming.
6 = Resp. Time
This function is only applicable to zones on RIO rev 1.2 and Smart PSU rev 0.7 and above.
This option allows the user to select , either Fast (10ms), System (default value programmed in 51 – Parameters, Option 27) or Slow (750ms), for each zone.
7 = Custom SIA
This option allows a different SIA mnemonic to be allocated to the selected zone. The default is the standard
SIA mnemonic for the zone type selection. The default mnemonic can be reselected by pressing the key.
The table that follows shows the list of available customisable mnemonics:
No
Event text
Description
Alarm
Closed
Omit
Unomit
Troub
Tr. Res
Test
Tamp
1
Default
2
AT/R Power
AC Trouble, AC Restoral
AT
AR
BB
BU
BT
BJ
BX
TA
3
BA/R Burglary
Burglary Alarm, Burglary Restoral
BA
BR
BB
BU
BT
BJ
BX
TA
4
DG/D Access
Access Granted, Access Denied
DG
DD
BB
BU
DT
DJ
BX
TA
5
FA/R Fire
Fire Alarm, Fire Restoral
FA
FR
FB
FU
FT
FJ
FX
TA
6
GA/R Gas
Gas Alarm, Gas Restoral
GA
GR
GB
GU
GT
GJ
GX
TA
7
HA/R Holdup
Holdup Alarm, Holdup Restoral
HA
HR
HB
HU
HT
HJ
BX
TA
8
KA/R Heat
Heat Alarm, Heat Restoral
KA
KR
KB
KU
KT
KJ
BX
TA
9
LT/R Line Fail
Line Trouble, Line Restoral
LT
LR
BB
BU
BT
BJ
BX
TA
10
MA/R Medical
Medical Alarm, Medical Restoral
MA
MR
MB
MU
MT
MJ
BX
TA
11
PA/R Panic
Panic Alarm, Panic Restoral
PA
PR
PB
PU
PT
PJ
BX
TA
12
QA/R Assist
Emergency Alarm, Emergency
Restoral
QA
QR
QB
QU
QT
QJ
BX
TA
13
RO/C Relay
Relay Open, Relay Closed
RO
RC
BB
BU
BT
BJ
BX
TA
14
SA/R Sprinklr
Sprinkler Alarm, Sprinkler Restoral
SA
SR
SB
SU
ST
SJ
BX
TA
15
TA/R Tamper
Tamper Alarm, Tamper Restoral
TA
TR
TB
TU
BT
BJ
TX
TA
16
WA/R Water
Water Alarm, Water Restoral
WA
WR
WB
WU
WT
WJ
BX
TA
17
YT/R Battery
Battery Alarm, Battery Restoral
YT
YR
BB
BU
BT
BJ
BX
TA
18
ZA/R Freezer
Freezer Alarm, Freezer Restoral
ZA
ZR
ZB
ZU
ZT
ZJ
BX
TA
Table 6-14. Customisable Mnemonics
NOTE: If two zones, programmed as Custom SIA, activate within the confirm time window, whether it be in
the SET or UNSET condition, then a CONFIRM is logged.
6-73
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
52 - Program Zones (cont’d)
8 = Activity Mon.
This attribute allows a zone to be checked for activity during a set time period or set/unset cycles. The options
are:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
0 = None
1 = Type1
2 = Type2
3 = Type3
4 = Type4
5 = Type5
6 = Type6
The default option is 0 = None.
If the zone does not activate at least once within the programmed criteria a zone masked fault is indicated at
the panel. The fault is logged as a masked event which indicates that the zone has been inactive for the programmed period. See Option 51.61=Parameters.Activity Monitoring.
9 = Res. Select
This option allows the zone resistor configuration to be selected from a pre-defined value.
•
00 = System (follows the system default as programmed in parameter 51.46 = Zone Resistance)
•
Option 01 = Preset 1 - 1k (double balanced)
•
Option 02 = Preset 1 - 1k (end-of-line)
•
Option 03 = Preset 2 - 2k2 (double balanced)
•
Option 04 = Preset 2 - 2k2 (end-of-line)
•
Option 05 = Preset 3 - 4k7 (double balanced)
•
Option 06 = Preset 3 - 4k7 (end-of-line)
•
Option 07 = Preset 4 - 5k6 (double balanced)
•
Option 08 = Preset 4 - 5k6 (end-of-line)
•
Option 09 = 1k Fault (double balanced)
•
Option 10 = 1k Fault (end-of-line)
The values assigned by each of the options are shown in tables 10 and 11, Parameter 51.46=Zone Resistance.
10 = Group
NOTE: The Groups attribute is only available if groups have been enabled on the system (refer to option 63
= OPTIONS).
The Group attribute allows the zone to be assigned to a single group on the system. All zones default to
Group A1.
On selecting the Group attribute, the group that the zone is currently assigned to is displayed. All zones
default to group A1. Press the number of the group that the zone is to be reassigned to and press the ent key.
Multi-group Systems
The larger Galaxy panels have 32 groups; these are displayed on the keypad in blocks of eight groups, subdivided into A, B, C and D:
6-74
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
52 - Program Zones (cont’d)
Use the A or B key to select the required group (A1–D8). When the end of a block is reached, the next
block of eight groups is displayed; use keys 1–8 to assign the relevant group in the current block to the zone;
press the ent key to accept the selection.
Star ( ) Group Function
Certain zone functions have an additional Group attribute feature that allows the other groups to be affected
by their operation. This feature is assigned by pressing the key when allocating the group to the zone.
On pressing the key the display indicates the group currently assigned to the zone and prompts for other
groups to be added, for example 1 1 – – – – – – –, pressing 4 and 7 assigns 1 1 – – 4 – – 7 –.
Final, Secure Final, Part Final Keyswitch and Push Set Zones
If the star group feature is assigned a zone programmed as Final, Secure Final, Part Final or Push Set,
then closing the zone when setting multiple groups terminates the setting procedure for all groups assigned to
the zone.
Refer to the zone functions for further information on the operation of these zone functions.
Exit Zones
The star group feature can be assigned to a zone programmed as Exit. This allows an Exit zone to be
activated in a group which is not currently being unset without activating an Intruder alarm condition.
Refer to the zone functions for further information on the operation of this zone function.
System Alarms
The Galaxy panels have tamper and alarm monitoring circuits which are not programmable. These circuits
maintain the integrity of the system and all correspond to Group A1.
Zone
Alarm
Description
0001
CUBATT
Control unit battery low
0002
CUAC
Control unit AC fail
0003
LID TAMPER
Control unit lid tamper
0004
AUX TAMPER
Control unit tamper return
Table 6-15. Control Panel Alarms
6-75
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
52 - Program Zones (cont’d)
Zone Function
Zone Function
01
Final
27
Remote Access
02
Exit
28
Video
03
Intruder
29
Video Exit
04
24 Hours
30
Intruder Delay
05
Security
31
Log Delay
06
Dual
32
Set Log
07
Entry
33
Custom-A
08
Push Set
34
Custom-B
09
Keyswitch
35
Exitguard
10
Secure Final
36
Mask
11
Part Final
37
Urgent
12
Part Entry
38
PA Unset
13
PA
39
Keyswitch Reset
14
PA Silent
40
Bell Fail
15
PA Delay
41
Intr Low
16
PA Delay Silent
42
Intr High
17
Link
43
PSU Fault
18
Spare
44
Not Used
19
Fire
45
Not Used
20
Tamper
46
Not Used
21
Bell Tamper
47
Vibration
22
Beam Pair
48
ATM-1
23
Battery Low
49
ATM-2
24
Line Fail
50
ATM-3
25
AC Fail
51
ATM-4
26
Log
52
Alarm Extend
Table 6-16. Available Zone Functions
6-76
52 - Program Zones (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
01 Final
Zones programmed as Final initiate the unsetting procedure and terminate setting procedure; opening the
Final zone when the system or group is set starts the entry timer; opening and then closing the Final zone
during the exit procedure sets the system or assigned groups, providing all the zones are closed. The opening
(+) and closing (–) of Final zones during the setting and unsetting procedures are recorded in the event log.
Pressing the
key when programming a Final zone doubles the entry time of the group.
Opening a Final zone during the exit time is reported on the keypad as an open zone; the Entry/Exit Horns
bleep rapidly to indicate that the zone is open.
NOTE: The termination feature of a Final zone can be extended to terminate the setting of multiple groups
by pressing the key when assigning a group to the zone. Refer to the Star Group Function.
02 Exit
Zones that protect the entry and exit routes are programmed as Exit. During the setting and unsetting procedures Exit zones have a non-alarm operation. If the Exit zone is activated while the system is set - without the
unsetting of the group being initiated - an Intruder alarm condition is activated.
Opening an Exit zone during the exit time is reported on the keypad as an open zone; the Entry/Exit Horns
bleep rapidly to indicate that the zone is open.
NOTE: The Exit zone can be assigned to multiple groups by pressing the key when assigning a group to
the zone. This allows an Exit zone to be activated in a group which is not currently being unset
without activating an Intruder alarm. Refer to the Star Group Function.
03 Intruder
The Intruder function is inactive when the system is unset. When the system is set, activation of an Intruder
zone causes a full alarm activation that requires to be reset with a code authorized for System Reset - refer
to option 51.6 = PARAMETERS.System Reset and option
51.55.3 = PARAMETERS.Confirm.Reduce Reset.
All zones are programmed as Intruder by default; this includes the zones on RIOs that are added to the
system at a later date.
04 24 Hours
The 24 Hours zone function is continuously operational. In the unset state, activation of the zone function
generates a local alarm condition (the Intruder outputs are not activated). If the zone is activated while the
system is set, the 24 Hours function operates the same as an Intruder function and results in a full alarm
condition. The 24 Hours zone function requires a system reset following an activation in both the set and unset
conditions.
05 Security
The operation of the Security zone function is identical to the 24 Hours zone function, except a Security
zone activation in the unset generates a local alarm (Horn outputs activated) that does not require a system
reset; any valid code (type 2 or above) cancels the alarm and resets the system. An activation in the set state
generates a full alarm that requires a system reset. The activation (+) and restoration (–) of Security zones is
recorded in the event log.
6-77
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
52 - Program Zones (cont’d)
06 Dual (Double Knock)
The operation of the Dual (Double Knock) function is identical to the Intruder function, with the exception
that an alarm condition is activated only when there have been two activations from any Dual zones (assigned
to the same group) within a 20 minute period while the system is set.
07 Entry
This function initiates the unsetting procedure in the same way as a Final zone. However, during the setting
routine an Entry zone operates as an Exit zone type. This function is normally used in conjunction with a
Push Set zone, which acts as the exit terminator for the setting procedure.
Pressing the
key when programming an Entry zone doubles the entry time of the group.
Opening an Entry zone during the exit time is reported on the keypad as an open zone; the Entry/Exit
Horns bleep rapidly to indicate that the zone is open.
08 Push Set
This zone function is used to terminate the setting routine. The system sets when the Push Set zone, usually a
push button, is activated. The Entry/Exit Horn stops immediately the button is pressed; the system sets after
four seconds, allowing the doors to settle to the closed state. The Push Set zone remains inactive until the
next setting routine.
NOTE: The Push Set zone can be either 1kΩ going to 2kΩ or 2kΩ to 1kΩ - refer to Installation Manual
(II1-0033), System Architecture for wiring details. The first time that the Push Set is used to
terminate the setting, the button will require to be pressed twice; the first press identifies the normal
status of the button to the system.
Activating a Push Set zone during the exit time is not reported on the keypad as an open zone; the Entry/
Exit Horns bleep rapidly to indicate that the zone is open.
NOTE: The termination feature of a Final zone can be extended to terminate the setting of multiple groups
by pressing the key when assigning a group to the zone. Refer to the Star Group Function.
09 Keyswitch
The Keyswitch function allows a zone to be used as an on/off switch for the system or assigned groups.
Operating a Keyswitch zone when the system is unset starts the timed full setting routine, therefore the exit
time is applicable. The system sets when the exit time expires or a Final or Push Set is activated.
NOTE: Assigning a # to the keyswitch zone function will cause the Instant setting routine to be activated. In
this case the exit time is not applicable. If a Keyswitch Zone has its omit attribute enabled, activation
of the Keyswitch will force set the assigned groups. Only zones with the omit attribute enabled will
be omitted.
When the keyswitch is activated twice during the exit time of an autoset, the autoset is temporarily cancelled
for a few seconds, then it restarts the exit time causing the panel to reset.
Operating a keyswitch zone type during the pre-warn period of an autoset will start a Force Set. If you then
activate the switch again (i.e. unset with keyswitch) before the panel sets, the pre-warn continues on the
autoset.
NOTE: When the keyswitch is activated the second time to take panel back into pre-warn, it can be up to
10 seconds before the pre-warn tones at the keypad start up again.
6-78
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
52 - Program Zones (cont’d)
If the system is set, operating a Keyswitch immediately unsets the assigned groups; there is no entry time
countdown.
The Part attribute of the Keyswitch function defaults to 0 (disabled); the standard Keyswitch function full
sets the system. To part set the system using the Keyswitch, the Part attribute must be enabled.
NOTE: The operation of a Keyswitch zone can be extended to the setting and unsetting of multiple groups
by pressing the key when assigning a group to the zone. Refer to the Star Group Function.
The standard programming of the Keyswitch function requires a momentary change from 1kΩ to 2kΩ to
both set and unset the system. If the Keyswitch connected has a latching mechanism, press the key when
assigning the function; the display indicates 09= KEYSWITCH has been assigned. The
Keyswitch operation is as follows: 1kΩ to 2kΩ sets the system; 2kΩ to 1kΩ unsets the system.
The Keyswitch function can also be programmed to reset alarms - refer to option 51.14 =
PARAMETERS.Keyswitch Level. If the Keyswitch is assigned a sufficient type to reset the alarm condition, the alarm is cancelled and immediately reset when the Keyswitch is used to unset the system following
an alarm activation.
NOTE: The activated zones are not displayed on the keypad when a Keyswitch is used to reset the alarm.
10 Secure Final
This zone has dual functionality depending on whether the system is set or unset. When the system is setting,
set or unsetting the operation is identical to the Final zone function. When the system is unset the operation is
identical to the Security zone function.
Pressing the
key when programming a Secure Final zone doubles the entry time of the group.
Opening a Secure Final zone during the exit time is reported on the keypad as an open zone; the Entry/Exit
Horns bleep rapidly to indicate that the zone is open.
The termination feature of a Secure Final zone can be extended to terminate the setting of multiple groups by
pressing the key when assigning a group to the zone. Refer to the Star Group Function.
11 Part Final
This zone has dual functionality depending on whether the system is full set or part set. When the system is full
set the zone operation is identical to the Final zone function. When the system is part set the zone operation is
identical to the Intruder zone function.
Pressing the
key when programming a Part Final zone doubles the entry time of the group.
Opening a Part Final zone during the exit time is reported on the keypad as an open zone; the Entry/Exit
Horns bleep rapidly to indicate that the zone is open.
12 Part Entry
This zone has dual functionality depending on whether the system is full set or part set. When the system is full
set the zone operation is identical to the Exit zone function. When the system is part set the zone operation is
identical to the Entry zone function.
Pressing the
key when programming a Part Entry zone doubles the entry time of the group.
6-79
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
52 - Program Zones (cont’d)
13 PA
The PA (Personal Attack) function is continuously operational. Activation of this zone type overrides the Bell
Delay parameter and causes an instant full alarm condition that requires to be reset with a code authorized for
PA Reset — refer to Option 51 – PARAMETERS, 22 = PA Reset; the Intruder outputs are not activated by PA zones.
NOTE: If a PA zone is open, it is indicated on the keypad whenever a valid code is entered. The group that
the open PA is assigned to cannot be set until it is closed.
14 PA Silent
The PA Silent function is identical to the PA function, with the exception that there is no audible or visual
indication of the activation; that is, no bells or strobes are activated. Only the PA output (normally channel 2
on the digital communicator) signals the alarm. The activation (+) and restoral (–) of PA Silent zones is
recorded in the event log.
NOTES
1. At the time of setting, any PA Silent zones that are currently open are reported to the user.
2. The tamper facility on the PA zone remains active while engineer mode is accessed.
3. Engineer mode cannot be exited if a PA Silent zone is open.
15 PA Delay
The PA Delay function is identical to the PA function, with the exception that the PA output activation can be
delayed for up to 60 seconds; this is determined by option 51.13 = PARAMETER.PA Delay. During the
period of delay the Entry/Exit Horns activate to remind the user that the PA delay is counting down; entering
a valid code or closing the PA Delay zone aborts the alarm.
NOTES
1. If a PA Delay zone is open, it is indicated on the keypad whenever a valid code is entered. The group
that the open PA Delay is assigned to cannot be set until it is closed.
2. The tamper facility on the PA zone remains active while engineer mode is accessed.
16 PA Delay Silent
The PA Delay Silent function is identical to the PA Delay function, with the exception that there is no audible
or visual indication of the activation; that is, no bells or strobes are activated. Only the PA output (normally
channel 2 on the digital communicator) signals the alarm. The activation (+) and restoral (–) of PA Delay
Silent zones are recorded in the event log.
NOTES
1. At the time of setting, any PA Delay Silent zones that are currently open are reported to the user.
2. The tamper facility on the PA zone remains active while engineer mode is accessed.
6-80
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
52 - Program Zones (cont’d)
17 Link
This zone type has no operational function; it is designed to be used as a source of a link - refer to option 54 =
LINKS. The activation (+) and de-activation (–) of Link zones is recorded in the event log.
18 Spare
The Spare function allows any zones that are not being used to be ignored by the system; the resistance
readings from the circuit - including the tamper conditions - do not activate an alarm condition.
NOTE: It is recommended that all unused zones are programmed as Spare and that a 1kΩ 1% resistor is
connected across each of these zones.
19 Fire
The Fire function is continuously operational. When activated, a FIRE zone overrides the Bell Delay parameter and activates an instant alarm (Bell, Strobe and Fire). The keypad buzzer and control panel horn
output, if fitted, emit an interrupted tone (one second on, 0.5 seconds OFF), easily distinguishable from all
other alarm conditions. Any valid code entry cancels the Fire activation.
20 Tamper
The Tamper function is continuously operational. When a Tamper zone is activated (1kΩ to 2kΩ), a tamper
alarm is generated; this requires to be reset by a code authorized for Tamper Reset - refer to option 51.7 =
PARAMETERS.Tamper Reset. If a tamper condition (open or short circuit) occurs, a tamper alarm is also
generated.
21 Bell Tamper
This function is identical to the operation of the Tamper function but is dedicated to bells, sirens and other
modules or output devices requiring tamper protection.
22 Beam Pair
This function is only operational when two consecutively addressed zones programmed as Beam Pair are
open in the set condition; the activation is identical to the Intruder function. The system cannot set if a single
Beam Pair is open.
NOTE: Beam Pair zones must be consecutively addressed; the first Beam Pair zone must have an even
number address, the second Beam Pair must have the next address (an odd number). For example,
valid Beam Pair addresses are 1036 & 1037, 2018 & 2031 - in this case, RIO 202 has not been
connected, therefore zone 2031 is the next address to 2018.
23 Battery Low
This function is used to monitor the voltage output of a standby battery connected to a power supply. The
activation (+) and de-activation (–) of Battery Low zones is recorded in the event log.
6-81
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
52 - Program Zones (cont’d)
24 Line Fail
The Line Fail function is used to monitor the communication line that a remote signalling device is connected
to for communications failure.
When the system is in the unset state, the first activation of a Line Fail zone causes a local alarm and the
message COMMS FAILURE is displayed, subsequent Line Fail activations do not sound the local alarm;
the only indication is the keypad display.
When the system is set, activation of the Line Fail zone overrides the Bell Delay parameter; on unsetting the
system a local alarm is generated and the keypad gives an indication that Line Fail zone has activated. If an
alarm condition occurs while the Line Fail is active, an instant full alarm is generated.
If the Line Fail zone is active at the point of setting, a warning message is displayed; the user can choose to
continue or abort the setting procedure. It is also possible to prevent the system setting if the Line Fail is
active by enabling the Stop Set parameter (option 51.18).
25 AC Fail
This function is used to monitor a remote power supply. In the event of a power failure the AC Fail zone is
activated; the activation (+) and de-activation (–) of the zone is recorded in the event log.
26 Log
This zone type has no operational function; it is designed to record the activation of a zone in both the set and
unset state. The activation (+) and de-activation (–) of Log zones is recorded in the event log.
27 Remote Access
This function is used to disable remote servicing of the Galaxy panel. When the Remote Access zone is
active the Remote Servicing software is prevented from gaining access to the Galaxy panel.
28 Video
This function is identical to the Intruder function, with the exception that the cumulative number of activations
from Video zones, before a full alarm is generated, is programmable. The number of activations required is
determined by the Video parameter (option 51.30); the range is 1–9. The activation count is incremented
when any Video zone in the group activates; the count is reset to zero when the group is unset.
29 Video Exit
The Video Exit function is identical to the Video function, with the exception that the user can activate the
zone during setting and unsetting without incrementing the Video activations count. The Video output is not
activated during setting and unsetting.
6-82
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
52 - Program Zones (cont’d)
30 Intruder Delay
The Intruder Delay function is identical to the Intruder function, with the exception that the full alarm activation can be delayed for up to 50 minutes (0–3000 seconds); this is determined by the Delay Alarm parameter (option 51.31). The Intruder Delay zone must remain open for the period of the Delay Alarm parameter; while the zone is open the Entry/Exit Horns activate to remind the user that the Delay Alarm is counting down. Unsetting the system or closing the Intruder Delay zone aborts the alarm and resets the timer.
If a second Intruder Delay zone opens followed by the first zone closing, the Delay Alarm time continues to
count from the activation of the first zone. The Delay Alarm timer is reset only when all delay type zones
return to the closed state.
31 Log Delay
The Log Delay function operation is identical to the Log function, with the exception that the recording of the
zone activation can be delayed for up to 50 minutes (0–3000 seconds); this is determined by the Delay
Alarm parameter (option 51.31). Closing the Log Delay zone resets the timer and aborts the recording of
the event in the log.
32 Set Log
The Set Log function is identical to the Log function, with the exception that zone activations are only recorded in the event log during the set period.
33 Custom A
The Custom A function allows a zone to be assembled. The functionality of the zone; when it activates; the
outputs activated; if it sets or unsets the systems; if it logs, are assigned using menu option 64 = ASSEMBLE
ZONE. Once the Custom A zone has been created, it can be assigned to as many zones as required.
34 Custom B
This function is identical in operation and assembly to Custom A.
6-83
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
52 - Program Zones (cont’d)
35 = Exit Guard
The Exitguard function allows a zone to be used to omit other zones on the system. This is useful for permitting access via doors programmed as 24 Hours or Security.
The Exitguard zone must be the source of a link (refer to option 54 = LINKS); the destination of the
Exitguard link is either a zone address or an output type.
When opened, the Exitguard omits the zone entered as the link destination; an alarm is not activated if the
Exitguard zone is open while a zone that it is omitting is open. If the destination zone is opened while the
Exitguard zone is closed, an alarm activation occurs; opening the Exitguard omits the zone and silences the
output types assigned to the link destination. Closing the Exitguard zone while the destination zone is still
open does not result in an alarm activation; closing the destination zone deactivates the link and returns the
zone to its normal operation.
NOTE: The Exitguard function cannot be used as a link source to activate a link destination output.
Programming Example:
•
Zone 1014 = An on/off keyswitch programmed as Exitguard.
•
Zone 1015 = A door contact programmed as Security.
•
Output type Link A = An output wired to a local horn and programmed as Link
A.
NOTE: Exit Guard zones do not omit zones open when the exit guard zone is activated , even if they are
subsequently closed.
Operation: The Security door contact (1015) can be omitted at any time by operating the Exitguard
keyswitch (1014). If the door (1015) is opened without first being omitted, then the Link A horn activates and
needs to be reset by operating the keyswitch (1014).
Link
Source
Destination
1
Zone = 1014
Zone = 1015
2
Zone = 1015
Output = Link A
3
Zone = 1014
Output = Link A
Table 6-17. Exit Guard Zones
36 Mask
The Mask function is designed to be used with detectors capable of reporting that their field of view has been
blocked or masked. The Mask function is identical to the Security function, with the exception that the
Mask output is activated instead of Security.
NOTE: This zone type is independent from the mask zone state which can be detected for zones supporting
the masked feature.
37 Urgent
The Urgent function is continuously operational; it is identical to the Intruder function, with the exception that
it activates a full alarm condition (including the Intruder outputs) in any set or unset condition.
6-84
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
52 - Program Zones (cont’d)
38 PA Unset
This PA Unset function is identical to the PA Silent function, with the exception that it is only operational
when the system is unset; the function is inactive when the group is set.
39 Keyswitch Reset
The Keyswitch Reset function allows alarms to be cancelled and the system to rearm without unsetting the
Galaxy. The type of reset authorization is determined by the Keyswitch Level (option 51.14). The type
required to reset Intruder, PA and Tamper alarms is determined by the System Reset, Tamper Reset
and PA Reset parameters (option 51.06, 51.07 and 51.22) respectively.
This function is designed to permit a remote signal, for example REDCare’s Return Path Signalling feature, to
reset the system following an alarm condition.
40 Bell Fail
This zone type is intended for bells which have diagnostic capabilities and failure outputs. If activated, this zone
causes a fault condition.
41 Intr Low
This zone type assigns a low priority to a zone in the event of an intruder alarm. The event is logged as low
priority in the event log.
42 Intr High
This zone type assigns a high priority to a zone in the event of an intruder alarm. The event is logged as high
priority in the event log.
43 PSU Fault
This zone type triggers a general fault output and logs a PSU fault in the event log. The fault is signalled to the
ARC as YP when using SIA format and 314 when using CID format.
44-46
Not used
47 Vibration
The Vibration function is continuously operational and is designed for use with vault sensors. Vibration
zones can be block omitted using menu option 11 = Omit Zones. If the zone selected to be omitted from the
system is a Vibration zone, then all zones programmed with this function are omitted.
NOTES
1. All Vibration zones in all groups are omitted when any Vibration zone is omitted. The user code does
not have to have access to all of the groups.
2. Vibration zones remain omitted until a single Vibration zone is manually reinstated. The unsetting of the
system does not reinstate omitted Vibration zones.
6-85
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
52 - Program Zones (cont’d)
48-51 ATM-1, ATM-2, ATM-3 & ATM-4
There are four ATM (Automatic Teller Machine) zone types. These zone functions are continuously operational and are designed for the special maintenance and restocking requirements of ATM’s.
A single ATM zone type can be omitted for the duration of the period entered in the ATM Timeout parameter (option 51.39). The ATM Delay parameter (option 51.38) determines the delay before the selected
ATM zones are omitted once selected by an ATM code. Each of the zones ATM-1 to ATM-4 zones activates a corresponding ATM output.
NOTE: The relevant ATM outputs are activated as soon as the ATM Delay expires.
On entering an ATM code, the system prompts for one of the ATM zone types to be selected; to select the
ATM zone type to be omitted use the A or B key or enter the number of the ATM zone type. Once the zone
is selected, the keypad indicates the DELAY ACCESS - the number of minutes remaining until the ATM
zones are omitted. Once the zone is omitted, the initiating keypad indicates the ACCESS TIMEOUT - the
number of minutes remaining until the selected ATM zones are reintroduced to the system. The Entry/Exit
Horns sound a warning ten and five minutes before the zones are reinstated.
The omitted ATM zone type can be reinstated at any time, or the omit period can be extended by the ATM
user code. Enter the ATM code and press the ent key; the system prompts for 1 = RESET ACCESS or 2 =
ABORT ACCESS. Press 1 to restart the ATM Timeout or 2 to reinstate the omitted ATM’s.
NOTE: Only one ATM zone type may be omitted at any time.
52 Alarm Extend
The Alarm Extend function is identical to the Urgent function, with the exception that if the zone is open (and
has not been previously omitted) at the end of the bell duration (refer to option 51.1 = PARAMETERS.Bell
Time) it immediately activates another full alarm condition. Alarm Extend zones can only be omitted by
option 11 = OMIT ZONES.
6-86
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
53 - Program Outputs
Option 53 – Program Outputs
This option is used by the engineer to modify the programming of the outputs on the system. The option also
allows the attributes of the outputs to be changed. The programmable options are:
Attributes
Description
1
Output Function
Assign output type
2
Output Mode
1 = Latch - requires valid code to reset
2 = Reflex - follows activation status of zones
3 = Pulse (001 - 3000 secs) - activates for programmed period
3
Output Polarity
0 = POS - 12V going to 0V in activation
1 = NEG - 0V going to 12V in activation
4
Diag. Recording
Assigns output to be active during Diagnostic Test
5
Descriptor
Assigs a descriptor of up to 12 characters for each output
6
Lighting
1 = Control (0=OFF, 1=Toggle, 2=Trigger)
2 = Show Status (0=OFF, 1=ON)
7
Output Groups
Assign groups to the output
Note: Groups only appear if the Group option is enabled
(refer to option 63.1 = OPTIONS. Groups).
Table 6-18. Output Attributes
Selecting Outputs
RIO Outputs
On entering the option, the first output on the system is displayed; the output address, function and mode are
displayed on the top line, the polarity and assigned groups are displayed on the bottom line.
From the display of the first output, any output on the system can be displayed by pressing the A or B keys or
by entering the address of a specific output.
The output is selected for programming by pressing the ent key; the first output programming attribute 1=Op
Function is displayed.
Trigger Header Outputs
There are six trigger outputs, that can be used as communication triggers, but can also be used for any other
purpose. The output address and default function of these outputs are as follows:
0001 - Fire
0002 - Panic
0003 - Intruder
0004 - Set
0005 - Zone Omit
0006 - Confirm
6-87
53 - Program Outputs (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Keypad Outputs
The keypad outputs are fully programmable. The address of the keypad output is the keypad address prefixed with a star, for example the output for keypad 06 is 06. The function of keypad outputs default to
Entry/Exit Horn.
The valid addresses of the keypads on each of the panels and the respective output addresses are indicated in
the following table:
Panel
Line
Address
Output Addresses
GD-48
1
0 – 2, B, C, D, E & F (NOTE)
10-12, 15-19
GD-96
1
0 – 2, B, C, D, E & F (NOTE)
10-12, 15-19
GD-264
1
0 – 2, B, C, D, E & F (NOTE)
10-12, 15-19
2
0–6&F
20-26, 29
1
0 – 2, B, C, D, E & F (NOTE)
10-12, 15-19
2
0–6&F
20-26, 29
3
0–6&F
30-36, 39
4
0–6&F
40-46, 49
GD-520
Table 6-29. Addresses of Valid Keypad Outputs
It is possible to add additional keypads at any unused comms module addresses (B, C, D and E) as detailed
in the following NOTE. These must be standard keypads. An engineer keypad can also be used at address F.
NOTE: On Line 1, keypad addresses B, C, D and E are not available if the Ethernet,
ISDN, RS232 or Telecom modules respectively are fitted.
Control Horn ( 99)
The control unit horn output - addressed as 99 - is fully programmable.
Attributes
The attributes can be stepped through by pressing the A or B keys or directly selected by pressing the attribute number (1–4). Once the required attribute is on display, press the ent key to gain access for modification.
Once the attribute has been assigned press the ent key to save the programming and return to the attribute
selection level. Pressing the esc key at any time when assigning attributes aborts the programming and returns
to the attribute selection level.
1 = Output Function
Entering the Output Function attribute displays the address and the current function of the selected output
along with the output function reference number. The output functions can be stepped through, forwards or
backwards, using the A and B keys. Alternatively, a function can be directly selected by entering the function
reference number, for example, entering 16 displays output function 16 = FIRE.
Once the required output function is displayed, it is assigned to the output by pressing the ent key.
6-88
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
53 - Program Outputs (cont’d)
2 = Output Mode
Each output function defaults to a specific, logical output mode. However, the output mode of each function
can be modified to meet special requirements: when reprogrammed, the new mode applies to all outputs
assigned to that function. The output modes are:
1 = Latch: the output remains active until a valid code is entered.
2 = Reflex: the output follows the activity of the triggering event, for example, the Set output follows the
setting and unsetting of the group.
3 = Pulse: the output remains active for the programmed pulse time 1-3000 seconds (50 mins).
Programming the Output Mode
Select the required mode using the A or B keys or by selecting the number 1 – 3. Once the required mode is
on selected, press the ent key to accept the programming. If assigning the Pulse output mode, enter the pulse
time (001 – 3000 seconds) and press the ent key.
3 = Output Polarity
The Output Polarity determines the normal operational state of the output. All outputs are referred to having
positive (0 = POS) or negative (1 = NEG) polarity. An output programmed as positive polarity is 12 V in the
normal condition and goes to 0 V when activated. A negative polarity output goes from the normal condition
of 0 V to 12 V in the active state. All outputs except SET (09) default to positive output mode.
NOTE: The Switch DC output is a positive polarity output, however, the normal condition is 0 V, going to
12 V when activated. The output mode is normally Pulse.
4 = Diag Recording
When this attribute is enabled, the selected output will be switched on during the diagnostic test (see Option
61.2.3=Diagnostics.Historical.Record).
This test can also be carried out remotely.
5 = Descriptor
This attribute assigns a descriptor of up to 12 characters for each output.
6 = Lighting
This attribute allows the state of certain panel outputs to be controlled by the user from the Touch Center.
There are two options:
1 = Control
Each lighting output can be controlled by setting to 0=OFF, 1=Toggle or 2=Trigger.
If the Control is set to Toggle or Trigger for an output, it will be controllable via the Touch Center whose
group map contains the output’s group. If the Control is set to OFF it cannot be controlled or viewed by the
Touch Center.
2 = Show Status
The status can be either 0=OFF or 1=ON. When set to ON the light shows the state of the output.
6-89
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
53 - Program Outputs (cont’d)
7 = Output Groups
NOTE: The Groups attribute is only available if groups have been enabled on the system (refer to option 63
= OPTIONS).
The Group attribute allows the output to be assigned to the groups on the system; an output can be assigned
to more than one group. All outputs default to all groups on the system.
On selecting the Output Groups attribute, the groups that the output is currently assigned to are displayed.
Press the relevant number keys to toggle the status of the group and press the ent key; if the group number is
displayed on the top line, then the group is assigned to the output; if a dash (–) appears in place of the group
number, the group has been removed from the output.
The output will activate if triggered by an event in any of the groups assigned to that output, unless output
group status has been programmed.
Multi-group Systems
The larger Galaxy panels have 32 groups; these are displayed on the keypad in block of eight groups, subdivided into A, B, C and D:
Group Block
Physical Groups
A1-8
1-8
B1-8
9-16
C1-8
17-24
D1-8
25-32
Table 6-20. Output Groups
Use the A or B key to select the required group (A1–D8). When the end of a block is reached, the next
block of eight groups is selected; press keys 1–8 to toggle the status of the relevant group in the current block
to the output; press the ent key to accept the selection.
Group Status
This group attribute offers an additional feature that makes the operation of the output conditional on the set
status of each of the system groups. An output assigned Group Status only activates if the set conditions of
the programming are met, for example, an Intruder output used to trigger a communicator can be programmed to activate only if groups 2 and 4 are set and group 3 is unset.
Groups
STATUS
12345678
>-SUS----
To assign the Group Status conditions, press the key when selecting the groups: an arrow (>) is displayed
on the bottom line as well as the current Status. Press the relevant number keys to toggle the status of the
groups and press the ent key to accept the programming. The available group status conditions are:
S
=
Set — group must be set to allow output to activate;
U
=
Unset — group must be unset to allow output to activate;
–
=
Set or unset — output activation is independent of the group status.
6-90
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
53 - Program Outputs (cont’d)
Output Functions
The following table shows all the outputs and the zone functions and conditions that result in their activation.
Output Functions
Bells
Strobe
PA
Intruder
Tamper
24
Hrs
Reset
Switch
DC
Set
Engineer
Spare
Ready
Security
AC
Fail
Zone Function
14
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
01
Final
S
S
–
S
T
–
X
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
02
Exit
S
S
–
S
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
03
Intruder
S
S
–
S
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
04
24 Hours
S
S
–
S
T
A
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
05
Security
S
S
–
S
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
A
–
06
Dual
S
S
–
S
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
07
Entry
S
S
–
S
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
08
Push Set
–
–
–
–
T
–
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
09
Keyswitch
–
–
–
–
T
–
X
X
S
–
–
–
–
10
Secure Final
S
S
–
S
T
–
X
–
–
–
–
A
U
–
11
Part Final
S
S
–
S
T
–
X
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
12
Part Entry
S
S
–
S
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
13
PA
A
A
A
–
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
14
PA Silent
–
–
A
–
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
15
PA Delay
A
A
A
–
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
16
PA Delay Silent
–
–
A
–
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
17
Link
?
?
?
?
?T
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
18
Spare
–
–
–
–
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
19
Fire
A
A
–
–
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
20
Tamper
S
S
–
S
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
21
Bell Tamper
A
S
–
S
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
22
Beam Pair
S
S
–
S
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
23
Battery Low
–
–
–
–
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
24
Line Fail
–
–
–
–
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
25
AC Fail
–
–
–
–
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
26
Log
–
–
–
–
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
27
Remote Access
–
–
–
–
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
28
Video
S
S
–
S
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
29
Video Exit
S
S
–
S
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
30
Intruder Delay
S
S
–
S
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
31
Log Delay
–
–
–
–
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
32
Set Log
–
–
–
–
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
33
Custom-A
?
?
?
?
?T
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
34
Custom-B
?
?
?
?
?T
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
35
Exitguard
L
L
L
L
LT
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
36
Mask
S
S
–
S
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
37
Urgent
A
A
–
A
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
38
PA Unset
–
–
U
–
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
U
–
–
39
Keyswitch Reset
–
–
–
–
T
–
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
40
Bell fail
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
41
Intr Low
S
S
–
S
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
42
Intr High
S
S
–
S
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
43
PSU Fault
–
–
–
–
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
44–46
Not Used
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
47
Vibration
A
A
–
A
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
48
ATM-1
A
A
–
A
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
49
ATM-2
A
A
–
A
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
50
ATM-3
A
A
–
A
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
51
ATM-4
A
A
–
A
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
52
Alarm Extend
A
A
–
A
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
Key:
S = Activates when system is set
P = Activates when system is Part Set
U = Unset
A = Activated in any condition
- = No effect
O= Activates when zone is omitted
? = Activation dependant on system programming
X = Activates during Exit Time
E = Activates during Entry Time
L = Switches output off if linked to destination output
T = Activates if zone resistance is less than value for tamper s/c
or greater than value for tamper o/c
Table 6-21A. Output Activations per Zone
6-91
–
53 - Program Outputs (cont’d)
Output Functions
Batt
Low
Fire
Horn
Zone Function
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
E/E Horn
Part
Set
Confirm
Line
Fail
Video
Comm
Fail
Batt
Test
Wrong Alert
CD
DLYD
Fire
No
Timer-A
Re-arm
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
01
Final
–
–
S
SXE
–
-
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
29
–
02
Exit
–
–
S
SXE
–
S
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
03
Intruder
–
–
S
SXE
–
S
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
04
24 Hours
–
–
S
A
–
–
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
05
Security
–
–
S
A
–
–
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
06
Dual
–
–
S
SXE
–
S
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
07
Entry
–
–
S
SXE
–
-
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
08
Push Set
–
–
–
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
09
Keyswitch
–
–
–
–
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
10
Secure Final
–
–
A
A
X
S
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
11
Part Final
–
–
A
SXE
X
S
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
12
Part Entry
–
–
A
XE
–
S
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
13
PA
–
–
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
14
PA Silent
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
PA Delay
–
–
A
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
16
PA Delay Silent
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
17
Link
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
18
Spare
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
19
Fire
–
A
A
A
–
–
–
V
–
–
–
–
A
A
–
20
Tamper
–
–
A
A
–
–
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
–
21
Bell Tamper
–
–
A
A
–
–
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
22
Beam Pair
–
–
S
SXE
–
–
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
23
Battery Low
U
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
24
Line Fail
–
–
–
U
–
–
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
25
AC Fail
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
26
Log
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
27
Remote Access
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
28
Video
–
–
S
SXE
–
S
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
29
Video Exit
–
–
S
SXE
–
S
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
30
Intruder Delay
–
–
S
SXE
–
–
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
31
Log Delay
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
32
Set Log
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
33
Custom-A
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
34
Custom-B
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
35
Exitguard
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
36
Mask
–
–
S
SXE
–
–
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
37
Urgent
–
–
A
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
38
PA Unset
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
39
Keyswitch Reset
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
40
Bell fail
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
41
Intr Low
–
–
S
SXE
–
S
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
42
Intr High
–
–
S
SXE
–
S
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
43
PSU Fault
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
44–46
Not Used
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
47
Vibration
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
48
ATM-1
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
49
ATM-2
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
50
ATM-3
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
51
ATM-4
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
52
Alarm Extend
A
A
–
A
T
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
Key:
S = Activates when system is set
P = Activates when system is Part Set
U = Unset
A = Activated in any condition
- = No effect
O= Activates when zone is omitted
? = Activation dependant on system programming
X = Activates during Exit Time
E = Activates during Entry Time
L = Switches output off if linked to destination output
T = Activates if zone resistance is less than value for tamper s/c
or greater than value for tamper o/c
Table 6-21B. Output Activations per Zone
6-92
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
53 - Program Outputs (cont’d)
Output Functions
Timer-B
Walk
Test
Zone
Omit
Warning
Custom
A
Custom
B
Test
Zone Function
Reset
RQD
Mask
Valid
cd
Fail
Set
Duress
Illegal
Code
Max
Tamp
Abort
Unset
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
01
Final
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
S?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
02
Exit
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
S?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
03
Intruder
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
S?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
04
24 Hours
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
S?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
05
Security
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
S?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
06
Dual
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
S?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
07
Entry
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
S?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
08
Push Set
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
09
Keyswitch
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
UX
–
–
–
–
U
10
Secure Final
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
11
Part Final
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
12
Part Entry
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
13
PA
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
14
PA Silent
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
PA Delay
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
16
PA Delay Silent
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
17
Link
?
U?
O?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
–
?
?
18
Spare
–
–
–
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
?
–
–
19
Fire
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
A?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
20
Tamper
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
A?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
21
Bell Tamper
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
A?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
22
Beam Pair
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
Battery Low
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
24
Line Fail
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
25
AC Fail
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
26
Log
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
27
Remote Access
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
28
Video
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
S?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
29
Video Exit
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
S?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
30
Intruder Delay
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
S?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
31
Log Delay
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
32
Set Log
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
33
Custom-A
?
?
O?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
–
?
?
34
Custom-B
?
?
O?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
35
Exitguard
L
L
LO
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
?
L
L
36
Mask
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
SPE
–
–
–
–
L
?
–
37
Urgent
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
A?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
38
PA Unset
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
U?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
39
Keyswitch Reset
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
40
Bell Fail
–
–
–
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
41
Intr Low
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
S?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
42
Intr High
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
S?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
43
PSU Fault
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
44–46
Not Used
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
47
Vibration
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
A?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
48
ATM-1
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
A?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
49
ATM-2
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
A?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
50
ATM-3
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
A?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
51
ATM-4
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
A?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
52
Alarm Extend
–
U
O
A
–
–
–
A?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
Key:
S = Activates when system is set
P = Activates when system is Part Set
U = Unset
A = Activated in any condition
- = No effect
O= Activates when zone is omitted
? = Activation dependant on system programming
X = Activates during Exit Time
E = Activates during Entry Time
L = Switches output off if linked to destination output
T = Activates if zone resistance is less than value for tamper s/c
or greater than value for tamper o/c
Table 6-21C. Output Activations per Zone
6-93
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
53 - Program Outputs (cont’d)
Output Functions
Set Late
U/S
Early
Pre- Warn
Autoset
DR
Masked
Link A-O
RF
Jam
RF
Super
Bell
Fail
Low
Volts
Lockout
Vib
Test
Atm 1-4
Fault
Zone Function
Bell Test Comms
Test
46
47
48
49
50
51-65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72-75
76
77
78
01
Final
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
02
Exit
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
03
Intruder
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
04
24 Hours
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
05
Security
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
06
Dual
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
07
Entry
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
08
Push Set
U?
S?
–
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
09
Keyswitch
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
10
Secure Final
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
11
Part Final
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
12
Part Entry
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
13
PA
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
14
PA Silent
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
PA Delay
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
16
PA Delay Silent
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
17
Link
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
–
?
?
?
–
–
–
18
Spare
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
19
Fire
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
20
Tamper
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
21
Bell Tamper
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
22
Beam Pair
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
Battery Low
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
24
Line Fail
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
25
AC Fail
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
26
Log
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
27
Remote Access
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
28
Video
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
29
Video Exit
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
30
Intruder Delay
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
31
Log Delay
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
32
Set Log
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
33
Custom-A
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
–
?
?
?
–
–
–
34
Custom-B
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
–
?
?
?
–
–
–
35
Exitguard
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
–
L
L
L
–
–
–
36
Mask
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
37
Urgent
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
38
PA Unset
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
39
Keyswitch Reset
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
40
Bell Fail
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
41
Intr Low
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
42
Intr High
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
43
PSU Fault
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
44–46
Not Used
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
47
Vibration
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
A
–
–
–
–
48
ATM-1
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
O
–
–
–
49
ATM-2
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
O
–
–
–
50
ATM-3
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
O
–
–
–
51
ATM-4
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
O
–
–
–
52
Alarm Extent
–
–
?
–
–
?
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
Key:
S = Activates when system is set
P = Activates when system is Part Set
U = Unset
A = Activated in any condition
- = No effect
O= Activates when zone is omitted
? = Activation dependant on system programming
X = Activates during Exit Time
E = Activates during Entry Time
L = Switches output off if linked to destination output
T = Activates if zone resistance is less than value for tamper s/c
or greater than value for tamper o/c
Table 6-21D. Output Activations per Zone
6-94
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Output Functions
Door
Prop
Door
Forced
Listen-in
Zone Function
79
80
81
01
Final
–
?
-
02
Exit
–
?
-
03
Intruder
–
?
?
04
24 Hours
–
?
-
05
Security
–
?
-
06
Dual
–
?
-
07
Entry
–
?
-
08
Push Set
S?
–
-
09
Keyswitch
–
?
-
10
Secure Final
–
?
-
11
Part Final
–
?
-
12
Part Entry
–
?
-
13
PA
–
?
?
14
PA Silent
–
?
?
15
PA Delay
–
?
?
16
PA Delay Silent
–
?
?
17
Link
?
?
-
18
Spare
–
?
-
19
Fire
–
?
?
20
Tamper
–
?
-
21
Bell Tamper
–
?
-
22
Beam Pair
–
?
-
23
Battery Low
–
?
-
24
Line Fail
–
?
-
25
AC Fail
–
?
-
26
Log
–
?
-
27
Remote Access
–
?
-
28
Video
–
?
-
29
Video Exit
–
?
-
30
Intruder Delay
–
?
?
-
31
Log Delay
–
?
32
Set Log
–
?
-
33
Custom-A
?
?
-
34
Custom-B
?
?
-
35
Exitguard
L
L
-
36
Mask
–
?
-
37
Urgent
–
?
-
38
PA Unset
–
?
?
39
Keyswitch Reset
–
?
-
40
Bell Fail
–
–
-
41
Intr Low
–
?
?
42
Intr High
–
?
?
43
PSU Fault
–
?
-
44–46
Not Used
–
?
-
47
Vibration
–
?
-
48
ATM-1
–
?
-
49
ATM-2
–
?
-
50
ATM-3
–
?
-
51
ATM-4
–
?
-
52
Alarm Extent
–
?
-
Key:
S = Activates when system is set
P = Activates when system is Part Set
U = Unset
A = Activated in any condition
- = No effect
O= Activates when zone is omitted
53 - Program Outputs (cont’d)
? = Activation dependant on system programming
X = Activates during Exit Time
E = Activates during Entry Time
L = Switches output off if linked to destination output
T = Activates if zone resistance is less than value for tamper s/c
or greater than value for tamper o/c
Table 6-21E. Output Activations per Zone
6-95
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
53 - Program Outputs (cont’d)
01 Bells (Latch)
The Bells output is activated on a full alarm event when the system is set. This output is subject to the Bell
Time, Bell Delay and No. Rearm parameters.
02 Strobe (Latch)
The Strobe output is activated on a full alarm event during the set state. This output is subject to the Bell
Delay. The Strobe output follows the Bell Time, but latches on after the last rearm.
03 PA (Latch)
The PA output is activated whenever any of the PA zone types activate. The output is not subject to the
Rearm parameter; it latches on remains active until a valid code, with the appropriate PA Reset level, is
entered.
04 Intruder (Latch)
The Intruder output is activated on a full alarm event during the set state. Dependent upon the programming
of parameter 51.56 Force Restore the intruder output restore is either subject to the Confirm Time Window
+ unset or entry of a valid code with the appropriate system reset level.. Refer to the 51.56 Force Restore
description for further details.
05 Tamper (Latch)
The Tamper output is activated whenever a circuit tamper or lid tamper occurs. The output is not subject to
the Rearm parameter: it latches on and remains active until a valid code, with the appropriate Tamper Reset
level, is entered.
The output is also activated on the first entry of the engineer code when accessing engineer mode.
NOTE: The Tamper output is not activated on the Galaxy 512 when engineer access is authorized by the
user.
06 24 Hours
The 24 Hours output is activated whenever a 24 Hour zone is activated. The output is not subject to the
Rearm parameter: it latches on and remains active until a valid code, with the appropriate System Reset
level, is entered.
07 Reset (Latch)
The Reset output type is used as a control line output to latch, freeze and reset movement detector LEDs.
08 Switch DC (Pulse)
This Switch DC output is used to power detectors that require a momentary power interruption to reset them,
for example, break glass or vibration detectors. This output reverses its polarity (changes from 0V to 12V) for
the period of the Pulse output mode when the setting procedure has been initiated.
NOTE: When installing detectors that require to be powered from a Switch DC output, connect the positive
lead of the detector to the 12V terminal of a power supply and the negative lead to Switch DC
output terminal. Do not change the Output Polarity to 1=Neg: it must remain as positive polarity.
6-96
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
53 - Program Outputs (cont’d)
09 Set (Reflex)
The Set output is activated when the assigned groups on the system are set. This output is a Reflex output
and follows the set and unset status of the groups.
10 Engineer (Reflex)
The Engineer output is activated while the engineer mode is being accessed.
11 Spare (Latch)
The Spare output has function: it is used to designate outputs that are not being used on the system.
12 Ready (Reflex)
The Ready output is active when all zones in the system (group) are closed. This output activates in both the
unset and set conditions.
13 Security (Latch)
The Security output is activated whenever a Security zone is activated. The output is not subject the Rearm
parameter: it latches on and remains active until a valid code (type 2 or above) is entered.
14 AC Fail (Reflex)
The AC Fail output indicates the status of the a.c. (mains) power supply. The output activates when the a.c.
supply fails or an AC Fail zone is activated. The output is reset when the a.c. supply is restored or the AC
Fail zone is closed. The activation is delayed subject to the time entered in the 20=Power Delay parameter.
15 Battery Low (Reflex)
The Battery Low output activates whenever the control unit stand-by battery falls below 10.5V or a Battery
Low zone is activated. The output is restored when the voltage rises above 10.5V or the Battery Low zone
is closed.
16 Fire (Latch)
The Fire output is activated whenever a Fire zone is activated. The output is not subject to the Rearm
parameter: it latches on and remains active until a valid code (type 2 or above) is entered.
17 Horn (Latch)
The Horn output is a general alarm output and is activated by most zone types in both the local and full alarm
modes. For example, a Fire zone activation causes the Horn output to pulse on and off – on for 0.5 seconds,
off for 0.1 seconds. The Horn output is subject to the Bell Time, Bell Delay and No. Rearm parameters.
6-97
53 - Program Outputs (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
18 E/E Horn (Latch)
The Entry/Exit Horn output has a dual function:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
in an alarm condition its function is identical to that of the Horn output;
during the unsetting and setting of the system it is used to provide an indication on the
status of the system. The indication states are as follows:
General Alarm
ON 500 msecs. OFF 500 msecs.
Clear to Exit
Continuous
Exit interrupted
ON 100 msecs. OFF 100 msecs.
75% Exit Time
ON 200 msecs. OFF 200 msecs.
Set
ON 600 msecs. OFF 600 msecs (twice)
Normal Entry
ON 800 msecs. OFF 200 msecs.
75% Entry Time
ON 200 msecs. OFF 200 msecs.
Fire
ON 500 msecs. OFF 100 msecs.
Chime
ON 500 msecs. OFF 400 msecs (twice)
19 Part Set (Reflex)
The Part Set output is activated when the assigned groups on the system are part set. This output is a Reflex
output and follows the part set and unset status of the groups.
20 Confirm (Latch)
The Confirm output is activated when there have been activations on two separate zones: the second activation must occur within the Confirm Time Window. The zones do not have to be in the same group, however,
both groups must be assigned to the Confirm output to allow activation. Cross-group confirmation is controlled by the Communications programming in menu 56.1, Int Telecoms or 56.5, Ext Telecoms. If signalling
is by DTMF format, cross-group confirmation will occur on groups that share the same confirm channel. In all
other signalling formats, cross-group confirmation will occur on groups that share the same account number.
NOTE: The Confirm output is used to give positive identification that a genuine intruder alarm condition has
occurred and to minimise the possibility of false alarm activations.
21 Line Fail (Reflex)
The Line Fail output is activated whenever a Line Fail zone is active or the telecom module detects and
sustains a line failure for more than 30 seconds.
22 Video (Pulse)
The Video output is activated by the Video zone when the system is set. This output can be used to activate
video recorder or video transmission systems.
23 Comm Fail (Latch)
The Comm Fail output is activated whenever there is a communication failure on the telecoms module telephone line. A fail to communicate event overrides the remaining Bell Delay period.
6-98
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
53 - Program Outputs (cont’d)
24 Batt Test
This output is activated when a battery load test is in progress. Refer to option
61.1.4 = Diagnostics.Latest.PSU Comms.
25 Wrong CD
This output is activated whenever a wrong code alarm occurs. That is, when six wrong codes in succession
are entered at the keypad. The output, by default pulses on for 90 seconds.
26 Alert (Latch)
The Alert output is activated when the control panel loses communication with one of the remote modules or
keypads.
27 Fire Delay (Latch)
The Fire Delay output is activated whenever a Fire zone is activated. The activation of the output is delayed
subject to the period determined by the 03=Abort Time parameter. The Fire Delay output is not subject to
the Rearm parameter: it latches on and remains active until a valid code (type 2 or above) is entered.
28 No Re-Arm (Latch)
The No Rearm output is activated on a full alarm event during the set state: it is subject to the Bell Delay
parameter. The No Rearm output is similar to the strobe output, but it stays on at the end of the bell time,
until unset.
29 Timer A (Reflex)
The Timer-A output is controlled by the Timer-A option (refer to option 65=Timers A/B) and activates in
accordance with the programmed on and off times assigned to the function.
30 Timer B (Reflex)
The Timer-B output is controlled by the Timer-B option (refer to option 65=Timers A/B) and activates in
accordance with the programmed on and off times assigned to the function.
NOTE: If the TIMER A or B outputs are programmed as LATCH mode, then they can only be reset by a
user code with access to all of the groups assigned to the relevant timer.
31 Walk Test (Reflex)
The Walk Test output is activated when a zone included in the walk test is tested (refer to option 31=Walk
Test).
32 Zone Omit (Reflex)
The Zone Omit ouput is activated as soon as a zone is omitted from the system by option 11=OMIT
ZONES or by option 54=LINKS. If the Output Mode attribute is assigned as:
•
•
Reflex (default) the output remains active until the zone is reinstated;
Latch the output is reset on entry of a valid code.
6-99
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
53 - Program Outputs (cont’d)
33 Warning (Latch)
The Warning output is activated by the first occurrence of a high (1200-1300Ω) and low (800-900Ω)
resistance reading on each of the system zones in a single 24 hour period: the activating zone is recorded in the
log.
NOTE: The time period finishes at midnight, not 24 hours from first activation.
Subsequent high and low resistance readings from the same zone on the same day do not activate the output if
it has been reset by a valid user code.
NOTE: If a low resistance reading is followed by a high resistance reading, the Warning output activates on
the first occurrence of both activations.
34 Custom A (Latch)
The Custom-A output is activated whenever a Custom-A zone is activated.
35 Custom B (Latch)
The Custom –B output is activated whenever a Custom-B zone is activated.
36 Test (Pulse)
The Test output is activated at 12:00 hours each day for two seconds – the period of the Pulse can be
altered. This output can be used to perform a daily test on a digicom connected to the system.
37 Reset RQD (Latch)
The Reset RQD output is activated when a system, tamper or PA alarm has occurred that requires to be
reset by the engineer (type 3.7) code. Refer to option 51=PARAMETERS for details modifying the code
types assigned to the 06=System Reset, 07=Tamper Reset and 22=PA Reset parameters.
38 Mask (Latch)
The Mask output is activated whenever the zone resistance values returned by the RIO to the panel fall within
the range of the masked state (see Parameter 51.46, Zone Resistance). The output is not subject to the
Rearm parameter: It latches on and remains active until a valid group code (type 2 or above) is entered.
39 Valid Code (Reflex)
The Valid Code output is activated by the entry of any valid code. If the Output Mode assigned is Reflex,
the output remains active while the user is accessing the menu and setting and unsetting the system. Once the
menu is exited or the system sets or unsets, the output is restored.
40 Fail Set (Latch)
The Fail Set is activated if the system (or assigned groups) fails to set within the time assigned in parameter
35=Fail to Set – refer to option 51=PARAMETERS.
41 Duress (Latch)
The Duress function is activated on entry of a Duress Code (any valid code followed by two #’s, or a code
assigned as a Duress Code using menu option 42 – Codes). The output is not subject to the Rearm parameter: it latches on and remains active until a valid code (type 2 or above) is entered.
6-100
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
53 - Program Outputs (cont’d)
42 Illegal Code (Latch)
The Illegal Code is activated 60 seconds after an entry of a single Dual Code or a code which is entered
outwith the Timer A and/or Timer B times assigned to it in menu option 42.1.4=CODES.User
Codes.Schedule.
43 Max Tamp (Latch)
The MAX TAMP output is activated when a MAX, MicroMAX or MAX3 tamper is activated.
44 Abort (Latch)
The ABORT output is activated when a valid code is entered during the Abort period on system entry.
45 Unset
The Unset output is activated each time the system (or group) is unset. The default output mode attribute is
programmed as pulse, for two seconds. This can be used to activate a buzzer to notify a user that the system
has been unset, when using an RF fob.
46 Set Late (Latch)
The Set Late output is activated if the system has not been set by the programmed Monitor time – refer to
option 65.3.1=TIMERS.Autoset.Status.
47 U/S Early (Latch)
The Unset Early output is activated if the system has been unset before the programmed Monitor time –
refer to option 65.3.1=TIMERS.Autoset.Status.
48 Prewarn (Reflex)
The Prewarn output is active during the programmed prewarning period of the autoset function. The mode is
Reflex. The Prewarn emits a constant tone if the autosetting of the system can be extended. If an extension
is not possible, the Prewarn output pulses.
49 Autoset (Reflex)
The Autoset output is activated when the system has been set by the autoset function – refer to option
65.3=TIMERS.Autoset. The default Output Mode attribute is programmed as Reflex, therefore the output
remains active until the system unsets.
NOTE: The Set is also activated when the system autosets.
50 DR. Masked
The DR. (detector) Masked output is activated when zones, programmed for zone activity checks, are not
activated in the unset state within the time period or set/unset cycles programmed in Parameter 51.61. The
zones are programmed for activity in menu 52.8.
51 – 65 Link A – O (Reflex)
Link output types have no inherent function: they are designed for use with option 54 = LINKS to provide the
engineer with a means of activating a specific output address.
6-101
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
53 - Program Outputs (cont’d)
Link outputs can be activated by any of the link option sources. The operation of the Link output is dependent on the Output Mode and Groups assigned to the output. The Groups assigned to the Link must have at
least one group common to the link output, if that output is to be activated. This feature can be used to multiply the number of different link outputs available on the system.
NOTE: When a zone function is the source of a Link output type, then a point to point link is available and
is as effective as direct wiring.
66 RF Jam (Latch)
The RF Jam output is activated whenever any of the RF RIO’s configured onto the system detect a significant
level of interference to cause radio jamming.
67 RF Super (Latch)
The RF Supervision output is activated whenever there is a supervision failure from any one of the supervised RF detectors configured onto the system. That is, when the system has received no signals (including
periodic check-in signals) whatsoever, from a particular detector within the programmed supervision period.
68 Bell Fail
The Bell Fail output activates whenever a zone causes a fault condition.
69 Low Volts
The Low Volts output activates when the voltage of the AUX outputs drops below 10V.
70 Lockout (Reflex)
The Lockout output is active between the ON and OFF times assigned to the Lockout Status (option
65.3.6=TIMERS.Autoset.Lockout Status). The Lockout output mode is Reflex, therefore it remains
active until the lockout switches OFF.
71 Vibration Test (Pulse)
The Vibration Test function is used to test zones programmed as Vibration. This output is used in conjunction with Precheck (menu option 66 – Pre-Check: - Mode: 4 – Forced Check). The Vibration Test output
sends a five second positive removed pulse to the vault sensors. Any sensor not activated by the test is reported by the pre-check function and prevents the system from setting.
72 – 75 ATM-1, ATM-2, ATM-3, ATM-4 (Reflex)
The relevant ATM output is activated when the respective ATM zone type is omitted. This output is a Reflex
output and follows the omit status of the ATM zone types.
76 Fault (Latch)
This output will activate any time there is a fault condition present on the panel and will clear when all the fault
conditions have cleared.
The following fault types will activate the fault output:
Line fail (any module), ARC comms fail (any module), RF jam, RF low battery, RF supervision failure, Bell fail
(from a bell fail zone), AC fail (panel, AC zone or power supply), Battery fail (panel, battery zone or power
supply), Mask.
SMS signalling faults will not activate the fault outputs.
6-102
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
53 - Program Outputs (cont’d)
77 Bell Test
This output activates when Bell Test is selected via menu 32. This causes the bell and strobe output to
activate. This output is normally used to activate a relay to cut power to the bell.
78 Comms Test (Pulse)
This output is used for remote routine inspection, via the downloader software. When a remote inspection is
carried out, this output will activate for 10 seconds in order to trigger the test input of an external comms
device.
79 Door Prop
This output activates when a door is held open for longer than the programmed time and an Open Timeout
occurs (Option 69).
80 Door Force
This output activates when a door is forced open without authorization and an alarm occurs.
81 Listen-in
This output activates after an alarm activation and an audio transmission is in progress.
6-103
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
54 - Links
Option 54 – Links
The Links option offers a powerful method of interconnecting zones, output functions, codes, keypads, and
MAX modules. The links table is constructed by creating a link between one of the source types and a valid
destination type. Activating the source of a link activates the destination – this can be used to switch outputs
on and off to omit zones, codes, keypads and MAX modules from the system.
The links function allows MAX destinations to be assigned a ( ) star function. If the destination is programmed as MAX and the ( ) star is allocated, the assigned MAX door relay will open for the duration the
link is active. During this period no MAX alarms are generated if the door contact timeout is exceeded. The
on-board horns are deactivated and the green open LED will be illuminated throughout.
When the link is deactivated the MAX horn sounds and the door relay remains open for the programmed
relay duration period. - simulates an egress button activation.
If a max is disabled as the destination of a link, a card swiped at the max will still cancel an alarm or unset the
system. However it will not activate the relay or do a max function.
The number of links that can be assigned on each of the Galaxy systems is:
•
•
•
•
Galaxy 48 =
Galaxy 96 =
Galaxy 264 =
Galaxy 520 =
64
128
256
256
Programming Links
On selecting the Links option, the details of Link 01 are displayed. If no link has been assigned the screen
displays 01 NOT USED.
The details of each link can be displayed using the A and B keys, or a specific link can be selected by entering
the required link number, for example 05, 29. When the required link is displayed, press, the ent key to begin
the programming procedure. The system prompts for the Link Source to be assigned. If groups are set then
some sources and destinations will not be available for programming:
1. Press the # key to select the required link source from the available types (refer to Table 23. Link
Source ).
2. Press the A or B keys to select the actual link source (for example, the zone address or the user code
number).
3. If the source is required to toggle the destination on and off, press the key. The source is prefixed by a
on the display.
NOTES:
1. The link destination is activated by the first operation of the source and then deactivated by the second
operation.
4. Press the ent key; the source of the link is assigned and the keypad prompts for the link destination to be
allocated.
5. Press the # key to select the required link destination from the available types (refer to Table 24. Link
Destination).
6. Press the A or B keys to select the actual link destination (for example, the zone address or the output
type). To cancel a link program the source as not used.
7. Press the ent key.
6-104
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
54 - Links (cont’d)
8. If the link destination is d). Output Type and Groups have been enabled (refer to option 63=OPTIONS) then each link must be allocated to at least one group (use the A or B key to move between the
group blocks; press keys 1 – 8 to assign the relevant groups in each block) and press the ent key.
NOTE: The groups determine which of the assigned output type destinations the link activates.
9. The details of the assigned link are displayed.
NOTE: If the link is currently active, the source is separated from the destination by a + (plus) symbol. If the
link is not active a – (negative) symbol is displayed.
10. Press the A or B key to move to the next link to be assigned and repeat steps 1 –9 or press the ent key
to escape from the LINKS menu option.
Source Type
a) Not Used
b) Zone Address
c) User Code
d) Output Address
e) MAX Address
f) Link Timer
* Modifier
Example
Display
-
Notes
This link is not operational
Off
*1014
When the zone is opened the link is active.
When the zone is closed the link is inactive.
On
*1014
When the zone opens first time, the link is activated. When the zone
opens a second time, the link is deactivated.
Off
*001
When the code is entered, the link is activated momentarily only. This
option is only practical to trigger a destination event, for example, an
output pulse.
On
**001
When the code is entered first time, the link is activated.
When the code is entered the second the link is deactivated.
Off
#1014
When the output is on, the link is active.
When the output is off, the link is inactive.
On
*#1014
When the output turns on first time, the link is activated.
When the output turns on second time, the link deactivates.
Off
01
On
*01
Off
LT01
On
*LT01
When the MAX is swiped with a card the link activates momentarily
only. This option is only practical to trigger a destination event, for
example, an output pulse.
When the MAX is swiped with a card, the link is activated.
When the MAX is swiped a second time, the link deactivates.
When the Link timer times out, the link activates momentarily only. This
option is only practical to trigger a destination event, for example, an
output pulse.
When the Link timer times out, the link is activated.
When the Link timer times out a second time, the link is deactivated.
Table 6-22. Link Source
6-105
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
54 - Links (cont’d)
Destination Type
* Modifier
Notes
a) Not used
-
The link is not operational.
b) Zone Address
-
When the link is active, the zone is omitted from
the system
c) User Code
-
When the link is active, the user's PIN and MAX
card are not operational.
d) Output Type
-
When the link is active, all outputs programmed
with the selected function are activated.
e) Output Address
-
When the link is active, the specific output
address is switched on. Please note that when
using the output address as the destination, the
deactivation of the link will switch the output off
immediately, overriding any pulse time or latch
mode of the output programming.
f) Keypad Address
-
When the link is active, the buttons on the keypad
will not operate.
g) MAX Address
h) Latch Timer**
i) Reflex Timer**
Off
When the link is active, the MAX reader will not
read cards.
On
When the link is active, the door lock relay for the
reader will constantly be in the unlocked state.
The door contact input will also be bypassed so
that no alarm will occur.
-
-
When the link is deactivated, the Link Timer
starts to count down from the Latch timer value.
Each subsequent activation of the link will restart
the timer count down to this value. When the
timer reaches zero the Link timer activates and it
can trigger another link. If the link is continuously
activated within the timer period, the counter will
never reach zero and the Link timer will be held
off. The application for this would be a link that
didn't activate so long as another event continues
to happen with the time period.
The Reflex timers operate identically to the Latch
timer except that the timer cannot be restarted
while it is running. A Reflex timer destination will
still start a Link Timer running in the same way as
a Latch timer destination.
An application for this would be a delayed action
link.
Table 6-23. Link destination
NOTE:
There are 16 Link timers in the system. These Link timers are triggered by the Latch and Reflex
timer destinations. Both the Latch and Reflex options operate the same set of Link timers. They just
start the timers in different ways. A Latch timer can restart the Link timer while it is running. A Reflex
timer cannot.
¹¹
6-106
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
55 - Soak
Option 55 – Soak
The Soak option allows selected zones to be put onto test for a period ranging from 1 – 14 days (refer to
option 51.16=PARAMETERS.Soak Time). Activations from a zone on the soak test do not cause alarms
but are recorded in the event log and are reported to type 2 (and above) users on unsetting of the system.
The zone remains on soak test until the selected number of days has passed without any alarm activation, the
zones then resume normal operation – that it, activations result in alarms being generated.
The Soak Time is reset to the full number of days if there is an alarm activation on any of the selected zones.
NOTE: The Soak Time starts when the first zone is put onto soak test; subsequent additions are only tested
for the period remaining in the Soak Time. Parameter 51.16, Soak Time must be programmed
before activating any zones in to the soak test. The period remaining decreases by one day each day
at 0900 hours.
Activation of an Exit or Video Exit zone during the Entry time does not reset the soak test and period.
Programming Soak Zones
On selecting the Soak option, the address and function of the first zone on the system is displayed. Move to
the required zone by pressing the A or B keys or by entering the zone address. To place the zone on the soak
test press the # key; the keypad indicates that the zone is now ON TEST. Select other zones to be put on
soak test in the same way. Once all the zones have been selected, press the esc key; the keypad briefly
displays the number of days remaining in the Soak Time parameter before escaping from the Soak operation.
6-107
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications
Option 56 – Communications
The Communications option is used to program the Galaxy Communication peripherals. This option has 7
sub menus, one for each of the communication peripherals. Each of these has its own set of sub menus as
detailed in the following pages.
1 = Int Telecoms (Comm 1)
This section supports programming of the on-board Telecom module, for alarm signalling and remote servicing
over PSTN.
2 = Ext RS232 (Comm 2)
This section supports programming of the RS232 module to allow direct wire communication to a serial comm
port on a PC, or over PSTN using a third party modem connection.
3 = ISDN (Comm 3)
This section supports programming of the ISDN module, for alarm signalling and remote servicing over ISDN
B and D channels.
4 = Ethernet (Comm 4)
This section supports programming of the Ethernet module for alarm signalling and remote servicing over an
Ethernet LAN/WAN using both TCP/IP and UDP/IP protocols.
5 = Ext Telecoms (Comm 5)
This section supports programming of the remote Telecom module, for alarm signalling and remote servicing
over PSTN.
6 = Int RS232 (Comm 6)
This section supports programming of the onboard RS232 port.
7 = 2-Way Audio (Comm 7)
This section supports programming of the 2-way audio system.
6-108
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
1 = Internal Telecoms
1 = Int Telecoms
01 = Format
1 = DTMF
1 = Channels 1-16
1 = Output Function
2 = Output Mode
1 = Latch
2 = Reflex
3 = Pulse
3 = Output Polarity
4 = Diag Recording (not available)
5 = Descriptor (not available)
6 = Lighting (not available)
7 = Output Functions
2 = Acct/Channel
2 = SIA
0 (0-4)
1 = Trigger Events
3 = Microtech
1 = Trigger Events
1 = Status
2 = Groups
1 = Telephone No.
2 = Account No.
1 = Status
2 = Groups
1 = 30 seconds
2 = 60 seconds
1 = Telephone No.
2 = Account No.
2 = Group Settings
2 = Group Settings
4 = Contact ID
1 = Trigger events
2 = Ack Timeout
3 = Group Settings
02 = Telephone No. 1
1 = Status
2 = Groups
1 = Telephone No.
2 = Account No.
22 digits Max
03 = Account No.
6 digits Max.
04 = Receiver
1 = Single
2 = Dual
3 = Alternate
05 = Telephone No. 2
22 digits Max
06 = Dial Type
1 = Tone
2 = Pulse
07 = Autotest
1 = Start Time
2 = Intervals
3 = Int. Test
0 - 99 hours
0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
4 = Group Condition
08 = Engineer Test
09 = No. of Rings
10 (1-20)
10 = Line Fail
1 = Line Volts
2 = Dial Tone
3 = Incoming Call
0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
11 = Fail to Comm
12 = Remote Access
1 = Access Period
2 = Mode
13 = Call Home
Not Available
14 = Alarm Monitoring
1 = Trigger (1-20)
2 = Telephone No.
3 = Account No.
15 = Backup module
1 = Off
2 = Ext. Telecoms
3 = Ext. RS232
4 = ISDN
5 = Ethernet
6 = Int RS232 1
16 = Forced V.21
0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
17 = SMS Paging
1 = Mobile No.
2 = Centre No.
3 = Format
1 = Off
2 = All Unset
3 = Any Set
4 = Any Time
1 = Direct Access
2 = Manager Authorize
3 = Call Back
1 = TAP
1 = Status
2 = Groups
2 = UCP (SMS)
1 = Status
2 = Groups
3 = UCP (Minicall)
1 = Status
2 = Groups
4 = UCP (Numeric)
1 = Status
2 = Groups
4 = Site ID
5 = Password
Figure 6-6. Telecom Module Programming Structure
6-109
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
The on-board Telecom module allows two-way communication via the telephone network. This can be used:
• to transmit alarm and event signals to ARCs, (Alarm Receiving Centres), supporting a number of signalling
formats.
• to remotely service the Galaxy control panel via a PC with Remote Servicing Software installed.
NOTE: When using the Telecom module as a digital communicator to signal alarms and events to ARCs or
to a PC with Alarm Monitoring software installed, the Format, Telephone Number 1 and Account
Number required to be programmed. Programming of the remaining options is either optional or not
required.
56.1.01 Format
The Telecom module provides 4 signalling formats:
•
DTMF
•
SIA
•
Microtech
•
Contact ID
Once the format has been selected, the alarm and event triggers that the panel will transmit to the ARCs may
be programmed.
1 = DTMF (Dual Tone Multiple Frequency)
When DTMF format is selected, the operation of the Telecom module is similar to that of a hardwired 8 or 16
channel communicator. The Telecom module transmits as an eight channel communicator if channels 9 - 16 are
programmed as Spare.
NOTES:
1. DTMF is fast format
2. A battery low condition occurring on the Galaxy panel is always sent to the ARC as a code 8 in the
status channel. This may cause problems for some ARCs. If a channel is assigned as Battery Low, then
both the channel and the code 8 in channel 9 is transmitted.
Programming Channels
On selecting DTMF, the keypad displays 1 = Channels 1 – 16. All 16 channels can be individually programmed. To access the Channels option press the ent key; the programming details of the first channel are
displayed. Select the required channel using the A and B keys or by entering the channel number directly and
press the ent key.
Channel Output Function
Channel
Polarity
CH03 INTRUDER *L
POS
A12345678
6-110
Mode Status
Mode
Groups assigned
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
Channels 1-16
Each channel can be programmed with the following attributes:
1 = Output function
2 = Output mode
3 = Output Polarity
4 = Diag Recording
5 = Descriptor
6 = Lighting
7 = Output Groups
1 = Output Function
Any of the system output functions (see option 53 = Program Outputs) can be assigned to each of the
channels 1 – 16. Channel 3 defaults to output function 04 = INTRUDER. All other channels default to
11=SPARE. Select the required output function using the A and B keys or by entering the function
number directly. Once the required function is displayed, press the ent key to assign the function to the
selected channel. For example, a PA function programmed on channel 2 results in a PA code to be transmitted on channel 2 to the ARC when there is a PA alarm activation.
Confirmed alarm conditions will now work across multiple groups. Previously, a confirmed condition
would only be created if both zones activated were in the same group. Confirmed outputs (and channels
in DTMF format, option 56.1.1.1) will activate for alarms across groups as long as both groups
concerned have been assigned to that output or channel.
2 = Output Mode
Each output function defaults to a specific, logical output mode. However, the output mode of each function can be modified to meet special requirements: when reprogrammed, the new mode applies to all
outputs assigned to that function. The output modes are:
1 = Latch:
the output remains active until a valid code is entered,
2 = Reflex:
the output follows the activity of the triggering event, for example, the Set output follows the
setting and unsetting of the group.
3 = Pulse:
the output remains active for the programmed pulse time (1-3000 seconds).
Programming the Output Mode
Select the required mode using the A or B keys or by selecting the number 1 - 3. Once the required mode
is selected, press the ent key to accept the programming. If assigning the Pulse output mode, enter the
pulse time (001 – 300 seconds) and press the ent key.
NOTE: The Output Mode status determines the operation of the channel restore. The status is modified
by pressing the key when the channel details display on the keypad. The status options are:
= Restore – channel sends restore code when reset
+ = Open/close - channel reports setting/unsetting
blank = Alarm only - channel signals alarm only (no restore signal transmitted)
6-111
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
3 = Output Polarity
The Output Polarity determines the normal operational state of the output.
0 = POS - channel activates when the output is triggered.
1 = NEG - channel activates when the output is reset.
4 = Diag Recording
Option not available
5 = Descriptor
Option not available
6 = Lighting
Option not available
7 = Output Groups
NOTE: The Groups attribute is only available if groups have been enabled on the system (refer to option
63 = OPTIONS)
The Group attribute allows the channel to be assigned to the groups on the system; a channel can be
assigned to more than one group. The channel will only trigger when an event occurs on one of the groups
assigned to the channel. All channels default to all groups on the system.
On selecting the Output Groups attribute, the groups that the channel is currently assigned to are displayed. Press the relevant number keys to toggle the status of the group and press the ent key: if the group
number is displayed on the top line, then the group is assigned to the channel; if a dash (–) appears in place
of the group number, the group has been removed from the channel.
Multi-group Systems
The larger Galaxy panels have 32 groups; these are displayed on the keypad in blocks of eight groups,
sub-divided into A, B, C and D:
Use the A or B key to select the required group (A1–D8). When the end of a block is reached, the next
block of eight groups is selected, press keys 1-8 to toggle the status of the relevant group in the current
block to the channel; press the ent key to accept the selection.
Group Status
This group attribute offers an additional feature that makes the operation of the channel conditional on the
set status of each of the system groups. A channel assigned Group Status only activates if the set conditions of the programming are met, for example, an Intruder channel can be programmed to activate only if
groups 2 and 4 are set and group 3 is unset.
To assign the Group Status conditions, press the key when selecting the groups: an arrow (>) is displayed on the bottom line as well as the current Status. Press the relevant number keys to toggle the status
of the groups and press the ent key to accept the programming. The available group status conditions are:
S = Set - group must be set to allow channel to activate;
U = Unset - group must be unset to allow channel to activate;
–
= Set or unset - channel activation is independent of the group status.
6-112
56 - Communications (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Programming Individual Channel Account Numbers
When the account number is programmed using option 56.1.2 = COMMUNICATIONS.Telecoms.
Account No., then all 16 channels are automatically programmed with the same number. The Account/
Channel menu option allows each channel to be programmed with a separate account number if required.
The account number can be up to a maximum of six digits, however a four digit account number is the
standard.
NOTE: Changing the main account number overwrites all separate account numbers previously programmed for channels 1 – 16.
On selecting DTMF, the keypad displays 1 = Channels 1 - 16. Press the A key; the 2 = Acct/Channel
option is displayed. All 16 channels can be individually programmed. To access the Acct/Channel option
press the ent key; the first channel is displayed. Select the required channel using the A and B keys or by
entering the channel number directly and press the ent key; the account number currently assigned to the
channel is displayed. Press the B key to delete each of the digits and then enter the new account number.
2 = SIA (Security Industries Association)
The SIA format provides a highly detailed protocol that transmits detailed information including zone descriptions to a PC loaded with suitable software or to a SIA compatible receiver. The SIA format is capable of
transmitting over 330 different Galaxy events (refer to Appendix C for further details).
On selecting the SIA format, the keypad prompts for the required SIA level to be entered, there are five SIA
levels available:
•
0 (default) - Basic event information with 4 digit account number.
•
1 - as level 0 plus 6 digit accounts
•
2 - as level 1 but with event modifiers
•
3 - as level 2 but with text descriptions
•
4 - as level 3 but allows control commands to be received by the Galaxy control panel.
Trigger Events
When the SIA level has been selected press the ent key, the keypad displays the first trigger event and its
On/Off status (see table 6-25 for a list of available triggers). These are the events and alarms that are
transmitted to the ARC or PC. If the trigger status is set to On, an activation of an event controlled by the
trigger results in the transmission to the receiver of the event details. Step through the trigger events using
the A and B keys.
The table below shows the list of signalling triggers that are available to the Telecom module, the RS232
module, the ISDN module and the Ethernet module.
No
Trigger Event
No
Trigger Event
1
PA/Duress
11
Reset/Cancel
2
Intruder
12
Modules/Comms
3
24 Hours
13
Elec Status
4
Security
14
Menu Access
5
Custom Zones
15
Trouble
6
Fire
16
Log Zone
7
Set Fault
17
Max Tag
8
Omit
18
Zone Restoral
9
Tamper
19
RF Supervision
10
Setting
20
Fault
Table 6-24. Trigger Events
6-113
56 - Communications (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
1 = Status
To modify the trigger, select the required trigger type using the A and B keys and press the ent key. To
program the status to On press 1, to set it to Off press 0. Press the ent key to save the programming and
return to the previous menu level.
Programming the SIA Format with Groups Enabled
If groups have been enabled on the system (refer to option 63 = OPTIONS), then the SIA format menu alters
slightly; an additional level is added.
1 = Trigger Events
On selecting the SIA level the keypad displays 1 = Trigger Events; press the ent key to display the first
trigger event; the keypad shows the trigger, the trigger status and the groups assigned.
1 = Status
To modify the trigger select the required trigger type using the A and B keys and press the ent key. The
1 = Status option is then displayed. If the status requires to be modified, press the ent key. To program
the status to On press 1, to set it to Off press 0. Press the ent key to save the programming and return to
the previous menu level.
2 = Groups
If groups have been enabled on the system (refer to option 63 = OPTIONS), then groups can be assigned
to the events. This means that the events have to occur in assigned groups before they are signalled. Press
the A key, the keypad displays 2 = Group Settings and then press the ent key; the status of the groups
assigned to the trigger is displayed. If the group has Y below it, then this event occurring in this group is
signalled. If N is displayed, then the event is not signalled for that group. To toggle the status of a group,
enter the group number. When all the groups have been assigned press the ent key to save the programming and return to the previous menu level.
Cross Group Confirmation
Confirmed outputs (and channels in DTMF format, option 56.1.1.1) will activate for alarms across groups
as long as both groups concerned have been assigned to that output or channel. In the point ID signalling
formats (SIA, Microtech and Contact ID), confirmed signals will be transmitted across groups that share the
same account number. For example, in option 56.1.1.2 (SIA), it is possible to select a different account
number for each group on the system. Group 1 and group 2 can both be programmed with the same account
number. If there is a single activation in group 1 then a single intruder activation in group 2, within the confirmed time window, a confirmed alarm signal will be transmitted for group 2.
Multi-group systems
The larger Galaxy panels have 32 groups; these are displayed on the keypad in blocks of eight groups,
sub-divided into A, B, C and D:
Use the A or B key to select the required group (A1–D8). When the end of a block is reached the next
block of eight groups is selected, press keys 1–8 to toggle the status of the relevant group in the current
block; press the ent key to accept the selection.
6-114
56 - Communications (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
2 = Group Settings
NOTE: This option is only displayed if the groups have been enabled (refer to option 63 = OPTIONS).
The event triggers are signalled to the telephone number, with the account number, programmed in the
menu options 56.1.2 = Telephone Number 1 and 56.1.3 = Account Number. However, each group can
be programmed to transmit event details to a unique telephone number and assigned a separate account
number. On selecting the Group Settings option the first system group is displayed. Select the required
group using the A or B keys and press the ent key, 1 = Telephone Number is displayed.
1 = Telephone Number
To assign a telephone number to the group press the ent key and enter the required number. The telephone
number can be a maximum of 22 digits (including dial pause and dial tone detect # characters); press the
ent key to save the programming and return to the previous menu level.
2 = Account Number
To assign an account number to the group press the ent key and enter the required number. The account
number can be a maximum of six digits; press the ent key to save the programming and return to the
previous menu level.
Account Groups
It is possible to have a number of groups bound by the same Account Number (an Account Group).This
means that one CL signal is not sent until all the groups within the Account Group are set. Individual groups
within the Account Group will not send a CL signal. The groups within the Account Group are identified by
a starred ( ) Account Number, for example, 2112.
When the Account Group is fully set, the identifier of the CL message is 999 to identify it as an Account
Group that has set.
For unset, each group that is part of the Account Group can report individually that it is open.
NOTE: Account Groups only operate for SIA signalling.
3 = Microtech
Microtech format is a protocol that transmits detailed point identification information to a Personal Computer
(PC) which has the Galaxy Alarm Monitoring software installed.
The menu structure and programming of the options are identical to the SIA format. Refer to 2 = SIA for
programming details.
4 = Contact ID
Contact ID format is a protocol which transmits point identification information to an Alarm Receiving Centre
that is capable of receiving the Galaxy variant of contact ID.
The menu structure and programming of the options are identical to the SIA format except for the addition of
the 2 = Ack timeout programming option. This option selects how long the telecom module waits for the
handshake tone from the receiver and can be set to 1 (30 seconds) or 2 (60 seconds).
6-115
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
56.1.02 Telephone No. 1
Telephone number 1 must be entered. This is the main telephone number that the alarms are signalled to. Up
to 22 digits may be entered, including control modifiers. The control modifiers are entered using the and #
keys:
Pause (for two seconds before dialling the next digit). Multiple entries can be made, for example,
entering
gives a six second pause.
#
Dial tone detect (wait for new dial tone). Each dial tone detect lasts for 15 seconds. Multiple entries can
be made, for example, entering ## gives a 30 second dial tone detect. If a new dial tone is not detected in this
time, then the dialling attempt is aborted. This is counted as a fail to communicate.
The B key is used to erase an existing telephone number. Each press deletes the last digit displayed.
56.1.03 Account No.
This is the site identifier. A unique account number must be entered, this can be up to a maximum of six digits
although four digits is the standard.
The B key is used to erase an existing number. Each press deletes the last digit displayed.
NOTE: Entering the account number into this menu option automatically copies the number to all channel or
group triggers in the selected format. Any individual account numbers that have been programmed
are overwritten.
56.1.04 Receiver
The transmission destination can be set to one of three modes:
1 = Single
Reports to the telephone number programmed in Telephone Number 1.
2 = Dual
Reports to both numbers programmed in Telephone Number 1 and Telephone Number 2. The alarm must
be transmitted to both numbers.
3 = Alternate
Reports to Telephone Number 1 OR Telephone Number 2. Each number is tried in sequence until the
alarm is successfully transmitted. The alarm is only transmitted to one number. Telephone number 1 is always
the first number attempted.
56.1.05 Telephone No. 2
A second telephone number is available to support Dual and Alternate dialling to a second destination
receiver. The programming is identical to Telephone Number 1.
The B key is used to erase an existing number. Each press deletes the last digit displayed.
6-116
56 - Communications (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56.1.06 Dial Type
The transmission mode can be selected from two types:
1. Tone (also known as “DTMF Dial”) this is much quicker at dialling than the Pulse option.
2. Pulse (also known as “Rotary” or “Loop Disconnect”) is universal, however, an increasing number of
exchanges now provide the Tone (DTMF Dial) option.
NOTE: If unsure of the type of exchange that the panel is connected to, leave as Pulse dialling.
56.1.07 Autotest
An engineer test can be automatically transmitted to the Monitoring Station at programmed intervals, in order
to indicate alarm transmission path integrity.
1 = Start Time
The engineer uses this option to enter the time that the first engineer test is transmitted. Subsequent engineer
test transmissions are offset by the value assigned in the Test Interval option.
2 = Intervals
This option determines the period between engineer test transmissions following the Start Time, the programmable range is 0 – 99 hours.
NOTES:
1. If the Test Interval is 0 (default) the Autotest is disabled — even if a Start Time has been assigned.
2. To disable Autotest enter 00:00 (default); no transmissions of test signals can be sent at midnight.
3 = Intelligent Test
This option stops the transmission of an automatic engineer test if an alarm signal has already been sent during
the autotest interval.
4 = Group Condition
NOTE: This option is only displayed if the groups have been enabled (refer to option 63 = OPTIONS).
The Group Condition determines the status that each group must satisfy before the Autotest is transmitted.
This can be used to prevent an Autotest from being signalled when groups are set on the system. On selecting
this option press the relevant number keys to toggle the status of the groups and press the ent key to accept
the programming. The available group status conditions are:
S = Set - group must be set to allow autotest transmission;
U = Unset - group must be unset to allow autotest transmission;
– = Set or unset - autotest transmission is independent of the group status.
6-117
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
56.1.08 Engineer Test
An engineer test can be sent to the alarm destination once the Account Number and the Telephone Number
1 have been entered, to ensure that the station is receiving transmissions sent from the Telecom module.
On selecting this option a warning message is displayed on the keypad, WARNING!!! ENT = SEND
MESSAGE. Press the ent key to send the engineer test.
The test attempts to transmit once for each selection of the option. If the test is not successfully transmitted,
the communicator does not attempt to resend. An unsuccessful transmission is not counted as a FAIL TO
COMMUNICATE.
NOTE: Activation of an engineer test will send a test signal via all Galaxy communication modules.
56.1.09 No. of Rings
This option determines the number of rings before the Telecom module answers an incoming call; the programmable range is 1 – 20, the default is 10.
56.1.10 Line Fail
The Telecom module continually monitors the telephone line that it is connected to. This option determines the
line monitoring conditions that result in a LINE FAIL event being reported and recorded in the log. The three
line monitoring capabilities are:
1 = Line Volts (default Enabled): A line fail occurs if the voltage on the telephone line falls below
three volts, or the line is cut.
2 = Dial Tone (default Disabled): A line fail occurs if the Telecom module cannot detect a dial tone
on the telephone line, when a dial attempt is made. In this case the Telecom module records the line
fail, but will continue the call attempt even if no dial tone is detected.
3 = Incoming Call (default Disabled): A line fail occurs if the Telecom module attempts to transmit
an alarm while there is an incoming call.
NOTE: Any combination of the above options may be enabled or disabled at any time.
When one of these conditions is detected, a LINE FAIL message is sent to the Galaxy and is stored in the
event log, with the exception of line volts which is monitored for a further period determined by the value
programmed in parameter 51.68. If sufficient line voltage is restored within this period, no event will be stored.
If an attempt is made to set the system or part of the system within this period, the message ALERT - LINE
FAIL 1 ent = CONTINUE SET will be displayed. If ent is pressed the set will continue; if esc is pressed a
line fail will immediately be logged. If the system is unset, the COMM LINE FAIL message appears on the
keypad display and a local alarm is sounded - the keypad buzzers and on-board horn (if connected) are
activated. If the system is set when a line fail condition occurs, the message COMM LINE FAIL will be
displayed when the system is unset. This will be accompanied by a local alarm.
The local alarm is only activated for the first line condition of each unset period. Subsequent line fails are
displayed as COMM LINE FAIL messages on the keypad for the duration of the condition and are recorded in the event log.
If an alarm occurs during a line fail condition, then the programmed bell delay for each of the groups is overridden (refer to option 51.02 = PARAMETERS.Bell Delay).
6-118
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
56.1.11 Fail to Communicate
This option determines how long the on-board telecom module will attempt to gain a connection before the
COMM FAIL message is recorded in the event log.
When an alarm condition or event is to be transmitted to the monitoring station, the Telecom module snatches
the telephone line and dials the programmed telephone numbers. After a successful communication the LED
lights for three seconds, the module then releases the telephone line and reconnects any serially connected
equipment. This procedure is repeated for the second telephone number if the Receiver option has been
programmed as Dual.
NOTE: The Telecom module communicator snatches and holds the line until a successful attempt has been
made to the required telephone numbers or all the repeat attempts have been tried.
If the communication attempt is unsuccessful, the LED flashes rapidly for three seconds. The communicator
then waits for a short period before redialling the number (or the second telephone number if the Receiver
option has been programmed as Dual or Alternate ). When the Fail To Communicate option is left at the
default setting of 120 seconds, a communication Fail will be recognised if there has not been a successful
kiss-off, irrespective of the number of failed attempts. Bell Delay (parameter 51.2) is overridden when this
condition occurs.
The FAIL TO COMM parameter has 5 time values:
1 = 60 seconds; 2 = 120 seconds; 3 = 180 seconds; 4 = 240 seconds; 5 = 300 seconds.
NOTE: If the Receiver option is programmed as Dual then successful transmission must be made to both
telephone numbers.
56.1.12 Remote Access
This option defines when and how Remote Servicing will operate. The options are described as follows.
1 = Access Period
This option determines under what conditions the remote site can be accessed by the Remote operator. There
are four modes:
1 = Off
Remote Servicing access to the Galaxy panel is disabled
2 = All Unset
Access only when all the groups are unset. If groups are not enabled access is available at any time.
3 = Any Set
No access if any of the groups are set. The system must be fully unset, whether groups are enabled or not.
4 = Any Time (default)
Access available at any time
6-119
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
2 = Mode
1 = Direct Access
This permits access at anytime. Once access is authorized, uploading, downloading and remote servicing can
begin.
2 = Manager Authorize
There are two methods that an authorized user can use to enable access to the Galaxy via Remote Servicing:
•
Timed Access: Remote Servicing must access the Galaxy within 40 minutes of this option being
enabled by the manager. Once connected, there is no time limit on the access period. On terminating the
connection, Remote Servicing can reaccess the system within a 15 minute period of the termination.
•
Call Back: the manager instructs the Galaxy to initiate a connection to a PC (with Remote Servicing
software loaded) by dialling one of the numbers programmed in the Call Back option.
3 = Call Back
Up to five telephone numbers can be programmed into this option. Remote Servicing requests the Galaxy to
call back to one of the numbers.
NOTES:
1. If Manager Authorize is selected as the Remote Access Mode, then the telecoms module can only
make outgoing calls - it is disabled from answering all incoming calls. This allows another telephone, fax or
answering machine to be connected to the line without interference from the telecom module when calling into
the premises.
2. If Call Back is selected, then access to the Galaxy is denied unless the call back option in Remote
Servicing is used to initiate the connection.
56.1.13 Call Home
Not used
56.1.14 Alarm Monitoring
This option is used to allow events to be dialled to a PC with Alarm Monitoring software loaded.
The Alarm Monitoring option transmits alarm events information only when all of the alarms have been sent
to the ARC (or all five of the communication attempts have been unsuccessfully made). If a new alarm event
occurs while the system is transmitting in the Alarm Monitoring mode, the transmission is terminated and the
alarms are sent to the ARC using the primary format selected.
The menu structure and programming of the Alarm Monitoring options are identical to the SIA format.
Refer to option 2 = SIA for programming details.
6-120
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
56.1.15 Backup Module
This option allows another module to become the primary communication module if a line fail is detected on
the on-board telecom. There are 6 options:
1 = Off; 2 = Ext Telecoms; 3 = Ext RS232; 4 = ISDN; 5 = Ethernet; 6 = Int RS232 1.
56.1.16 Force V.21
Option not available
56.1.17 SMS
The SMS option is available on Galaxy panels with V4.00 and above software and Telecom modules with
V5.xx and above software. This option generates and transmitts SMS text messages, for events generated by
the Galaxy panel.
1=Mobile No.
This is a 22 digit telephone number and is the mobile phone number of the recipient of the message.
2=Centre No.
This is a 22 digit telephone number and is the phone number of the SMS centre. The default is different for
each operator.
3=Format
The options for this menu are:
1=TAP
For mobile phones (UK)
2=UCP (SMS)
For mobile phones (outside UK)
3=UCP (Minicall)
For alpha pagers
4=UCP (Numeric)
For numeric pagers
4=Site ID
This is a 16 character alphanumeric string and is used to identify the panel/site sending the message. If the
format is UCP (Numeric), then the site ID is numeric only, and only the first four characters are sent out.
5=Password
This is a 16 character string and is an optional field required by some paging centres.
6-121
56 - Communications (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
2 = External RS232 Interface Module
2 = RS232
1 = Mode
1 = Direct
2 = Modem
1 = Telephone No.
2 = Dial Type
1 = Tone
2 = Pulse
2 = Format
3 = X25
Not Available
4 = Paging
Not Available
1 = SIA
0 (0-3)
1 = Trigger Events
2 = Microtech
1 = Trigger Events
1 = Status
1 = Status
2 = Groups
2 = Groups
3 = Account No.
6 digit Max.
4 = Copy/Overwrite 1 = Copy Site
2 = Overwrite Site
1 = Start
2 = Abort
1 = Start
2 = Abort
3 = Copy Stored
5 = Comms Setup
Not Available
Figure 6-7. RS232 Programming Structure
The Galaxy RS232 Interface module is a multipurpose communication peripheral. This module can be used to:
•
signal alarms and events to a single local PC with Galaxy Alarm Monitoring and third party monitoring
software installed.
•
remotely service the Galaxy control panel via a PC with Remote Servicing software installed,
•
act as an interface to third party products using Galaxy SIA control porotocol.
•
operate as a printer interface unit.
For information on the installation and operation of the RS232 Interface module refer to Section 3 - Peripherals and the RS232 Module Operating Instructions (part number IO1-0054).
56.2.1 Mode
The Mode option allows selection of the method of connection to the PC:
1 = Direct
This mode is selected if the Galaxy panel and PC are located in close proximity to one another and can interface via an RS232 cable.
2 = Modem
This mode is selected if the RS232 is communicating, via a modem and telephone line, with a remote PC. The
telephone number of the remote PC must be entered in option 1 = Telephone Number and the type of
telephone exchange (Pulse or Tone) must be assigned in option 2 = Dial Type.
6-122
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
56.2.2 Format
This option allows selection of the alarm signalling format. There are two formats available for the RS232
module:
1 = SIA
Refer to the Telecom format menu (56.1.2) for programming details.
2 = Microtech
Refer to the Telecom format menu (56.1.3) for programming details.
NOTE: The SIA and Microtech formats for the RS232 module are identical in structure and programming to
the Telecom menu. The only difference is that when groups have been enabled there is no Group
Settings option.
56.2.3 Account No.
This is the site identifier. A unique account number must be entered, this can be up to a maximum of six digits.
The B key is used to erase an existing number. Each press deletes the last digit displayed.
56.2.4 Copy/Overwrite
This RS232 feature is not compatible with Galaxy Version 5 and Version 6 software.
6-123
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
3 = ISDN Module
3 = ISDN
01 = Primary
1 = Default Tel No
2 = Default Acc No
3 = Dial Type
1 = Analogue
2 = Digital
3 = X.25
4 = RAM
4 = Format
02 = Secondary
5 = CUG Index
Option not available
1 = DTMF
2 = SIA
3 = Microtech
4 = Contact ID
5 = Robofon
6 = X.25 Protocol 1
7 = X.25 Protocol 2
1 = Default Tel No
2 = Default Acc No
3 = Dial Type
4 = Format
5 = Copy Primary
6 = Alternate
1 = Disable
2 = Enable
03 = ISDN Type
1 = Point to Multipoint
2 = Point to Point
04 = ISDN Snatch
1 = Hardware
1 = Always Snatch
2 = Never Snatch
3 = Snatch if Line Fail
2 = Software
1 = Disabled
2 = Enabled
05 = Autotest
1 = TEI
2 = LCGN
3 = LCN
4 = Polling Rate
1 = Start Time
2 = Intervals
3 = Int. Test
4 = Group condition
06 = Engineer Test
07 = Line Fail
1 = None
2 = Line Volts Only
3 = Layer 1 Only
4 = Volts and Layer 1
5 = Volts or Layer 1
08 = Fail to Comm
09 = Remote Access
1 = Access Time
1 = Off
2 = All Unset
3 = Any Set
4 = Any Time
2 = Mode
10 = Alarm Monitoring
11 = Backup Module
1 = Direct Access
2 = Manager Authorize
3 = Call Back
1 = Trigger
2 = Phone Number
3 = Account Number
1 = Off
2 = Ext. Telecoms
3 = Ext. RS232
4 = Ethernet
5 = Int. Telecom
6 = Int. RS232 1
Figure 6-8. ISDN Programming Structure
6-124
1 = None
2 = 90 secs
3 = 15 mins
4 = 60 mins
5 = Programmable
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
The Galaxy ISDN Module supports alarm signalling and remote servicing over ISDN B and D channels.
56.3.01 Primary
1 =Default Telephone Number
Telephone number 1 must be entered. This is the main telephone number that the alarms are signalled to. Up
to 22 digits may be entered, including control modifiers. The control modifiers are entered using the and #
keys:
Pause (for two seconds before dialling the next digit). Multiple entries can be made, for example,
entering
gives a six second pause.
#
Dial tone detect (wait for new dial tone). Each dial tone detect lasts for 15 seconds. Multiple entries can
be made, for example, entering ## gives a 30 second dial tone detect. If a new dial tone is not detected in this
time, then the dialling attempt is aborted. This is counted as a fail to communicate.
The B key is used to erase an existing telephone number. Each press deletes the last digit displayed.
2 = Default Account Number
This is the site identifier. A unique account number must be entered, this can be up to a maximum of six digits
although 4 digits is the standard.
The B key is used to erase an existing number. Each press deletes the last digit displayed.
NOTE: Entering the account number into this menu option automatically copies the number to all triggers in
the selected format (DTMF, SIA, Microtech, Contact ID, X.25 Protocol 1 and X.25 Protocol 2).
Any individual account numbers that have been programmed are overwritten.
3 = Dial Type
This option allows selection of the type of ISDN transmission.
NOTE: The available signalling formats are only compatible with certain dial types. If a dial type is selected
which does not match the currently programmed format a warning will be displayed momentarily to
indicate the mismatch.
1 = Analogue
This selection uses voice mode to transmit data to ISDN or PSTN networks. Default selection for ISDN
B-channel communications.
2 = Digital
The ISDN line is capable of transmitting alarm data in a digital format with a speed of 64K bit per
second.(This option is not yet available)
6-125
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
3 = X.25
The X.25 dialling type allows transmission of data via an X.25 network to compatible X.25 receivers. The
ISDN Module uses the D-channel of the ISDN line to set up the connection. After set-up the connection will
remain activated. On selection of the X.25 dial type a number of configuration options will be made available.
1 = TEI (Terminal Endpoint Identifier)
Since it is possible to connect several devices to one ISDN line, like X.25 ISDN Module but also X.25
pay systems for an ATM card, the local telecom provider uses the TEI to identify the devices. The local
telecom provider issues the TEI number. The value can vary from 00 to 63.
2 = LCGN (Logical Channel Group Number)/ 3 = LCN (Logical Channel Number)
The X.25 data network uses the LCGN and LCN to identify the users that are connected. Normally the
users are connected directly to the X.25 network. To allow a high number of users the LCN can vary from
000 to 255. The LCGN can multiply this number of users with 15. The LCGN can vary from 00 to 15.
When using X.25 over ISDN the LCGN is set to 00 and the LCN is set to 001.
4 = Polling Rate
The polling rate is used to monitor the X.25 connection end to end. A poll is sent from the ISDN Module
to the X.25 receiver. The receiver also monitors if the poll is received within the specified limit. The interval
between the polls can be programmed using this parameter.
5 = CUG (Closed User Group)
Depending on the country of use and the local telecom provider the CUG index is used. The telecom
provider can issue a closed number group to a certain monitoring station. The extra subscription for X.25
use over the ISDN line is often available in several packages depending on the use of the X.25 facility. The
value can vary from 0 to 9.
4 = RAM
Option not used
4 = Format
The ISDN module provides seven signalling formats:
1 = DTMF
2 = SIA
3 = Microtech
4 = Contact ID
5 = Robofon
6 = X.25 Protocol 1 (SIA based format compatible with the OA BX X.25 receiver)
7 = X.25 Protocol 2 (SIA based format compatible with the Alphatronics RC 4000 receiver)
NOTE: The DTMF, SIA, Microtech and Contact ID formats are identical in structure and programming to
the Telecom Module menu.
NOTE: X.25 Protocol 1 and Protocol 2 are similar in programming structure to the SIA protocol.
6-126
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
56.3.02 Secondary
The secondary option is available to support Dual and Alternate dialling to a second destination receiver. If
using alternate mode both the dial type and format must be identical to the values programmed for the primary
number.
1 = Default Telephone Number
The programming is identical to Telephone Number 1.
2 = Default Account Number
Refer to Primary format
3 = Dial Type
Refer to Primary Dial Type (except X.25 should be option not available).
4 = Format
Refer to Primary Format. It is possible to assign different formats to both the Primary and Secondary numbers, however, when using the alternative signalling option the format must be identical.
5 = Copy Primary (1 to 2)
Copies Primary Program to Secondary Program, for ease of programming.
6 = Alternate
If enabled, signalling is attempted alternately to primary and secondary numbers until successful transmission to
either is achieved. If enabled, the user will be requested to copy the primary programming to the secondary
programming to ensure both paths are configured identically.
56.3.03 ISDN Type
Two types of ISDN lines are available on the EURO ISDN network; Point to Multipoint and Point to Point.
This option allows selection of the type to be used.
1 = Point to Multipoint (default)
This configuration is used when more than one ISDN system is connected to the ISDN bus. To ensure that the
ISDN module responds to incoming calls from Remote Servicing only a specific MSN (Multiple Subscriber
Number) should be entered. The MSN number should be provided by the Telecom provider.
NOTE: All devices not programmed with an MSN number will also respond to incoming calls.
6-127
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
2 = Point to Point
Only one device is allowed on the ISDN bus. In this configuration a TEI number must be programmed. The
default is 0. Since only one device is allowed the ISDN module will act differently when programmed to Point
to Point. The hardware ISDN snatch relay is always activated before the module starts a dialling sequence.
After all the alarms are transmitted the relay will be deactivated and the customer PABX, if connected, will be
connected to the ISDN network again. During the dialling sequence it is not possible to use the PABX for an
outside call. Upon an incoming call for the module, the relay will be activated directly switching the PABX off
the ISDN line, after which the ISDN module will seize the line. To ensure correct functionality of the PABX
and the ISDN module always connect the PABX to the ISDN out ports. The phone numbers that are available on a Point-to-Point line often only vary in the last 2 digits e.g.123401 ~ 123409. To handle incoming
calls from Remote Servicing one phone number need to programmed into the ISDN module. This specific
phone number cannot be used by the PABX because the ISDN module will seize the incoming call directly.
NOTE: X.25 in combination with a Point-to-Point ISDN line is not possible.
56.3.04 ISDN Snatch
In order to ensure maximum security the ISDN Module must be able to make a call in every circumstance.
The ISDN Module offers both hardware and software line seizure options.
1 = Hardware
The hardware snatch is performed using a relay. This relay can switch the other devices off when the ISDN
Module needs to communicate. In order to switch the other devices off it is important that these other devices
are connected to the ISDN out connection of the module. Some ISDN devices are not willing to release a Bchannel even when the network indicates that the B-channel must be released. When this is detected or a
tamper causes interference on the ISDN bus communication the relay will be activated.
A number of configurations are available for the hardware snatch function.
1 = Always Snatch
A hardware snatch is always attempted irrespective of the software snatch programming.
2 = Never Snatch
A hardware snatch is never attempted.
3 = Snatch if Fail
A hardware snatch is attempted if the software snatch fails or the software snatch is disabled.
2 = Software
The software in the ISDN module monitors every communication on the ISDN bus including those of other
devices. The software snatch enables the possibility to clear a B-channel when both are occupied at that time.
When both B-channels are occupied the ISDN module always clears the call that started first.
Certain ISDN devices will not release the B-channel when a software snatch is attempted. In this case, depending on the programming of option 56.3.4.1 = Hardware, a hardware snatch can be attempted to ensure
a channel is made available to the ISDN Module. Software snatch can be enabled or disabled.
6-128
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
56.3.05 Autotest
An engineer test can be automatically transmitted to the Monitoring Station at programmed intervals.
1 = Start Time
The engineer uses this option to enter the time that the first engineer test is transmitted. Subsequent engineer
test transmissions are offset by the value assigned in the Intervals option.
2 = Intervals
This option determines the period between engineer test transmissions following the Start Time, the programmable range is 0 – 99 hours.
NOTES:
1. If the Test Interval is 0 (default) the Autotest is disabled — even if a Start Time has been assigned.
2. To disable Autotest enter 00:00 (default); no transmissions of test signals can be sent at midnight.
3 = Interval Test
This option can either be disabled or enabled to allow an engineer test to be carried out.
4 = Group Condition
NOTE: This option is only displayed if the groups have been enabled (refer to option 63 = OPTIONS).
The Group Condition determines the status that each group must satisfy before the Autotest is transmitted.
This can be used to prevent an Autotest from being signalled when groups are set on the system. On selecting
this option press the relevant number keys to toggle the status of the groups and press the ent key to accept
the programming. The available group status conditions are:
S
=
Set - group must be set to allow autotest transmission;
U
=
Unset - group must be unset to allow autotest transmission;
–
=
Set or unset - autotest transmission is independent of the group status.
56.3.06 Engineer Test
An engineer test can be sent to the Monitoring Station once the Account Number and the Telephone
Number 1 have been entered, to ensure that the station is receiving transmissions sent from the ISDN
module.
On selecting this option a warning message is displayed on the keypad. Press the ent key to send the engineer
test.
The test attempts to transmit once for each selection of the option. If the test is not successfully transmitted,
the communicator does not attempt to resend. An unsuccessful transmission is not counted as a FAIL TO
COMMUNICATE.
56.03.07 Line Fail
The ISDN module continually monitors the ISDN line that it is connected to. In addition to the DC volts
monitoring of the ISDN line, the ISDN Module can be programmed to use layer 1 check monitoring. The
layer 1 option will activate the ISDN line every 40 seconds and monitor the activation response from the
6-129
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
ISDN network. This activation will remain for about 20 seconds. When X.25 is used the layer 1 check is not
performed because the ISDN line is already activated continuously.
The ISDN module can be configured to report a line fail when either one or a combination of the volts and
layer 1 checks fail. The options are:
1 = None
No line monitoring
2 = Line Volts
DC volts monitored only
3 = Layer 1
Layer 1 monitored only
4 = Volts and Layer 1
Volts and layer 1 both monitored. Line Fail activated if both fail.
5 = Volts or Layer 1
Volts and Layer 1 both monitored. Line Fail activated if either fail.
56.3.08 Fail to Comm
This option determines the number of unsuccessful communication attempts before the COMM FAIL message is recorded in the event log.
When an alarm condition or event is to be transmitted to the monitoring station, the ISDN module snatches the
telephone line and dials the programmed telephone numbers. This procedure is repeated for the second
telephone number if the Receiver option has been programmed as Dual.
NOTE: The ISDN module communicator snatches and holds the line until a successful attempt has been
made to the required telephone numbers or all the repeat attempts have been tried.
If the communication attempt is unsuccessful, the communicator waits for a short period before redialling the
number (or the second telephone number if the Receiver option has been programmed as Dual or Alternate). When the Fail To Communicate option is left at the default setting of 3, if the first three dialling attempts are unsuccessful, the COMM FAIL message is recorded in the event log and the alarms to be transmitted are erased from the buffer.
6-130
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
56.3.09 Remote Access
This option defines when and how Remote Servicing will operate. The options are described as follows.
1 = Access Time
This option determines the type of access that is available to the Remote Servicing operator. There are four
modes:
1 = Off:
Galaxy Gold access to the Galaxy panel is disabled
2 = All Unset:
Access only when all the groups are unset. If groups are not enabled access is available at any time.
3 = Any Set:
No access if any of the groups are set. The system must be fully unset, whether groups are enabled or not.
4 = Any Time (default):
Access available at any time
2 = Mode
1 = Direct
This permits access to be initiated from Remote Servicing.
2 = Manager Authorize
If this option is selected here are two methods that an authorized user can use to enable access to the Galaxy
via Remote Servicing:
Timed Access:
Remote Servicing must access the Galaxy within 40 minutes of this option being enabled by the manager.
Once connected, there is no time limit on the access period. On terminating the connection, Remote Servicing can re-access the system within a 15 minute period of the termination.
Call Back:
The manager instructs the Galaxy to initiate a connection to a PC (with Remote Servicing software loaded)
by dialling one of the numbers programmed in the Call Back option.
Refer to option 47 = Remote Access for details of how to initiate the Manager authorized connection.
6-131
56 - Communications (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
3 = Call Back
Up to five telephone numbers can be programmed into this option. Remote Servicing requests the Galaxy
to call back to one of the numbers.
NOTES:
1. If Manager Authorize is selected as the Remote Access Mode, then the ISDN module can only
make outgoing calls - it is disabled from answering all incoming calls.
2. If Call Back is selected, then access to the Galaxy is denied unless the call back option in Remote
Servicing is used to initiate the connection.
56.3.10 Alarm Monitoring
This is identical to the Microtech format communications (56.1.3). This option is used to allow alarms to be
dialled to a PC with Alarm Monitoring software loaded as well as to an ARC using the Primary and/or Secondary formats.
56.3.11 Backup Module
This option allows another module to become the primary communication module if a line fail is detected on
the ISDN module. There are 6 options:
1 = Off; 2 = Ext Telecoms; 3 = Ext RS232; 4 = Ethernet; 5 = Int Telecom; 6 = Int RS232 1.
6-132
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
4 = Ethernet Module
4 = Ethernet
01= Module
Config
02 = Alarm
Reporting
1 = IP Address
2 = Site Name
3 = Gateway IP
4 = Network Mask
1 = Format
1 = SIA (0-4)
1 = Trigger
1 = Status
2 = Groups
2 = Groups Setting
1 = Account No.
2 = IP Address
3 = Port No.
2 = Microtech (Same as SIA format)
2 = Primary IP
1 = IP Address
2 = Port No.
3 = Secondary IP
1 = IP Address
2 = Port No.
4 = Account No.
5 = Receiver
1 = Single
2 = Dual
6 = Alarm Mon.
1 = Trigger
1 = Status
2 = Groups
2 = Account No.
3 = IP Address
4 = Port No.
03 = Remote
Access
04 = Autotest
7 = Heartbeat
1 = Interval
8 = Protocol
0 = UDP
1 = TCP
1 = Access Period
1 = Off
2 = All unset
3 = Any Set
4 = Any Time
2 = Mode
1 = Direct access
2 = Mgr Authorize
1 = Start Time
2 = Interval
05 = Engineer Test
1 = Call Back IP1
1 = IP Address
2 = Port No.
2 = Call Back IP2
1 = IP Address
2 = Port No.
3 = Call Back IP3
1 = IP Address
2 = Port No.
4 = Call Back IP4
1 = IP Address
2 = Port No.
5 = Call Back IP5
1 = IP Address
2 = Port No.
06 = Fail to Comm
07 = Line Fail
1 = Network
0 = Off
1 = Available
2 = Signal Path
1 = Primary
2 = Secondary
3 = Alarm Mon.
4 = Any
5 = All
8 = SIA Control
1 = IP Address
9 = Encrypt
1 = Alarm Report
0 = Off
1 = On
2 = Remote Access
0 = Off
1 = On
3 = SIA Control
0 = Off
1 = On
4 = Alarm Mon.
0 = Off
1 = On
10 = Backup module
1 = Off
2 = Ext. Tel Mod
3 = Ext. RS232
4 = ISDN
5 = Int. Telecoms
6 = Int. RS232 1
Figure 6-9. Ethernet Module Programming Structure
6-133
56 - Communications (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
The Ethernet module allows the Galaxy control panel to communicate over Ethernet local and wide area
networks, using both UDP and TCP Ethernet protocols. The Ethernet module supports both alarm signalling
and remote servicing. Features included in the Ethernet module communications are data encryption and path
supervision between the Ethernet module and alarm receiving applications.
56.4.01 Module Config
Each Ethernet module is pre-programmed with a unique MAC address, which identifies the module on the
network. However in order for the module to communicate with other applications an IP address should be
assigned to the unit. The information programmed in this section is required for other applications on the
network to recognise the Ethernet module.
1 = IP Address
This is the IP address of the Ethernet module. This must be a unique, static IP address. The address will be in
the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX. The dot separator will be automatically added after each sequence of three
numbers or can be manually added by pressing the * key.
An example of a valid IP address is 192.0.1.152.
This address should be provided by your IT administrator
2 = Site Name
This option is not used at this time
3 = Gateway IP
When using the Ethernet module over a wide area network the IP address of the gateway router connected to
the Ethernet local area network must be entered in this field. The format of this address is identical to the IP
address of the Ethernet module.
This information should be supplied by the IT administrator
4 = Network Mask
The network mask identifies the class of network being used. This field masks off the parts of the gateway IP
address which, are common and not required for specific identification of the Ethernet module.
This information should be supplied by the IT administrator.
56.4.02 = Alarm Reporting
This option allows selection of the alarm signalling format used to transmit the events. This option also controls
the types of events, which are sent and the destination/identification for each independent group.
1 = Format
This is the signalling format of the receiver and has the following two formats:
1 = SIA (0-4) Security Industries Association
The SIA format can be programmed between levels 0 and 4 and provides a protocol that transmits detailed
information including textual descriptors, to a SIA compatible receiver or PC loaded with suitable receiver
software.
6-134
56 - Communications (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
The SIA format is capable of transmitting the Galaxy events indicated in Appendix D of this manual.
Refer to Appendix C of this manual for the detailed breakdown of the SIA event structure for each level.
On selecting the SIA format, the keypad prompts for the required SIA level to be entered, there are five SIA
levels available:
•
Level 0 (default) – basic event information with 4 digit account numbers
•
1 – as level 0 plus 6 digit account numbers
•
2 – as level 1 but with event modifiers
•
3 – as level 2 but with text descriptors
•
4 – as level 3 but also enables the SIA control command feature (refer option 08 SIA control)
1 = Trigger Events
When the SIA level has been selected press the ent key. The keypad displays the first trigger event and it’s
On/Off status (see table 25 for the list of available triggers, and Appendix B for the events which are
controlled by each trigger). The triggers control the events, which are transmitted. If the trigger is set to On,
any events logged, which are controlled by the trigger will be transmitted. If the trigger is set to Off, the
events controlled by the trigger will not be transmitted. Step through the trigger events using the A and B
keys.
1 = Status
To modify the trigger on/off status select the trigger to be modified using the A and B keys and press the
ent key. To program the status to On press 1, to set it to Off press 0. Alternatively use the A/B keys to
toggle between On and Off. To accept the new status, press the ent key. This will automatically return
the display to the previous menu level.
Programming the SIA format with groups enabled
If groups have been enabled on the system (refer to option 63.1), then the SIA format menu alters slightly to
support the independent event trigger programming for each group.
1 = Trigger Events
On selecting the SIA level the menu enters the Trigger Events option. Press the ent key to display the first
trigger event; the keypad shows the trigger, the trigger status and the groups assigned.
To modify the trigger event select the required event using the A and B keys and press the ent key. The
1=Status option is then displayed. If the status requires to be modified press the ent key.
1 = Status
To program the status to On press 1, to set it to Off press 0. Alternatively use the A/B keys to toggle
between On and Off. To accept the new status, press the ent key. This will automatically return the
display to the previous menu level.
2 = Groups
If groups have been enabled on the system (refer option 63.1), then the groups can be assigned to each
event trigger. This means that the events have to occur in assigned groups before they are signalled. To
modify the groups assigned to a specific trigger press the ent key from the 2=Groups menu option. The
display will show the groups and indicate whether it is assigned (Y) or not assigned (N) to the group. To
assign or unassign a group from a specific trigger press the number key corresponding to the group
6-135
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
number. The display will show the new status. To accept the new status, press the ent key and return to
the previous menu level. If the Galaxy panel supports more than 8 groups use the A and B keys to
scroll through all available groups.
Groups Setting
NOTE: This option is only displayed if the groups have been enabled (refer option 63.1)
Each of the events are signalled to Primary IP/Port Numbers programmed in menu option 56.4.2.2 and the
account number programmed in 56.4.2.4. However, each group can be programmed to transmit event
details to a unique IP address and port number, with a unique account number. On selecting the 2=Group
Settings option the first group is displayed. Select the required group to be modified using the A/B keys
and press ent. 1=Account No. is displayed
1 = Account No.
By default the account number programmed in option 56.4.2.4 will be entered in this field. To assign a
unique account number to the group selected use the B key to erase any existing numbers and enter the
new number. The account number should be between four and six digits long. Press the ent key to save
the programming and return to the previous menu level.
To modify the IP address which events from a specific group will be signalled to press the A or 2 keys,
then press ent.
2 = IP Address
By default the IP address programmed in option 56.4.2.2 will be displayed. To programme a new IP
address use the B key to erase any existing programming and enter the new IP address to which the
events are to be sent. Press ent to save the new address and return to the previous menu level.
To modify the Port No. which events from a specific group will be sent press either the A or 3 keys,
then press ent.
3 = Port No.
By default the Port No. programmed in option 56.4.2.2 will be displayed. To programme a new port
number use the B key to erase any existing programming and enter the new port number. Press the ent
key to save the new address and return to the previous menu.
2 = Microtech
Microtech format is a protocol that transmits detailed point id information to a PC, which has the Galaxy
Alarm Monitoring application installed and running.
The level of information supplied is similar to SIA level 3.
The menu structure and programming of the options are identical to the SIA format. Refer 1=SIA for programming details.
2 = Primary IP
The Primary IP defines the receiver destination details for the primary alarm transmission path. The destination
is made up of an IP address and a port number. To programme the IP address press ent. If groups are enabled the information programmed for the primary IP and port numbers is automatically copied to all groups.
1 = IP Address
Enter the IP address of the primary receiver. The address will be in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX. The dot
separator will be automatically added after each sequence of three numbers or can be manually added by
6-136
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
pressing the * key. To save the address and return to the previous menu level press ent. To programme the
port number of the primary destination receiver press either 2 or A, then press ent.
Note: This number must be programmed, even if groups have been enabled and all groups have a programmed IP address. This is the IP address used for all system wide events.
2 = Port No.
To erase any previously programmed numbers press the B key. Enter the port number of the primary destination receiver. The default value is 10002. Press ent to save the programmed number.
3 = Secondary IP
The Ethernet module supports signalling to more than one receiver destination. The Secondary IP defines the
receiver destination details for the secondary alarm transmission path. The destination is made up of an IP
address and a port number. To programme the IP address press ent.
1 = IP Addresss
Enter the IP address of the secondary receiver. The address will be in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX. The
dot separator will be automatically added after each sequence of three numbers or can be manually added by
pressing the * key. To save the address and return to the previous menu level press ent. To programme the
port number of the secondary destination receiver press either 2 or A, then press ent.
2 = Port No.
To erase any previously programmed numbers press the B key. Enter the port number of the secondary
destination receiver. The default value is 10002. Press ent to save the programmed number.
4 = Account No.
The account number identifies the Galaxy system to the receiver when signals are transmitted. Every signal
transmitted contains the account number. The account number should be between 4 and 6 digits long. After
entering the account number press ent to save and return to the previous menu level.
If groups are enabled the account number entered in this field is automatically copied to all groups.
5 = Receiver
This option determines the paths, which will be used for alarm signalling.
1 = Single
If selected the Primary IP destination and/or specific group IP programming is used to signal alarms. If 1=Single is selected and a Secondary IP is programmed the Secondary IP destination will be used in the event of a
failure to the Primary IP. A Fail to Comm will be logged against the Primary alarm transmission path.
2 = Dual
If selected and if a secondary IP is programmed events are sent to both the primary and secondary IP destinations.
6 = Alarm Monitoring
This option provides a further alarm transmission path specifically for events being sent to the Galaxy Alarm
Monitoring application.
6-137
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
The keypad displays the first trigger event and it’s On/Off status (see table 25 for the list of available triggers,
and Appendix B for the events which are controlled by each trigger). The triggers control the events, which
are transmitted. If the trigger is set to On, any events logged, which are controlled by the trigger will be transmitted. If the trigger is set to Off, the events controlled by the trigger will not be transmitted. Step through the
trigger events using the A and B keys.
1 = Trigger
Press the ent key to display the first trigger event; the keypad shows the trigger, the trigger status and the
groups assigned.
To modify the trigger event select the required event using the A and B keys and press the ent key. The
1=Status option is then displayed. If the status requires to be modified press the ent key.
1 = Status
To program the status to On press 1, to set it to Off press 0. Alternatively use the A/B keys to toggle
between On and Off. To accept the new status, press the ent key. This will automatically return the display
to the previous menu level.
2 = Groups
If groups have been enabled on the system (refer option 63.1), then the groups can be assigned to each
event trigger. This means that the events have to occur in assigned groups before they are signalled. To
modify the groups assigned to a specific trigger press the ent key from the 2=Groups menu option. The
display will show the groups and indicate whether it is assigned (Y) or not assigned (N) to the group. To
assign or unassign a group from a specific trigger press the number key corresponding to the group
number. The display will show the new status. To accept the new status, press the ent key and return to the
previous menu level. If the Galaxy panel supports more than 8 groups use the A and B keys to scroll
through all available groups.
2 = Account No.
This option is required to assign a unique account number to the events signalled to Alarm Monitoring. This
data must be entered before any events are sent to Alarm Monitoring via this option. The account number can
be a maximum of 6 digits. Press the ent key to save the programming and return to the previous menu level.
3 = IP Address
To programme a new or modify the Alarm Monitoring IP address use the B key to erase any existing programming and enter the new IP address to which the events are to be sent. Press ent to save the new address
and return to the previous menu level.
4 = Port No.
To programme a new port number use the B key to erase any existing programming and enter the new port
number. Press the ent key to save the new address and return to the previous menu.
7 = Heartbeat
The Ethernet module supports path supervision to ensure the alarm transmission paths are available to transmit
event when required. This option, if programmed determines the frequency, which the alarm transmission paths
are checked.
6-138
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
1 = Interval
Enter the interval within which a path supervision signal (heartbeat) must be received from each alarm transmission path (refer option 56.4.7.2 Line Fail – Signalling Path). If a heartbeat is not received within the programmed interval a line fail condition will be activated in the panel. The Line Fail event will indicate which path
has failed (Primary, Secondary or Alarm Monitoring).
The default period is 30 minutes.
8 = Protocol
The Ethernet module is capable if signalling using either TCP (Transmission Control Protocol) or UDP (Universal Datagram Protocol). Earlier versions of Ethernet module, Alarm Monitoring and Remote Servicing only
supported the TCP protocol.
NOTE: If communicating with V3.26 Alarm Monitoring or V6.26 Remote Servicing the TCP option should
be selected.
If encryption is required for alarm signalling the UDP protocol should be selected.
Irrespective of the programming in this option Remote Servicing and SIA control command protocol will
always use the TCP protocol.
0 = UDP
When this option is selected all alarm signalling from the Ethernet module will use the UDP format.
1 = TCP
When this option is selected all alarm signalling from the Ethernet module will use the TCP format.
56.4.03 = Remote Access
The Ethernet module supports remote servicing of the Galaxy alarm panel. The programming options in this
section control when remote access can be granted and whether access is initiated from the panel or the
Remote Servicing PC.
1 = Access Period
This option determines when the Galaxy panel can be accessed remotely.
1 = Off
Remote Servicing access to the Galaxy panel is disabled.
2 = All Unset
Remote Servicing access is only granted when all groups or the complete system are unset.
3 = Any Set
Remote Servicing access will only be granted if any of the groups or the complete system are set.
4 = Any Time (default)
Access available at any time.
6-139
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
2 = Mode
This option controls access authorization and whether the remote session is initiated from (Panel or PC).
1 = Direct Access
This permits access at any time (in conjunction with Access period). Access is initiated from Remote Servicing. Once access is authorized/initiated, uploading, downloading and remote servicing can begin.
2 = Manager Authorize
This option requires authorization from the site manager in order to gain remote access to the Galaxy panel.
There are two methods that the manager can use to enable access to the Galaxy via Remote servicing.
Timed Access – Remote Servicing must access the Galaxy panel within 40 minutes of this option being enabled by the manager (Option 47.1.2.0). Once connected there is no time limit on the access period. On
terminating the connection, Remote Servicing can reaccess the system within a 15 minute period of the termination.
Call Back – the manager instructs the Galaxy panel to initiate a connection to the Remote Servicing PC (Use
option 47.1.2.1) by selecting one of the Call back IP addresses programmed into the system
1 = Call Back IP 1-5
There are 5 possible IP address/Port number destinations, which can be programmed for Remote Servicing access. This allows communication with up to five different Remote Servicing locations.
1 = IP Address
Enter the IP address of the PC running the Remote Servicing application
2 = Port No.
Enter the Port Number allocated to Remote Servicing on the PC (Default is 10001)
56.4.04 = Autotest
An engineer test can be automatically transmitted to the receiving station at programmed intervals.
1 = Start Time
The engineer uses this option to enter the time that the first engineer test is transmitted. Subsequent engineer
test transmissions are sent periodically. The frequency of each test is controlled by the 2=Interval option.
2 = Interval
This option determines the period between automatic engineer test transmissions following the Start Time. The
programmable range is 0-99 hours.
56.4.05 = Engineer Test
An engineer test can be sent on each of the transmission paths once the appropriate IP address/port no, and
account numbers have been programmed into the system. This allows the installation engineer to ensure that
6-140
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
the receiving station is correctly receiving the events from the Ethernet module.
On selecting this option a warning message is displayed on the keypad, WARNING!!! ENT=SEND MESSAGE. Press the ent key to send the engineer test.
56.4.06 = Fail to Comm
This option determines the number of unsuccessful communication attempts before the COMM FAIL message is recorded in the event log.
When an event is to be transmitted to the monitoring station, the Ethernet module attempts to initiate a session
with the destination receiver for each programmed transmission path. If the programmed number of attempts is
reached a Fail to Comm message will be logged. The logged event will include which path has failed.
Note: if the receiver option is programmed as Dual then a successful transmission must be made to both
primary and secondary to be considered a successful transmission.
56.4.07 = Line Fail
The line fail option controls which Ethernet connections are monitored. The Ethernet module can be programmed to monitor both the network availability and the programmed transmission paths between the
Ethernet module and receiver applications.
Line fail events (whether network or transmission path) must be present for the time programmed in parameter
51.68 before the event is activated. If a line fail is present and an attempt is made to set the system within
parameter 51.68 delay period, the line fail will immediately be logged and indicated.
1 = Network
This option monitors the connection between the Ethernet module and the local network.
0 = Off
If programmed to off, the connection between the Ethernet module and local network will not be monitored. If
the local network is not available or the Ethernet module is disconnected, no line fail will be indicated.
1 = Available
If programmed as available then the connection between the Ethernet module and the local Ethernet network
is monitored. If the Ethernet module is disconnected from the network or the local network is not available a
Line Fail event will be activated at the panel. The Line Fail event logged will indicate that the Line Fail was as
a result of a network failure.
2 = Signal Path
This option determines which signalling paths, will be monitored by the Ethernet module. Monitoring is
achieved by transmission of a path supervision signal (heartbeat) between the receiver application and the
Ethernet module. The Ethernet module must receive a path supervision signal at least as often as the frequency
programmed in option 56.4.2.7 (Alarm Reporting Heartbeat). If the signal is not received a line fail condition
will become present. The line fail event will indicate the path which failed and the destination IP address of that
path.
NOTE: If groups are enabled a failure on the primary path will not provide specific IP information.
6-141
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
Options are available to select specific paths or all paths.
1 = Primary
When selected the Ethernet module will only monitor the primary transmission path. All other transmission
paths will not be monitored.
2 = Secondary
When selected the Ethernet module will only monitor the secondary transmission path. All other transmission
paths will not be monitored.
3 = Alarm Mon.
When selected the Ethernet module will only monitor the Alarm Mon. transmission path. All other transmission
paths will not be monitored.
4 = Any
When selected the Ethernet module monitors all transmission paths. If a supervision failure is detected in any
of the paths a line fail condition will be activated.
5 = All
When selected the Ethernet module monitors all transmission paths. If a supervision failure is detected in all of
the paths a line fail condition will be activated.
56.4.08 = SIA Control
When using the SIA control command protocol for integration purposes the IP address of the computer
sending the SIA control commands should be entered in this field to ensure that only commands from a computer with the programmed IP address will be recognised by the Ethernet module.
1 = IP Address
The address will be in the form XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX. The dot separator will be automatically added after
each sequence of three numbers or can be manually added by pressing the * key.
56.4.09 = Encrypt
The Ethernet module supports a high level 128bit encryption algorithm for all communication options. This
option allows encryption to be enabled/disabled for each of the communication options.
1 = Alarm Report
This option controls encryption for the Primary and Secondary alarm transmission paths. Default is disabled.
0 = Off
If selected encryption is disabled for the Primary and Secondary alarm transmission paths.
1 = On
6-142
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
If selected encryption is enabled for the Primary and Secondary alarm transmission paths. In order for data to
be received when this option is selected the receiver must support decryption.
2 = Remote Access
This option controls encryption for the Remote Servicing sessions. Default is disabled.
0 = Off
If selected encryption is disabled for the Remote Servicing sessions.
1 = On
If selected encryption is enabled for the Remote Servicing sessions. In order for data to be received when this
option is selected the receiver must support decryption.
3 = SIA Control
0 = Off
This option controls encryption for communications between the Ethernet module and remote PC using the
SIA control command protocol. Default is disabled.
1 = On
If selected encryption is enabled for communications between the Ethernet module and remote PC using the
SIA control command protocol. In order for data to be received when this option is selected the receiver must
support decryption.
4 = Alarm Mon.
This option controls encryption for the Alarm Monitoring alarm transmission paths. Default is disabled.
0 = Off
If selected encryption is disabled for the Alarm Monitoring alarm transmission paths.
1 = On
If selected encryption is enabled for the Alarm Monitoring alarm transmission paths. In order for data to be
received when this option is selected the receiver must support decryption.
56.4.10 Backup Module
This option allows another module to become the primary communication module if a line fail is detected on
the Ethernet module. There are 6 options:
1 = Off; 2 = Ext Telecoms; 3 = Ext RS232; 4 = ISDN; 5 = Int Telecoms; 6 = Int RS232 1.
6-143
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
5 = Ext Telecoms
The external telecom module has the same menu structure and function as the internal telecoms with the
following exceptions:
11 Fail to Comm
This is controlled by the number of attempts and not time.
15 Backup Module
This option allows another module to become the primary communication module if a line fail is detected on
the external telecoms module. There are 6 options:
1 = Off; 2 = Ext RS232; 3 = ISDN; 4 = Ethernet; 5 = Int Telecoms; 6 = Int RS232 1.
6-144
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
6 = Int RS232 Port
6 = Int RS232 Port
1 = Mode
1 = Printer
2 = Direct
3 = Modem
1 = Telephone No.
2 = Dial Type
1 = Tone
2 = Pulse
3 = Init String
4 = Storage Mode
2 = Format
1 = SIA
0 (0-3)
1 = Trigger Events
1 = Status
2 = Groups
2 = Microtech
1 = Trigger Events
1 = Status
2 = Groups
3 = Account No.
6 digit Max.
4 = Comms Setup
1 = Baud Rate
2 = Data Bits
3 = Stop Bits
4 = Parity
1 = No Parity
2 = Odd Parity
3 = Even Parity
Figure 6-10. Internal RS232 Programming structure
The Galaxy Dimension supports an on-board RS232 serial port. This ports is:
•
Programmable independently from the panel.
•
Speed configurable from 300 to 56K bps (or highest practical speed).
•
Able to configure data length, parity and stop bits.
•
Supervised (optional via programming).
The RS232 port is configurable to support:
•
Connection to a PC.
•
Connection to a serial modem.
•
Connection to 3rd party communication modules.
•
Connection to serial printers.
•
Connection to serial wireless transmitters.
6-145
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
56.6.1 Mode
The Mode option allows selection of the method of connection to the PC:
1 = Printer
This option is selected if the Galaxy is communicating with a serial printer.
2 = Direct
This mode is selected if the Galaxy panel and PC are located in close proximity to one another and can interface via an RS232 cable.
3 = Modem
This mode is selected if the RS232 is communicating, via a modem and telephone line, with a remote PC.
1 = Telephone No.
The telephone number of the remote PC must be entered here.
2 = Dial Type
The type of telephone exchange (Pulse or Tone) must be assigned here.
3 = Init String
The initialisation string is an alpha-numeric string which is used to initialise the modem connected to the internal
RS232 port.
4 = Storage Mode
This mode allows the panel to emulate the behaviour of an external RS232 module which can then be attached
to another Galaxy panel to copy programming data. Refer to Appendix E for a full description of this function.
56.6.2 Format
This option allows selection of the alarm signalling format. There are two formats available for the RS232
module:
1 = SIA
Refer to the Telecom format menu (56.1.2) for programming details.
2 = Microtech
Refer to the Telecom format menu (56.1.3) for programming details.
NOTE: The SIA and Microtech formats for the RS232 module are identical in structure and programming to
the Telecom menu.
6-146
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
56.6.3 Account No.
This is the site identifier. A unique account number must be entered, this can be up to a maximum of six digits.
The B key is used to erase an existing number. Each press deletes the last digit displayed.
56.6.4 Comms Setup
Serial communication between the on-board R232 port and a remote PC require the following 4 elements.
1 = Baud Rate
This is the number of bits that occur each second (bps). This can be set as follows:
1=300; 2=600; 3=1200; 4=2400; 5=4800; 6=9600 (default); 7=19200; 8=38400; 9=57600 .
2 = Data bits
This can be sets follows:
1=5; 2=6; 3=7; 4=8 (default)
3 = Stop Bits
This can be set as follows:
1=1 (default); 2=2.
4 = Parity
This can be set with one of three options:
1 = No Parity (default)
2 = Odd Parity
3 = Even Parity
6-147
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
7 = Audio
This section controls the configuration of Audio Transmission in order to allow audio verification of an alarm.
Each system group can be assigned one audio channel, each with a maximum of three microphones. following
an alarm transmission over PSTN, the panel can be programmed to route recorded audio from the time of the
alarm activation, and live audio, direct to the Alarm Receiving Centre. The following menu options are
available:
Note: Group mode (option 63.1.1) must be
enabled to allow groups to function
7 = Audio
1 = Listen In
1 = Intruder
0 = NO
1 = YES
2 = Confir m
0 = NO
1 = YES
3 = PA's
0 = NO
1 = YES
4 = Others
0 = NO
1 = YES
STATUS A12345678
Groups YYNNYYNY
STATUS A12345678
Groups YYNNYYNY
STATUS A12345678
Groups YYNNYYNY
STATUS A12345678
Groups YYNNYYNY
2 = Alarm
Monitoring
Not Used
3 = Dial In
Not Used
4 = Audio Module
1 = Path (PSTN)
0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
2 = Audio Channels
Channel No 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
5 = Pre-alarm
Toggle number
to select group
Y = YES
N = NO
Pre Listen Time
00 (0 -10) secs
Figure 6-11. Audio Programming structure
56.7.1 Listen-In
This option allows audio verification on site over PSTN for an operator, after the panel sends an alarm signal
to the ARC. The type of alarm and the groups which will activate the listen-in function are programmed here.
NOTE: If the engineer wants to program the audio Listen-in to occur on 1 = Intruder, then the
2 = Confirm option must be set to NO (disabled). If the engineer wants to program the audio
Listen-in to occur on 2 = Confirm, then the 1 = Intruder option must be set to NO (disabled).
1 = Intruder
When set to Y (Yes) for a particular group, this option enables listen-in after the panel sends an intruder alarm
signal or entry timeout transmission to the ARC. The function is inactive when the system is unset.
NOTE: Group mode (63.1.1) must be enabled to allow the group to function.
2 = Confirm
When set to Y (Yes) for a particular group, this option enables listen-in after a confirm transmission.
6-148
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
3 = PA’s
When set to Y (Yes) for a particular group, this option enables listen-in after a PA audible or PA Silent transmission.
4 = Others
When set to Y (Yes) for a particular group, this option enables listen-in after a Fire transmission.
56.7.2 Alarm Monitoring
Not Used
56.7.3 Dial In
Not Used
56.7.4 Audio Module
This option enables the Audio Interface Module and configures the audio channels that will be used to record
sound in the event of an alarm.
1 = Path (PSTN)
This option selects PSTN as the communication line between the panel and ARC when set to 1 = Enabled.
2 = Audio Channels
This option controls the audio channels and enables group attachment to a particular channel.
This option selects the channel through which communication to the ARC will function for each group. The
channel is in a four-digit format. For example: Channel 9024.
9 = Line number (fixed)
0 = Audio Interface number (fixed)
2 = Mux Module number
4 = Audio channel.
Pressing ent gives the status of the current audio channel, for example:
ENABLED 9024A1
0=DISABLED
Group number
Pressing ent again disables the audio channel and the group association disappears:
Channel 9024
[ent]to select
The A and B keys scrolls through the available channels.
6-149
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
56 - Communications (cont’d)
56.7.5 Pre Alarm
This option sets the alarm delay recording time. The audio channel will continuously record a rolling 10 seconds of audio. Upon an alarm activation, the system will stop recording and store 10 seconds of audio. The
amount of alarm delay in the recorded audio can be so configured using the pre-listen time parameter.
Pre Listen Time
The alarm delay listen time can be set from 00-10 seconds. Setting the time to 5 seconds (default) means that
there is 5 seconds of pre-alarm and 5 seconds of post alarm audio saved.
6-150
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
57 - System Print
Option 57 – System Print
The System Print option allows the details of the system programming to be printed. There are 2 options for
the printer output:
1 = Printer Module
2 = Int RS232 1
From either option, the specific details of one or all of the menu options in the following table can be selected:
Menu Option
Menu No.
01
System Data
23
02
C odes
42
03
Parameters
51
04
Zones
52
05
Outputs
53
06
Links
54
07
Communication
56
08
ISDN
09
Groups
63
10
Keypads
58
11
Timers
65
12
Event Log
22
13
All (items 1-11)
56.3
Table 6-25. System Print Options
Selecting a Print Option
The required print option is selected by entering the option number 01 – 12 or by using the A and B keys and
then pressing ent. When printing option 11 = EVENT LOG, the system prompts for Groups to be selected;
the print shows only those events logged for the groups selected. The print can be aborted at any time by
pressing the esc key.
NOTE: A serial printer on line must be connected to communication line 1 of the Galaxy before the print
option is selected. If the printer is off-line or is not connected, the PRINTER off-line / ESC to
abort message is displayed. Press the ESC key and correct the problem.
Printing Timers
Printing 10 = Timers gives details of all the times that have been assigned in option 65 = TIMERS; this
includes the autoset time, the pre-warning period and lockout times.
6-151
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
58 - Keypad
Option 58 – Keypad
The keypads connected to the Galaxy control panel can be assigned individual attributes allowing each
keypad to respond in a particular way.
On selecting the Keypad option the details of the first keypad connected to the system are displayed.
Keypad Address
Flashing cursor if
keypad viewed is
this keypad
Option 1
Option 2
10 A[12]+ B[13]Mimic=1
Light=1
Option 3
Option 4
The required keypad is selected by entering the keypad address or by using the A and B keys and then
pressing ent; the keypad displays 1=A-key. Press the A and B keys to select the required option and press
the ent key.
NOTE: When the address of the keypad currently being used is displayed, a black square flashes on and off
over the first digit of the keypad address.
1 = A-key
Code Status
This option assigns a menu function to the A key. On selecting the option the keypad displays 1 = Code
Status, this determines the method of operation of the A key:
0 = OFF [ ] - A key disabled
1 = WITH CODE [+] - A key requires code to be entered prior to operation
2 = NO CODE [–]— A key is a single touch operation no code is required
Select the required Code Status and press the ent key.
NOTE: The Code Status assigned to the key is displayed when selecting the keypad address, for example
A[12]– indicates that the A key does not require a user code.
Menu Option
To assign one of the menu options to the A key, press the A key to move to the 2 = Menu option and press
the ent key. The keypad displays the currently assigned menu option.
10 A-key Option
12=Timed Set
To assign a new menu function, enter the full menu option number 11 – 71 or press the A and B keys until the
required menu option is displayed; press the ent key to accept the selection and return to the previous menu
level.
6-152
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
58 - Keypad (cont’d)
2 = B-key
The programming of the B key is identical to that of the A key.
3 = Buzzer Mimic
This option determines whether the keypad buzzer mimics the function of the programmed keypad output
(refer to option 53 = PROGRAM OUTPUTS). The default function of the keypad output is Entry/Exit
Horn and the default Mimic defaults to On, therefore the keypad buzzer operates as an Entry/Exit Horn at
factory setting.
To disable the keypad buzzer from mimicking the output select 0 = Off.
4 = Backlighting
This option determines when the keypad backlighting switches on and off.
0=
always off,
1=
always on (default),
2=
on when the system is unset;
off when the system is set;
switches on when the keys are pressed,
3=
on during setting and unsetting;
switches on when keys are pressed;
switches off after keypad timeout and when menu is exited,
4=
switches on when keys are pressed;
switches off after keypad timeout and when menu is exited.
5 = Keypad Mute
This option allows the bleep which normally accompanies a valid keypress to be disabled. This features
improves security and reduces tampering with the keypad when it is located in a public place.
When the Mute option is set to 1 = On, whenever the keypad banner is displayed the keypresses are silent,
there are no s displayed as each key is pressed and the keypad backlighting remains off. As soon as a valid
code is entered the keypad returns to normal operation - the keys are accompanied by bleeps and the
backlighting switched on. The Mute option defaults to disabled (0 = Off).
Keypad Disable
A keypad may be disabled by programming the address of the keypad as a link destination (refer to menu
option 54 - Links). When the source of the link is activated the keypad does not respond to any keypress,
however, the LCD, keypad buzzer and any keypad output device acts as normal.
6-153
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
58 - Keypad (cont’d)
6 = Show Status
This option allows the keypad to display the set status of the groups. When Show Status is enabled, pressing
the and # keys simultaneously when the normal banner is displayed indicates the group set status.
F = Fault
STATUS 12345678
R = Ready
Groups RRSRLPFP
S = Set
P = Part Set
L = Locked Out
Group block
- = Group not assigned to Keypad
NOTE: The Show Status indicates the set conditions of groups when the system is set (keypad blank) or
unset (normal banner). Show Status does not operate while engineer mode is accessed.
Pressing the and # keys again toggles the display to show the status of the groups individually. To move
between each groups, press the and A or the and B keys simultaneously.
Pressing the
and # keys again returns the keypad to the banner display.
Multi-group Systems
The larger Galaxy panels have 32 groups; these are displayed on the keypad in block of eight groups, subdivided into A, B, C and D. Press the A or B key to display each of the group blocks.
7 = Keypad Groups
Each keypad can be assigned to selected groups; the keypad then responds only to user codes that have a
group common to it and only displays alarm information on the groups assigned.
Entering a user code which is assigned to all groups, on a keypad which is only assigned to a single group,
allows access to all of the user’s groups. The user is not restricted by the groups that are assigned to the
keypad as long as there is one group common to both. This means that a keypad assigned only to group 1, for
example, can be used to set groups 1, 2, 3 and 4 by a code with all of these groups allocated.
Keypad Group Restriction
To restrict access only to groups that are common to both the user and the keypad, press the key when
assigning groups to the keypad. This means that when a user with access to groups 1, 2 and 3 sets the system
on a keypad assigned to groups 2, 3 and 4, only the common groups (groups 2 and 3) are set.
Assigning Keypad Groups
On selecting the Keypad Groups option, the groups currently allocated to the keypad are displayed (the default
is all groups assigned). Pressing the group number toggles the group assigned to the keypad.
Multi-group Systems
The larger Galaxy panels have 32 groups; these are displayed on the keypad in block of eight groups, sub-divided
into A, B, C and D. Use the A or B key to move between the group blocks; press keys 1 – 8 to assign the
relevant groups in each block to the user.
When the required groups have been assigned to the user, press the ent key to accept the programming and
return to the previous menu level.
NOTE: Also see menu 53, to control the buzzer operation on each keypad. This is independent of the
keypad group parameter.
6-154
59 - Quick Menu
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Option 59 – Quick Menu
The Galaxy quick menu consists of up to 10 menu options that are accessed by all type 2.3 (and above) user
codes that do not have a assigned to their code type. This option allows the quick menu to be reprogrammed to any selection of the menu options. The Quick Menu defaults to a factory selection as shown in
the following table:
User
Type
Menu Option
0
Omit Zones
11
2.3
1
Forced Set
14
2.3
2
Chime
15
2.3
3
Display Zones
21
2.4
4
Display Log
22
2.4
5
Print
24
2.4
6
Walk Test
31
2.5
7
Time/Date
41
3.6
8
Codes
42
2.1
9
Summer
43
3.6
Table 6-26. Quick Menu Options
Modifying the Quick Menu
On selecting the Quick Menu option, the details of the first option assigned to the quick menu are displayed;
this includes the quick menu location, the menu option assigned, the full menu option number and the current
user type assigned to the option.
Quick Menu location
0=OMIT ZONES
Option=[11] L=3
Menu Options
User level
Full Menu option number
Select the quick menu number to be modified by entering the option number 0 – 9 or by using the A and B
keys and then pressing ent. The display indicates the quick menu location and the full menu option number
currently assigned.
To modify the quick menu, enter the full menu option number 11 – 71 or press the A and B keys until the
required menu option is displayed; press the ent key to accept the selection and return to the previous menu
type. To delete a quick menu option, press the key instead of a menu option number;
=NOT USED is
displayed.
The system arranges the quick menu in order of lowest user type access required, therefore if quick menu
number 0 is assigned a menu option which is of a higher access type than options 2, 3 and 4, the menu is
rearranged and the display indicates that the option is now number 4.
NOTE: Assigning duplicate quick menu options is denied. The message DUPLICATE ENTRY is displayed
and the system prompts for a new option to be assigned.
6-155
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
61 - Diagnostics
Engineer 2
Option 61 – Diagnostics
This option allows several diagnostic tests to be run on the system, providing valuable information on the
operational status of the Galaxy and connected modules.
The Galaxy diagnostic option performs a number of checks including:
the communication integrity between the Galaxy panel and modules on the system.
•
voltage measurements.
•
current measurements.
•
resistance measurements
•
module version checks
•
panel memory checks
•
fuse checks
This option is split into two sections: Latest and Historical.
Latest gives real time diagnostic information for the Galaxy system.
Historical allows a snapshot of the Galaxy system diagnostic status to be generated and saved.
1 Latest
The Diagnostic options are:
1. MEMORY TEST - This option forces a check of the panel memory.
2. KEYPAD COMMS - the communication level between the Galaxy panel and the keypads.
3. RIO COMMS - the voltage and version at each RIO as well as the communication level between the
Galaxy panel and the RIO.
4. PSU COMMS - the voltage at each Galaxy Dimension Power Supply Unit and the communication level
between the Galaxy panel and the SPSUs. It is identical to the RIO COMMS diagnostic with the
exception that it also indicates the current output from the SPSU, fuse status and battery status.
A number to the right of the current indicates a blown fuse:
2 = Battery fuse (F1)
3 = +12V Auxilliary 1 fuse (F4)
4 = +12V Auxilliary 2 fuse (F3).
5 = Not Used
6 = On-board Bell Fuse (F2)
A indication means low battery or a missing battery.
95% 2 13.6V 1.9A.
6-156
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
61 - Diagnostics (cont’d)
Pressing the # key gives 7 different displays in the following order:
1. The system status in volts and current draw are displayed.
2. The battery standby time and the battery charge time are displayed. The standby time is the estimated
time that the battery can power the panel or smart PSU if the AC power should fail. It is based on the
actual current draw and the battery size (parameter 51.36). An exclamation mark is displayed after
standby time if the battery cannot support the panel or smart PSU for the time specified in parameter 51.37 = Standby Time.
Standby Time 8h
Charge Time
4h
3. The status of the AC power and battery are displayed. Also, if available, the lowest voltage during the
last battery load test.
4. This displays the battery charging voltage and current information. The panel and Galaxy Dimension
PSU will also display the current charging state after Battery. This is either Charging or Charged.
5. This displays the battery load test. It is only available for the on-board PSU.
Pressing the ent key again initiates a system wide battery load test. This test is only available for RIO
100 and 101.
6. This displays the AUX1 volts and current draw.
7. This displays the AUX2 volts and current draw.
NOTE: The current reading for the auxilliary supply is the total current of AUX1 and AUX2. The
current display on the keypad for AUX1 or AUX2 is the combined reading of both.
5. MAX COMMS - the communication level between the Galaxy panel and the MAX/DCM readers.
6. COMM MODULES - the communication level between the Galaxy panel and the Int Telecoms, the
Int RS232, the Audio Module and Mux Modules.
Audio Module
100% CM08 V 1 . 0
Press #
Audio Module
100% CM08 13.72V
To access the MUX module diagnostics press the asterisk key when the keypad display shows the diagnostics
for the audio interface. Then use the arrow key to scroll between each MUX module. To exit the menu, to
return to the other comms modules diagnostics, press the escape key once.
7. ZONES - the status of each zone can be viewed.
8. DCM ZONES - the status of each DCM zone can be viewed.
6-157
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
61 - Diagnostics (cont’d)
2 Historical
This option allows a full diagnostic baseline to be performed on the complete Galaxy system, including power
supplies and peripherals. There are 5 selectable options:
1 = View
This option allows any stored baseline data to be viewed from option 61.2.3 = Record.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
MEMORY TEST - As latest.
KEYPAD COMMS - Snapshot value from last test.
RIO COMMS - Snapshot value from last test.
PSU COMMS - Snapshot value from last test.
MAX COMMS - Snapshot value from last test.
COMM MODULES - Snapshot value from last test.
ZONES - Snapshot value from last test. The * key allows printing of results.
DCM ZONES - snapshot value from last test.
2 = Timeline
This option shows the time and date when the last check was carried out for each of the areas listed in the
following table:
AREA
DATA GATHERED
1 = Batt Size
Battery size in Ah
2 = Batt RF
The battery status of all RF devices. Shows
LOW if not ok.
3 = PSU Volts
The voltage level of all Smart PSU's on the
system including on-board PSU's
4 = RIO Volts
The voltage level of all Smart PSU's on the
system including the on-board RIOs
5 = Zone Ohms
The current resistance across all zones on
the system. For RF zones - signal strength
and time since supervision
6 = Communication
Type of device, address, and the% level with
all peripherals on the system
7 = Panel memory
A check of the panel memory
8 = Total amps
the total current draw for all Smart PSU's on
the system, including the on-board PSU.
This included aux current and battery current
9 = Batt Volts
Voltage level of the battery connected to the
control panel
Table 6-27. Historical Timeline
3 = Record
This option initiates a baseline check of areas 1 to 7 in the table above. The dispay prompts the user to press
the * key to continue with the diagnostic check.
4 = Checks
This option allows each of the areas 1 to 9 listed in the table above to be included or excluded from the
baseline recording. All areas are included by default.
5 = Print
This option allows the stored baseline data to be printed using either the printer module or the on-board
RS232 port.
6-158
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
62 - Full Test
Option 62 – Full Test
The Full Test option allows two zones to be selected and tested under full set conditions. Activating the
selected zone results in a full alarm condition, including remote signalling. Constantly active zones (Security,
24 Hours, PA, Fire) remain active throughout the Full Test; an activation generates the appropriate local or
full alarm depending on the zone.
On selecting the Full Test option, the address and function of the first zone on the system is displayed. Move
to the required zone by pressing the A or B keys or by entering the zone address. Press the ent key. An
option is then given to choose a second confirm zone. If you press the A (YES) key, select a second required
zone by pressing the ent key. If you press the B (NO) key, the system begins the full setting procedure.
Activating the zone results in a full alarm condition. To end the full test unset the system.
6-159
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
63 - Options
Option 63 – Options
The Options function allows the Galaxy to be divided into group subsystems.
Options
1 = Groups
1 = Group Mode
0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
2 = Setting Logic
A/B to move to group and ent to select.
Number keys to toggle:
- = status of group unimportant
S = Group must be set to allow group to set.
3 = Group Name
A/B to move to group and ent to select.
# = toggle upper case, lower case or library text.
* = delete last character.
A/B = move to character/word.
ent = assign character/word.
esc = save programming.
Figure 6-12. Options
63.1=Groups
On selecting Options, the keypad displays 1 = Groups; press the ent key to select this function.
1 = Group Mode
This option is used to enable the Groups function (default is 0 = Disabled). When enabled, the system
options that are eligible for group programming are then made available throughout the menu, otherwise they
do not appear.
Enabling Groups
On selecting 1 = Enabled, press the ent key to accept the programming and return to the previous menu
type.
NOTE: You must return to the Engineer Mode banner for groups to be fully enabled.
Disabling Groups
The Group Disabled feature operates as follows:When disable groups is selected in menu option 63.1.1 two option are given:1.
Reset Groups
2.
Disabled
If option 1 - Reset Groups is selected the engineer is prompted to confirm the selection. If confirmed, by
pressing the enter key, all group programming, for all the panel features, are reset to A1. When engineering
mode is exited a warning message is displayed (ATT!!! GRPS OFF, SYS. OP. IMPACT) alerting the
engineer that groups have been reset and there will be an impact on the operation of all functions not programmed as group A1. This warning message will be displayed until the ESC key is pressed by the engineer,
acknowledging the warning.
NOTE: When group programming is re-enabled all previous group programming will not be restored.
6-160
63 - Options (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
If option 2 - Disabled is selected the engineer is prompted to confirm the selection. If confirmed, by pressing
the enter key, all group programming, other than A1 will be disabled (zones, outputs, links, users). When
engineering mode is exited a warning message is displayed (ATT!!! GRPS OFF, SYS. OP. IMPACT)
alerting the engineer that groups have been disabled and there will be an impact on the operation of all areas
not programmed as group A1. This warning message is displayed until the ESC key is pressed by the engineer, acknowledging the warning.
NOTE: If this option is selected, when group mode is re-enabled all previous group programming will be
restored. However, while group mode is disabled, a zone not programmed to group A1 will not
operate normally on the system. It is strongly recommended that, whenever possible, groups are
always reset to A1 when disabling groups.
2 = Setting Logic
The Setting Logic option restricts a group from setting by determining which other groups must be set before
it can set. For example, group 1 may be prohibited for setting unless groups 3, 7 are already set. The Setting Logic is individually defined for each group.
Programming Setting Logic
On selecting the Setting Logic option, group 1 is displayed. Use the A or B keys to move to the required
group or directly select it by pressing the required group number; press the ent key to access the group. On
selecting the group, the current Setting Logic details are displayed:
•
S below a group means that it must be set to allow the selected group to set
•
a dash (–) below the group indicates that the set status of this group is not important.
Toggle the status between S and – by pressing the number key. When the required setting logic pattern has
been defined press the ent key to accept the programming and return to the previous menu type.
Multi-group Systems
The larger Galaxy panels have 32 groups; these are displayed on the keypad in block of eight groups, subdivided into A, B, C and D:
Group Block
Physical Groups
A1-8
1-8
B1-8
9-16
C1-8
17-24
D1-8
25-32
Table 6-28. Groups
Use the A or B key to move between the group blocks; press keys 1 – 8 to toggle the Setting Logic for the
relevant groups in each block.
6-161
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
63 - Options (cont’d)
Setting Logic Operation
If Setting Logic has been assigned to a group, the set status of the groups must satisfy the conditions defined
in the option to permit the group to set. If the Setting Logic conditions are not satisfied, then the group
cannot set. If multiple groups are being set simultaneously, but one group is restricted due to the programmed
Setting Logic, the remainder of the groups set. The restricted group does not set; there is no warning or
indication given.
If the programmed Setting Logic results in none of the selected groups being allowed to set, a warning
message is displayed on the keypad.
2 Groups not set
[<],[>]
to view
This message does not appear if at least one group sets.
3 = Group Name
This option is used to assign a name of up to 12 characters to each of the groups. This name is assembled
from the character set and/or library options. On selecting the Group Name option, the name currently
assigned to group 1 is displayed. All group names default to Group X (where X is the group number). Use
the A or B keys to move to the required group or directly select it by pressing the required group number;
press the ent key to access the group. On selecting the group, the following details are displayed:
Current Group name
Upper case text.
# to toggle upper case/
lower case/library
A2 Group Name
EFG HIJKLMNÖØOP
The currently assigned name is displayed on the top line - an underscore shows where the next character will
be positioned, and a selection of the alphabet is shown on the bottom line - the cursor flashes on the letter L.
Press the
key to erase the characters already assigned to the name.
The A or B keys can be used to move the alphabet left or right until the required character is positioned
underneath the flashing cursor. When the required character is in position press the ent key to copy the character to the descriptor in the top line. Repeat this procedure to assemble the required Group Name.
Text Case & Library
On entering the Group Name option the alpha-numeric characters are all presented in upper case. Pressing
the # key toggles the characters to lower case.
Pressing the # key when the lower case alphanumeric characters are displayed toggles to the library words.
The words can be viewed using the A or B keys or directly selected using the reference number - refer to
Appendix A - Library. When the required word is displayed, press the ent key to copy it to the name.
NOTE: Library words are a maximum of 12 characters and upper case only.
6-162
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
63 - Options (cont’d)
Group Name Display
When viewing the groups assigned to an option, for example user code or outputs, simultaneously pressing the
# and keys displays the groups individually. The keypad displays the group number, name and the status of
the particular option being displayed. Press the # key to toggle the status of the group. To move to another
group press the A or B keys or enter the number of the group directly.
Current group name
Selected group
A or B key to move
to other group
A2 Sales Dept
S
[<],[>],#=CHANGE
Status of group
# key to toggle status
Notes on Groups
1. All zones default to group 1.
2. All keypads, user codes and outputs default to all system groups assigned.
3. Remove unused groups from user codes, otherwise the unused groups will set and unset even though
they are not programmed.
4. Final, Keyswitch and Exit can be programmed to function in regard to other groups during the
setting and unsetting procedures (refer to option 52 = PROGRAM ZONES).
5. Outputs can be assigned to any selection of groups. Output activation can be made dependent on the
set or unset status of the assigned groups (refer to option 53 = PROGRAM OUTPUTS).
6. After programming zones, codes, keypads and outputs into their various groups they remain programmed if the Group Mode function is disabled. Only Group 1 remains active.
7. The Galaxy control panels have multi-user software that allow several users to operate the system
simultaneously.
6-163
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
64 - Assemble Zones
Option 64 – Assemble Zone
The Assemble Zones option allows 2 zone functions to be customised to the user’s requirements; these are
the 1 Custom-A and 2 Custom-B zones. Once a custom zone function has been assembled, it is assigned to
zones using option 52 = PROGRAM ZONES.
Programming a Custom Zone
The flexibility of this menu option allows for an extensive range of possibilities. It is therefore important that
the engineer is fully aware of the system and has a clear picture of what is required of the new zone function.
The procedure for assembling a custom zone has 4 stages:
1. Outputs
2. Status
3. Setting
4. Log
1 = Outputs
Output Type:
Disabled
S et
Unset
Set/Unset
A/B – select output type
# – toggle between Disabled, Set, Unset
& Set/Unset
esc – save programming
2 = Status
1 = Unset
Disabled
Alarm
# – toggle between Disabled and Alarm
esc – save programming
2 = Entry/Exit
Disabled
Alarm
3 = Part Set
Disabled
Alarm
4 = Full Set
Disabled
Alarm
1 = B egi n S et
Disabled
Enabled
2 = Begin Entry
Disabled
Enabled
3 = Sets
System
Disabled
Enabled
3 = Setting
4 = Log
Disabled
Entry Exit
24 Hours
Alarms
# – toggle between Disabled and
Enabled
esc – save programming
# – toggle between Disabled, Entry/Exit,
24 Hours & Alarms esc – save
programming
Table 6-29. Programming a custom Zone
6-164
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
64 - Assemble Zones (cont’d)
1 = Outputs
Any of the available output types can be assigned to the custom zone. On selecting this attribute the
01=BELLS output type is displayed along with it status; the default status is disabled. The status indicates the
conditions under which the custom zone activates the output. To assign the output type status press the # key,
this toggles between each of the status settings:
1.
Disabled
the output is not activated by the custom zone,
2
Set
the output is activated by the custom zone only when the system is set,
3
Unset
the output is activated by the custom zone only when the system is unset,
4.
Set/Unset
the output is activated by the custom zone when the system is both set and unset.
Select the output types to be assigned by pressing the A and B keys or by entering the number of the required
output type and assign the required status. When all of the output types have been selected, press the esc key
to return the previous menu level.
For a full list of output types refer to option 53 = Program Outputs.
2 = Status
The Status attribute determines the system conditions that custom zone is operational in. The four Status
attributes are:
1.
Unset
activates an alarm when the system is unset,
2.
Entry/Exit
activates an alarm when the system is setting and unsetting,
3.
Part Set
activates an alarm when the system is part set,
4.
Full Set
activates an alarm when the system is full set.
The default for each of the Status attributes is disabled. To enable the zone to activate an alarm, select the
required Status attribute using the A or B keys and press the # key; the display indicates that a custom zone
activation while the system is in the selected Status will create an Alarm condition and switch on the assigned
outputs.
NOTE: The custom zone can be operational in all four Status conditions if required.
6-165
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
64 - Assemble Zones (cont’d)
3 = Setting
The Setting attribute determines the function (if any) that the custom zone has in setting and unsetting the
system.
1.
Begin Set
if enabled, the custom zone starts the setting procedure,
2.
Begin Entry
if enabled, the custom zone starts the unsetting procedure,
3.
Sets System
if enabled, the custom terminates the setting procedure.
The default for each of the Setting attributes is disabled. To enable the options, select the required Setting
attribute using the A or B keys and press the # key; the display indicates that attribute is ENABLED for the
custom zone.
NOTE: The custom zone can be assigned all three Setting attributes if required, however, it is recommended
that either attribute 1 (Begin Set) or 3 (Sets System) is enabled, but not both.
4 = Log
This attribute determines which custom zone activations are logged. On selecting Log the current selection is
displayed. To change the selection press the # key, this toggles between the Log options;
Disabled
the custom zone activations are not logged,
Entry/Exit the custom zone activations only log during the setting and unsetting procedure,
24 Hours all custom zone activations log (both in the set and unset states)
Alarms
the custom zone only logs when an activation results in an alarm condition.
NOTE:
The opening (+) and closing (–) of custom zones are recorded in the event log.
6-166
64 - Assemble Zones (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Assemble Zone Example:
Assemble a zone that:
• activates Bells outputs when the system is set,
• activates Link-A outputs when the system is unset,
• generates an alarm condition when the system is part and full set,
• does not generate an alarm condition during the setting and unsetting procedure,
• acts as a terminator when the system is setting,
• logs all activation (in both set and unset states).
Programming:
(Assuming factory default settings)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
Select option 64 = ASSEMBLE ZONES; press the ent key,
Select custom zone (1 = Custom-A, 2 = Custom-B); press the ent key,
Outputs is displayed. Press the ent key to select this option,
Bells is displayed. Press the # key. Set is displayed,
Enter 51. Link-A is displayed. Press the # key. Set is displayed,
Press the # key. Unset is displayed,
Press the esc key. Outputs is displayed,
Press the A key. Status is displayed. Press the ent key to select this option,
Unset Disabled is displayed,
Press the A key. Entry/ Exit Disabled is displayed,
Press the A key. Part Set Disabled is displayed,
Press the # key. Part Set Alarm is displayed,
Press the A key. Full Set Disabled is displayed,
Press the # key. Full Set Alarm is displayed,
Press the esc key. Status is displayed,
Press the A key. Setting is displayed. Press the ent key to select this option,
Begin Set Disabled is displayed,
Press the A key. Sets System Disabled is displayed,
Press the # key. Sets System Enabled is displayed,
Press the esc key. Setting is displayed,
Press the A key. Log is displayed. Press the ent key to select this option,
Log Disabled is displayed,
Press the # key. Log Entry/Exit is displayed,
Press the # key. Log 24 Hours is displayed,
Press the esc key three times to return to the 64 = ASSEMBLE ZONES display.
6-167
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
65 - Timers
Option 65 – Timers
The Timer s menu are as follows:
65 = Timers
1 = Weekly
Schedule
(01-67)
1 = Name (12 alpha-numeric)
2 = Status
0 = Off
1 = On
3 = Events
Use A or B key to select timer
then press ent.
:
W01-67
[>], [<], #, 0-9,
A(>), B(>) key to program day (Mon - Sun)
# to toggle ON/OFF status
0-9 keys to enter time
to delete programming
**** *** ** **
*
2 = Timer
Outputs
4 = Holiday
Period
00-32 (00=None)
5 = Holiday
Schedule
01-67 schedules
6 = Pattern day
1 = Mon
2 = Tue
3 = Wed
4 = Thu
5 = Fri
1 = Timer A
2 = Timer B
3 = Autoset
(groups)
Use A or B keys to
select group and
press ent.
1 = Status
0 = Off
1 = On
2 = Weekly
Schedule
01-67 schedules
1 = Status
0 = Off
1 = On
2 = Weekly
Schedule
01-67 schedules
1 = Status
2 = Prewarning
0 = Off
1 = On
2 = Monitor
1 = Period
30 (0-50) mins
2 = Audible
0 = Off
1 = On
3 = Extension
030 (0-400) mins
4 = Force Set
0 = Off
1 = On
5 = Weekly
Schedule
01-67 schedules
6 = Lockout
Status
7 = Lockout
Schedule
Figure 6-13. Timers
6-168
0 = Off
1 = On
01-67 schedules
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
65 - Timers (cont’d)
The Galaxy Dimension control panel provides programming of timer schedules on a weekly basis. Each event
corresponds to an ON or an OFF time. The state of the schedule is ON or OFF depending on the last event
that was reached.
Timers can be assigned to:
• Individual users to disable them
• Individual doors to lock them
• Individual groups for autoset
• Outputs for automatic activation.
NOTE: The ON period is the secure period for a particular schedule when users will be unable to gain access
to allocated areas and the Autoset and Lockout features for allocated groups are enabled.
The Timers menu Structure is as follows:
65.1 = Weekly Schedule
A weekly schedule consists of a selection of daily time programs for each day of the week. The state of the
weekly schedule is ON or OFF depending on the last event that was reached. Up to 67 weekly schedules
with 28 time slots are available for programming depending on panel variant
The weekly schedules are used to control various panel features:
•
Auto setting
•
Lockout times
•
User access times
•
Timer Outputs
1 = Name
A maximum 12 character alpha-numeric name can be entered here for a weekly schedule.
2 = Status
The status of the each of the timers is shown here whether 0 = OFF or 1 = ON. To change the status press
the A or B key or press 1 to select ON or 2 to select OFF.
3 = Events
This option programs the weekly timer events with Day (Mon-Sun) and ON/OFF times.
NOTE: The number of weekly timer events is dependent on panel variant.
Programming Timer Events
1
Enter the Weekly Schedule menu. The first timer is displayed.
2
Go to 3 = Events and press enter. The programmed status (if any) of the first timer is displayed.
3
If the timer has not been programmed then the following window appears on the keypad:
First timer
W01*** *** **:**
6-169
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
65 - Timers (cont’d)
4
To enter a new timer program for W01 do the following:
•
Press ent to select the timer.
•
Press the A or B keys to select the day (MON to SUN).
•
Press the # key to select the status ON or OFF.
•
Press the number keys (0-9) to select the first time (4 digit 24 hour format) on the top row.
•
Press ent to accept the programming. The following typical window is displayed:
W01MON ON
5
08:30
To program the OFF time on the bottom row repeat step 4. The following typical window is displayed:
W01MON ON
MON OFF
6
08:30
17:00
Press the esc key three times to escape from the Timers option.
NOTE: The Timer Status can be switched On and Off by users via option 45 = TIMER CONTROL.
4 = Holiday Period
This is the holiday period programmed in 45.2.1. Timer Control.Holidays.Modify Dates. Up to 32 holiday
periods can be viewed with this option.
5 = Holiday Schedule
This is an alternative schedule that is used if option 45.2. Timer Control.Holidays is activated. The system
defines a selection of holiday dates (65.1.4) and then a schedule of times can be used on those dates under
this option. Up to 67 holiday schedules can be selected.
6 = Pattern Day
The Pattern Day can only be allocated by the engineer. This option determines the programmed timers that
are effective when the Weekend Day option (45.6.1) is selected by the user; the timers of the selected
Pattern Day are adopted by the days selected for weekend work.
On selecting this option the programmed Pattern Day is displayed; the default is 1 = MON. Use the A or B
keys to select the required day or days and press the ent key to accept the programming and return to the
previous menu level:
1
=
MON
2
=
TUE
3
=
WED
4
=
THU
5
=
FRI
6-170
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
65 - Timers (cont’d)
65.2 = Timer Outputs
Once the times have been programmed and the Status is set to 1=On, the Timer-A or Timer-B outputs
53.29 and 53.30 are activated at the On times and deactivated at the Off times programmed in
65.1=Weekly Schedule. User codes that they have been attributed to a Time Zone A or B are invalid
between an On time and the next Off time for the appropriate timer.
65.3 = Autoset
Each group can be programmed with up to 67 (dependent on panel variant) Autoset times over a 7 day
period. These can be combined in any order of On and Off times as required.
When the system has been set by the Autoset function, outputs programmed as Autoset (refer to option 53 =
PROGRAM OUTPUTS) are activated; the Set outputs are also activated.
Programming Autoset
If groups are enabled (refer to option 63 = OPTIONS) the keypads prompts for the group that the autoset
time is to be allocated to. Press the A or B keys to step through the groups until the required number is displayed and press the ent key.
NOTE: The group can be directly selected by entering the group number. Larger Galaxy systems have 32
groups; these are displayed in blocks of eight groups, sub-divided into A, B, C and D;
Group Block
Physical Groups
A1-8
1-8
B1-8
9-16
C1-8
17-24
D1-8
25-32
Table 6-30. Groups
Use the A or B key to select the required group (A1–D8). When the end of a block is reached, the next
block of eight groups is displayed; use keys 1–8 to assign the relevant group in the current block to the zone;
press the ent key to accept the selection.
Account Group Autosetting
The Galaxy Dimension allows Account Group autosetting. This means that several groups can be bound
together into one account group and, instead of a sending a normal CA event, the panel sends a CL event.
Refer to menu option 56.1.2.2.2 = Communications.Internal Telecoms.Format.SIA.Group
Settings.Account No.
6-171
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
65 - Timers (cont’d)
There are five stages to programming the Autoset function:
1. Autoset Status
0 = Off (default)
1 = On
2 = Monitor - if selected, the setting and unsetting of the group is monitored:
• if not set manually before the On time, then the Set Late output is activated
• if unset before the Off time, then the Unset Early output is activated.
2. Prewarning
1 = Period
0 – 50 minutes (default 30 minutes):
2 = Audible (this can be turned ON or OFF)
This option determines the warning period given to users prior to the system autosetting. Outputs programmed
as Prewarning activate during the prewarning period. The output normally emits a constant tone, however if
an extension is not possible, then a pulsed tone is emitted and prewarn activates at the Autoset time. At the
end of the prewarning period, the system begins the timed setting procedure.
NOTE: Pressing the esc key at any time during the prewarning resets and restarts the prewarning countdown. If more than one group is in the prewarning period, each group can be viewed by pressing *
and > or * and <.
3. Extension
0 – 400 minutes (default 30 minutes):
An autoset Extension can be assigned to each group on the system - programmed with different values per
group. Entering a user code during the Prewarning delays the autosetting by the period assigned to the
Extension.
NOTE: The Late Working option (refer to option 45 = TIMERS) authorizes an Extension in advance of
the Prewarning period.
Late Set appears if the system is not set after prewarn time plus 300 seconds (longest possible exit delay)
An Extension cannot be granted once the timed setting procedure begins.
4. Force Set
0 = Off (default)
1 = On
As a factory preset, any zone that is open at the start of the setting procedure - except Final, Exit, Entry, or
Push Set, (or Secure Final or Part Final when acting as a Final) - is omitted by the autoset routine whether
or not it is omittable. If one of the above listed zones is open and is non-omittable, on expiry of the time
programmed in the Fail-to-Set parameter the Fail-to-Set outputs are activated along with a full alarm.
6-172
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
65 - Timers (cont’d)
5. Weekly Schedule
This option assigns a programmed weekly schedule for each group when the selected group is automatically
switched On (Autoset) and Off (Autounset).
When the keyswitch is activated twice during the exit time of an autoset, the autoset is temporarily cancelled
for a few seconds, then it restarts the exit time causing the panel to reset.
Operating a keyswitch zone type during the pre-warn period of an autoset will start a Force Set. If you then
activate the switch again (i.e. unset with keyswitch) before the panel sets, the pre-warn continues on the
autoset.
NOTE: When the keyswitch is activated the second time to take panel back into pre-warn, it can be up to
10 seconds before the pre-warn tones at the keypad start up again.
Lockout
Each group can be allocated with up to 67 (dependent on panel variant) Lockout schedules over a seven day
period. These can be combined in any order of On and Off times as required.
If Lockout has been assigned to a group, the group is locked-out at the Lockout On time or when the group
sets - whichever occurs first. Outputs programmed as Lockout are active while the system is locked out - this
will not always correspond to the times assigned to the Lockout depending on whether the group sets prior to
Lockout On. When a group is locked-out the setting status indicates that it cannot be unset by displaying
an L.
G R O U P S 12345678
LLLUULLS
6-173
65 - Timers (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
During the Lockout period, the group can not be unset unless an alarm has been activated in the group. In the
event of an alarm occurring during the Lockout period, any valid type 2.3 (or above) code assigned to the
group in alarm may be used to unset and/or reset the group. If multiple locked-out groups are in an alarm
condition entry of a single valid code (type 2.3 or above with access to the relevant groups) cancels the alarms
and unsets the activated groups.
The group can only be manually unset once in each Lockout Off period. If no Lockout times are programmed, the group may be unset at any time.
Codes are not affected by Lockout, and can be used to gain access to the menus and to manually set the
group.
Programming Lockout
There are two stages to programming the Lockout function. These are options 6 = Lockout Status and
7 = Lockout Schedule of the Autoset programming menu:
6 = Lockout Status
The lockout status has to be set to On before the lockout schedule will function.
0 = Off (default)
1 = On
7 = Lockout Schedule
This option allocates the automatic lockout time schedule OFF (Unlock) and On (Lockout) for the selected
group. Up to 67 weekly schedules are available which are programmed in 65.1=Weekly Schedule.
6-174
66 - Pre-Check
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Option 66 – Pre-checks
The Pre-Check option provides added system security by alerting the user to zones that may not be operating
correctly.
NOTE: Pre-check does not operate when the system is in the engineer mode.
Testing Zones
16 CHECK ZONES
A=VIEW
The Entry/Exit Horns beep once when each zone is tested. As each zone is successfully tested, the keypad
indicates the number that remain to be tested. When the last zone is successfully tested the Entry/Exit Horn
sounds twice and the keypad displays 0 CHECK ZONES; press the ent key to resume the system routine.
1 = Mode
The Mode determines the pre-check level that the selected zones are subjected to before the system can set.
The Mode is selected from one of the following:
1. Disabled (default): the pre-check option is disabled; even if zones are selected, they are not checked.
2. Warning: when the setting routine is started the user is informed of the number of selected pre-check
zones that have not been activated since the system was unset; press the A or B keys to view the zones.
Press the ent key to continue the setting routine. The zone that have not been activated do not have to be
tested.
3. Autocheck: when the setting routine is started the user is informed of the number of selected pre-check
zones that have not been activated since the system was unset and a warning is sounded; press the A or B
keys to view the zones. These zones must be tested before setting can be resumed.
4. Forced Check: when the setting routine is started the keypad indicates the number of pre-check zones
that are on the system; to view the pre-check zone addresses press the A or B keys. All of the preselected zones must be tested before setting can take place.
0 CHECK ZONES
ENT=VIEW
2 = Select Zones
On selecting 2 = Select Zones, the address and function of the first zone on the system is displayed. Move to
the required zone by pressing the A or B keys or by entering the zone address. To toggle the status of the precheck attribute of the zone press the # key; the keypad indicates that the zone is included in the pre-check by
displaying PRE-CHECK ZONE. Select other zones to be pre-checked in the same way. Once all of the
zones have been selected, press the esc key.
6-175
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
67 - Remote Reset
Option 67 – Remote Reset
The Remote Reset option allows a user to perform an engineer reset authorized by the Alarm Receiving
Centre (ARC). In the event of an alarm that requires an engineer reset, the keypad displays a number, which,
when quoted to the ARC is decoded and exchanged for a new number. When this new number is entered it
resets the Galaxy panel. Entering the engineer code also resets the Galaxy panel.
NOTE: The alarm conditions that require to be reset remotely must have the appropriate System Reset,
Tamper Reset or PA Reset parameters programmed for engineer reset (type 3.7).
Each alarm activation generates a random number, therefore, the number required to reset the panel changes
each activation. As ARCs have different decoding equipment, the appropriate reset system must be selected
from the following Remote Mode options:
0 = OFF (default).
1 = SMS - Southern Monitoring Service (4 digits).
2 = Technistore (5 digits) - requires a four digit local modifier (000 - 255) to be assigned.
3 = Microtech (6 digits) - requires a four digit local modifier (0000 - 9999) to be assigned.
NOTE: The local modifier for the Technistore or Microtech reset modes must be assigned after discussion
with the ARC.
6-176
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
68 - Menu Access
Option 68 – Menu Access
The Menu Access option is used to assign access types to each of the menu options. This allows code types
2.3 – 3.6 to have access to menu options to which they would normally have insufficient access rights.
On selecting this option, 11 = OMIT ZONES is displayed along with the current code types assigned (3456
default).
Levels
11=OMIT
3456
ZONES
Use the A or B key to select the required menu option or enter the option number directly and press the ent
key. The currently assigned types appear displayed on the top line of the display. The type maps default to the
standard access. To modify the types, press the required number keys; this toggles the access type numbers
on the bottom line of the display on and off.
Levels
3456
>–-5-
Press the ent key to save the programming and return to the previous menu level. If the level is assigned to the
option the number is displayed, if it has been removed a dash (–) is displayed.
For example, type 2.5 5 codes can be given access to menu 42 which would allow them to allocate codes.
Levels
42=CODES
––-6
Users can only allocate codes up to the type that they have been assigned. A type 2.4 user cannot assign a
user code as type 2.5.
NOTE: The following menu access types are fixed: option 48 = DATELOCK level 3.6, and option 68 =
MENU ACCESS engineer access (type 3.7 and 3.8).
6-177
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
69 - Access Control
Option 69 – Integrated Access Control
The Galaxy Dimension Access Control System is a complete security system. A choice can be made as to
which type of access control to use: either the MAX3 or the Door Control Module or both. The following
diagrams shows the programming options for the MAX3 and the Door Control Module.
69 = Access Control
1 = Mode
0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
2 = MAX
1 = MAX Address
A/B to select line
ent to start MAX search.
0 = On-line, ent then key 0 - 7 to readdress MAX.
1 = Standalone
2 = MAX Parameters
MAX XXX (select)
A/B to move to required MAX address.
# to display MAX address graphic.
ent to select:
1 = Descriptor
# = toggle upper case, lower case or library text.
* = delete last character
A/B = move to character/word
ent = assign character/word
esc = save programming
2 = Relay Duration
1 - 60 seconds (default = 05).
3 = Open Timeout
0 - 60 seconds (default = 10).
4 = Groups
1 = Alarm Group
2 = Group Restrict
3 = Exit group
5 = Emergencies
Enable or disable option. If group mode is enabled,
a separate enable is available for each group.
6 = AntiPassBack
1 = Mode
7 = Security
0 = Off
No antipassback restriction.
1 = Soft
Access is never denied but any violations
will be recorded in the event log.
2 = Hard
No access will be granted for a second
swipe within the antipassback period
following a valid swipe.
2 = Timeout
(0 - 60 minutes). Specifies the time that the
antipassback restrictions last for.
3 = Forgive
Allows the engineer to remove all antipassback
restrictions for the selected MAX. Use the
A>B< keys to select the reader address then
press enter to forgive.
1 = Nightlock
00-67 weekly schedules
2 = Unlock Time
00-67 weekly schedules
3 = Dual Mode
0 = Disabled
1 = Card and Card
2 = Card and Pin
4 = Dual Time - Option not available
8 = Menu Recall
1 = Menu Function (** = not used)
2 = Menu Mode
1 = Card Held
3 = Keypad
** = Keypad
# = enable/disable
cont'd on next page
Figure 6-14. Access Control Programming Structure (sheet 1)
6-178
69 - Access Control (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
69 = Access Control (cont'd)
3 = DCM
1 = DCM Parameters
DCM XXX (select)
1 = Descriptor ABCDE_ (9 characters)
2 = Operation
0 = Entry & Exit
1 = Entry & Entry
2 = Single Entry
3 = System Group
4 = Facility Code
1 = Code 1
2 = Code 2
3 = Code 3
4 = Code 4
5 = Reader (01 or 02)
01 = Descriptor (ABCDE_ 9 characters)
02 = Relay Duration - 0-60 seconds (default = 05)
03 = Open Timeout - 1-60 seconds (default = 10)
04 = Group
Config
1 = Alarm Group
2 = Group Restrict
3 = Exit Group
05 = Emergencies
06 = AntiPassBack
0 = Disabled, 1 = Enabled
1 = Mode
0 = Off
1 = Soft
2 = Hard
2 = Timeout 00 (0-60) minutes
3 = Forgive
07 = APB (by group)
08 = Security
1 = Nightlock
00-67 weekly schedules
2 = Unlock Time
00-67 weekly schedules
3 = Dual Mode
0 = Disabled
1 = Card and Card
2 = Card and Pin
4 = Dual Time - Option not available
09 = Menu Recall
1 = Menu Function 11-71 (** = not used)
2 = Menu Mode
1 = Triple Repeat
2 = Recall Button
3 = Keypad
** - Keypad
# = Enable
2 = Card Format
0 = 26bit
1 = Crp 1K 35bit
2 = 37bit no FC
3 = Northern 34 bit
4 = Custom
1 = Format Name
2 = Card Length
3 = Start Point
4 = User Field
1 = 26 Bit, 2 = 27 Bit, 3 = 32 Bit, 4 = 34 Bit
5 = 35 Bit, 6 = 37 Bit, 7 = 40 Bit
13 (1-33)
1 = Field Position 00 (1-13)
2 = Field Length 09 (1-13)
Figure 6-15. Access Control Programming Structure (sheet 2)
69.1 = Access Mode
The Access Control function can either be set to 0 = Disabled or 1 = Enabled. The default is Enabled.
The following pages describe the MAX menu programming functions followed by the Door Control Module
programming functions.
6-179
69 - Access Control (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
69.2 = MAX
This option is used to program the Galaxy MAX access control readers. The MAX can be fully integrated
into the system, communicating on the AB lines and fully utilising the facilities of the Galaxy control panel. If the
MAX is programmed as a standalone module, it is completely separate from the Galaxy; the panel does not
monitor the module or share any of the facilities or options with it.
When enabled, the options that are eligible for MAX programming are made available throughout the menu,
otherwise they do not appear or appear as Option not Available.
NOTE: If the MAX Mode is disabled following programming of MAX readers, the readers remain operational, however, no further programming, including assigning new MAX cards and fobs, is possible
until the mode is enabled.
69.2.1 = MAX Address
The address and the on-line or standalone status of the MAX Modules are assigned and modified using this
option. On selecting MAX Address the Galaxy searches for the MAX with the highest address. The Galaxy
3-48 prompt for the AB line (1-1); the Galaxy 3-96 and 3-264 prompt for the AB line (1-2); the Galaxy 3520 prompts for the AB line (1-4) that is to be searched. Select the line and press the ent key. On locating
the MAX, the keypad prompts for the TYPE of MAX to be assigned:
0 = On-Line
The MAX is fully integrated with the Galaxy system and communicates via the AB line,
sharing system resources and facilities
1 = Standalone The MAX operates as an entirely independent unit. The Galaxy does not monitor the MAX
for alarms, tampers or power failure.
The MAX can then be readdressed. The keypad displays the current address of the MAX and the range of
valid addresses. All MAX modules default to address 7, it is recommended that when adding MAX modules,
the first is redressed as 0, the second as 1 and so on.
Enter the new MAX address and press the ent key; the Galaxy then reprograms the address of the MAX.
The keypad indicates the old and new MAX addresses and the status of the reprogramming.
When the reprogramming is complete the MAX bleeps and the display returns to 2 = MAX Address.
Old address
7 –> 0 [24]
New address
Status of
reprogramming
69.2.2 = MAX Parameters
This option defines the individual operational features of each of the MAX modules. On selecting this option
the address of the first MAX on the system is displayed along with the descriptor currently assigned to it.
While the MAX3 address is displayed on the keypad, the address pattern on the MAX module is indicated by
the LEDs switching on. Pressing the # key displays a graphic on the keypad which corresponds to the LED
pattern on the MAX module.
The following figure shows the graphic display for both a MAX and a MicroMAX address as 26.
6-180
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
69 - Access Control (cont’d)
MicroMAX/MAX3 LEDs Displayed
MAX
MAX
26
Top (unused)
MAX LEDs Displayed
26
Bottom
The line numbers are represented by the top row in MAX and blocks 2nd and 3rd from the top in the
MicroMAX and the address numbers are represented by the bottom row of blocks in the MAX and the four
bottom blocks in the MicroMAX. The top LED on the MicroMAX is always off in this mode.
The combinations are shown in the following Figure:Line No.
1
2
3
4
Module Address
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Select the required MAX/MicroMAX address using the A and B keys or by entering the MAX/MicroMAX
address directly and pressing the ent key. The first MAX parameter, 1 = Description is displayed. Use the A
or B keys to move to the required parameter and press the ent key.
1 = Descriptor
This option is used to assign a name of up to 12 characters to each of the MAX modules. This name is assembled from the character set and/or library options. On selecting the Descriptor parameter the currently assigned name is displayed on the top line - an underscore shows where the next character will be positioned,
and a selection of the alphabet is shown on the bottom line - the cursor flashes on the letter L.
Press the
key to erase the characters already assigned to the name.
The A or B keys can be used to move the alphabet left or right until the required character is positioned
underneath the flashing cursor. When the required character is in position press the ent key to copy the character to the descriptor in the top line. Repeat this procedure to assemble the required Descriptor.
Text Case & Library
On entering the Descriptor parameter the alpha-numeric characters are all presented in upper case. Pressing
the # key toggles the characters to lower case.
Pressing the # key when the lower case alphanumeric characters are displayed toggles to the library words.
The words can be viewed using the A or B keys or directly selected using the reference number - refer to
Appendix A - Library. When the required word is displayed, press the ent key to copy it to the name.
Library words are a maximum of 12 characters and upper case only.
6-181
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
69 - Access Control (cont’d)
2 = Relay Duration
This is the period, following the user card swipe, that the MAX relay is activated allowing a door strike to be
unlocked and the door to be opened without creating an alarm. The MAX relay de-activates as soon as the
door contact opens or the Open Timeout occurs.
On entering the Relay Duration parameter, the current value is displayed; assign the required time within the
range 01 – 60 seconds, the default time is 5 seconds. Press the ent key to save the programming and return
to the previous menu level.
NOTE: Pressing the A key increases the time by one second increments, the B key decreases the time in one
second decrements.
3 = Open Timeout
This is the period following the user card swipe that the door can remain open when gaining access. If the
door remains open longer than the period assigned to the Open Timeout, then an alarm occurs.
NOTE: If the Open Timeout is programmed as 0 seconds, then the door can remain open indefinitely
without resulting in an alarm being activated.
On entering the Open Timeout parameter, the current value is displayed; assign the required time within the
range 00 – 60 seconds, the default time is 10 seconds. Press the ent key to save the programming and return
to the previous menu level.
NOTE: Pressing the A key increases the time by one second increments, the B key decreases the time in one
second decrements.
4 = Group Config
1=Alarm Group
On selecting the Alarm Group option, the group currently allocated to the MAX is displayed. Pressing
the group number toggles the group assigned to the MAX. The MAX does not allow access through
the door when the group is set. A user must have this group assigned to them in order to gain access at
this door.
Multi-group Systems
The larger galaxy panels have 32 groups; these are displayed on the MAX in block of 8 groups, sub-divided
into A, B, C and D. Use the A or B key to move between the group blocks; press keys 1 – 8 to assign the
relevant groups in each block to the MAX.
When the required groups have been assigned to the user, press the ent key to accept the programming and
return to the previous menu level.
6-182
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
69 - Access Control (cont’d)
2=Group Restrict
Each MAX module can be assigned selected groups using the Group Restriction option. This group restriction affects the operation of the MAX readers for card held functions. A card can only be used at a reader if
there are common groups between them. By default each reader is assigned to all groups on the system.
Groups can be removed as required to restrict the operation of the MAX reader.
NOTE: Each MAX card can be assigned a single menu function (refer to option 42 = CODES). Activating
this function with a card that is assigned to all groups, on a MAX that is only assigned to a single
group, results in the function operating on all of the card’s groups. The MAX function is not restricted to the groups assigned to the MAX, it is restricted to the groups assigned to the card, as
long as there is one group common to both. This means that a MAX assigned only to group 1, for
example, can be used to activate the MAX function on groups 1, 2, 3 and 4 by a card with all of
these groups allocated. The groups are assigned to the MAX card using option 42 = CODES.
In access mode access will be granted if there are common groups between the card and the MAX reader
and all the groups assigned to the card are unset. For the card held function, the groups affected by the function will be all the groups assigned to the card, so long as there is at least one common group between the
card and the MAX.
Common Group Restriction
The group restrictions can be enhanced further by pressing the key when assigning group in Group Restriction. This limits the operation described in the paragraph above only to groups which are common to both the
MAX and the card.
Refer to the following table for examples of how the readers respond to different situations with the Common
Group Restriction on and off. The card held function used in the example is “Timed Set”.
Action on card held
Situation at time of card sw ipe
No 7
7 On Group Restriction
All groups unset
All groups on card start to
se t
All common groups start to
se t
All groups set
All groups on card are unset
All common groups are
unset
Common groups unset and one or
more groups on card set
Groups on card are unset
Common groups are set
One or more common groups set,
other groups unset
All groups on card are unset
All common groups are
unset
Table 6-31. Card Held Function Set up for Setting
6-183
69 - Access Control (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Assigning Groups to Group Restriction
On selecting the Groups option, the groups currently allocated to the MAX are displayed. Pressing the group
number toggles the group assigned to the MAX.
Larger Galaxy panels have 32 groups; these are displayed on the MAX in blocks of eight groups, sub-divided
into A, B, C and D. Use the A or B key to move between the group blocks; press keys 1 – 8 to assign the
relevant groups in each block to the MAX.
When the required groups have been assigned to the user, press the ent key to accept the programming and
return to the previous menu level.
5 = Emergencies
This option allows each individual MAX unit to be configured to respond to fire zones in a given set of groups.
Upon the opening of a fire zone in one of the groups allocated to the MAX, the MAX will trigger the door
strike and hold the door open until the system is reset. All the MAX LEDs will light and the buzzer will sound.
Closing the fire zone will have no effect - the MAX units are treated as latched outputs and an appropriate
level reset is required, at which point they are immediately reset.
A second group map is allocated to each MAX in order to facilitate this function. This permits the existing
door control features to be completely detached from the fire escape features.
The default setting for each MAX is all groups selected. Therefore, a system, which is unchanged from the
default will open all MAX doors in response to any fire zone activation.
On selecting the Emergencies option select the groups you want allocated to the MAX for escape purposes
and accept the programming by pressing the enter key. When a fire zone is activated in any of the groups
programmed, the door controlled by the MAX will be opened.
6 = AntiPassBack
This option, when enabled, will prevent more than one use of any particular card at a particular reader within a
given time period.
A forgiveness function is available to clear all or particular antipassback restrictions in force. A manager code
can authorize a forgive function on a particular user in option 42.1 = Codes.User Codes. An engineer code
can authorize a forgive function on a particular reader.
1 = Mode
This option has three settings:
0 = Off
No antipassback restriction
1 = Soft
Access is never denied but any violations will be recorded in the event log
2 = Hard
No access will be granted for a second swipe within the antipassback period, following a valid swipe.
2 = Timeout (0-60 minutes)
This option specifies the time that the anti passback restriction lasts for. The default is 0 minutes.
3 = Forgive
This option allows the engineer to remove all anti passback restrictions for the selected MAX. Use the A>B<
keys to select the reader address the press enter to forgive.
6-184
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
69 - Access Control (cont’d)
7 = Security
This option determines when and how a door can be locked and unlocked for access.
1 = Nightlock
This allows a time schedule to be allocated to determine when access to the door will be blocked. Up to
67 weekly time schedules can be programmed. Setting the schedule to 00 disables the function.
2 = Unlock Time
This allows a time schedule to be allocated to determine when the door will be unlocked to provide unrestricted access. Up to 0-67 weekly time schedules can be programmed. Setting the schedule to 00 disables the function.
Dual Mode
This defines if access at a door requires dual authority or not via the assigned keypad. The options are:
0 = Disabled
A card or a Pin is required to gain access.
1 = Card and Card
Two cards are required to gain access.
2 = Card and Pin
A card and a Pin from the same user are required to gain access.
8 = Menu Recall
This means that a card-held function can be assigned to the reader. A user is able to do a card-held function
even if they do not have card-held priviledges themselves.
1 = Menu Function
Depending on the level of access granted in Option 68, Menu Access, the user can hold their card at a
compatible reader for three seconds to activate a single menu function selected from the available list. A
new option is assigned by pressing the A or B keys until the required option is displayed or by entering the
option number directly and then pressing the ent key to accept the selection. Assigning a Double asterisk
(**) to the menu function makes it not used.
2 = Menu Mode
This determines whether a card held function can be used to access the reader. There is one option which
is 1 = Card Held.
2 = Keypad
This assigns a specific keypad address to work in conjunction with a MAX. This keypad is used to display
the menu action assigned in 1 = Menu Function.
6-185
69 - Access Control (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
69.3 = DCM
This option is used to program the Galaxy Door Control Module (DCM) access control readers. The DCM
can be fully integrated into the system, communicating on the AB lines and fully utilising the facilities of the
Galaxy control panel. Each DCM can control up to two readers. The exit reader can be replaced with a
request to exit button.
When enabled, the options that are eligible for DCM programming are made available throughout the menu,
otherwise they do not appear, or appear as Option not Available.
Addressing the DCM
The DCM takes its address from a rotary hex switch on-board or by setting with DIP switches. Refer to
Section 5, Access Control, Door Control Module.
69.3.1 = DCM Parameters
This option defines the individual operational features of each of the Door Control Modules. On selecting this
option the address of the first DCM on the system is displayed along with the descriptor currently assigned to
it. If there are no DCM’s on the system the message NO ENTRIES is displayed.
Select the required DCM address using the A and B keys pressing the ent key. The first parameter,
1 = Descriptor is displayed. Use the A or B keys to move to the required parameter and press the ent key.
1 = Descriptor
This option is used to assign a name of up to 9 characters to each of the DCM’s. This name is assembled from
the character set and/or library options. On selecting the Descriptor parameter the currently assigned name is
displayed on the top line - an underscore shows where the next character will be positioned, and a selection of
the alphabet is shown on the bottom line - the cursor flashes on the letter L.
Press the
key to erase the characters already assigned to the name.
The A or B keys can be used to move the alphabet left or right until the required character is positioned
underneath the flashing cursor. When the required character is in position press the ent key to copy the character to the description in the top line. Repeat this procedure to assemble the required Descriptor.
2 = Operation
This option determines how the DCM will operate. There are three choices;
0 = Entry and Exit
This option provides entry at one reader and exit at another reader.
1 = Entry and Entry
This option provides entry only at both readers
2 = Single entry
This option means that one reader is connected and its type is entry.
3 = System Group
This is the group that the DCM will report on for module tampers and diagnostics.
6-186
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
69 - Access Control (cont’d)
4 = Facility Code
This allows the cards to be programmed as a specific technology with a Facility code plus an ID.
1 = Code 1
2 = Code 2
3 = Code 3
4 = Code 4
5 = Reader (01 or 02)
This option allows the DCM readers to be set up with the 9 options that follow:
01 = Descriptor
This option is used to assign a name of up to 9 characters to each of the readers. This name is assembled
from the character set and/or library options. On selecting the Descriptor parameter the currently assigned
name is displayed on the top line - an underscore shows where the next character will be positioned, and a
selection of the alphabet is shown on the bottom line - the cursor flashes on the letter L.
Press the * key to erase the characters already assigned to the name.
The A or B keys can be used to move the alphabet left or right until the required character is positioned
underneath the flashing cursor. When the required character is in position press the ent key to copy the
character to the description in the top line. Repeat this procedure to assemble the required Descriptor.
02 = Relay Duration
This is the period, following the user card swipe, that the reader relay is activated allowing a door strike to
be unlocked and the door to be opened without creating an alarm. The reader relay de-activates as soon
as the door contact opens or the Open Timeout occurs.
On entering the Relay Duration parameter, the current value is displayed; assign the required time within
the range 0 – 60 seconds, the default time is 5 seconds. Press the ent key to save the programming and
return to the previous menu level.
NOTE: Pressing the A key increases the time by one second increments, the B key decreases the time in one
second decrements.
03 = Open Timeout
This is the period, following the user card swipe, that the door can remain open when gaining access. If the
door remains open longer than the period assigned to the Open Timeout, then an alarm occurs.
NOTE: If the Open Timeout is programmed as 0 seconds, then the door can remain open indefinitely
without resulting in an alarm being activated.
On entering the Open Timeout parameter, the current value is displayed; assign the required time within
the range 0 – 60 seconds, the default time is 10 seconds. Press the ent key to save the programming and
return to the previous menu level.
NOTE: Pressing the A key increases the time by one second increments, the B key decreases the time in
one second decrements.
6-187
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
69 - Access Control (cont’d)
04 = Group Config
The groups option allows each DCM readers to be allocated to a particular group (s).
1 = Alarm Group
On selecting the Alarm Group option, the group currently allocated to the DCM reader is displayed.
Pressing the group number toggles the group assigned to the reader. The reader does not allow access
through the door when the group is set. a user must have this group assigned to them in order to gain
access at this door.
Multi-group Systems
Larger Galaxy panels have 32 groups; these are displayed on the DCM reader in block of 8 groups,
sub-divided into A, B, C and D. Use the A or B key to move between the group blocks; press keys 1
– 8 to assign the relevant groups in each block to the DCM reader.
When the required groups have been assigned to the user, press the ent key to accept the programming
and return to the previous menu level.
2 = Group Restrict
Each DCM reader can be assigned selected groups using the Group Restriction option. This group
restriction affects the operation of the DCM readers for both access and card held functions. A card
can only be used at a reader if there are common groups between them. By default each reader is
assigned to all groups on the system. Groups can be removed as required to restrict the operation of the
DCM reader.
NOTE:
Each DCM card can be assigned a single menu function (refer to option 42 = CODES).
Activating this function with a card that is assigned to all groups, on a reader that is only assigned to a
single group, results in the function operating on all of the card’s groups. The DCM function is not
restricted to the groups assigned to the reader, it is restricted to the groups assigned to the card, as long
as there is one group common to both. This means that a DCM reader assigned only to group 1, for
example, can be used to activate the DCM reader function on groups 1, 2, 3 and 4 by a card with all of
these groups allocated. The groups are assigned to the DCM card using option 42 = CODES.
3 = Exit Group - Option not available
This allows the group outside of the protected area to be defined. This is only used in conjunction with
an exit reader, so that the current location of a specific user can be tracked.
05 = Emergencies
This option allows each individual DCM reader to be configured to respond to fire zones in a given set of
groups. Upon the opening of a fire zone in one of the groups allocated to the reader, the reader will trigger the
door strike and hold the door open until the system is reset. The DCM LED will light and the buzzer will
sound. Closing the fire zone will have no effect - the DCM readers are treated as latched outputs and an
appropriate level reset is required, at which point they are immediately reset.
A second group map is allocated to each DCM reader in order to facilitate this function. This permits the
existing door control features to be completely detached from the fire escape features.
The default setting for each DCM reader is all groups selected. Therefore, a system, which is unchanged from
the default will open all DCM doors in response to any fire zone activation.
Selecting the Emergencies option selects the groups you want allocated to the DCM readers for escape
purposes and accepts the programming by pressing the enter key. When a fire zone is activated in any of the
groups programmed, the door controlled by the DCM will be opened.
6-188
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
69 - Access Control (cont’d)
06 = AntiPassBack
This option, when enabled, will prevent more than one use of any particular card at a particular reader
within a given time period.
A forgiveness function is available to clear all or particular antipassback restrictions in force. A manager
code can authorize a forgive function on a particular user in option 42.1 = Codes.User Codes. An engineer code can authorize a forgive function on a particular reader.
1 = Mode
This option has three settings
0 = Off
No antipassback restriction.
1 = Soft
Access is never denied but any violations will be recorded in the event log.
2 = Hard
No access will be granted for a second swipe within the antipassback period, following a valid
swipe.
2 = Timeout (0-60 minutes)
This option specifies the time that the antipassback restriction lasts for. The default is 0 minutes.
3 = Forgive
This option allows the engineer to remove all antipassback restrictions for the selected DCM. Use the
A>B< keys to select the reader address the press enter to forgive.
07 = APB
Not used
08 = Security
This option determines when and how a door can be locked and unlocked for access.
1 = Nightlock
This allows a time schedule to be allocated to determine when access to the door will be blocked. Up
to 67 weekly time schedules can be programmed. Setting the schedule to 00 disables the function.
2 = Unlock Time
This allows a time schedule to be allocated to determine when the door will be unlocked to provide
unrestricted access. Up to 67 weekly time schedules can be programmed. Setting the schedule to 00
disables the function.
3 = Dual mode
This defines if access at a door requires dual authority or not via the assigned keypad. The options are:
0 = Disabled
A card or a Pin is required to gain access.
1 = Card and Card
Two cards are required to gain access.
2 = Card and Pin
A card and a Pin from the same user are required to gain access.
6-189
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
69 - Access Control (cont’d)
4 = Dual Time
Option not available
09 = Menu Recall
This determines whether the user is allowed to apply the menu recall function at any DCM reader. This is in
addition to any DCM function that may be assigned. There are two options:
1 = Menu Function
Depending on the level of access granted in Option 68, Menu Access, the user can hold their card at
a compatible reader for three seconds to activate a single menu function selected from the available list
(11-71). A new option is assigned by pressing the A or B keys until the required option is displayed or
by entering the option number directly and then pressing the ent key to accept the selection. Assigning a
Double asterisk (**) to the menu function makes it not used.
2 = Menu Mode
This determines how the menu function will operate. There are two options:
1 = Triple Repeat
The card is presented to the reader three times to activate the menu.
2 = Recall Button
The recall button is pressed once to activate the menu.
2 = Keypad assignment
This assigns a specific keypad address to work in conjunction with a MAX. This keypad is used to
display the menu action assigned in 1 = Menu Function.
6-190
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
69 - Access Control (cont’d)
69.3.2 = Card Format
This option selects what type of card is used with the DCM reader. There are five options:
0 = 26 bit
1 = Crp 1K 35 bit
2 = 37 bit no FC
3 = Northern 34 bit
4 = Custom.
1 = Format Name
This option is only available when 4 = Custom is selected as the format. It gives a name to the custom format.
The maximum number of characters in the name is 12.
2 = Card Length
The bit size of the card can be 26, 27, 32, 34, 35, 37 or 40.
3 = Start Point
If the card structure is unknown then it can be decided where the card number starts from. This is a numeric
value that must be less than the maximum length of the card.
4 = User Field
This is where the facility code is specified. Two options can be selected:
1 = Field Position
This is the start bit for the facility code. It can be from 1 to the card number start point.
2 = Field Length
This is the length of the facility code. The maximum field length is from the field position to the start of the
card number.
6-191
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
71 - SPI Key
Engineer 3
Option 71 – SPI Key
The SPI (Serial Peripheral Interface) key is an engineering peripheral used for copy/overwriting programming
data and carrying out software upgrades.
Using the SPI Key
If no key is fitted the display will briefly show:
SPI Key:
Device error
SPI Keys can be supplied in one of two ways:
1. Programmed - the SPI Key will be pre-programmed with a specific application file.
2. Un-programmed - The SPI Key is blank and contains no application or configuration data.
If the SPI Key is fitted and the key is blank, then the only option presented to the user will be 1 = Format
Key.
1 = Format Key
This function formats the key ready for copy and overwriting of panel configuration data. On selecting this
option the user is presented with a display where the top line reads “Formatting”, with a progress bar shown
on the bottom line.
Once the key has been formatted the user is presented with the following options:
1 = Show Key
This option is only shown when there is existing information stored on the SPI Key and then provides options
for downloading the saved information into the panel. The user can scroll through the available files on the SPI
Key.
For each file the display toggles between the:
Filename, creation time and date of the saved data and the,
Panel Type, Panel version and file type.
A further press of the ent key will provide the user with the following two options:
1 = Use File
Selecting this option will reprogram your control panel with the software application file or configuration file
stored on the SPI key. This will take approximately 2 minutes.
NOTE: If a new panel application file is being downloaded, the panel configuration stored in the
panel should firstly be saved from the panel to the SPI Key. The new panel application can
then copied from the SPI Key to the panel. Once the new application has been
downloaded the saved panel configuration can be copied back to the panel.
6-192
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
71 - SPI Key (cont’d)
Once the process has started, the panel will validate the data, then begin reprogramming the control
panel. While reprogramming is taking place, the panel stops running. The keypads and other peripherals
will go off-line for a short period. Once the reprogramming is complete, the panel will automatically
reboot. Once the panel has fully reconfigured, power may be removed or any previously saved
configuration can be restored via option 1 = show key and selecting the appropriate file.
CAUTION:
Do not remove power or unplug the SPI key until the panel has restarted.
2 = Delete File
When selected, the binary file stored on the SPI Key is deleted.
CAUTION:
Do not use this command as the SPI key will have to be recalled to Honeywell
Security to be reprogrammed with the software.
2 = Save config
This option allows the panel configuration data to be saved to SPI Key. If selected the user is first prompted
for filename for the saved data. This can be up to 8 characters in length.
Once the filename has been entered the data save sequence is started. The keypad display gives an indication
of the progress until the configuration has been saved.
3 = Check space
If selected this option displays the available space left on the SPI Key. This will display the number of free
memory Kbytes left on the device, out of a maximum of 4096.
4 = Erase key
This option deletes all programming and returns the SPI key to the unformatted state. This option should not
be used.
NOTE: If replacing the software all users, other than the engineer at the keypad in use will be logged out of
the system. The keypad banner will display a warning of what is happening. The engineer will be
given a warning that the panel software is about to be replaced. It will take approximately 2 minutes
to replace the software, during which time the keypads will go off line. Once reprogrammed the
panel will restart.
6-193
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
6-194
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Library
Appendix A: Library
00
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
space
Å
Ä
A
Æ
B
C
D
E
F
G
space
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
Ø
Ö
O
space
P
Q
R
S
T
U
Ü
V
W
X
space
Y
Z
.
,
/
+
&
(
)
space
001
002
003
004
005
006
007
008
009
010
011
012
013
014
015
016
017
018
019
020
021
022
023
024
025
026
027
028
029
030
031
032
033
034
035
036
037
038
039
040
041
042
043
044
045
046
047
048
049
050
051
052
053
054
055
056
057
058
ABOVE
ACCESS
ACCOUNTANT
ACCOUNTANTS
ACCOUNTS
ADMIN.
ALARM
ALERT
ANIMAL
ANNEXE
ARCH
AREA
ARENA
AROUND
ART
ASSEMBLY
ASSISTANT
AT
ATTACK
ATTIC
AUTOMATIC
AUXILIARY
BACK
BAGGAGE
BAKERY
BALCONY
BALLROOM
BANK
BANKING
BAR
BARN
BASEMENT
BATH
BATHROOM
BAY
BEAM
BEDROOM
BEHIND
BELL
BELOW
BENCH
BESIDE
BIOLOGY
BIRD
BLOCK
BLUE
BOARD
BODY
BOILER
BOOTH
BOTTOM
BOX
BOYS
BRANCH
BROOM
BROWN
BUILDING
BUNKER
059
060
061
062
063
064
065
066
067
068
069
070
071
072
073
074
075
076
077
078
079
080
081
082
083
084
085
086
087
088
089
090
091
092
093
094
095
096
097
098
099
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
A-1
BY
CABINET
CAFE
CALL
CANTEEN
CAR
CARGO
CARPENTER
CARPET
CASH
CASHIER
CEILING
CELL
CELLAR
CENTRAL
CENTRE
CHAIR
CHANGING
CHEMISTRY
CHICKEN
CHURCH
CLASSROOM
CLEANER
CLEANERS
CLEANING
CLERK
CLERKS
COAL
COAT
COIN
COLD
COLLECTION
COMMUNICATOR
COMPUTER
CONFERENCE
CONTAINER
CONTACT
CONSERVATORY
CORNER
CORRIDOR
COUNTER
COURT
COW
CUPBOARD
CURRENCY
DAIRY
DARK-ROOM
DATA
DAY
DEPARTURE
DEPUTY
DEPT.
DESIGN
DESK
DETECTOR
DEVELOPMENT
DEVICE
DIARY
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
129
130
131
132
133
134
135
136
137
138
139
140
141
142
143
144
145
146
147
148
149
150
151
152
153
154
155
156
157
158
159
160
161
162
163
164
165
166
167
168
169
170
171
172
173
DINING
DIRECTOR
DIRECTORS
DISPATCH
DOG
DOOR
DOUBLE
DOWNSTAIRS
DRAMA
DRAWER
DRAWING
DRINKS
DRIVE
DRUGS
EAST
ECONOMICS
EDGE
EIGHT
EIGHTEEN
EIGHTY
ELECTRIC
ELECTRICIAN
ELECTRONICS
EMERGENCY
END
ENGINE
ENGINEER
ENGINEERS
ENGLISH
ENTRANCE
ENTRY
EQUIPMENT
ESCAPE
ESCALATOR
EXIT
EXPORT
EXTERNAL
FACTORY
FAILURE
FAR
FARM
FAX
FEED
FEMALE
FENCE
FIELD
FIFTEEN
FIFTY
FLING
FIRE
FIRST
FIRST-AID
FISH
FIVE
FLAT
FLOOR
FOR
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Library (cont’d)
174
175
176
177
178
179
180
181
182
183
184
185
186
187
188
189
190
191
192
193
194
195
196
197
198
199
200
201
202
203
204
205
206
207
208
209
210
211
212
213
214
215
216
217
218
219
220
221
222
223
224
225
226
227
228
229
230
231
232
233
234
FOREIGN
FORTY
FOUNTAIN
FOUR
FREEZER
FRENCH
FRIDGE
FROM
FRONT
GAMES
GARAGE
GARDEN
GATE
GENTS
GEOGRAPHY
GERMAN
GIRLS
GLASS
GOLD
GOODS
GREAT
GREEN
GROCERY
GROUND
GROUNDS
GROUNDSMAN
GROUP
GUARD
GUN
GYM
HALL
HAND
HANGER
HEAD
HEAT
HEATER
HIGH
HISTORY
HOME
HORSE
HOT
HOUSE
ICE
IN
INDUSTRIAL
INFANT
INFANTS
INFORMATION
INFRARED
INSIDE
INSTRUCTORS
INTERIOR
INTO
IRON
ISOLATION
IT
ITALIAN
JANITOR
JANITORS
JUDGE
JUNIOR
235
236
237
238
239
240
241
242
243
244
245
246
247
248
249
250
251
252
253
254
255
256
257
258
259
260
261
262
263
264
265
266
267
268
269
270
271
272
273
274
275
276
277
278
279
280
281
282
283
284
285
286
287
288
289
290
291
292
293
294
295
JUST
KEEP
KEYPAD
KITCHEN
LAB
LADIES
LANDING
LAST
LATIN
LAUNDRY
LAVATORY
LAWN
LEAST
LECTURE
LEFT
LEVEL
L.H.S.
LIBRARY
LIFT
LIGHT
LINE
LITTLE
LOADING
LOBBY
LOCK
LOFT
LORRY
LOUNGE
LOW
LUNCH
MACHINE
MAGNETIC
MAIN
MAJOR
MALE
MAN
MANAGER
MANAGERS
MASTER
MAT
MATHS
MEDICAL
MEN
MESS
METAL
METER
MEZZANINE
MICROWAVE
MIDDLE
MILK
MINOR
MOBILE
MODEL
MONITOR
MOULDING
MOVEMENT
NEAR
NEW
NEXT
NIGHT
NINE
A-2
296
297
298
299
300
301
302
303
304
305
306
307
308
309
310
311
312
313
314
315
316
317
318
319
320
321
322
323
324
325
326
327
328
329
330
331
332
333
334
335
336
337
338
339
340
341
342
343
344
345
346
347
348
349
350
351
352
353
354
355
356
NINETEEN
NINETY
NODE
NOISE
NURSE
NURSERY
NORTH
OF
OFFICE
OFFICER
OFFICERS
OFFICES
OIL
ON
ONE
OPEN
ORANGE
OUT
OUTER
OUTSIDE
OVAL
OVER
P.A. BUTTON
PACKING
PAINT
PANEL
PANIC
PANTRY
PARCEL
PARK
PARTITION
PASSIVE
PATH
PATIO
PEN
PENTHOUSE
PERIMETER
PERSONAL
PERSONNEL
PHONE
PHYSICS
PIG
PIR
PIR BY
PIR IN
PIR ON
PLACE
PLANT
PLAY
PLAZA
PLUMBER
PLUMBERS
POINT
POND
POOL
PORCH
POST
POWER
PRESSURE
PRIMARY
PRIME
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
357
358
359
360
361
362
363
364
365
366
367
368
369
370
371
372
373
374
375
376
377
378
379
380
381
382
383
384
385
386
387
388
389
390
391
392
393
394
395
396
397
398
399
400
401
402
403
404
405
406
407
408
409
410
411
412
413
414
415
416
417
PRINT
PROCESSING
PRODUCTION
PUBLIC
PURCHASING
PURPLE
QUALITY
QUANTITY
QUIET
QUICK
RANGE
READING
REAR
RECEPTION
RECORDS
RECTOR
RECTORS
RED
REED
REFECTORY
REMOTE
REPAIR
RESEARCH
REST
RESTAURANT
REVOLVING
RIGHT
R.H.S.
ROLLER
ROOF
ROOM
ROUND
RUN
SAFE
SALES
SCAN
SCANNER
SCANNERS
SCANNING
SCREEN
SEA
SECOND
SECURE
SECRETARIES
SECRETARY
SECTION
SECURITY
SENSOR
SEVEN
SEVENTEEN
SEVENTY
SHACK
SHAFT
SHED
SHEEP
SHOP
SHOWROOM
SHORT
SHOWER
SHUTTER
SIDE
418
419
420
421
422
423
424
425
426
427
428
429
430
431
432
433
434
435
436
437
438
439
440
441
442
443
444
445
446
447
448
449
450
451
452
453
454
455
456
457
458
459
460
461
462
463
464
465
466
467
468
469
470
471
472
473
474
475
476
477
478
Library (cont’d)
SILENT
SILVER
SITE
SITTING
SIX
SIXTEEN
SIXTY
SLIDING
SMOKE
SOFTWARE
SOLITARY
SOUND
SOUTH
SPANISH
SPRAY
SPRING
SQUARE
SQUASH
STABLE
STADIUM
STAFF
STAIRS
STAIRWELL
STALLS
STAND
START
STATION
STOP
STORE
STORES
STROBE
STRONG
STUDY
SUITE
SUMMER
SUNDAY
SUPPLY
SURGERY
SWIMMING
SWITCH
SYSTEM
TABLE
TALL
TAMPER
TEA
TEACHER
TECHNICAL
TECHNICIAN
TELLER
TEN
TENNIS
TEST
THE
THEATRE
THEN
THIRTEEN
THIRTY
THREE
TICKET
TILL
TO
A-3
479
480
481
482
483
484
485
486
487
488
489
490
491
492
493
494
495
496
497
498
499
500
501
502
503
504
505
506
507
508
509
510
511
512
513
514
515
516
517
518
519
520
521
522
523
524
525
526
527
528
529
530
531
532
533
534
535
536
537
538
TOILET
TOOL
TOP
TRACK
TRACTOR
TRADE
TRAILER
TRAIN
TRAINING
TRANSPORT
TRAP
T.V.
TWELVE
TWENTY
TWIN
TWO
TYPE
TYPING
TYRE
ULTRASONIC
UNDER
UNIT
UP
UPPER
UPSTAIRS
USER
UTILITY
VAN
VARIABLE
VAULT
VENTILATOR
VISUAL
VOLTAGE
WAITING
WALK
WALL
WARD
WAREHOUSE
WASH
WATER
WAY
W.C.
WEAPON
WEEKEND
WEST
WINDOW
WINTER
WITH
WOOD
WOODWORK
WORK
WORKS
WORKSHOP
X-RAY
YARD
YEAR
YELLOW
ZERO
ZONE
ZOO
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
A-4
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Event Codes
Appendix B: SIA and Contact ID Event Codes
Ev
SIA Event
Galaxy Log
Galaxy Log Event
Description
Event
Description
ALM CAUSE
User report alarm cause
AC FAILCU-ACAC FAIL-
Ev Type Galaxy
Contact
Trigger
ID Event
USER
ALWAYS TR
None
AC Fail zone restored
ZONE
13.ELEC.ST
301
Control Unit AC restred
ZONE
13.ELEC.ST
301
Module AC fail restored
MOD.
13.ELEC.ST
301
STAND LOW-
Standby Battery Low
MOD
13.ELEC.ST
301
CU FUSE-
Control Unit fuse rest.
MISC
9.TAMPER
300
AC FAIL+
AC Fail zone trouble
ZONE
13.ELEC.ST
301
CU-AC+
Control Unit AC trouble
ZONE
13.ELEC.ST
301
AC FAIL+
Module AC fail trouble
MOD.
13.ELEC.ST
301
STAND LOW+
CU FUSE+
Standby Battery Low
Control Unit fuse trouble
MOD
MISC
301
300
FUSE AUX1
Aux1 fuse trouble
MOD
FUSE AUX2
Aux2 fuse trouble
MOD
FUSE BELL
Bell fuse trouble
MOD
13.ELEC ST
9. TAMPER
13.ELEC ST
9.TAMPER
13.ELEC ST
9.TAMPER
13.ELEC ST
9.TAMPER
13.ELEC ST
ENTRY
Entry zone alarm
ZONE
NONE
150
EXIT+
Exit zone alarm
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
134
INTRUDER+
Intruder zone alarm
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
130
24 HOURS+
24 hour zone alarm
ZONE
3.24 HOURS
135
SECURITY+
Security zone alarm
ZONE
4.SECURITY
135
DUAL+
Dual zone alarm
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
130
FINAL
Final zone alarm
ZONE
NONE
150
SEC FINAL+
Secure final zone alarm
ZONE
4.SECURITY
134
PRT FINAL+
Part final zone alarm
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
134
PRT ENTRY+
Part entry zone alarm
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
134
BEAM PAIR+
Beam pair zone alarm
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
130
VIDEO+
Video zone alarm
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
130
VIDEO EXT+
Video exit zone alarm
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
130
CUSTOM A+
Custom A zone alarm
ZONE
5.CUS ZON
130
CUSTOM B+
Custom B zone alarm
ZONE
5.CUS ZON
130
MASK+
Mask zone alarm
ZONE
4.SECURITY
135
INT DELAY
Intruder Delay alarm
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
150
URGENT+
Urgent zone alarm
ZONE
3.24 HOURS
130
VIBRATION+
Vibration zone alarm
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
133
ATM-1+
ATM-1 zone alarm
ZONE
3.24 HOURS
133
ATM-2+
ATM-2 zone alarm
ZONE
3.24 HOURS
133
ATM-3+
ATM-3 zone alarm
ZONE
3.24 HOURS
133
ATM-4+
ATM-4 zone alarm
ZONE
3.24 HOURS
133
ALARM EXT+
Extend zone alarm
ZONE
3.24 HOURS
130
T/O BURGL+
Entry timeout with zone
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
134
A - Alarm Cause
AC
Alarm Cause
A - AC Power
AR
AC Restoral
13. ELEC.ST
AT
AC Trouble
300
300
300
B - Burglary
BA
Burglary Alarm
B-1
Event Codes (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Ev
SIA Event
Description
Galaxy Log
Event
Galaxy Log Event
Description
Ev Type Galaxy
Trigger
Contact
ID Event
BB
Burg Bypass
OMITTED
Zone omitted
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
FORCEOMT+
Force omit after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
GRP OMIT+
Group omitted
USER
8.OMIT
574
OMIT VIBS
Omit Vibration zone
EVENT
8.OMIT
572
OMIT-ATM1+
Omit ATM-1 zone
EVENT
8.OMIT
572
OMIT-ATM2+
Omit ATM-2 zone
EVENT
8.OMIT
572
OMIT-ATM3+
Omit ATM-3 zone
EVENT
8.OMIT
572
OMIT-ATM4+
Omit ATM-4 zone
EVENT
8.OMIT
572
KSW CANCL
Keyswitch Cancel
ZONE
11.RESET
406
CANCEL
Cancel by user
USER
11.RESET
406
BC
Burg Cancel
BF
Intruder High
INTR HIGH
Intruder zone alarm
ZONE
2. INTRUDE
130
BJ
Burg Troub rest
LOW RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
RF SUPER-
RF Supervision Failure
ZONE
15.TROUBL
381
BL
Intruder Low
INTR LOW
Intruder zone alarm
ZONE
2. INTRUDE
130
BR
Burglary Rest
EXIT-
Exit zone type restored
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
134
18.ZN RESTO
INTRUDER-
Intruder zone restored
ZONE
24 HOURS-
24 hour zone restored
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
130
18.ZN RESTO
3.24 HOURS
135
18.ZN RESTO
SECURITY-
Security zone restored
ZONE
DUAL-
Dual zone restored
ZONE
4.SECURITY
135
18.ZN RESTO
2.INTRUDE
130
18.ZN RESTO
SEC FINAL-
Secure final zone rest.
ZONE
4.SECURITY
134
18.ZN RESTO
PRT FINAL-
Part final zone restored
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
134
18.ZN RESTO
PRT ENTRY-
Part entry zone restored
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
134
18.ZN RESTO
BEAM PAIR-
Beam pair zone rest.
ZONE
VIDEO-
Video zone restored
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
130
18.ZN RESTO
2.INTRUDE
130
18.ZN RESTO
VIDEO EXT-
Video exit zone rest.
ZONE
CUSTOM A-
Custom A zone rest.
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
130
18.ZN RESTO
5.CUS ZON
130
18.ZN RESTO
CUSTOM B-
Custom B zone rest.
ZONE
MASK-
Mask zone restored
ZONE
5.CUS ZON
130
18.ZN RESTO
4.SECURITY
135
18.ZN RESTO
INT ALARM-
Intruder Delay restored
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
130
18.ZN RESTO
URGENT-
Urgent zone restored
ZONE
3.24 HOURS
130
18.ZN RESTO
VIBRATION-
Vibration zone restored
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
18.ZN RESTO
B-2
133
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Ev
SIA Event
Description
Event Codes (cont’d)
Galaxy Log
Event
Galaxy Log Event
Description
Ev Type Galaxy
Trigger
Contact
ID Event
ATM-1-
ATM-1 zone restored
ZONE
133
3.24 HOURS
18.ZN RESTO
ATM-2-
ATM-2 zone restored
ZONE
ATM-3-
ATM-3 zone restored
ZONE
3.24 HOURS
133
18.ZN RESTO
3.24 HOURS
133
18.ZN RESTO
ATM-4-
ATM-4 zone alarm
ZONE
3.24 HOURS
133
18.ZN RESTO
ALARM EXT-
Alarm extend zone rest.
ZONE
3.24 HOURS
130
18.ZN RESTO
T/0 BURGL-
Entry timeout restore
ZONE
2.INTRUDE
134
18.ZN RESTO
BT
BU
BV
BX
Burg. Trouble
Burg Unbypass
Burg Confirm
LOW RES+
Low resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES+
High resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
RF SUPER+
RF Supervision Failure
ZONE
15.TROUBL
381
MASKED
Zone masked
ZONE
15.TROUBLE
380
GRP OMIT-
Group unomitted
USER
8.OMIT
574
OMIT-ATM1-
Unomit ATM-1 zone
EVENT
8.OMIT
572
OMIT-ATM2-
Unomit ATM-2 zone
EVENT
8.OMIT
572
OMIT-ATM3-
Unomit ATM-3 zone
EVENT
8.OMIT
572
OMIT-ATM4-
Unomit ATM-4 zone
EVENT
8.OMIT
572
FORCE OMT-
Unomitted after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
CONFIRM
2 independant alarms
EVENT
2.INTRUDE
None
EXIT
Exit zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
INTRUDER
Intruder zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
24 HOURS
24 hour zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
SECURITY
Security zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
DUAL
Dual zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
ENTRY
Entry zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
PUSH SET
Push set zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
KEYSWITCH
Keyswitch zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
SEC FINAL
Secure final zone test.
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
PRT FINAL
Part final zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
PRT ENTRY
Part entry zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
PA
PA zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
PA SILENT
PA silent zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
PA DELAY
PA delay zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
PA DEL/SL
PA delay sil zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
LINK
Link zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
SPARE
Spare zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
TAMPER
Tamper zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
BELL TAMP
Bell tamper zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
BEAM PAIR
Beam pair zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
611
BATT LOW
Battery Low zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
LINE FAIL
Line fail zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
AC FAIL
AC fail zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
LOG
Log zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
RM ACCESS
Rem acc zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
B-3
Event Codes (cont’d)
Ev
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
SIA Event
Galaxy Log
Galaxy Log Event
Description
Event
Description
VIDEO
Video zone tested
VIDEO EXT
INT DELAY
Ev Type Galaxy
Contact
Trigger
ID Event
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
Video exit zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
Intrud delay zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
SEC DELAY
Security del zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
SET LOG
Set Log zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
CUSTOM A
Custom A zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
CUSTOM B
Custom B zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
EXITGUARD
Exitguard zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
MASK
Mask zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
URGENT
Urgent zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
PA UNSET
PA unset zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
KSW RESET
Ksw. reset zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
VIBRATION
Vibration zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
ATM-1
ATM-1 zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
ATM-2
ATM-2 zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
ATM-3
ATM-3 zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
ATM-4
ATM-4 zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
ALARM EXT
Alarm extend zone test.
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
SOAK TEST
Soak test zone act
ZONE
NOT SENT
611
401
C - Closing
CA
Closing Report
FULL SET
Automatic Set
EVENT
10.SETTING
CE
Closing Extend
EXTENSION
Auto arm exten. delay
USER
10.SETTING
464
PREWARN
Auto arm prewarn delay
MISC
NEVER TR
464
PART SET
Part set by user
USER
10.SETTING
441
KSW P/SET
Part set by user
KSSET
10.SETTING
442
Fail to Set
FAIL SET
Fail to Set
EVENT
7. SET FAULT
454
CJ
Late to Set
LATE SET
Late to Set
EVENT
10.SETTING
454
CL
Closing Report
FULL SET
Full set
USER
10.SETTING
401
FULL SET
Set by keypad
EVENT
10.SETTING
401
CG
CI
Close Area
KSW SET
Keyswitch set
ZONE
10.SETTING
409
CP
Auto. Closing
REARM
Rearm after alarm
EVENT
10.SETTING
463
CR
Recent Close
RECEN.SET
Previous alarm was within 5 mins of set
EVENT
2.INTRUDER 459
CT
Late to Open
TIMEOUT
Entry timeout
EVENT
10.SETTING
None
D - Access
DD
Acces Denied
Invalid Card
MAX tag unknown
MOD.
17.MAXTAG
421
DF
Door Forced
MAX ALARM
Door contact broken
MOD.
4.SECURITY
423
17.MAXTAG
DG
DK
Acces Granted
Acces Lockout
DCM EVENT
Door contact broken
MOD.
4.SECURITY
423
LEGAL CD
Legal code entered
USER
16.LOG
462
LEGAL CD
ATM code entered
USER
16.LOG
462
Valid
MAX tag accepted
USER
17.MAXTAG
422
ILL-CODE
Illegal code entry
USER
16.LOG
421
REJECT CARD
Illegal MAX tag
USER
17.MAXTAG
421
FOB REJECT
Illegal Fob
ZONE
10.SETTING
421
B-4
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Ev
SIA Event
Description
Galaxy Log
Event
DK
Access Lockout DCM EVENT
Event Codes (cont’d)
Galaxy Log Event
Description
Ev Type Galaxy
Trigger
Contact
ID Event
Invalid Card Reader Lockout
USER
421
16.LOG
10.SETTING
17.MAXTAG
DT
Door propped
DOOR PROP
MAX - Door left open
MOD.
4.SECURITY
426
E - System Trouble
ER
Mod Removed
REMOVED
Module Removed
MOD
TAMPER
532
ET
RF NVM Fail
RF MEM!
RF NVM RAM Fail
MOD
TAMPER
333
F - Fire
FA
Fire Alarm
FIRE+
Fire zone alarm
ZONE
6.FIRE
110
FB
Fire Bypass
OMITTED
Fire zone ommitted
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
FORCEOMT+
Force omit after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
LOW RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
6.FIRE
110
FJ
Fire Troub rest
FR
Fire Restoral
FIRE-
Fire zone restored
ZONE
FT
Fire Trouble
LOW RES+
Low resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES+
High resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
18.ZN RESTO
FU
Fire Unbypass
FORCE OMT-
Unomitted after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
FX
Fire Test
FIRE
Fire zone tested
ZONE
NOT SENT
None
SOAK TEST
Soak test fire zone act
ZONE
NOT SENT
None
Note 1
G - Gas (Custom SIA - See Note 2)
GA
Alarm
Note 1
zone in alarm
ZONE
5.CUS ZON
GB
Bypass
OMITTED
zone ommitted
ZONE
8.OMIT
Note 1
FORCEOMT+
Force omit after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
Note 1
GJ
Trouble Rest
LOW RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
Note 1
HIGH RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
Note 1
5.CUS ZON
Note 1
GR
Alarm Restore
Note 1
zone restored
ZONE
GT
Trouble
LOW RES+
Low resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
Note 1
HIGH RES+
High resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
Note 1
GU
Unbypass
FORCE OMT-
Unomitted after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
Note 1
PA SILENT+
PA Silent zone alarm
ZONE
1.PA/DURE
122
PA DEL/SL+
PA Delay Sil.zone alarm
ZONE
1.PA/DURE
122
DURESS
Duress with code
USER
1.PA/DURE
121
PA UNSET+
PA Unset zone alarm
ZONE
1.PA/DURE
122
OMITTED
Holdup zone omitted
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
FORCEOMT+
Force omit after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
380
18.ZN RESTO
H - Holdup
HA
HB
Holdup Alarm
Holdup Bypass
HJ
Hold Troub rest
LOW RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
HIGH RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HR
Hold Restoral
PA SILENT-
PA Silent zone restored
ZONE
1.PA/DURE
122
18.ZN RESTO
PA DEL/SL-
PA Delay Sil.zone rest.
ZONE
1.PA/DURE
122
18.ZN RESTO
PA UNSET-
PA Unset zone restored
ZONE
1.PA/DURE
122
LOW RES+
Low resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES+
High resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
FORCE OMT-
Unomitted after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
18.ZN RESTO
HT
HU
Holdup Trouble
Hold Unbypass
B-5
Event Codes (cont’d)
Ev
SIA Event
Description
Galaxy Log
Event
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Galaxy Log Event
Description
Ev Type Galaxy
Trigger
Contact
ID Event
J - Wrong code, Time changed
JA
Code Tamper
WRONG CD
Wrong code alarm act.
MOD.
9.TAMPER
461
Invalid Code
INVALID CD
Invalid Code entered
MOD.
ALWAYS TR
None
JL
LOG 90%
MISC
Always TR
632
JR
TIMER A
MISC
NONE
0
TIMER B
MISC
NONE
0
AUTOTIMER
MISC
NONE
0
MISC
NONE
0
USER
ALWAYS TR3
625
LOCKTIMER
JT
Time changed
NEW T/D
Time/Date modified
K - Heat (Custom SIA - See Note 2)
KA
Alarm
Note 1
zone in alarm
ZONE
5.CUS ZON
Note 1
KB
Bypass
OMITTED
zone ommitted
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
FORCEOMT+
Force omit after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
LOW RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
5.CUS ZON
Note 1
KJ
Trouble Rest
KR
Alarm Restore
Note 1
zone restored
ZONE
KT
Trouble
LOW RES+
Low resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES+
High resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
KU
Unbypass
FORCE OMT-
Unomitted after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
ENGINEER+
Engineer mode entered
MISC
ALWAYS TR
627
USER
NONE
0
18.ZN RESTO
L - Phone, Program
LB
Program begin
TEST O/P
FULL TEST
SET
NONE
0
MOD T/D
USER
NONE
0
MOD CODES
USER
NONE
0
MOD REM
USER
NONE
0
OMIT ZONE
USER
NONE
0
ENG PARAM
USER
NONE
0
ENG ZONES
USER
NONE
0
ENG O/PS
USER
NONE
0
ENG LINKS
USER
NONE
0
ENG SOAK
USER
NONE
0
ENG DIGI
USER
NONE
0
ENG PRINT
USER
NONE
0
ENG QUICK
USER
NONE
0
ENG DIAG
USER
NONE
0
ENG GROUP
USER
NONE
0
ENG ASSEM
USER
NONE
0
ENG TMRS
USER
NONE
0
ENG CHECK
USER
NONE
0
LR
Line Restore
LINE FAIL-
Zone Tel line fail rest.
ZONE
12.MD/COM
351
LINE FAIL-
Module Tel line fail rest.
MOD
12.MD/COM
351
LT
Line Trouble
LINE FAIL+
Zone Tel line fail trouble
ZONE
12.MD/COM
351
LINE FAIL+
Mod Tel line fail trouble
MOD
12.MD/COM
351
ENGINEER-
Engineer mode exited
EVENT
ALWAYS TR
627
LX
Local Prog end
B-6
Event Codes (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
M - Medical (Custom SIA - See note 2)
MA
Alarm
Note 1
zone in alarm
ZONE
5.CUS ZON
Note 1
MB
Bypass
OMITTED
zone ommitted
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
FORCEOMT+
Force omit after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
LOW RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
5.CUS ZON
Note 1
MJ
Trouble Rest
MR
Alarm Restore
Note 1
zone restored
ZONE
MT
Trouble
LOW RES+
Low resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES+
High resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
FORCE OMT-
Unomitted after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
18.ZN RESTO
MU
Unbypass
O - Opening
OA
Open Report
UNSET
Automatic Unset
EVENT
10.SETTING
401
OG
Open Area
UNSET
Part Unset
USER
10.SETTING
401
KSW UNSET
Keyswitch part unset
ZONE
10.SETTING
409
OK
Early Open
U/S EARLY
Unset Early
EVENT
10.SETTING
451
OP
Open Report
UNSET
Unset
USER
10.SETTING
401
KSW UNSET
Keyswitch unset
ZONE
10.SETTING
409
SYS RESET
All Burglar alarms reset
USER
11.RESET
313
PA RESET
All PA alarms reset
USER
1.PA/DURE
465
OR
Disarm alarm
TAMP RST
All Tamper alarms reset
USER
9.TAMPER
313
SYS RESET
Ksw reset Burglar alarm
EVENT
11.RESET
313
PA RESET
Ksw reset PA alarms
EVENT
1.PA/DURE
465
TAMP RESET
Ksw reset Tamp alarm
EVENT
9.TAMPER
313
LF RESET
USER
20.FAULT
313
FAULT RST
USER
20.FAULT
313
PF RESET
USER
20.FAULT
313
B-7
Event Codes (cont’d)
Ev
SIA Event
Description
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Galaxy Log
Event
Galaxy Log Event
Description
Ev Type Galaxy
Trigger
Contact
ID Event
PA+
PA zone alarm
ZONE
1.PA/DURE
120
DELAY ALM+
PA Delay zone alarm
ZONE
1.PA/DURE
120
OMITTED
PA zone omitted
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
P - Panic
PA
Panic Alarm
PB
Panic Bypass
FORCEOMT+
Force omit after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
PJ
Pan Troub rest
LOW RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
PR
Panic Restoral
PA-
PA zone restored
ZONE
1.PA/DURE
120
18.ZN RESTO
DELAY ALM-
PA Delay zone restored
ZONE
1.PA/DURE
120
18.ZN RESTO
PT
PU
Panic Trouble
Panic Unbypas
LOW RES+
Low resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES+
High resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
FORCE OMT-
Unomitted after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
Q - Assist (Custom SIA - see note 2)
QA
Alarm
Note 1
zone in alarm
ZONE
5.CUS ZON
Note 1
QB
Bypass
OMITTED
zone ommitted
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
FORCEOMT+
Force omit after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
QJ
Trouble Rest
LOW RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
Note 1
zone restored
ZONE
5.CUS ZON
Note 1
QR
Alarm Restore
18.ZN RESTO
QT
Trouble
LOW RES+
Low resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES+
High resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
QU
Unbypass
FORCE OMT-
Unomitted after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
REM LOG
USER
NONE
0
REM RESET
USER
NONE
0
REM ID
USER
NONE
0
REM COPY
USER
NONE
0
REM OVRWR
USER
NONE
0
REM MSG
USER
NONE
0
COPY SITE
MODULE
NONE
0
R - Remote,Log,Test
RB
OVWR SITE
RC
Relay closed
MODULE
NONE
0
LINK-
Link zone closed
ZONE
16.LOG
150
LOG-
Log zone closed
ZONE
16.LOG
150
LOG DELAY-
Log delay zone closed
ZONE
16.LOG
150
CUSTOM A-
Zone closed(Non alarm)
ZONE
16.LOG
150
CUSTOM B-
Zone closed(Non alarm)
ZONE
16.LOG
150
EXITGUARD-
Exitguard zone closed
ZONE
16.LOG
150
B-8
Event Codes (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Ev
SIA Event
Description
Galaxy Log
Event
Galaxy Log Event
Description
Ev Type Galaxy
Trigger
Contact
ID Event
RD
Prog, denied
RMACCESS+
Zone denied rem. acc
ZONE
14.MEN AC
553
RO
Relay open
BELL FAIL
Bell fail zone opened
ZONE
16. LOG
150
KEYSWITCH
KS
NONE
150
LINK+
Link zone opened
ZONE
16.LOG
150
LOG+
Log zone opened
ZONE
16.LOG
150
LOG DELAY+
Log delay zone opened
ZONE
16.LOG
150
NOT USED
ZONE
16. LOG
150
SET LOG
ZONE
16. LOG
150
CUSTOM A+
Zone opend(Non alarm)
ZONE
16.LOG
150
CUSTOM B+
Zone opend(Non alarm)
ZONE
16.LOG
150
EXITGUARD+
Exitguard zone opened
ZONE
16.LOG
150
PUSH SET
Push set zone opened
ZONE
NONE
150
KS
NONE
150
SPARE
Spare zone opened
ZONE
16. LOG
150
KSW RESET
RP
Automatic test
AUTOTEST
Automatic test
EVENT
ALWAYS TR
602
RR
Power Up
MEMORY OK
Warm start of panel
EVENT
13.ELEC ST
305
RS
Prog, success
RM ACCESS-
Zone allowed rem acc
ZONE
14.MEN AC
553
REM CALL
Remote call complete
MOD
14.MEN AC
412
RX
Manual test
ENG TEST
Engineer test
USER
ALWAYS TR
601
S - Sprinker (Custom SIA - see note 2)
SA
Alarm
Note 1
zone in alarm
ZONE
5.CUS ZON
Note 1
SB
Bypass
OMITTED
zone ommitted
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
FORCEOMT+
Force omit after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
LOW RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
SJ
Trouble Rest
SR
Alarm Restore
Note 1
zone restored
ZONE
5.CUS ZON
Note 1
ST
Trouble
LOW RES+
Low resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES+
High resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
FORCE OMT-
Unomitted after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
TAMPER+
Tamper zone alarm
ZONE
9.TAMPER
137
BELL TAMP+
Bell Tamper zone alarm
ZONE
9.TAMPER
137
LID TAMP+
Lid Tamper alarm
ZONE
9.TAMPER
137
AUX TAMP+
Auxilary Tamper alarm
ZONE
9.TAMPER
137
TAMP S/C+
Tamper short circuit
ZONE
9.TAMPER
383
TAMP O/C+
Tamper open circuit
ZONE
9.TAMPER
383
SU
Unbypass
T - Tamper,Test
TA
Tamper Alarm
TAMPER+
Module Tamper
MOD
9.TAMPER
145
MISSING+
Missing module alarm
MOD
9.TAMPER
145
CV TAMP+
Voltage tamper on zone
ZONE
9.TAMPER
383
MAX TAMP+
MAX Module Tamper
MOD.
9.TAMPER
145
WALL TAMP
Wall tamper zone alarm
ZONE
9.TAMPER
137
ZONE
9.TAMPER
383
MASK TAMP
TE
Test End
DCM EVENT
Invalid Card Tamper alarm
MOD.
9.TAMPER
None
ADDED
Module Added
MOD.
9.TAMPER
531
ENG TAMP+
Engineering Tamper
MISC
9.TAMPER
None
WALK TEST-
Walk test finished
USER
14.MEN AC
607
B-9
Event Codes (cont’d)
Ev
TR
SIA Event
Description
Tamper Restor
Galaxy Log
Event
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Galaxy Log Event
Description
Ev Type Galaxy
Trigger
TAMPER-
Tamper zone restored
ZONE
BELL TAMP-
Bell Tamper zone rest.
ZONE
LID TAMP-
Lid Tamper restored
ZONE
9.TAMPER
Contact
ID Event
137
18.ZN RESTO
9.TAMPER
137
18.ZN RESTO
9.TAMPER
137
18.ZN RESTO
AUX TAMP-
Auxilary Tamper rest.
ZONE
TAMP S/C-
Tamper s/circuit rest.
ZONE
9.TAMPER
137
18.ZN RESTO
9.TAMPER
383
18.ZN RESTO
TAMP O/C-
Tamper o/circuit rest.
ZONE
9.TAMPER
383
18.ZN RESTO
TAMPER-
Module Tamper rest.
MOD
9.TAMPER
145
18.ZN RESTO
MISSING-
Missing module rest.
MOD
9.TAMPER
145
18.ZN RESTO
CV TAMP-
Voltage tamper rest.
ZONE
9.TAMPER
383
18.ZN RESTO
MAX TAMP-
MAX Module Tamp rest
MOD.
ENG TAMP-
Engineer Tamper
MISC
9.TAMPER
145
18.ZN RESTO
9.TAMPER
None
18.ZN RESTO
TS
Test Start
WALK TEST+
USER
14.MEN AC
607
ARC TEST
Walk test started
TEST
ALWAYS TR
607
PRINT OC
USER
NONE
0
PRINT OL
MISC
NONE
0
V -??
VY
W - Water(Custom SIA - see note 2)
WA
Alarm
Note 1
zone in alarm
ZONE
5.CUS ZON
Note 1
WB
Bypass
OMITTED
zone ommitted
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
FORCEOMT+
Force omit after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
LOW RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
Note 1
zone restored
ZONE
5.CUS ZON
Note 1
WJ
WR
Trouble Rest
Alarm Restore
18.ZN RESTO
WT
Trouble
LOW RES+
Low resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
WU
Unbypass
HIGH RES+
High resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
FORCE OMT-
Unomitted after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
B-10
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Ev
Event Codes (cont’d)
SIA Event
Description
Galaxy Log
Event
Galaxy Log Event
Description
Ev Type Galaxy
Trigger
Contact
ID Event
XQ
RF Jam
RF JAM+
RF Signal Jammed
MOD
15.TROUBLE
344
XT
RF Batt Low
RF BATLOW+
RF Battery Low
ZONE
13.ELEC ST
384
X - RF
15.TROUBLE
XH
RF Jam Restore
RF JAM-
RF Jam Restore
MOD
15.TROUBLE
344
XR
RF Batt Lo Rst
RF BATLOW-
RF Battery Low Restore
ZONE
13.ELEC ST
384
15.TROUBLE
Y
YC
Comms Fail
internal to tel
Tel module lost RS485
EVENT
ALWAYS TR
350
YF
Panel Cold Start
MEM RESET
Power Up Panel
MISC
13.ELEC ST
None
YK
Comm Restoral
internal to tel
Tel module rest. RS485
EVENT
ALWAYS TR
350
YL
+AC+ Batt Fail
+AC+BATT
Mains fail and batt low
EVENT
13.ELEC ST
None
YP
PSU fail
PSU FLT+
Power Supply Unit fault
EVENT
13.ELEC ST
314
YR
Sys Batt Rest.
BATT LOW-
Battery Low restored
ZONE
13.ELEC ST
302
CU BATT-
Control unit batt restore
ZONE
13.ELEC ST
302
BATT LOW-
Mod Battery Low rest
MOD
13.ELEC ST
302
YT
Sys Batt Troub
BATT FUSE-
Battery Fuse restored
MOD
13.ELEC ST
302
BATT LOW+
Battery Low
ZONE
13.ELEC ST
302
CU BATT+
Control unit Battery Low
ZONE
13.ELEC ST
302
302
BATT LOW+
Module Battery Low
MOD
13.ELEC ST
BATT FUSE+
Battery Fuse blown
MOD
13.ELEC ST
302
MOD
13.ELEC ST
302
FUSE A2P
Z - Freezer (Custom SIA - see note 2)
ZA
Alarm
Note 1
zone in alarm
ZONE
5.CUS ZON
Note 1
ZB
Bypass
OMITTED
zone ommitted
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
FORCEOMT+
Force omit after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
ZJ
Trouble Rest
LOW RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES-
Restor zone resistance
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
Note 1
zone restored
ZONE
5.CUS ZON
Note 1
ZR
Alarm Restore
18.ZN RESTO
ZT
Trouble
LOW RES+
Low resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
HIGH RES+
High resistance on zone
ZONE
15.TROUBL
380
ZU
Unbypass
FORCE OMT-
Unomitted after rearm
ZONE
8.OMIT
573
00 - Non-reported Events
00
SUSP. SET
USER
NONE
0
00
BEGIN SET
USER
NONE
0
00
INST SET
USER
NONE
0
00
ENT UNSET
UNSET
NONE
0
00
ENT SETTING
USER
NONE
0
00
ENT DELAY
USER
NONE
0
00
ENT SET
USER
NONE
0
00
ENT UNSTG
USER
NONE
0
00
ABORT SET
USER
NONE
0
00
AUDIBLE
MISC
NONE
0
00
JAM DELAY
MISC
NONE
0
00
FB BATLOW
USER
NONE
0
B-11
Event Codes (cont’d)
Ev
SIA Event
Description
Galaxy Log
Event
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Galaxy Log Event
Description
Ev Type Galaxy
Trigger
Contact
ID Event
00
DIAG REC
LIST
NONE
0
00
LOC WRITE
LIST
NONE
0
00
REM WR/RD
LIST
NONE
0
00
DIAG CHK
LIST
NONE
0
00
DISCHARGE
ZONE
13.ELEC ST
0
00
ETST PASS
USER
NONE
0
00
ETST FAIL
MISC
NONE
0
00
OVERRIDE
MISC
NONE
0
00
R. TIMESET
MISC
NONE
0
00
CU-RIO.SW
MISC
NONE
0
00
CLBK1 ERR
USER
NONE
0
00
REM TRY
USER
NONE
0
00
REM FIN
USER
NONE
0
00
REM ABORT
USER
NONE
0
00
REM FAIL
USER
NONE
0
Note 1 : Dependant upon zone type selected
Note 2: Custom SIA event allow existing zone types to be modified in order to send specific SIA events from the panel. This allows more
specific SIA information to be transmitted. The zones used to programme the custom SIA events will continue to function as per the zone
description
B-12
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
SIA Event Structure
Appendix C: SIA Event Structure
E ven t
Type
SIA
LE V E L
ACC.
Block
DATA Block Format
(N block code)
Ascii Block Format (A block code)
Explanation
ZONE
3,4
#xxxxxx
Ntixx:xx/rixx/EVzzzz
A e e e e e e e e e si i i i i i i i d d d d d d d d d d d d d d d d
Detector alarmed, keyswitch etc
2
#xxxxxx
Ntixx:xx/rixx/EVzzzz
1
#xxxxxx
NEVzzzz
0
#xxxx
NEVzzzz
3,4
#xxxxxx
Ntixx:xx/rixx/iduuu/pixxx/EV
A e e e e e e e e e si i i i i i i i d d d d d d
User Set/Unset,reset,duress,etc
2
#xxxxxx
Ntixx:xx/rixx/iduuu/pixxx/EV
1
#xxxxxx
NEVmmm
0
#xxxx
NEVmmm
3,4
#xxxxxx
Ntixx:xx/rixx/pimmm/EV
A e e e e e e e e e si i i i i i i i d d d
2
#xxxxxx
Ntixx:xx/rixx/pimmm/EV
1. With ri modifier:
Set with A or B key without code
1
#xxxxxx
NEVmmm
0
#xxxx
NEVmmm
3,4
#xxxxxx
Ntixx:xx/rixx/EV
2
#xxxxxx
Ntixx:xx/rixx/EV
1
#xxxxxx
NEV
0
#xxxx
NEV000
User
Module
Event
2. Without ri modifier:
Keypad added,Rio missing etc
A e e e e e e e e e si i i i i i i i
1. With ri modifier:
Automatic set, timer activated
2. Without ri modifier:
Automatic test, engineer mode
K ey:
Data Block
Ascii Block
ti
Time modifier
e
Log event (9 chars, see Galaxy Log Event in table supplied)
ri
Group modifier (not used if groups are
disabled)
s
Event state ('+' : ON, '-' : OFF, ' ' : NOT USED)
id
User modifier
i
Site identifier (8 char description of site - can be blank)
u
User number
d
Descriptor (additional text to describe event),
pi
Peipheral modifier
1. Zone Event - 16 char zone descriptor
m
Peripheral number
2. User Event - 6 char user name
EV
Event Code Type (see SIA event list supplied)
3. Module Event - 3 char module name,
z
Zone number
'RIO' (8 zone module), 'KEY' (keypad), 'MAX' (Proximity
Reader 'COM' (COM1 = Int Telecom, COM2 = Ext RS232)
COM3 = ISDN, COM4 = Ethernet, COM5 = Ext Telecom
COM6 = Int RS232)
x
maximum digits for modifier field
C-1
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
C-2
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Event Log
Appendix D: Event Log Messages
KEYPAD TEXT
DESCRIPTION
Trigger Event
0001 + CU-BATT
Control Unit Standby Battery Low has occurred (battery voltage below 10.5 Vd.c.).
13. Elec Status
20. Fault
0001 - CU-BATT
Control Unit Standby Battery Low has finished (battery voltage now above 10.5 Vd.c.).
13. Elec. Status
0002 + CU-AC
Control Unit Mains (a.c.) Power Fail has occurred.
13. Elec. Status
20. Fault
M
0002 - CU-AC
Control Unit Mains (a.c.) Power Fail has finished.
13. Elec. Status
M
0003 + LID TAMP
Lid Tamper on control unit has occurred.
9. Tamper
M
0003 - LID TAMP
Lid Tamper on control unit has finished.
9. Tamper
18. Zone restoral
M
0004 + AUX TAMP
Auxiliary Tamper on control unit has occurred.
9. Tamper
M
0004 - AUX TAMP
Auxiliary Tamper on control unit has finished.
9. Tamper
18. Zone restoral
M
+ABORT SET
Setting process aborted
11. Reset
+AC+BATT
AC Fail and battery voltage low.
+ AC FAIL
AC Fail zone activated (opened) or an AC Fail on a Power Supply Unit.
– AC FAIL
AC Fail zone de-activated (closed) or an AC Fail on a Power Supply Unit has
stopped.
13. Elec. Status
20. Fault
13. Elec. Status
20. Fault
13. Elec. status
20. Fault
3. 24 Hours
16. Log Zone
M
M
NM
M
M
M
+ALARM EXT
Alarm extend zone activated.
ALM CAUSE
Reset of system required by entry of an alarm cause code.
Always TR
M
ADDED
Engineer has added a module to the system.
9. Tamper
M
ARC TEST
Alarm Receiving Centre Test
Always TR
+ATM-1
ATM-1 zone activated.
+ATM-2
ATM-2 zone activated.
+ATM-3
ATM-3 zone activated.
+ATM-4
ATM-4 zone activated.
AUTOTEST
Automatic Test of the system via a comms module
Always TR
+AUTOTIMER
Autoset timer activated.
None
NM
–AUTOTIMER
Autoset timer de-activated.
None
NM
BURG HIGH
High priority intruder alarm zone open
BURG LOW
Low priority intruder alarm zone open.
+BAT FUSE
Battery fuse on Power Supply Unit blown.
+ BATT LOW
Battery Low activated on Power Supply Unit.
– BATT LOW
Battery Low de-activated on Power Supply Unit.
+BEAM PAIR
Beam Pair zones activated (opened).
2. Intruder
+BEGIN SET
Setting process started.
None
NM
+ BELL FAIL
Bell Fail zone opened.
16. Log Zone
NM
+ BELL TAMP
Bell Tamper zone activated (opened).
9. Tamper
– BELL TAMP
Bell Tamper zone de-activated (closed).
9. Tamper
18. Zone restoral
BOOT UP
System has been started up or restarted.
13. Elec. status
NM
CANCEL
Alarm activation Cancelled by a valid user Code (system or Group(s) still Set).
11. Reset/Cancel
NM
COMM FAIL
Communication Failure has occurred on a comms module.
20. Fault
M
CONFIRM
Two independent alarms.
2. Intruder
M
COPY SITE
Remote Copy of the Site (system) has occurred via Remote Servicing or the RS232
Module.
None
3. 24 Hours
16. Log Zone
3. 24 Hours
16. Log Zone
3. 24 Hours
16. Log Zone
3. 24 Hours
16. Log Zone
2. Intrude
18. Zone Restoral
2. Intrude
18. Zone Restoral
13. Elec Status
20. Fault
13. Elec. status
20. Fault
13. Elec. status
20. Fault
5. Custom zones
16. Log Zone
5. Custom Zones
16. Log Zone
9. Tamper
13. Elec Status
20. Fault
M
NM
NM
NM
NM
NM
M
M
M
M
M
NM
M
M
NM
CUSTOM-A
Custom-A zone activated (opened).
CUSTOM-B
Custom-B zone activated (opened).
+CU-FUSE
Control Unit Fuse trouble.
DELAY ALM
PA Delay Alarm zone activated after PA Delay timeout.
1. PA/duress
DL/SL ALM
PA Delayed Silent zone activated after PA Delay timeout.
1. PA/duress
DOOR PROP
MAX - Door left open
4. Security
DR MASKED
Detector masked. Activity monitoring of zone has failed.
15. Trouble
20. Fault
M
DUAL
Dual (Double Knock) zone activated (opened).
2. Intruder
M
NOTE:
NOTE:
NM
NM
M
M
M
NM
M = Mandatory. NM = Non-Mandatory
A plus (+) means an event has started. A negative (-) means an event has finished.
D-1
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Event Log (cont’d)
KEYPAD TEXT
DESCRIPTION
Trigger Event
DURESS
Duress code has been entered.
1. PA/Duress
M
ENG ASSEM
Engineering Assemble Zone menu (Menu Option 64) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
M
ENG CHECK
Engineering Pre-Check menu (Menu Option 66) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
M
ENG DIAG
Engineering Diagnostics menu (Menu Option 61) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
M
ENG DIGI
Engineering Digicom (Communications) (Menu Option 56) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
M
ENG GROUP
Engineering Groups (Menu Option 63) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
M
ENG KPAD
Engineering Keypad (Menu Option 58) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
M
ENG LINKS
Engineering Links (Menu Option 54) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
M
ENG O/PS
Engineering Outputs (Menu Option 53) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
M
ENG PARAM
Engineering Parameters (Menu Option 51) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
M
ENG PRINT
Engineering Print (Menu Option 57) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
M
ENG QUICK
Engineering Quick Menu (Menu Option 59) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
M
ENG SOAK
Engineering Soak Test (Menu Option 55) has been accessed
14. Menu Access
M
ENG TEST
Engineer Test of the system via the Telecom Module.
Always TR
ENG TMRS
Engineering Timers A/B (Menu Option 65) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
M
ENG ZONES
Engineering Zones (Menu Option 52) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
M
ENG TAMP
Tamper when entering Engineer Mode.
None
NM
+ENGINEER
Entering Engineer mode.
Always TR
NM
Leaving Engineer mode.
Always TR
NM
ENT DELAY
User entering Ent Delay State
None
NM
ENT SET
User entering Ent Set State
None
NM
ENT SETNG
User entering Setting State
None
NM
ENT UNSET
User entering Unset State
None
NM
ENT UNSTG
User entering Unsetting State
None
NM
+ENTRY
Entry zone activated (opened) during Setting/Unsetting procedure or when Set.
None
NM
–ENTRY
Entry zone de-activated (closed) during Setting/Unsetting procedure or when Set.
None
NM
ETST FAIL
Engineer test has failed
None
NM
ETST PASS
Engineer test has passed
None
NM
+EXIT
Exit zone activated (opened) during the Unsetting procedure or when Set.
2. Intruder
NM
–EXIT
Exit zone de-activated (closed) during the Unsetting procedure or when Set.
2. Intruder
NM
EXITGUARD
ExitGuard zone activated (opened).
16. Log
NM
EXTENSION
System or Group(s) are in the Autoset Extension period.
10. Setting
NM
FAIL SET
Fail to set event.
7. Set Fault
M
+FAULT
Fault condition activated on zone
20. Fault
M
–FAULT
Fault condition cleared from zone
20. Fault
M
FAULT RST
Fault has been cleared
20. Fault
NM
FB BATLOW
RF Fob has low battery
None
NM
–ENGINEER
NOTE:
NOTE:
M = Mandatory. NM = Non-Mandatory
A plus (+) means an event has started. A negative (-) means an event has finished.
D-2
NM
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
KEYPAD TEXT
Event Log (cont’d)
DESCRIPTION
Trigger Event
+FINAL
Final zone activated (opened) during Setting/Unsetting procedure or when Set.
7. Set Fault
NM
–FINAL
Final zone de-activated (closed) during Setting/Unsetting procedure or when Set.
7. Set Fault
NM
FIRE
Fire zone activated (opened).
6. Fire
M
FOB REJCT
Illegal fob
None
M
FORCE OMT
Force Omit of a zone (Menu Option 14).
8. Omit
M
FULL SET
Full Set (Menu Option 12) of the system or Group(s).
10. Setting
M
FULL TEST
Full Test (Menu Option 62) has occurred.
None
13. Elec. Status
20. Fault
9. Tamper
13. Elec. Fault
9. Tamper
13. Elec. Status
9. Tamper
13. Elec. Status
NM
M
FUSE 14.5
Fault with 14.5V fuse on Power Supply Unit
FUSE AUX1
Fault with AUX1 fuse on Power Supply Unit
FUSE AUX2
Fault with AUX2 fuse on Power Supply Unit
FUSE BELL
Fault with Bell Fuse on Power Supply Unit
+GRP OMIT
Group Omit has occurred (Group(s) has been omitted).
8. Omit
M
–GRP OMIT
Group Omit has finished (Group(s) has been un-omitted).
8. Omit
M
+HIGH RES
Zone changing to High Resistance (1200 to 1300 Ohm) Engineer Log only.
15. Trouble
M
–HIGH RES
Zone changing from High Resistance to Normal Closed (1300 to 1200 Ohm) Eng. Log only
15. Trouble
M
ILL -CODE
Illegal code entry
16. Log Zone
NM
+INST SET
Instant set of system or group
None
NM
INTRUDER
Intruder zone activated (opened)
2. Intruder
18. Zone restoral
M
INT DELAY
Intruder delay zone activated (opened)
None
M
INVALD CD
Invalid Code entered
None
NM
JAM DELAY
RF jam signal sent to panel
None
M
KEYSWITCH
Keyswitch zone activated (opened)
None
NM
KSW CANCL
Keyswitch Cancels alarm activation (system or Group(s) still Set).
11. Reset/Cancel
NM
KSW P/SET
Keyswitch part sets the system or group(s)
10. Setting
KSW RESET
Keyswitch resets the system or group(s)
None
KSW SET
Keyswitch full sets the system or group(s)
10. Setting
M
KSW UNSET
Keyswitch unsets the systems or group)s)
10. Setting
M
LATE SET
Late Set of the system or group(s)
10. Setting
NM
LEGAL CD
Legal code entered
16. Log Zone
NM
LF RESET
Line Fail Reset has occured
20. Fault
NM
LID TAMP
Lid Tamper alarm
9. Tamper
M
+LINE FAIL
Comms Module Line fail has occured or a Line Fail zone activated (opened)
–LINE FAIL
Comms Module Line fail has finished or a Line Fail zone de-activated (closed)
+LINK
Link zone activated (opened)
16. Log Zone
NM
–LINK
Link zone de-activated (closed)
16. Log Zone
NM
NOTE:
NOTE:
12. Modules/Comms
20. Fault
12. Modules/Comms
20. Fault
M = Mandatory. NM = Non-Mandatory
A plus (+) means an event has started. A negative (-) means an event has finished.
D-3
M
M
M
M
NM
M
M
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Event Log (cont’d)
KEYPAD TEXT
DESCRIPTION
Trigger Event
LOC WRITE
Diagnostics local write event
None
M
+LOCKTIMER
Lockout timer activated.
None
NM
–LOCKTIMER
Lockout timer de-activated.
None
NM
+LOG
Log zone activated (opened).
16. Log
NM
–LOG
Log zone de-activated (closed).
16. Log
NM
LOG 90%
Event log 90% full
Always TR
NM
LOG DELAY
Log Delay zone has been activated (opened) for longer than the Delay Alarm time.
16. Log
NM
+LOW RES
Zone changing to low resistance (900 to 800 Ohm).
15. Trouble
M
–LOW RES
Zone changing from Low Resistance to Normal Closed (800 to 900 Ohm).
15. Trouble
M
+LOW VOLTS
Voltage of AUX outputs has dropped below 10V.
13. Elec Status
15. Trouble
M
+MASK
Mask zone activated (opened).
4. Security
M
–MASK
Mask zone de-activated (closed).
4. Security
18. Zone restoral
M
MASKED
Zone masked. Detector has activated its masking output.
15. Trouble
20. Fault
M
MAX ALARM
MAX alarm — door forced.
4. Security
17. Max Tag
M
MAX TAMP
MAX Tamper
9. Tamper
M
MEM RESET
Memory Reset (Restart) to factory default settings (Cold Start).
13. Elec Status
+MISSING
Module Missing its AB (RS485) communications.
9. Tamper
M
–MISSING
Module that was Missing now has its AB (RS485) communications re-established.
9. Tamper
18. Zone restoral
M
MOD CODES
Modify Codes menu (Menu Option 42) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
M
MOD REM
Remote Servicing menu (Menu Option 47) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
NM
MOD SUMMR
Modify Summer menu (Menu Option 43) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
NM
MOD T/D
Modify Time/Date menu (Menu Option 42) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
M
MOD TMRS
Modify Timers Control menu (Menu Option 45) has been accessed.
14. Menu Access
NM
NEW T/D
New Time/Date after modification.
Always TR
M
OMIT ATM1
Omit all ATM1 zones.
8. Omit
M
OMIT ATM2
Omit all ATM2 zones.
8. Omit
M
OMIT ATM3
Omit all ATM3 zones.
8. Omit
M
OMIT ATM4
Omit all ATM4 zones.
8. Omit
M
OMIT VIBS
Mass omit of vibration zones.
8. Omit
M
OMIT ZONE
Omit zones menu (menu option 0 in Quick Menu or menu option 11 in Full Menu has been
accessed.
None
M
OMITTED
Zone has been omitted
8. Omit
M
OVERRIDE
Event has been overridden to set the system
None
M
OVWR SITE
Remote overwrite of the site has occured via Remote Servicing or RS232 module
None
M
P.AUDIBLE
PA Audible zone activated (opened).
None
NM
PA
PA zone activated (opened)
1. PA/Duress
NOTE:
NOTE:
M = Mandatory. NM = Non-Mandatory
A plus (+) means an event has started. A negative (-) means an event has finished.
D-4
NM
M
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
KEYPAD TEXT
Event Log (cont’d)
DESCRIPTION
Trigger Event
PA DEL/SL
PA Delayed Silent zone activated (opened).
1. PA/Duress
M
PA DELAY
PA Delayed zone activated (opened).
1. PA/Duress
M
PA RESET
PA Reset has occurred.
1. PA/Duress
NM
PA SILENT
PA Silent zone activated (opened).
1. PA/Duress
M
PA UNSET
PA Unset zone activated while group in unset condition.
1. PA/Duress
M
PART SET
Part Set of system or Group(s).
10. Setting
M
PF RESET
System has returned to the set status after a power failure.
20. Fault
NM
PREWARN
System or Group(s) in the Autoset Prewarning period.
None
NM
PRINT OC
Print On Command.
None
NM
PRINT OL
Print On Line, the automatic printing of the Event Log. Not to be confused with the
printer on-line message from a printer.
None
NM
+PRT ENTRY
Part Entry zone activated (opened).
2. Intruder
NM
–PRT ENTRY
Part Entry zone de-activated (closed).
2. Intruder
18. Zone restoral
NM
+PRT FINAL
Part Final zone activated (opened).
2. Intruder
NM
–PRT FINAL
Part Final zone de-activated (closed).
2. Intruder
18. Zone restoral
NM
+PSU FLT
Power Supply Unit fault
13. Elec. Status
20. Fault
M
PUSH SET
Push Set (Exit Terminator) zone activated (opened).
None
NM
R.TIMESET
Remote timeset.
None
NM
REARM
Rearm of system has occurred.
10. Setting
M
RECEN.SET
Recent Set. Alarm occured within 5 minutes of set.
2. Intruder
M
REM ABORT
Remote connection timeout.
None
NM
+REM CALL
Remote device connected.
14. menu access
NM
–REM CALL
Remote device disconnected.
14. Menu access
NM
REM COPY
Remote Copy of site details via SIA has occurred.
None
NM
REM FAIL
Remote failure after all retries.
None
NM
REM FIN
Remote connection finished.
None
NM
REM ID
Remote suite ID menu accessed.
None
NM
REM LOG
Remote log menu accessed.
None
NM
REM MSG
Remote message menu accessed.
None
NM
REM OVRWR
Remote Overwrite via SIA has occurred.
None
M
REM RESET
Remote reset menu accessed.
None
NM
REM TRY
First remote connection attempt logged.
None
NM
REM WR/RD
Diagnostics remote read/write
None
M
REMOVED
Engineer has Removed a module from the system.
9. Tamper
M
RF BATLOW
RF Battery low
13. Elec. Status
15. Trouble
20. Fault
M
RF JAM
RF signal jammed
15. Trouble
20. Fault
M
RF MEM!
RF RIO Non Volatile Memory failed
9. Tamper
M
RF SUPER
RF Supervision failure
19. RF Supervision
20. Fault
M
NOTE:
NOTE:
M = Mandatory. NM = Non-Mandatory
A plus (+) means an event has started. A negative (-) means an event has finished.
D-5
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Event Log (cont’d)
KEYPAD TEXT
DESCRIPTION
Trigger Event
RM ACCESS
Remote Access zone activated
14. Menu Access
+SEC FINAL
Security Final zone activated (opened)
4. Security
NM
M
-SEC FINAL
Security Final zone closed (closed)
4. Security
18. Zone restoral
M
+SECURITY
Security zone activated (opened).
4. Security
M
–SECURITY
Security zone de-activated (closed).
4. Security
18. Zone restoral
M
SET LOG
Set Log zone activated (opened) when the system or group(s) is set.
16. Log zone
M
SOAK TEST
Zone under Soak Test (Menu Option 55) activated when the system or group(s) is Set.
None
SPARE
Spare zone opened.
16. Log zone
NM
STANDLOW
Standby time for the battery is Low.
13. Elec status
SUSP. SET
Setting of system suspended
None
NM
SYS RESET
System Reset has occurred event.
11. Reset/Cancel
NM
TAG REJECTED
Rejected card
TAG VALID
Valid card
TAG HARD
ANTIPASSBACK
Hard APB
TAG SOFT
ANTIPASSBACK
Soft APB
TAG REJECT NOT
GRP MATCH
Rejected card - no group match
TAG REJECT GRP
SET
Rejected card - group set
TAG REJECT ILL
TIME
Rejected card - illegal time
+TAMP C/V
constant Voltage tamper event
9. Tamper
M
+TAMP O/C
Zone changing to Tamper Open Circuit (greater than 12,000 Ohm).
9. Tamper
M
–TAMP O/C
Zone changing from Tamper Open Circuit to Normal Closed (1200 to 900 Ohm).
9. Tamper
18. Zone restoral
M
M
M
TAMP RST
Tamper Reset of the system has occurred.
9. Tamper
NM
+TAMP S/C
Zone changing to Tamper Short Circuit (less than 800 Ohm).
9. Tamper
M
–TAMP S/C
Zone changing from Tamper Short Circuit (less than 800 Ohm). to Normal Closed (900 to 1200 Ohm).
9. Tamper
18. Zone restoral
M
+TAMPER
Tamper on a module activated (opened). A module is either a keypad, Galaxy RIO, Telecom Module
or RS232 Module.
9. Tamper
M
–TAMPER
Tamper on a module de-activated (closed). A module is either a keypad, Galaxy RIO, Telecom
Module or RS232 Module.
9. Tamper
18. Zone restoral
M
TEST O/P
Test Outputs menu (Menu Option 32) has been accessed.
None
TIMEOUT
Timeout alarm after the Entry Time has expired.
10. Setting
NM
+TIMER A
Timer A activated (on).
None
NM
–TIMER A
Timer A de-activated (off).
None
NM
+TIMER B
Timer B activated (on).
None
NM
–TIMER B
Timer B de-activated (off).
None
NM
T/O-BURGL
Timeout alarm after the Entry Time has expired (same as TIMEOUT but used as a SIA event).
2. Intruder
M
U/S EARLY
The Unset Early output has been activated before programmed time.
10. Setting
NM
UNSET
Unset of the system or Group(s).
10. Setting
M
URGENT
Urgent zone activated.
3. 24 Hours
M
VIBRATION
Vibration zone activated.
2. Intruder
16. Log Zone
NM
VIDEO
Video zone activated (opened).
2. Intruder
M
VID EXIT
Video Exit zone activated (opened).
2. Intruder
M
+WALK TEST
Walk Test has occurred.
14. Menu access
NM
–WALK TEST
Walk Test has finished.
14. Menu access
NM
M
WALL TAMP
Wall Tamper zone alarm.
9. Tamper
M
WRONG CD
Wrong Code alarm activation (6 consecutive wrong codes). This Requires a system reset.
9. Tamper
M
24 HOURS
24 Hours zone activated (opened).
3. 24 Hours
M
NOTE:
NOTE:
M = Mandatory. NM = Non-Mandatory
A plus (+) means an event has started. A negative (-) means an event has finished.
D-6
Data Storage
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Appendix E: Site Data Storage
Also referred to as the ‘dumpbox mode’, this function allows the Galaxy Dimension panel to emulate the
behaviour of an External RS232 module, which can then be attached to another Galaxy panel, including
Legacy panels of previous versions, to copy the programming data.
For the purposes of this document, the Galaxy panel in use is referred to as the Dimension panel. The panel to
which the Dimension panel is connected is referred to as the Legacy panel.
Preparing for Storage Mode
Prior to using the storage mode facility, the Dimension panel must be attached to the Legacy panel through the
RS485 line. It will be necessary to connect the A and B wires on line 2 of the Dimension panel to the same
wires on line 1 of the Legacy panel. It is not possible to substitute another line in either panel, the connection
must be as indicated.
If the Legacy panel and the Dimension panel are each independently powered, the + and – wires on the line
should NOT be connected. It is, however, possible to power either panel from the power supply of the other.
In this latter configuration, the + and – wires should be connected as normal.
While the Dimension panel is connected to the Legacy panel, the panels share the affected lines. If the Dimension panel is not itself in Storage mode, therefore, both panels will attempt to poll modules on these lines. It
should be assumed that any modules on line 2 of the Dimension panel, or on line 1 of the Legacy panel will
therefore be inoperable while this condition persists. Once the Dimension panel enters Storage mode, this
condition ceases to apply – the Legacy panel has full control over all modules on the line.
Enabling Storage Mode
On the Dimension panel, storage mode is enabled through the menu system as follows:
1.
Enter Engineer mode.
2.
Using a keypad NOT connected to line 2, enter menu 56.6.1.4=Communications.Int
RS232.Mode.Storage Mode.
3.
Press ent.
The display on the keypad used to activate storage mode will change to read STORAGE MODE \ [ESC]
to abort. From this point forward, the Dimension panel will appear to the Legacy panel as an external RS232
module connected to line 1. Additionally, at this point the Dimension panel will stop polling line 2, while the
Legacy panel should once again be able to poll modules on line 1.
E-1
Data Storage (cont’d)
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Using Storage Mode
On the Legacy panel, enter and leave Engineer mode, so the External RS232 module is recognised. Then reenter Engineer mode to use the storage mode facilities.
On the Legacy panel, enter menu 56.2.4=Communications.RS232.Copy/Overwrite.
To copy the programming data FROM the Legacy panel TO the Grade 3 panel, select 1=Copy Site. To
copy the programming data FROM the Grade 3 panel TO the Legacy panel, select 2=Overwrite Site.
Press 1 to start the copy procedure, or 2 to abort at any time. The copy procedure can also be aborted by
pressing esc on the Dimension panel; this exits Storage mode.
NOTE: The copy procedure is started as soon as the option is selected; neither panel requests confirmation
before proceeding.
During the copy procedure, the display on the affected keypad on the Dimension panel will show a message
indicating which data elements are being copied (Users, Parameters, etc).
Leaving Storage Mode
At any time, Storage mode can be exited by pressing esc on the Dimension panel. It is recommended that the
panels be separated before this is done, although doing so is not necessary. If the panels remain connected
while the Dimension panel is not in Storage mode, behaviour on line 2 of the Dimension panel and line 1 of the
Legacy panel cannot be guaranteed.
E-2
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Specifications
Appendix F: Specifications
Panel Specifications
Mechanical (all variants)
Enclosure (with PCB and transformer)
Physical space for batteries
Width: 440 mm
Height: 352 mm
Depth: 90 mm
Weight: 6.4 kg
2 x 17Ah Max (not suitable for 12Ah batteries)
PCB only
Width: 265 mm
Height: 120 mm
Depth: 47 mm
Weight: 0.3 kg
Operating temperature:
-10 deg.C to + 55 deg.C
Electrical
Mains input:
230V ac (+10%/-15%) @ 50 Hz
Power supply:
GD-48
Type A
Total capacity 1.5 A (0.75 A dedicated to battery)
Operating temperature: -10 deg.C to +40 deg.C
Power supply:
GD-96/264/520
Type A
Total capacity 3 A (1.5 A dedicated to battery)
Operating temperature: -10 deg.C to +40 deg.C
Auxiliary +12V outputs:
GD-48
12V nominal
0.5 A in total
50.0 mV maximum ripple
Auxiliary +12V outputs:
GD-96/264/520
12V nominal
1.0A in total
50.0 mV maximum ripple
Fuses
AUX1
AUX2
BELL
BATT GD-48
BATT GD-96/264/520
1.0A - 20 mm anti-surge
1.0A - 20 mm anti-surge
1.0A - 20 mm anti-surge
1.0A - 20 mm anti-surge
1.6A - 20 mm anti-surge
PSTN
RS232
RS485
V.22 Modem 1200 Baud
300 - 56k programmable
9600 Baud, Full Duplex, Asynchronous
F-1
Specifications (cont’d)
Modules
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Weight
Order Code
Galaxy Keypad (Mark VII)...................................................................... 190 g
Size: …………………………………................. 149 x 91 x 31 mm (L x B x H)
CP027
Galaxy Keyprox (Mark VII)..................................................................... 190 g
Size........................................................................ 149 x 91 x 31mm (L x B x H)
CP028
Keypads Material ...................................................................................
Keypad Colour .......................................................................................
PC + ABS
Neutral
Galaxy TouchCenter ....................................................................... 500 g
Size ............................................................. 182 x 128 x 34 mm (L x B x H)
CP040
MAX3 (Boxed)........................................................................................ 267 g
Size..................................................................... 185 x 120 x 48 mm (L x B x H)
MX03
Galaxy RIO (Boxed) .................................................................................300 g
Size: ......................................................................150 x 162 x 39 mm (L x B x H)
C072
Galaxy RF RIO (Boxed) ................................................................... 270 g
Size ............................................................. 150 x 162 x 39 mm (L x B x H)
C076
RS232 Module (Boxed) .......................................................................... 823 g
Size: .....................................................................180 x 155 x 35 mm (L x B x H)
E054
Door Control module (Boxed) No PSU ............................................... 270g
Size.................................................................... 150 x 162 x 39 mm (L x B x H)
C080
Door Control module (Boxed) with PSU ...............................................300g
Size.................................................................... 150 x 162 x 39 mm (L x B x H)
C081
Line Expander ......................................................................................... 820g
Size: .....................................................................180 x 155 x 35 mm (L x B x H)
A226
Doorguard ................................................................................................ 995g
Size: .....................................................................150 x 185 x 40 mm (L x B x H)
C075
Printer Interface (6-Way DIN Plug) ...................................................... 120 g
Printer Interface (25-Way D Plug) ........................................................ 130 g
Box Size: .............................................................. 75 x 52 x 28 mm (L x B x H)
Cable Size: ............ 2m for 4-Way IDC, and 0.3m for 6-Way/25-Way plug.
A134
A161
PCBs
Order Code
Weight
2-75A Power Block ................................................................................. 163 g
Size: .....................................................................115 x 102 x 33 mm (L x B x H)
A270
Galaxy Power RIO Control...................................................................... 118 g
Size: .....................................................................120 x 120 x 43 mm (L x B x H)
A250
Galaxy Power Unit Control..................................................................... 118 g
Size: .....................................................................120 x 120 x 43 mm (L x B x H)
A251
PSU Control.............................................................................................. 118 g
Size: .....................................................................120 x 120 x 43 mm(L x B x H)
A252
F-2
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Specifications (cont’d)
PCBs
Weight
GD-48...........................................................................................
320 g
Size:......................................................................265 x 120 x 50 mm (L x B x H)
Order Code
C048
GD-96 ............................................................................................
378 g
Size:.....................................................................265 x 120 x 50 mm (L x B x H)
C096
GD-264 ............................................................................................
378 g
Size:.....................................................................265 x 120 x 50 mm (L x B x H)
C264
GD-520 ............................................................................................
378 g
Size:.....................................................................265 x 120 x 50 mm (L x B x H)
C520
Galaxy RIO ............................................................................... ....... 92 g
A158
Size: .............................................................................. 121 x 90 x 15 mm (L x B x H)
Galaxy RF RIO .......................................................................... ....... 63 g
A215
Size: ............................................................................. 121 x 97 x 12 mm (L x B x H)
RS232 ...................................................................................................... 124 g
A169
Size: .............................................................................. 135 x 90 x 17 mm (L x B x H)
Telecom .................................................................................... ....... 90 g
E062
Size: .............................................................................. 121 x 90 x 20 mm (L x B x H)
Ethernet .................................................................................... ....... 56 g
E080
Size: .............................................................................. 121 x 90 x 15mm (L x B x H)
ISDN ........................................................................................ ..... 114 g
A211
Size: .............................................................................. 121 x 90 x 15 mm (L x B x H)
Audio Interface Module .......................................................... ..... 135 g
Size: .............................................................................. 121 x 122 x 17 mm (L x B x H)
Note: The above weights and order codes are from the populated Printed Circuit Board (PCB) only.
F-3
Specifications (cont’d)
Device
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Quiescent Current
(mA)
Device
Quiescent Current
(mA)
GD-48
100
4-Way Relay Interface
(C037)
160
GD-96
110
General Purpose
Relay Interface (A060)
40
GD-264
110
Galaxy Mk 7 (LCD)
Keypad (P037-02)
70
GD-520
150
Key Prox (C038-02)
90
Galaxy RIO (C072)
(Note 1)
30
Touch Center
(CP040-02)
105
RF RIO (C076)
55
Printer Interface
(A134/A161)
100
Power RIO (P026)
100
Doorguard (C075)
10
Telecom Module (E062)
(Note 2)
45
Max 3 Reader (MX03)
35
Audio Interface Module
(C084)
60
MicroMAX (MX11)
25
RS232 Module (E054,
E055)
50
Door Control Module
(C080)
15
MUX Module (C085)
60
ISDN Module (A211)
40
Speaker-mic Unit
(TP2-800GY)
10
Ethernet (E080-2)
155
Table F-1 Current Consumption
Note 1: Measured with no load on zone input
Note 2: Not communicating
F-4
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Approvals
Appendix G: Declaration of Conformity
Compliance and Approvals
The Galaxy Dimension control panels are compatible with the relevant parts of the following standards:
•
PD6662:2003
Scheme for the application of European Standards for intruder alarm
systems.
•
EN50131-1:2003 Draft 9d
Alarm systems - Intrusion systems - General requirements (grade 3).
•
TS50131-3
Alarm systems - Intrusion systems: Part 3 Control and indicating
equipment (grade 3).
•
prEN50131-5-3
Alarm systems - Intrusion systems: Part 5-3 systems using wire-free
interconnections (grade 2).
•
EN50131-6:1998
Alarm systems - Intrusion systems - Power supplies (grade 3).
•
EN50136-1-1:1998
Alarm systems - Alarm transmission systems and equipment - General
requirements for alarm transmission systems.
•
EN50136-1-3:1998
Alarm systems - Alarm transmission systems and equipment Requirementsf or systems with digital communicators using the public
switched telephone network.
•
EN50136-2-1:1998
Alarm systems - Alarm transmission systems and equipment - General
requirements for alarm transmission equipment.
•
EN50136-2-3:1998
Alarm systems - Alarm transmission systems and equipment Requirements for equipment used in systems with digital communicators
using the public switched telephone network.
•
CE Standards, including all EN safety and EMC standards.
•
R&TTE 99/5/EC
•
BS6799:1986
Code of practice for wire-free intruder alarm systems.
•
DD243:2002
Installation and configuration of intruder alarm systems designed to
generate confirmed alarm conditions - code of practice.
•
BSIA Guidelines for Remote Maintenance to systems installed to EN50131-1
G-1
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Approvals (cont’d)
EN50131 Compliance
This product is suitable for use in systems designed to comply with PD6662: 2004 and EN50131-1: 2006
Security Grade: 3
Environmental Class: II
Power Supply Type: A
The built-in Telecom module is for Remote Servicing use only on Grade 3 systems. An external Grade 3
communicator or Ethernet module must be used for alarm signalling.
The built-in Telecom module can be used for alarm signalling on Grade 2 systems:
Alarm Transmission System: 2 (options A, B, C & X)
This product is suitable for use in systems designed to comply with EN50131-1: 1997
Security Grade: 2
Environmental Class: II
Alarm Transmission System: 2 (options D2, T2, A2, S0, I0)
Power Supply Type: A
PD6662 Compliance
This product is suitable for use in systems designed to comply with PD6662: 2004 at grade 3 and environmental class II.
Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) approval
The equipment has been approved to Council Decision 98/482/EC for Pan -European single terminal connection to the Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN). However due to differences between the individual
PSTNs provided in different countries the approval does not, of itself, give an unconditional assurance of
successful operation on every PSTN network termination point.
In the event of problems contact the equipment supplier in the first instance.
The Galaxy is designed to interwork with the following networks:
Austria
France
Italy
Norway
Switzerland
Belgium
Greece
Liechtenstein
Portugal
United Kingdom
Denmark Iceland
Luxembourg
Spain
* Germany
Finland
Ireland
The Netherlands Sweden
* May have interworking difficulties.
NOTE: Contact the equipment supplier before using the Galaxy on any network not listed.
G-2
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Parts List Index
Appendix H: Parts List Index
P rodu ct N am e
U K P art No
Com m e nts
R epla ce m e nt P CB ,s
G D- 48 P CB
G D- 96 P CB
G D- 26 4 PC B
G D- 52 0 PC B
With exp a nd e r
Ac c es s ories
D oo rg ua r d
C 07 5
D oo rg ua r d co mm on ke y
C 07 5 C
E n gi ne e r ke yp a d ca b le
Tw iste d p ai r 4- co re c ab le
S e ria l P er ip he ra l i nte rfac e
Key
A136
W 0 02
A227
Doo r i sol atio n
Uni t
Al l use sa me
key
P S U’s
G a la xy Po we r U ni t
G a la xy Po we r R IO
E N G 3 P S U S ta nd -a lo ne
2 -7 5 A P o we r B loc k
G a la xy Po we r R IO
C on tro l P CB
G a la xy Po we r U ni t
C on tro l
P S U Co n tr ol
P025
P026
P027
A270
A250
Sp a re P C B
Sp a re P C B
A251
Sp a re P C B
A252
Sp a re P C B
K ey pa d/Ke yP rox
G a la xy Mk7 Ke yp a d
C P 03 7
G a la xy Mk7 Ke yP ro x
C P 03 8
G a la xy Ke yP ro x HID
A S K p ro x ca rd cla msh el l
H ID pr ox ca rd
A S K K e ytag
A S K G r ey Fo b
To u ch C en ter
C P 02 8 -0 1- H-B
Y X 0 -0 00 5
Y X 0 -0 00 6
Y X 0 -0 00 4
Y X 0 -0 02 0
C P 04 0
R em ot e M odule s
R IO (P C B)
R IO (b o xe d)
Te le co m Mo d ul e
R S2 3 2 M od ul e
R S2 3 2 M od ul e ( bo xe d)
P ri nte r Inte rfa ce
A 1 5 8- B
C 07 2
E 0 6 2- 01
E055
E054
A134
P ri nte r Inte rfa ce
A161
IS DN M od u le
E the rn e t M o du le
R F RIO ( b oxe d )
R F RIO ( P CB )
A u di o Co n tr ol le r
S p ea ke r-m ic Un it
E077
E 0 8 0- 2
C 07 6
A215
C 08 0
T P2 -8 0 0G Y
Ac c es s Cont rol
M AX Re a de r
M AX Fl ush mo u ntin g k it
M AX 3 P ro ximi ty R ea d er
M AX 3 van d al re sistan t
co ve r
M AX 3 exte n sio n re a d
h e ad
M AX 3 ha n d- he ld
p ro g ra mm er
M AX 3 Mo un tin g p la te
M AX ca rd with ma gn e ti c
str ipe
With vol um e
con tro l
AS K for ma t w ith
vol um e co n tr ol
AS K /HID for ma t
Cre di t c ar d
Cre di t c ar d
Tea r d ro p
P roduc t N am e
U K P art N o
M AX ca rd
M AX ke ytag
M AX p ro gr am mi ng
m od u le
D oo r Co n tr ol mo du le
D oo r Co n tr ol Mo du le with
P CU
S P I K e y Pr og r am me r
Y X 0 -0 00 2
Y X 0 -0 00 4
Y X 0 -0 00 7
C 08 7
S of tw a re P ac k ag es :
R em ot e S e rvic ing S uite
L ice n cin g K it
U pg ra de
L ice n ce K it (Do n gl e)
U pg ra de (D on g le )
R 03 0 KIT
R 03 0 -CD
R 03 1 -0 1- K IT
R 03 1 -CD
U se r Ma na gem e nt Su it e
L ice n ce K it
U pg ra de
L ice n ce K it (Do n gl e)
U pg ra de (D on g le )
R 03 2 -0 1- K IT
R 03 2 -CD
R 03 3 -0 1- K IT
R 03 3 -CD
Lit era ture
G a la xy Dim en sio n
In stal ler ma nu a l
G a la xy Dim en sio n Use r
G u id e
G a la xy Dim en sio n Qu ick
U ser G u id e
G a la xy Dim en sio n Qu ick
S tar t G u id e
D oo r Co n tr ol Mo du le
In stru ction s
A u di o Co n tr ol le r
In stru ction s
To u ch C en ter In stru ctio n s
To u ch C en ter Use r G ui de
6 p in D IN
con n ecto r
25 wa y s ub D
con n ecto r
M X 01
M X 02
M X 03
M X 03 -V RC
M X 03 -E RH
M X 03 -H P
M X 03 -M P
Y X 0 -0 00 1
H-1
C 08 0
C 08 1
IE 1 -0 06 3
IU 1- 00 6 3
IG 1 -0 06 4
IG 1 -0 06 3
II1 -0 80 0
II1 -0 80 1
II1 -0 80 2
II8 -0 80 3
Com m e nts
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
H-2
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Index
K
A
Access Control
Addressing the RF RIO
Appendix A: Library
Appendix B: SIA and
Contact ID Event Codes
Appendix C: SIA Event
Structure
Appendix D: Event Log
Appendix E: Site Data
Appendix F: Specifications
Appendix G: Declaration
of Conformity
Appendix H: Parts List
Index
Audio Interface Module
5-1
3-5
A-1
C-1
D-1
E-1
F-1
G-1
H-1
3-13
2-7
3-6
3-2
2-6
2-5
3-2
3-4
3-6
5-2
E
Engineer Mode
Ethernet Module
Event Monitoring
6-2
3-12
3-17
F
Full Menu
6-1
G
Galaxy Mk7 Keypad
Galaxy Keyprox
4-1
4-8
H
I
Introduction
ISDN Module
J
2-6
M
MAX3
Memory
Menu options
Menu Access
Mux Module
5-7
2-8
6-1
6-1
3-15
N
1-1
3-11
Option 65–Timers
Option 66– Pre-checks
Option 67–Remote Reset
Option 68–Menu Access
Option 69–Integrated
Access Control
Option 71–SPI Key
Outputs
Output Applications
6-168
6-175
6-176
6-177
6-178
6-192
2-16
2-17
P
PCB Layout
Peripherals
Power Supply Unit
Power Consumption
Printer Interface Module
2-2
3-1
3-7
4-1
3-10
Q
O
D
Door Control Module
L
B-1
C
Configuring the RF RIO
Configuring the RIO
Connecting Additional
Telecoms apparatus
Connecting the Galaxy
Dimension to the PSTN
Connecting the RIO
Connecting the RF RIO
Configuring the RF RIO
Keypad/Keyprox Installation
Procedure
4-2
Keypad/Keyprox Operation4-5
Line Monitoring
B
Battery Start-up
Index
On-board P S U
2-7
Option 11–Omit Zones
6-11
Option 12–Timed Set
6-13
Option 13–Part Set
6-13
Option 14–Forced Set
6-13
Option 15–Chime
6-13
Option 16–Instant Set
6-13
Option 17–Silent Part
6-14
Option 18–Home Set
6-14
Option 19–All Set
6-14
Option 21–Display Zones 6-15
Option 22–Display log
6-16
Option 23–System
6-17
Option 24–Print
6-18
Option 25–Access Doors 6-19
Option 31–Walk Test
6-23
Option 32–Outputs
6-25
Option 41–Time/Date
6-26
Option 42–Codes
6-27
Option 43–Summer
6-38
Option 44–Trace
6-38
Option 45–Timer control
6-39
Option 46–Group Omit
6-43
Option 47–Remote Access 6-44
Option 48–Engineer Access 6-50
Option 51–Parameters
6-51
Option 52–Program Zones 6-71
Option 53–Program
Outputs
6-87
Option 54–Links
6-104
Option 55–Soak
6-107
Option 56 –
Communications
6-108
Option 57–System Print
6-151
Option 58–Keypad
6-152
Option 59–Quick Menu
6-155
Option 61–Diagnostics
6-156
Option 62–Full Test
6-159
Option 63–Options
6-160
Option 64–Assemble Zone 6-164
1
Quick Setup
Quick Menu
1-3
6-1
R
Remote Servicing Suite
3-17
RF RIO
3-4
RF RIO Programming
3-6
RIO Outputs
3-3
RS 485 Data Communication
Bus (AB Lines)
2-8
RS485 Expansion module 2-3
RS485 Wiring
Configurations
2-8
RS485 Wiring
Recommendations
2-9
S
Self Diagnostics
Setting Options
SPI Header
Stand-by Battery
System Architecture
System Installation
and Wiring
System Operation
4-5
6-5
2-19
2-7
2-1
2-4
6-1
T
Time Schedules
Touch Center
Trigger header
5-1
4-9
2-18
U
User and Access Templates 5-1
User Management Suite
3-17
V
Variants
1-1
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Index (cont’d)
W
Wiring Keypad/Keyprox
Wiring Keyswitches
Wiring Multiple Detectors
Wiring Terminator Buttons
Wiring Zones
4-2
2-15
2-15
2-16
2-13
X
Y
Z
Zones
Zone addresses
2-11
2-11
2
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
3
Galaxy Dimension Installer Manual
Honeywell Security (UK 64)
Newhouse Industrial Estate
Motherwell
Lanarkshire
ML1 5SB
UK
IE1-0063 Rev 1.0
© Copyright Honeywell Security
4
Was this manual useful for you? yes no
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the work of artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Download PDF

advertisement